Uploaded by SAHIL GUPTA 11BEM0072

Human Resource Management 13th Edition

advertisement
Human Resource
Management
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd i
20/07/10 6:25 PM
Human Resource
Management
THIRTEENTH EDITION
R OBE RT L . M AT H I S
University of Nebraska at Omaha
JOHN H. JACKSON
University of Wyoming
Australia • Brazil • Japan • Korea • Mexico • Singapore • Spain • United Kingdom • United States
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd iii
20/07/10 6:25 PM
This is an electronic version of the print textbook. Due to electronic rights
restrictions, some third party content may be suppressed. Editorial
review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially
affect the overall learning experience. The publisher reserves the
right to remove content from this title at any time if subsequent
rights restrictions require it. For valuable information on pricing, previous
editions, changes to current editions, and alternate formats, please visit
www.cengage.com/highered to search by ISBN#, author, title, or keyword
for materials in your areas of interest.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
Human Resource Management,
13th Edition
Robert L. Mathis
John H. Jackson
Vice President of Editorial, Business:
Jack W. Calhoun
Publisher: Joseph Sabatino
Sr. Acquisitions Editor: Michele Rhoades
Sr. Developmental Editor: Susanna C. Smart
Sr. Editorial Assistant: Ruth Belanger
Marketing Manager: Clint Kernen
Content Project Manager: Corey Geissler
Media Editor: Rob Ellington
Sr. Frontlist Buyer, Manufacturing:
Kevin Kluck
© 2011, 2009 South-Western, Cengage Learning
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. No part of this work covered by the copyright
herein may be reproduced, transmitted, stored or used in any form
or by any means graphic, electronic, or mechanical, including but not
limited to photocopying, recording, scanning, digitizing, taping, Web
distribution, information networks, or information storage and retrieval
systems, except as permitted under Section 107 or 108 of the 1976
United States Copyright Act, without the prior written permission of
the publisher.
For product information and technology assistance, contact us at
Cengage Learning Customer & Sales Support, 1-800-354-9706
For permission to use material from this text or product,
submit all requests online at www.cengage.com/permissions
Further permissions questions can be emailed to
permissionrequest@cengage.com
Production Service: Integra
Sr. Art Director: Tippy McIntosh
Library of Congress Control Number: 2010930409
Internal and Cover Designer: c miller design
Student Edition ISBN-13: 978-0-538-45315-8
Student Edition ISBN-10: 0-538-45315-X
Cover Image: © John Foxx, Stockbyte,
Getty Images
Sr. Rights Acquisitions Specialist, Images:
Deanna Ettinger
Rights Acquisitions Specialist, Text: Mardell
Glinski Schultz
South-Western Cengage Learning
5191 Natorp Boulevard
Mason, OH 45040
USA
For your course and learning solutions, visit www.cengage.com
Purchase any of our products at your local college store or at our
preferred online store www.cengagebrain.com
Printed in the United States of America
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14 13 12 11 10
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd iv
20/07/10 6:25 PM
Dedications
TO
Jo Ann Mathis
for managing efforts on this book, and
Julie Foster and Lee Skoda as key supporters.
R. D. and M. M. Jackson,
who were successful managers of people for many years
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd v
20/07/10 6:25 PM
Contents in Brief
Preface xxv
SECTION 1
Chapter 1
Chapter 2
Chapter 3
SECTION 2
Chapter
Chapter
Chapter
Chapter
4
5
6
7
SECTION 3
Chapter 8
Chapter 9
Chapter 10
SECTION 4
Chapter 11
Chapter 12
Chapter 13
SECTION 5
Chapter 14
Chapter 15
Chapter 16
Environment of Human Resource Management 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning 36
Equal Employment Opportunity 72
Jobs and Labor 107
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 108
Human Resource Planning and Retention 144
Recruiting and Labor Markets 176
Selecting Human Resources 212
Training and Development 247
Training Human Resources 248
Talent Management 282
Performance Management and Appraisal 318
Compensation 357
Total Rewards and Compensation 358
Incentive Plans and Executive Compensation 394
Managing Employee Benefits 424
Employee Relations 465
Risk Management and Worker Protection 466
Employee Rights and Responsibilities 502
Union/Management Relations 538
Appendices 575
Appendix A
Appendix B
Appendix C
Appendix D
Human Resource Certification Institute: PHR and SPHR Test
Specifications 575
HR Management Resources 581
Major Federal Equal Employment Opportunity Laws and
Regulations 585
Uniform Guidelines on Employee Selection 587
vii
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd vii
20/07/10 6:25 PM
viii
CONTENTS IN BRIEF
Appendix E
Appendix F
Appendix G
EEO Enforcement 591
Preemployment Inquiries 595
Sample HR-Related Job Descriptions 599
Glossary 601
Author Index 609
Subject Index 615
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd viii
20/07/10 6:25 PM
ix
Contents
Preface xxv
S E C T I O N
1
Environment of Human Resource Management 1
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management
in Organizations 2
HR Headline: The Challenges and Crises
Facing HR Management 3
Human Resources as Organizational Core
Competency 4
Human Capital and HR 5
HR Functions 5
HR Management’s Contributing Role 7
Organizational Culture and HR 7
Organizational Productivity 9
Social Responsibilities and HR 10
HR Perspective: “Growing Green”
in HR 11
Customer Service and Quality Linked to
HR 11
Employee Engagement and HR
Culture 12
Organizational Ethics and HR
Management 12
Ethical Behavior and Organizational
Culture 13
HR Best Practices: Cisco Makes
Global Ethics Important and Fun 14
Ethics and Global Differences 14
HR’s Role in Organizational Ethics 15
Current and Future HR Management
Challenges 16
Organizational Cost Pressures
and Restructuring 16
Economics and Job Changes 16
Globalization of Organizations
and HR 19
Workforce Demographics and
Diversity 20
HR Technology 21
HR Online: Wikis, Blogs, Twitters,
and HR 22
Measuring HR Impact through Metrics 23
Managing HR in Organizations 23
Smaller Organizations and HR
Management 23
HR Cooperation with Operating and Line
Managers 24
How HR Is Seen in Organizations 24
HR Management Roles 25
Administrative Role of HR 26
Operational and Employee Advocate
Role for HR 27
Strategic Role for HR 27
HR Management Competencies and
Careers 28
HR Competencies 28
HR Management as a Career Field 28
HR Professionalism and Certification 29
ix
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd ix
20/07/10 6:25 PM
x
CONTENTS
Summary 31
Global Staffing 49
Critical Thinking Activities 32
HR Planning in Mergers and
Acquisitions 50
HR Experiential Problem Solving 32
Case: HR, Culture, and Business
Results Success at Google, Scripps,
and UPS 33
Supplemental Cases: Phillips Furniture;
Sysco 34
Notes 34
Before the Deal 50
During Integration 51
Post Integration 52
HR Perspective: Dow’s Formula
for Successful Acquisitions 52
Strategic Challenges 53
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management
and Planning 36
HR Headline: Strategic Utilization
of Talent Benefits Health Care
Organization 37
Managing a Talent Surplus 54
Legal Considerations for Workforce
Reductions 55
Managing a Talent Shortage 56
Technology Challenges 57
Effects on Work and
Organizations 57
Effects on Communication 58
Strategic Planning 38
Strategy Formulation 39
HR as Organizational Contributor 41
High-Performance Work Practices 42
HR Effectiveness and Financial
Performance 43
Environmental Analysis 43
HR Perspective: Numbers Add Up
for IBM 44
Internal Environmental Analysis 44
External Environmental Analysis 45
HR Perspective: Verizon Engages
Employees via Web Portal 59
Effects on Work Processes 59
Effects on HR Activities 60
Measuring Effectiveness of HR
Initiatives 61
HR Metrics 61
HR and Benchmarking 63
HR and the Balanced
Scorecard 63
Human Capital Effectiveness
Measures 64
HR Audit 66
HR Best Practices: NASA Launches
Workforce Realignment 47
Summary 66
Global Competitiveness and Strategic
HR 48
HR Experiential Problem
Solving 67
Global Framework 48
Global Legal and Regulatory
Factors 48
Offshoring 49
Case: Pioneers in HR Analytics 68
Critical Thinking Activities 67
Supplemental Cases: Where Do You
Find the Bodies?; Xerox 69
Notes 69
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd x
20/07/10 6:25 PM
xi
CONTENTS
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity 72
HR Headline: Sexual Harassment at the
United Nations 73
Nature of Equal Employment Opportunity
(EEO) 74
Disparate Treatment 75
Disparate Impact 75
Equal Employment Opportunity Concepts 76
Progressing Toward Equal Employment
Opportunity 77
HR Perspective: “Officer Dirt” 78
Race/Ethnic/National Origin 78
Civil Rights Act 1964, Title VII 78
Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478 79
Civil Rights Act 1991 79
Managing Racial and National Origin
Issues 79
Affirmative Action 80
Managing Affirmative Action
Requirements 81
Sex/Gender Discrimination Laws
and Regulations 82
Pregnancy Discrimination 82
Equal Pay and Pay Equity 83
Sexual Harassment 83
Managing Sex/Gender Issues 84
Individuals with Differing Sexual
Orientations 86
Nepotism 86
Consensual Relationships and Romance
at Work 86
Dealing with Sexual Harassment 87
Types of Sexual Harassment 88
Employer Responses to Sexual
Harassment 88
Harassment Likelihood 89
Individuals with Disabilities 90
Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) 90
Who Is Disabled? 90
Genetic Bias Regulations 91
Managing Disabilities in the
Workforce 92
HR On-the-Job: ADA and Employment
Questions 93
Age and Equal Employment
Opportunity 94
Age Discrimination in Employment Act
(ADEA) 95
Older Workers Benefit Protection Act
(OWBPA) 95
Managing Age Discrimination 95
Religion and Spirituality in the
Workplace 96
Managing Religious Diversity 96
Managing Other Discrimination Issues 97
Immigration Reform and Control Acts
(IRCA) 97
Language Issues 98
Military Status and USERRA 98
Sexual Orientation 99
Appearance and Weight Discrimination 99
HR Perspective: Discrimination against
“Caregivers” 100
Family Responsibility Discrimination (FRD) 100
Diversity Training 100
Components of Traditional Diversity
Training 101
Mixed Results for Diversity Training 101
Backlash against Diversity Training
Efforts 101
Summary 102
Critical Thinking Activities 102
HR Experiential Problem Solving 103
Case: Religious Accommodation? 103
Supplemental Cases: Keep on Trucking;
Mitsubishi Believes in EEO—Now 104
Notes 104
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xi
20/07/10 6:25 PM
xii
CONTENTS
S E C T I O N
2
Jobs and Labor 107
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job
Analysis 108
HR Headline: Work-Life Balancing 109
Workforce Composition 110
Business Contribution of Diverse
Workers 110
Race and Ethnicity 111
Preparing for and Introducing the Job
Analysis 129
Conducting the Job Analysis 129
Developing Job Descriptions and Job
Specifications 129
Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions
and Job Specifications 129
Job Analysis Methods 129
HR Best Practices: Resolving Language
Barriers Pays Off 112
Observation 130
Interviewing 130
Questionnaires 130
Computerized Job Analysis Systems 131
Combination Methods 131
Generational Differences 113
Gender Workforce Diversity 113
HR Online: O*Net Resources
for Employers 132
Nature of Jobs and Work 114
Job Analysis and O*Net 132
Work Flow Analysis 114
Job Design 116
Behavioral and Legal Aspects of Job
Analysis 133
Workers and Job Design 117
Common Approaches to Job Design 118
Characteristics of Jobs 118
Using Worker Teams in Jobs 119
Current Incumbent Emphasis 133
“Inflation” of Jobs and Job Titles 133
Employee and Managerial Anxieties 133
Legal Aspects of Job Analysis 134
Jobs and Work Scheduling 121
Job Descriptions and Job Specifications 135
Telework 121
Work Schedule Alternatives 122
HR On-The-Job: Writing Job
Descriptions 136
HR Perspective: Global Work Schedule
Differences 123
Job Descriptions 136
Job Specifications 136
Performance Standards 136
Job Description Components 137
Work Flexibility and Scheduling 124
Job Analysis 124
Purposes of Job Analysis 125
Job Analysis Responsibilities 126
Task-Based Job Analysis 126
Competency-Based Job Analysis 127
Summary 139
Critical Thinking Activities 139
HR Experiential Problem Solving 139
Case: ROWE and Flexible Work and Success at
Best Buy 140
Implementing Job Analysis 128
Supplemental Cases: The Reluctant Receptionist;
Jobs and Work at R.R. Donnelley 141
Planning the Job Analysis 128
Notes 141
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xii
20/07/10 6:25 PM
xiii
CONTENTS
CHAPTER 5
Drivers of Retention 164
Human Resource Planning
and Retention 144
HR Perspective: Global Retention 166
HR Headline: Need More Workers? 145
Retention Assessment and Metrics 168
Human Resource Planning 146
HR On-the-Job: Conducting Exit
Interviews 170
Organizational Size and HR Planning 146
HR Best Practices: Effective HR Planning
for Workforce Future 147
Managing Retention 168
Retention Evaluation and Follow-Up 170
Summary 171
HR Planning Process 147
Critical Thinking Activities 171
Assessing the External Workforce 148
HR Experiential Problem Solving 172
Economic and Governmental Factors 149
Competitive Evaluations 149
Changing Workforce Considerations 149
Case: Accenture—Retaining for Itself 172
Assessing the Internal Workforce 150
Notes 173
Current and Future Jobs Audit 150
Employee and Organizational Capabilities
Inventory 150
CHAPTER 6
HR Online: Technology Expanding Employee
Skills Database 151
Forecasting HR Supply and Demand 152
Forecasting Methods and Periods 152
Forecasting the Demand for Human
Resources 153
Forecasting the Supply of Human
Resources 153
Individual Workers and Organizational
Relationships 155
Psychological Contract 155
Individual Employee Performance and
Motivation 156
Nature of Job Satisfaction 158
Employee Turnover 159
Types of Employee Turnover 160
Measuring Employee Turnover 161
HR Metrics: Determining Turnover Costs 162
Retention of Human Resources 163
Myths and Realities about Retention 163
Supplemental Cases: The Clothing Store;
Alegent Health 173
Recruiting and Labor
Markets 176
HR Headline: Passive Recruiting Becomes
Active 177
Recruiting 178
Strategic Recruiting and HR Planning 178
Training of Recruiters and Managers 179
Labor Markets 179
Labor Market Components 180
Different Labor Markets and Recruiting 181
Strategic Recruiting Decisions 183
Recruiting Presence and Image 183
HR Best Practices: Effective Recruitment
at USDA 184
Organization-Based versus Outsourced
Recruiting 184
Regular versus Flexible Staffing 185
Recruiting and EEO: Diversity
Considerations 186
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xiii
20/07/10 6:25 PM
xiv
CONTENTS
Realistic Job Previews 188
Recruiting Source Choices: Internal versus
External 188
General Recruiting Process Metrics 205
Increasing Recruiting Effectiveness 207
Internet Recruiting 188
Critical Thinking Activities 208
E-Recruiting Means 188
Recruiting and Internet Social
Networking 189
HR Experiential Problem Solving 208
HR On-the-Job: Effective Recruiting Using
an Employer Website 190
Recruiting Using Special Technology
Means 190
Legal Issues in Internet Recruiting 191
Advantages of Internet Recruiting 192
Disadvantages of Internet Recruiting 193
External Recruiting Sources 193
Media Sources 193
Competitive Recruiting Sources 195
Employment Agencies 195
Labor Unions 195
HR Perspective: Outplacement Firms as
Recruiting Sources 196
Job Fairs and Creative Recruiting 196
Educational Institutions and Recruiting 197
Summary 208
Case: Recruiting at Kia 209
Supplemental Cases: Northwest State College;
Enterprise Recruiting 210
Notes 210
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources 212
HR Headline: Using Virtual Worlds for
Selection 213
Selection and Placement 214
Placement 214
Selection, Criteria, Predictors, and Job
Performance 215
Validity 216
Combining Predictors 218
Selection Responsibilities 218
The Selection Process 219
HR On-the-Job: Internships as a Part of
College Recruiting 198
Applicant Job Interest 220
Preemployment Screening 221
Internal Recruiting Methods 198
HR Perspective: Cheating on Electronic
Assesments 222
Internal Recruiting Databases and InternetRelated Sources 199
Job Posting 200
HR Perspective: Enhancing Opportunities
for Internal Promotion 201
Employee-Focused Recruiting 201
Recruiting Evaluation and Metrics 202
Evaluating Recruiting Quantity and
Quality 203
Evaluating Recruiting Satisfaction 204
Evaluating the Time Required to Fill
Openings 204
Evaluating the Cost of Recruiting 205
Application Forms 222
Immigration Verification 225
Selection Testing 225
Ability Tests 226
Personality Tests 227
Honesty/Integrity Tests 228
Controversies in Selection Testing 228
Selection Interviewing 229
Inter-Rater Reliability and Face Validity 229
Structured Interviews 230
Less-Structured Interviews 231
Who Conducts Interviews? 232
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xiv
20/07/10 6:25 PM
xv
CONTENTS
Effective Interviewing 232
Problems in the Interview 234
Selection Process for Global Assignments 239
HR Perspective: Common Interview
Mistakes 235
Defining Who Is an Applicant 240
Applicant Flow Documentation 241
Selecting for “Soft Skills” 241
Legal Concerns in the Selection Process 240
Background Investigations 235
Negligent Hiring and Retention 235
Legal Constraints on Background
Investigations 236
Medical Examinations and Inquiries 237
References 237
Making the Job Offer 238
Summary 241
Critical Thinking Activities 242
HR Experiential Problem Solving 242
Case: Full Disclosure on Sex Offenders? 243
Global Staffing Issues 238
Supplemental Cases: Strategic Selection: A
Review of Two Companies; Selecting
a Programmer 243
Types of Global Employees 238
Notes 244
S E C T I O N
3
Training and Development 247
CHAPTER 8
Training Human Resources 248
HR On-the-Job: Planning for New Employee
Orientation 258
Evaluating Orientation and Metrics 259
HR Headline: China’s Need for Training 249
Training and HR 250
Training Needs Assessment 260
Training Categories 250
Legal Issues and Training 251
Analysis of Training Needs 260
Establishing Training Objectives
and Priorities 262
Organizational Strategy and Training 252
Training Design 263
Strategic Training 252
Organizational Competitiveness and
Training 253
Learner Characteristics 263
Instructional Strategies 265
Transfer of Training 266
HR Perspective: Business Education
at Work 255
Training Delivery 266
Training for Global Strategies 256
Global Assignment Training 256
Intercultural Competence Training 256
Planning for Training 257
Orientation: Planning for New Employees 258
Internal Training 267
HR Perspective: Cross Training “Universal
Agents” 269
External Training 270
Combination Training Approaches 271
E-Learning: Online Training 272
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xv
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xvi
CONTENTS
HR Perspective: Simulations and Games 273
Training Evaluation 274
Levels of Evaluation 275
Training Evaluation Metrics 276
Training Evaluation Designs 277
Summary 278
Critical Thinking Activities 279
HR Experiential Problem Solving 279
Case: 21st-Century Onboarding 279
Supplemental Cases: Training Crucial for Hotels;
New Payroll Clerk 280
Notes 280
HR On-the-Job: Handling Global
Dual-Career Situations 301
Global Career Concerns 302
Developing Human Resources 303
Possible Development Focuses 303
Development Needs Analyses 304
HR Development Approaches 305
Job-Site Development Approaches 306
Off-Site Development Approaches 307
Learning Organizations and
Development 308
Management Development 309
CHAPTER 9
Supervisor Development 310
Leadership Development 311
Problems with Management Development
Efforts 313
Talent Management 282
Summary 314
HR Headline: How Top Companies
Develop Stars 283
Talent Management in Perspective 284
Talent Management “Systems” 285
Scope of Talent Management 286
Critical Thinking Activities 314
HR Experiential Problem Solving 314
Case: Leadership Leverage 315
Supplemental Cases: Equipping for the Future;
Developed Today, Gone Tomorrow 316
Notes 316
HR Perspective: Groundbreaking Talent
Management Programs 286
Succession Planning 288
Succession Planning Process 288
Succession Planning Decisions 290
Benefits of Formal Succession
Planning 292
Careers and Career Planning 293
Changing Nature of Careers 293
Organization-Centered Career
Planning 294
Individual-Centered Career Planning 295
Career Progression Considerations 296
Career Transitions 298
Common Individual Career Issues 299
Technical and Professional Workers 299
Women and Careers 300
Dual-Career Couples 300
CHAPTER 10
Performance Management
and Appraisal 318
HR Headline: Performance Management
Does Not Focus Enough on Ethics 319
The Nature of Performance
Management 320
Global Cultural Differences in Performance
Management 322
Performance-Focused Organizational
Cultures 323
Identifying and Measuring Employee
Performance 324
Types of Performance Information 325
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xvi
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xvii
CONTENTS
HR Perspective: Behaviors or Results . . .
Why Not Both? 326
Relevance of Performance Criteria 327
Performance Standards 327
Performance Metrics in Service Businesses 328
Graphic Rating Scales 339
Comparative Methods 343
Narrative Methods 345
Management by Objectives 345
Combinations of Methods 346
Training Managers and Employees
in Performance Appraisal 346
Performance Appraisals 329
Uses of Performance Appraisals 329
Rater Errors 347
HR Online: Using Technology to Enhance
Performance Appraisals 331
Decisions about the Performance Appraisal
Process 332
Legal Concerns and Performance
Appraisals 334
HR On-the-Job: Elements of a Legal
Performance Appraisal System 334
Who Conducts Appraisals? 335
Supervisory Rating of Subordinates 335
Employee Rating of Managers 336
Team/Peer Rating 336
Self-Rating 337
Outsider Rating 337
Multisource/360-Degree Feedback 337
Tools for Appraising Performance 339
Category Scaling Methods 339
Appraisal Feedback 349
Appraisal Interview 349
Feedback as a System 350
Reactions of Managers 351
Reactions of Appraised Employees 351
Effective Performance Management 351
HR Best Practices: Calibration Is the
Key to Better Employee Evaluations
and Performance Management 352
Summary 352
Critical Thinking Activities 353
HR Experiential Problem Solving 353
Case: Building Performance Management
through Employee Participation 354
Supplemental Cases: Performance Management
Improvements for Bristol-Myers Squibb;
Unequal/Equal Supervisors 354
Notes 355
S E C T I O N
4
Compensation 357
CHAPTER 11
Total Rewards
and Compensation 358
HR Best Practices: Using Rewards
to Effectively Develop Talent 364
HR Metrics for Compensation 365
Compensation Responsibilities 365
HR Headline: Rewarding Employees to
Encourage Positive Behaviors 359
Compensation System Design
Issues 366
Nature of Total Rewards and
Compensation 360
Compensation Fairness
and Equity 366
Types of Compensation 362
Compensation Philosophies 362
HR Perspective: Quantitative Techniques
Facilitate Compensation Management 367
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xvii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xviii
CONTENTS
Market Competitiveness and
Compensation 368
Competency-Based Pay 369
Individual versus Team Rewards 370
Global Compensation Issues 370
Compensating Expatriates 371
CHAPTER 12
Incentive Plans and Executive
Compensation 394
HR Headline: Variable Pay at Cox
Communications 395
Legal Constraints on Pay Systems 372
Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA) 372
Independent Contractor
Regulations 375
Acts Affecting Government
Contractors 375
Legislation on Equal Pay and Pay
Equity 376
State and Local Laws 376
Garnishment Laws 376
Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act 376
Development of a Base Pay System 377
Variable Pay: Incentives for Performance 396
Developing Successful Pay-for-Performance
Plans 396
HR Perspective: Awarding Points for Staff
Efforts 398
Global Variable Pay 399
Metrics for Variable Pay Plans 399
Successes and Failures of Variable Pay
Plans 400
Three Categories of Variable Pay 401
Valuing Jobs with Job Evaluation
Methods 378
Valuing Jobs Using Market Pricing 379
Pay Surveys 380
Individual Incentives 402
HR Online: Responding to Internet Pay
Survey Data Questions 381
Group/Team Incentives 404
Pay Structures 382
Pay Grades 383
Pay Ranges 383
Individual Pay 384
Determining Pay Increases 386
Performance-Based Increases 386
Standardized Pay Adjustments 388
Summary 389
Critical Thinking Activities 389
Piece-Rate Systems 402
Bonuses 402
Special Incentive Programs 403
Design of Group/Team Incentive Plans 405
Group/Team Incentive Challenges 406
Types of Group/Team Incentives 406
Group/Team Incentives and Information
Sharing 408
Organizational Incentives 408
Profit Sharing 408
Employee Stock Plans 409
Sales Compensation 410
Types of Sales Compensation Plans 410
HR Experiential Problem Solving 390
HR Perspective: Ethical Concerns and Sales
Compensation 411
Case: Pay for Performance Enhances
Employee Management at Scripps Health 390
Sales Compensation Challenges 412
Supplemental Cases: Compensation
Changes at JC Penney; Scientific Turmoil 391
Executive Compensation 413
Notes 391
Elements of Executive Compensation 414
Global Executive Compensation 416
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xviii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xix
CONTENTS
“Reasonableness” of Executive
Compensation 416
Severance Pay 438
HR Perspective: CEO Executives
Overpaid? 417
Increases in Health Benefits Costs 439
Controlling Health Care Benefits
Costs 439
Summary 419
Critical Thinking Activities 419
HR Experiential Problem Solving 420
Case: Sodexo Incentives 420
Supplemental Cases: Cash Is Good, Card Is Bad;
Incentive Plans for Fun and Travel 421
Notes 421
Health Care Benefits 438
HR Best Practices: Mini-Medical Plans
on the Rise 441
Consumer-Driven Health Plans 441
Health Care Preventive and Wellness
Efforts 443
Health Care Legislation 444
Retirement Benefits 446
CHAPTER 13
Managing Employee Benefits 424
HR Headline: Behavioral Economics Guides
Benefits Administration 425
Benefits and HR Strategy 426
Benefits as Competitive Advantage 427
Role of Benefits for Workforce Attraction and
Retention 429
Benefits Management and
Communications 429
Benefits Design 429
HR and Benefits Administration 431
HR Technology and Benefits 432
Benefits Measurement 432
Benefits Cost Control 433
Benefits Communication 433
HR Online: Using Online Technology to
Combat Presenteeism 434
Types of Benefits 434
Government-Mandated Benefits 435
Voluntary Benefits 436
Security Benefits 437
Workers’ Compensation 437
Unemployment Compensation 437
Social Security 446
Pension Plans 446
Pension Plan Concepts 448
Individual Retirement Options 448
Legal Requirements for Retirement
Benefits 449
Employee Retirement Income
Security Act 449
Retiree Benefits and Legal
Requirements 450
Retirement Benefits and Age
Discrimination 450
Financial Benefits 451
Insurance Benefits 451
Financial Services 452
Educational Assistance 452
Family-Oriented Benefits 453
Family and Medical Leave Act 453
Family-Care Benefits 454
Measuring the Effectiveness of Family
Benefits 455
Benefits for Domestic Partners 455
Time-Off and Other Benefits 456
Holiday Pay 457
Vacation Pay 457
Leaves of Absence 457
Paid-Time-Off Plans 458
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xix
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xx
CONTENTS
Case: Strategic Benefits at KPMG
Canada 460
Miscellaneous Benefits 458
Summary 459
Critical Thinking Activities 459
Supplemental Cases: Delivering Benefits;
Benefiting Connie 460
HR Experiential Problem Solving 459
Notes 461
S E C T I O N
5
Employee Relations 465
CHAPTER 14
Risk Management and Worker
Protection 466
HR Headline: $1.6 Million Fine When Young
Worker Suffocates 467
Current State of Health, Safety,
and Security 468
Trends 469
Global Health, Safety, and Security 470
Legal Requirements for Safety and
Health 471
Worker’s Compensation 471
American with Disabilities Act and Safety
Issues 473
Child Labor Laws 473
Occupational Safety and Health Act 474
OSHA Enforcement Standards 475
HR On-the-Job: Hazard
Communication 476
Ergonomics and OSHA 477
Work Assignments and OSHA 478
OSHA Recordkeeping Requirements 479
OSHA Inspections 479
Critique of OSHA 481
Safety Management 482
Organizational Commitment and a Safety
Culture 482
Safety Policies, Discipline, and
Recordkeeping 484
Safety Training and Communication 484
Safety Committees 485
Inspection, Investigation, and Evaluation 485
Measuring Safety Efforts 486
Employee Health 486
Substance Abuse 486
HR Perspective: The “Company
Doctor” 487
Emotional/Mental Health 488
Health and Older Employees 489
Smoking at Work 489
Health Promotion 489
Security Concerns at Work 491
Workplace Violence 491
Security Management 493
Employee Screening and Selection 495
Security Personnel 495
Disaster Preparation and Recovery
Planning 495
Disaster Planning 495
HR Perspective: Disaster Plan Put to the
Test 496
Disaster Planning for Disease 497
Summary 498
Critical Thinking Activities 498
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xx
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxi
CONTENTS
HR Experiential Problem Solving 499
Case: Data Security 499
Supplemental Cases: What’s Happened to Bob?;
Communicating Safety and Health Success 500
Notes 500
Workplace Monitoring 519
Employer Investigations 520
Substance Abuse and Drug Testing 521
HR Policies, Procedures, and Rules 523
Employee Handbooks 523
Communicating HR Information 525
Employee Absenteeism 525
CHAPTER 15
Employee Rights and
Responsibilities 502
HR Headline: Technology Usage and HR
Policy Issues 503
Employer and Employee Rights and
Responsibilities 504
Contractual Rights 504
Implied Contracts 506
HR Perspective: Employment Practices
Liability Insurance 507
Rights Affecting the Employment
Relationship 507
Employment-at-Will (EAW) 508
Just Cause 510
Due Process 510
Work-Related Alternative Dispute Resolution
(ADR) 511
Types of Absenteeism 525
HR Perspective: Effects of Tardiness on Work
and Absenteeism 526
Controlling Absenteeism 526
HR Metrics: Measuring Absenteeism 528
Employee Discipline 528
Reasons Why Discipline Might Not Be
Used 529
Effective Discipline 529
Approaches to Discipline 529
Discharge: The Final Disciplinary Step 531
HR On-the-Job: Termination
Procedure 532
Summary 533
Critical Thinking Activities 533
HR Experiential Problem Solving 534
Case: Dealing with Workplace Bullying 534
Supplemental Cases: George Faces Challenges;
Employer Liable for “Appearance Actions” 535
Managing Individual Employee and
Employer Rights Issues 513
Notes 535
Privacy Rights and Employee Records 513
Employees’ Free Speech Rights 515
CHAPTER 16
HR Online: Ethical HR Issues on Blogs 516
Technology and Employer/ Employee
Issues 517
Employee Rights and Personal Behavior
Issues 518
Balancing Employer Security and Employee
Rights 519
Union/Management Relations 538
HR Headline: Business versus Labor—Right
to Work Laws 539
Unions: Employee and Management
Perspectives 540
Why Employees Unionize 540
Why Employers Resist Unions 541
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxi
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxii
CONTENTS
Unions Globally 542
International Union Membership 542
Global Labor Organizations 542
HR Perspective: Unions in China 543
U.S. and Global Differences 543
Union Membership in the United States 544
Reasons for U.S. Union Membership
Decline 544
Public-Sector Unionism 547
Union Targets for Membership Growth 547
Unions in the United States 548
Historical Evolution of U.S. Unions 548
Union Structure 549
U.S. Labor Laws 550
Early Labor Legislation 550
Wagner Act (National Labor Relations
Act) 551
Taft-Hartley Act (Labor Management
Relations Act) 552
Landrum-Griffin Act (Labor Management
Reporting and Disclosure Act) 554
Civil Service Reform and Postal
Reorganization Acts 554
Proposed Legislation 555
The Unionization Process 555
Organizing Campaign 555
HR Perspective: Good Times,
Bad Times 557
Authorization Cards 558
Representation Election 558
HR On-the-Job: Unionization Do’s and
Don’ts for Managers 559
Certification and Decertification 560
Contract Negotiation (Collective
Bargaining) 560
Collective Bargaining Issues 561
Management Rights 561
Union Security 562
Classification of Bargaining Issues 562
Collective Bargaining Process 563
Preparation and Initial Demands 563
Continuing Negotiations 563
Settlement and Contract Agreement 564
Bargaining Impasse 564
Strikes and Lockouts 565
Union/Management Cooperation 566
HR Perspective: Union Helps Cut Costs
at Ford 567
Employee Involvement Programs 567
Unions and Employee Ownership 568
Grievance Management 568
Grievance Responsibilities 569
Grievance Procedures 569
Steps in a Grievance Procedure 569
Summary 570
Critical Thinking Activities 571
HR Experiential Problem Solving 571
Case: Teamsters and the Fraternal Order
of Police (FOP) 572
Supplemental Cases: Wal-Mart and Union
Prevention; The Wilson County
Hospital 572
Notes 573
APPENDIX A
Human Resource Certification
Institute: PHR and SPHR Test
Specifications 575
APPENDIX B
HR Management Resources 581
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxiii
CONTENTS
APPENDIX C
APPENDIX G
Major Federal Equal Employment
Opportunity Laws and
Regulations 585
Sample HR-Related Job
Descriptions 599
APPENDIX D
Uniform Guidelines on Employee
Selection 587
Glossary 601
Author Index 609
Subject Index 615
APPENDIX E
EEO Enforcement 591
APPENDIX F
Preemployment Inquiries 595
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxiii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
Preface
To reach a thirteenth edition is an honor for
a textbook and its authors. The authors of
Human Resource Management are gratified
that it has become the leader in both the
academic market for human resource texts
and in the market for human resource professionals.
For academics, the book is a standard
in HR classes. It is also used to provide HR
knowledge as part of professional degree
programs. For HR professionals, the book is
extensively used in the pursuit of HR professional education and certifications, specifically the PHR and SPHR from the Human
Resource Certification Institute (HRCI).
In preparing the thirteenth edition of the
book, we have extensively reviewed the academic, governmental, and practitioner literature published since the last revision. Further,
we have asked academics and practitioners,
both those who use this book and those who
do not, to provide input on the previous edition and what coverage should be added,
deleted, or changed. We have always been
receptive to input from our adopters and
reviewers and have made extensive use of
their observations and ideas. Consequently,
we have reorganized some chapters, incorporated relevant new topics, and updated
references so that readers can be certain that
they are getting the most current HR content
possible.
U.S. and Global Economics
During the past few years, both in the United
States and worldwide, economic shifts have
created major organizational impacts. Some
em-ployers have closed operations or reduced
their workforces, while others have increased
theirs. Many employers are expanding
throughout the world and, as they do, different cultural considerations affect HR management. Rather than having a separate chapter
on global HR management, the coverage of
global issues has been integrated throughout
the chapters and is indicated by a global icon.
Strategic HR Management
HR management in more and more companies is becoming a part of organizational
strategy decisions. To address strategic HR
management, Chapter 2 has been significantly revised and expanded to show why
HR management is an important strategic
contributor to the success of the organization.
In most chapters the topical connection
to strategy also is discussed. For example, the
strategic natures of recruiting (Chapter 6),
talent management (Chapter 9), compensation (Chapter 11), and benefits (Chapter 13)
all consider the implications for strategy of
decisions made in these areas.
THE THIRTEENTH EDITION
Measuring HR Effectiveness through
Metrics
Human resource management
and the organizations in which
it takes place are facing challenges from a changing environment. The thirteenth edition
G L O B A L
reflects those challenges and as
always suggests ways to deal with them. For
example, consider the following:
Closely related to strategic
HR management is the need
to measure the value of HR
management activities. The outM E A S U R E put of HR must be justified to
executives in organizations by
using financial and other data. The value of
HR management activities is measured by
xxv
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxv
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxvi
P R E FAC E
cost–benefit analysis, profit per employee,
new hire success, and similar metrics. Thus,
HR efforts can be justified financially and
the value that HR management brings to the
company’s goals can be documented.
The thirteenth edition includes sections in
most chapters called “HR Metrics” that identify how different activities can be measured.
A special metrics icon is used to identify this
content.
Workforce Changes
The demographics of workers in the United
States and globally are shifting. Diversity of
employees based on ethnicity, aging, gender,
and other factors is changing legal requirements and HR efforts needed. Beginning in
Chapter 1, workforce changes are identified as well as why they must be managed
effectively. In Chapters 4 and 5, workforce composition differences and their HR
implications are identified. Throughout other
chapters workforce composition issues are
discussed as part of the context for the relevant HR topics.
Attracting, Retaining, and Managing
Talent
A key part of managing the workforce is having the right people with the right capabilities
in the right jobs—and being able to retain
them. These HR concerns exist in most organizations and are emphasized in information
on recruiting, selection, job design, training,
retention, talent management, and compensation. These topics emphasize HR’s role in
ensuring that organizations have sufficient
and productive workforces, both currently
and in the future.
HR, Technology, and the Internet
The use of technology in HR has expanded
dramatically and is continuing to change
HR management activities with executives,
managers, and employees. The Internet, Webbased resources, social media, and blogs
all affect HR management. Throughout the
chapters of this edition is a feature titled “HR
Online” that highlights how technology is
being used in HR. Also, many chapters cover
HR technology topics in the specific content
areas.
The Internet continues to be a valuable
tool for HR professionals and affects a number of HR activities. To provide immediate
links for readers, numerous “Logging On”
features have been incorporated throughout
the text. This feature identifies websites that
contain useful sources of HR information
about topics being discussed and contains
specific Web address links. Also, references
from Web addresses are cited in the chapter
notes as appropriate.
ORGANIZATION OF THE
THIRTEENTH EDITION
The thirteenth edition reflects both the continuity and changes occurring in HR management. The following highlights some of the
significant content throughout the book section by section.
Section I: Environment of Human
Resource Management
The first three chapters of the book examine
factors in the changing environment in which
the HR function operates. The first chapter
looks at human capital, HR as a core competency, HR ethics, and HR challenges. The
necessary competencies for HR careers are
also discussed. Chapter 2 addresses strategic
HR management, environmental analyses,
global competitiveness, HR technology, and
metrics to evaluate the effectiveness of HR
management.
Equal employment opportunity (EEO) is
a key HR concern, both legally and operationally. Chapter 3 addresses the laws, regulations, and court decisions that determine the
legal framework of EEO. Furthermore, the
chapter looks at implementing equal employment and dealing with affirmative action,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxvi
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxvii
P R E FAC E
sexual harassment, age discrimination, and
other issues.
Section 2: Jobs and Labor
Chapter 4 discusses workforce composition
and describes workflow, scheduling, and
other job design issues that have an impact
on organizations and the people working in
them. The chapter concludes with coverage of
job analysis and the approaches to job analysis. Chapter 5 contains content on HR planning, job satisfaction, and employee turnover
and retention.
Chapter 6 focuses on recruiting in different labor markets. It discusses the difficulties
of recruiting employees with special skills—
and new methods to attract those individuals. The chapter contains significant content
on Internet recruiting and the evaluation of
recruiting efforts. An expansion of the coverage on selection in Chapter 7 encompasses
the selection strategy choices that management must make. The discussion of testing,
interviewing approaches, and other selection
techniques reflects the current research and
practices in HR management.
Section 3: Training and
Development
Because talent management is a growing
concern for many employers, major content
additions in this section have been made
to emphasize the nature and importance of
talent management. Chapter 8 discusses the
strategic role training plays in organizations
and how training can be linked to business
strategies and organizational competitiveness.
Specific content on adult learning and new
training design and means of delivery is provided. As the text addresses the growing use of
e-learning, it discusses both the contributions
and problems associated with Web-based
training. Chapter 9 on talent management
and development looks at the methods organizations use to expand the capabilities of
their human resources, the nature of talent
management, and succession planning.
Chapter 10 emphasizes performance
management and the role of the performance
appraisal process in enhancing the development of human resources in organizations. The chapter expands the material on
identifying and measuring employee performance, including additional information on
the numerous approaches used.
Section 4: Compensation
Compensation is viewed broadly as total
rewards that include base pay, variable pay,
and benefits. Employers are facing great pressure to control those expenditures while also
being competitive to attract and retain employees. Chapter 11 discusses the strategic nature of
total rewards and then looks at compensation.
The coverage of legal requirements, base compensation, pay for performance, and variable
pay programs has been revised and updated.
Chapter 12 discusses variable pay, which
can include incentives such as those for sales
employees. It concludes with an overview of
executive compensation and issues of current
concern in that area. Chapter 13 highlights
the growing changes and increasing costs of
benefits that are facing HR professionals and
their organizations. Specific expanded content
discusses health care costs and issues, as well as
retirement and other forms of benefits.
Section 5: Employee Relations
Employee relations include several evolving areas. One such area is risk management, which incorporates health, safety, and
security. The coverage in Chapter 14 identifies the nature of risk management, current
health and safety issues, OSHA compliance
requirements, health promotion, prevention
of workplace violence, and the importance
of workplace security. Revised content identifies the need for HR to develop disaster and
recovery plans for such situations as natural
disasters, terrorist threats, or pandemics.
The various issues associated with employee
rights and discipline—such as employment-atwill, privacy rights, and substance abuse—have
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxvii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxviii
P R E FAC E
been highlighted in Chapter 15. The chapter
also looks at such emerging issues as electronic monitoring, privacy, e-mail, and other
employee rights affected by technology. It
concludes with a discussion on employee terminations.
The changing role of unions in the U.S.
economy and the reasons for the decline in the
percentage of workers in unions are discussed
in Chapter 16. In addition to covering the
basic laws and regulations governing union/
management relations in the United States,
the chapter includes coverage of collective
bargaining and grievance management as key
components of union/management relations.
CHANGES TO THIS EDITION
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
NEW: Each chapter contains a new endof-chapter exercise, called HR Experiential
Problem Solving, which provides a problem, asks one to three brief questions about
it, and suggests resources to resolve it.
NEW: All end-of-chapter Cases are new.
NEW: End-of-chapter Supplemental
Cases have been increased from one to
two per chapter.
NEW: An expanded appendix section
provides additional information on a
variety of topics.
NEW: Material on HR as an organizational contributor from Chapter 2 is now
combined with new Chapter 1.
NEW: Previous edition Chapters 4 and
5 are combined into a new Chapter 3 to
put EEO laws and their management in
one chapter.
NEW: Chapter 4 on jobs and job analysis was formerly Chapter 6 and is significantly changed to reflect how HR
addresses workers, and the contributions
of various types of diverse workers.
Chapter 5 on HR planning and retention has major changes, with material
combined from several other chapters.
Sections revised include HR planning
components, individual workers in organizations, and turnover.
Chapter 6 on recruiting and labor markets (formerly Chapter 7) has revised coverage of strategic recruiting as tied to HR
planning, labor market components, and
strategic decisions, as well as additional
content on Internet recruiting methods.
• Chapter 7 (formerly Chapter 8) expands
the topic of placement to include common mismatch situations between people
and jobs, immigration status verification
to include E-Verify, and controversies in
selection testing
• Chapter 8 (formerly Chapter 9) expands
strategy and training, planning for training and orientation, evaluation of orientation, and instructional strategies, and
includes new research on the assessment
of e-learning use in training.
• Each chapter has been brought up-todate on any changes in HR research or
the laws that have transpired since the
twelfth edition.
•
CHAPTER FEATURES
Each chapter begins with specific learning
objectives. Next, the “HR Headline” feature
contains a concise example of a contemporary HR problem, situation, or practice
to illustrate topics covered. Throughout the
text, most chapters also include an “HR Best
Practices” feature that highlights effective
HR management in real-world companies.
Additionally, chapters contain “HR On-theJob,” a feature that presents suggestions on
how to handle specific HR issues or situations. The “Logging On” feature provides
links to additional materials beyond the
text content. To highlight how information
technology affects HR management, some
chapters contain “HR Online” and “HR
Perspective” features that address specific HR
issues, ethical concerns, technology, or interesting employer HR efforts.
Each chapter concludes with a point-bypoint “Summary” and a “Critical Thinking
Activities” section that provides critical thinking queries. At the end of every chapter is an
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxviii
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxix
P R E FAC E
“HR Experiential Problem Solving” exercise,
and a “Case” that presents a real-life HR
problem or situation using real organizations as examples. Further, two additional
“Supplemental Cases” are available in each
chapter on the text website. They briefly
describe typical HR problems faced in
organizations. Finally, reference “Notes” cite
sources used in the chapter, with particular
attention given to the inclusion of the most
current references and research. More than
80% of the references are new or updated
from the previous edition.
AACSB tags for general (NATIONAL) and
topic-specific (LOCAL) designations.
SUPPLEMENTS
PowerPoint Slide Presentation
Instructor’s Manual with Video Guide
The instructor’s manual, revised by Dr. Fraya
Wagner-Marsh, Eastern Michigan University,
represents one of the most exciting and useful instructor’s aids available. Comprehensive
teaching materials are provided for each
chapter—including overviews, outlines,
instructor’s notes, suggested answers to endof-chapter Review and Application Questions,
suggested questions for the “HR Headline,”
“HR Online,” “HR Best Practices,” and “HR
On-the-Job” features, suggested answers to the
end-of-chapter case questions, and suggested
questions and comments on the supplemental
cases for each chapter. In addition, a video
guide section describes the video segments
that are available on an Instructor’s DVD to
help integrate chapter content through current, interesting examples.
ExamView
ExamView contains all of the questions in
the printed test bank. Instructors can add
or edit questions, instructions, and answers.
Questions may be selected by previewing them
on screen, selecting them randomly, or selecting them by number. Instructors can also create quizzes online whether over the Internet,
a local area network, or a wide area network.
Instructor PowerPoint slides, prepared by
Charlie Cook of the University of West
Alabama, are available on both the Instructor’s
Resource CD and on the password-protected
Instructor’s Resources Website. Approximately
400 slides are included.
Handbook for Human Resource
Faculty
New to this edition, the Handbook for
Human Resource Faculty, originally created
by Corinne Livesay of Bryan College, has
been revised by Laura L. Wolfe of Louisiana
State University to provide additional teaching aids such as Generating Interest discussion topics, Dealing with Trouble Spots
features that provide resources to address
challenges, and Involving Students sections
that suggest activities and resources.
Test Bank
Instructor’s Resource CD
The test bank is significantly revised and
upgraded from previous editions, and contains more than 1,800 test questions prepared by Janelle Dozier. Multiple-choice, true/
false, and essay questions are provided for
every chapter. Answers are cross-referenced
to pages within the text so that it is easy to
pinpoint where relevant material is found.
Questions are identified by type—definition,
application, and analytical—and also include
The Instructor’s Resource CD includes the
instructor’s manual, test bank, ExamView,
the Handbook for Human Resource Faculty,
the Video Guide, and PowerPoint presentation slides for instructor convenience.
On-The-Job Video Package
A majority of the book’s video collection is
new and features companies with innovative
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxix
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxx
P R E FAC E
HR practices, many of which have been recognized for their excellence in HR practices.
Both small and large companies are featured
in the videos, and all video content is closely
tied to concepts within the text. These include
interviews with Metropolitan Bakery, Yale
Repertory Theater, Zappos, The Fruit Guys,
and many others. The videos are available on
DVD for the instructor.
CengageNOW
The HRCI 2009 Outline
•
The HRCI 2009 outline is featured in this edition to effectively prepare students with the
latest body of knowledge of human resource
management from which the certification
exams are taken.
•
•
•
•
Student Resource Guide
Designed from a student’s perspective by
Tonya Elliott, a certified HR professional, this
useful study guide provides aids that students
can use to maximize results in the classroom
and on exams and, ultimately, in the practice of HR. Chapter objectives and chapter
outlines aid students in reviewing for exams.
Study questions include matching, true/false,
idea completion, multiple-choice, and essay
questions. Answer keys are provided for
immediate feedback to reinforce learning.
Product Support Website
Please visit our product support website,
http://www.cengage.com/management/mathis,
which offers additional instructional and
learning tools to complement our text.
•
NEW: The new CourseMate online learning system helps students manage their
homework, make the most of every study
minute, and immediately view their progress. Interactive study tools, homework
assignments, and self-testing opportunities help students earn the grade they
want within the course and assist as them
in effectively preparing for professional
examinations.
This powerful and fully integrated online
teaching and learning system provides
instructors with flexibility and control,
saves valuable time, and improves outcomes. Students benefit by having choices
in the way they learn through a unique
personalized learning path made possible by
CengageNOW.
•
•
•
Homework, assignable and automatically
graded
Integrated e-book
Personalized learning paths
Interactive course assignments
Assessment options, including AACSB
learning standards achievement reporting
Test delivery
Course management tools, including
Grade Book
WebCT and Blackboard integration
Speak with your South-Western sales representative about integrating CengageNOW into your
courses. Visit www.cengage.com/now today to
learn more!
WebTutor™ for Blackboard® or
WebCT®
This dynamic learning and instructional
resource harnesses the power of the Internet
to deliver innovative learning aids that actively
engage students. Multimedia resources include
animated tutorials, quizzes with immediate feedback, online exercises to reinforce
principles learned, and online discussion to
encourage continuing communication between
students and instructors.
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
The success of each edition of Human
Resource Management can largely be attributed to our reviewers, who have generously
offered both suggestions for improvements
and new ideas for the text. We sincerely thank
the following reviewers:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxx
20/07/10 6:26 PM
xxxi
P R E FAC E
Collette M. Arens
Bates
Western Illinois
University
Linsey C. Willis
Florida Atlantic
University
Callie Burnley
California State
University, Fullerton
Ryan D.
Zimmerman
Texas A&M
Cathy Dubois
Kent State University
Andrea D. Ellinger
University of Illinois
at Champaign-Urbana
Yezdi Godiwalla
University of
Wisconsin,
Whitewater
Mark A. Johnson
Idaho State University
Carlos Jon
Keller Graduate School
Thomas Kanick
Southern New
Hampshire University
Stan Malos
San Jose State
University
Patrick McHugh
George Washington
University
Bob Meier
Robert Morris College
David Nye
Athens University
Kristin D. Scott
Clemson University
Larry Siefert
Webster University
Romilia Singh
University of
Wisconsin, Milwaukee
Susan Stewart
Western Illinois
University
K. J. Tullis
University of Central
Oklahoma
Fraya Wagner-Marsh Eastern Michigan
University
Finally, some leading HR professionals
provided ideas and assistance. Appreciation
is specifically expressed to Sean Valentine,
Patti Meglich, Sandra Washa, Steve Williams,
Kathy McKee, and Frank Giancola. Those
who assisted with many critical details of
manuscript preparation include Jo Ann
Mathis, Carolyn Foster, and our copyeditor,
Linda Ireland.
The authors thank Joe Sabatino,
Publisher, Michele Rhoades, Senior
Acquisitions Editor, and Susan Smart, Senior
Developmental Editor, for their guidance
and involvement. We also appreciate the
support of our Content Project Manager,
Corey Geissler, whose efforts contributed
significantly to making the final product
appealing. Thanks go also to our Media
Editor, Rob Ellington, for pulling together
the text website, and to our Marketing
Manager, Clint Kernen, for getting the word
out about the new edition.
The authors feel confident that this edition will continue as the standard for the
HR field. We believe it offers a relevant and
current look at HR management, and we are
optimistic that those who use the book will
agree.
Robert L. Mathis, SPHR
John H. Jackson
Omaha, Nebraska
Laramie, Wyoming
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxxi
20/07/10 6:26 PM
S
E
C
T
I
O
N
1
Environment
of Human Resource
Management
Chapter 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
Chapter 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
Chapter 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
1
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 1
21/07/10 8:42 PM
C H A P T E R
1
Human Resource
Management in
Organizations
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Define human capital and identify the seven categories of
HR activities.
•
Discuss how organizational culture and HR are related and
identify four areas that are part of these relationships.
•
Explain how organizational ethical issues affect HR
management.
•
Provide an overview of six challenges facing HR today.
•
Describe how the major roles of HR management are
being transformed.
•
Explain the key competencies needed by HR professionals
and why certification is important.
2
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 2
26/06/10 3:22 PM
HR Headline
The Challenges and Crises
Facing HR Management
D
(PhotoLink/Photodisc/Getty Image)
uring the past few years, economic
downturns, industry crises, bank failures, closings of plants and stores,
changes in global operations, and other factors
have significantly affected organizations, managers, and Human Resource (HR) management
professionals. For HR and other executives,
these changes have led to decisions about
layoffs, reductions in work hours, and cuts or
elimination of some employee benefits. HR
is facing a different world because of these
problems.
Other issues have created different workforce strategies as well. A recent survey found
that the highest-demand jobs include jobs like
registered nurse, elementary and secondary
school teacher, accountant and auditor, general and operations manager, network software engineer, and jobs that contain significant
professional responsibilities. The increased
demand for these jobs has been caused by
economic shifts in staffing that have affected
manufacturing, retail, and other industries.
These examples illustrate why HR must change. Organizational and HR
executives, managers, and employees are dealing in various ways with
major issues. According to surveys, some of the biggest problems include:
•
•
•
•
Adjusting benefits programs due to increasing costs
Attracting and retaining key employees
Planning for replacement of “baby boomers” when they retire
Using talent management to train and develop capabilities of
employees for future job needs
3
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 3
26/06/10 3:25 PM
4
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
•
•
Dealing with the expanded personal and organizational use of
HR technology through blogs, wikis, twitters, text-messaging, and
other formats
Complying with revised and changing federal, state, and local legal
requirements affecting discrimination, treatment errors, unionization, and other issues
The manner in which all these conflicting issues are managed can
influence how HR plans and contributes to organizational culture and
performance.1
Human resource (HR)
management Designing
management systems to
ensure that human talent is
used effectively and efficiently
to accomplish organizational
goals.
As the HR Headline indicates, managing people in changing organizations is
part of what is currently being done by supervisors, managers, and executives.
People as human assets are the “glue” that holds all the other assets, such as
financial and physical ones, together and guides their use to better achieve
results. Certainly, the cashiers, supervisors, and other employees at Wal-Mart
or Walgreen’s or the doctors, nurses, receptionists, technical professionals,
and other employees at a hospital allow all the other assets of their organization to be used to provide customer or patient services. How effectively
people at all levels contribute to organizational results is part of the challenge.
Managing people as human resources is essential in organizations of all sizes
and types.
As a field, human resource management is undergoing significant transformation. Human resource (HR) management is designing management systems
to ensure that human talent is used effectively and efficiently to accomplish
organizational goals. Whether employees are in a big company with thousands
of jobs or a small nonprofit agency, managing people in an organization is
about more than simply administering a pay program, designing training, or
avoiding lawsuits. If human resources are to be an important part of successfully competing in the marketplace, a different level of thinking about HR
management is necessary. Productive, creative people working in flexible,
effective organizations that provide rewarding work for individuals is important for all managers, not just those in HR departments. People in organizations can be a core competency.
HUMAN RESOURCES AS ORGANIZATIONAL CORE
COMPETENCY
Core competency
A unique capability that
creates high value and
differentiates an organization
from its competition.
The development and implementation of specific organizational strategies
must be based on the areas of strength in an organization. Referred to as core
competencies, those strengths are the foundation for creating a competitive
advantage for an organization. A core competency is a unique capability that
creates high value and differentiates an organization from its competition.
Figure 1-1 shows some possible areas where human resources may become
part of core competencies. Certainly, many organizations have identified that
having their human resources as core competencies differentiates them from
their competitors and is a key determinant of competitive advantages.2
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 4
26/06/10 3:26 PM
CHAPTER 1
5
Human Resource Management in Organizations
Core Competencies in Possible HR Areas
F I G U R E 1- 1
Productivity
Quality/Service
Human Resources
as Successful
Competencies
Employee Skills
Innovative Operations
Human Capital and HR
Human capital is not solely the people in organizations—it is what those
people bring and contribute to organizational success. Human capital is the
collective value of the capabilities, knowledge, skills, life experiences, and
motivation of an organizational workforce.
Sometimes human capital is called intellectual capital to reflect the thinking, knowledge, creativity, and decision making that people in organizations
contribute. For example, firms with high intellectual capital may have technical
and research employees who create new biomedical devices, formulate products that can be patented, or develop new software for specialized uses. All
these organizational contributions illustrate the potential value of human capital. A few years ago, a Nobel prize-winning economist, Gary Becker, expanded
the view of human capital by emphasizing that countries managing human
capital better are more likely to have better economic results.3
The importance of human capital in organizations can be seen in various
ways. One is sheer costs. In some industries, such as the restaurant industry,
employee-related expenditures may exceed 60% of total operating costs. With
such significant levels comes an increasing need to measure the value of human
capital and how it is changing through HR metrics, discussed in Chapter 2.
HR Functions
Human capital The
collective value of the
capabilities, knowledge,
skills, life experiences, and
motivation of an organizational
workforce.
HR management can be thought of as seven interlinked functions taking
place within organizations, as depicted in Figure 1-2. Additionally, external forces—legal, economic, technological, global, environmental, cultural/
geographic, political, and social—significantly affect how HR functions are
designed, managed, and changed. The functions can be grouped as follows:
•
Strategic HR Management: As part of maintaining organizational
competitiveness, strategic planning for HR effectiveness can be increased
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 5
26/06/10 3:26 PM
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
HR Management Functions
F I G U R E 1- 2
Tec
hn
olo
gic
al
a
Glob
Strategic HR Management
HR effectiveness
HR metrics
HR technology
HR planning
HR retention
en
tal
Equal Employment
Opportunity
Compliance
Diversity
Affirmative action
ic
ograph
l/Ge
tura
ic
om
Econ
Risk Management and
Worker Protection
Health and wellness
Safety
Security
Disaster and
recovery planning
Env
iro
nm
Cul
Employee and
Labor Relations
Employee rights and
privacy
HR policies
Union/management
relations
l
HR
FUNCTIONS
Staffing
Job analysis
Recruiting
Selection
Total Rewards
Compensation
Incentives
Benefits
Talent Management
Orientation
Training
HR development
Career planning
Performance
management
Po
lit
ica
l
6
Le
ga
l
Social
External environment
•
•
through the use of HR metrics and HR technology. These topics are
covered in Chapter 2.
Equal Employment Opportunity: Compliance with equal employment
opportunity (EEO) laws and regulations affects all other HR activities.
The nature of EEO is discussed in Chapter 3.
Staffing: The aim of staffing is to provide a sufficient supply of qualified
individuals to fill jobs in an organization. Workers, job design, and job
analysis lay the foundation for staffing by identifying what diverse people
do in their jobs and how they are affected by them. Through HR planning,
managers anticipate the future supply of and demand for employees and
the nature of workforce issues, including the retention of employees. These
factors are used when recruiting applicants for job openings. The selection
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 6
26/06/10 3:26 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
7
process is concerned with choosing qualified individuals to fill those jobs.
These staffing activities are discussed in Chapters 4, 5, 6, and 7.
• Talent Management and Development: Beginning with the orientation of
new employees, talent management and development includes different
types of training. Also, HR development and succession planning of
employees and managers is necessary to prepare for future challenges.
Career planning identifies paths and activities for individual employees as
they move within the organization. Assessing how well employees perform
their jobs is the focus of performance management. Activities associated
with talent management are examined in Chapters 8, 9, and 10.
• Total Rewards: Compensation in the form of pay, incentives, and benefits
rewards people for performing organizational work. To be competitive,
employers develop and refine their basic compensation systems and may
use variable pay programs such as incentive rewards. The rapid increase
in the cost of benefits, especially health care benefits, will continue to
be a major issue for most employers. Compensation, variable pay, and
benefits activities are discussed in Chapters 11, 12, and 13.
• Risk Management and Worker Protection: Employers must address
various workplace risks to ensure protection of workers by meeting
legal requirements and being more responsive to concerns for workplace
health and safety. Also, workplace security has grown in
importance along with disaster and recovery planning, and
LOGGING ON
these activities are examined in Chapter 14.
International Association for
• Employee and Labor Relations: The relationship
Human Resource Information
between managers and their employees must be
Management (IHRIM)
handled legally and effectively. Employer and employee
The International Association for
rights must be addressed. It is important to develop,
Human Resource Information
communicate, and update HR policies and procedures
Management (IHRIM) is the world’s
so that managers and employees alike know what is
leading clearinghouse for the HRMS
expected. In some organizations, union/management
industry for information management,
relations must be addressed as well. Activities
systems issues, trends, and technology.
associated with employee rights and labor/management
Visit its website at www.ihrim.org.
relations are discussed in Chapters 15 and 16.
HR MANAGEMENT’S CONTRIBUTING ROLE
Human Resources can create value and impact organizational results more in
some organizations than others. Being the core competency mentioned earlier,
HR may aid organizations in a number of ways. Given the changes in economic situations, workers, workforce challenges, and other factors, employers
can face significant reputation problems. One survey of global senior managers in 20 countries found that more than 60% indicated they had less trust in
their corporations than a year before.4 This study illustrates why HR must be
at the heart of enhancing organizational culture.
Organizational Culture and HR
Organizational culture
The shared values and beliefs
in an organization.
The ability of an organization to use its human capital as a core competency
depends in part on the organizational culture that is operating. Organizational
culture consists of the shared values and beliefs that give members of an organization meaning and provide them with rules for behavior. The culture of an
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 7
26/06/10 3:26 PM
8
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
organization is seen in the norms of expected behaviors, values, philosophies,
rituals, and symbols used by its employees, and it evolves over a period of time.
Only if an organization has a history in which people have shared experiences
for years does a culture stabilize. A relatively new firm, such as a business
existing for less than 2 years, may not have developed a stabilized culture.
HR Values and Organizational Cultures Central to organizational culture are values that are inherent in the ways organizations and their members
treat people both inside and outside the organization. Similar values are likely
to exist with some executives, managers, and HR professionals, as well, which
can affect the nature of the organizational culture.
Values may be used to define opportunities, plan strategies, and view
operational concerns, as highlighted in Chapter 2. Values in an organizational
culture can become relatively constant and enduring over time. Newcomers
learn the values and culture from the senior employees; hence, the rules of
behavior are perpetuated. These rules may or may not be beneficial, so the
values and culture can either facilitate or limit performance. They also affect
employee morale and how conflicts are resolved.5
Competitive Advantage of Organizational Culture Organizational
culture should be seen as the “climate” of the organization that employees,
managers, customers, and others experience. This culture affects service and
quality, organizational productivity, and financial results. One facet of the
culture of the organization, as viewed by the people in it, is that culture may
affect the attraction and retention of competent employees.6
Alignment of the organizational culture and HR helps organizational performance. One competitive aspect of an organizational culture is creativity
and innovation. Efforts in this area can enhance the organizational culture by
developing or revising current and new products and services, acquiring new
businesses, and performing other activities with competitive advantages.7
G L O B A L
Global Cultural Factors Cultural forces represent an important concern
affecting international HR management. One only has to look at the conflicts
caused by politics, religion, and ethnicity in Africa, the Middle East, and other
parts of the world to see the importance of culture in international organizations. Convincing individuals from different religious, ethnic, or tribal backgrounds to work together in a global firm may be difficult in some areas.
One widely used way to classify and compare cultures was developed by
Geert Hofstede, a Dutch scholar and researcher. Hofstede conducted research
on more than 100,000 IBM employees in 53 countries, and he defined five
dimensions useful in identifying and comparing cultures:8
•
•
•
•
•
Inequality in power
Individualism/group orientation
Masculinity/femininity
Uncertainty avoidance
Long-term/short-term orientation
Differences in many other facets of culture could be discussed, but it is
enough to note that international HR managers and professionals must recognize that cultural dimensions differ from country to country and even within
countries. Therefore, the HR activities appropriate in one culture or country
may have to be altered to fit appropriately into another culture, country, or
geographic area.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 8
26/06/10 3:26 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
9
Organizational Productivity
Productivity Measure of the
quantity and quality of work
done, considering the cost of
the resources used.
Unit labor cost Computed
by dividing the average cost
of workers by their average
levels of output.
F I G U R E 1- 3
HR management can play a significant role in organizations by helping to create
a culture that emphasizes effectiveness and productivity. In its most basic sense,
productivity is a measure of the quantity and quality of work done, considering the cost of the resources used. Productivity can be a competitive advantage
because when the costs to produce goods and services are lowered by effective
processes, lower prices can be charged or more revenue made. Better productivity
does not necessarily mean more output; perhaps fewer people (or less money or
time) are used to produce the same amount.
One useful way of measuring the productivity of human resources is to
consider unit labor cost, which is computed by dividing the average cost of
workers by their average levels of output. Using unit labor costs, one can see
that paying relatively high wages still can result in a firm being economically
competitive if high productivity levels are achieved. Low unit labor costs can
be a basis for a strategy focusing on human resources. Productivity and unit
labor costs can be evaluated at the global, country, organizational, departmental, or individual level as part of various HR measurement metrics.
Improving Organizational Productivity Productivity at the organizational level ultimately affects profitability and competitiveness in a for-profit
organization and total costs in a not-for-profit organization. Perhaps of all the
resources used for productivity in organizations, the ones often most closely
scrutinized are the human resources. Examples as indicated in Figure 1-3 of
Approaches to Improving Organizational Productivity
Restructuring the Organization
Revising organizational structure
Reducing staff
Aiding in mergers and acquisitions
Re-Designing Work
Changing workloads and
combining jobs
Reshaping jobs due to technology
changes
Goals
Increase
organizational
productivity
Reduce unit
labor costs
Aligning HR Activities
Attracting and retaining employees
Training, developing, and evaluating
employees
Compensating employees and other
HR activities
Outsourcing
Using domestic vendors/
contractors instead of employees
Outsourcing operations
internationally
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 9
26/06/10 3:26 PM
10
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
HR management efforts designed to enhance organizational productivity are
as follows:
•
•
•
•
Organizational restructuring involves eliminating layers of management
and changing reporting relationships, as well as cutting staff through
downsizing, layoffs, and early retirement buyout programs. That has
become a concern in a number of industries as economic factors have
changed.9
Redesigning work often involves having fewer employees who work
longer hours and perform multiple job tasks. It may also involve
replacing workers with capital equipment or making them more efficient
by use of technology or new processes.
Aligning HR activities means making HR efforts consistent with
organizational efforts to improve productivity. This alignment includes
ensuring that HR functions are not working against productivity.
Outsourcing analyses involve HR in conducting cost-benefit analyses
to justify outsourcing. Additional factors may include negotiating
with outsourcing vendors, ensuring that contractors domestically and
internationally are operating legally and appropriately, and linking
organizational employees to the employees of the outsourcing firm.
Outsourcing is discussed further in Chapter 2.
Social Responsibilities and HR
Organizational influences have changed as individuals, employers, governmental agencies, and other entities have evolved. Social responsibility and
networking have become more prevalent as organizational culture issues.
Part of HR management is to ensure that social responsibility is integrated
into the organizational culture. Both explicit and implicit requirements are
needed.10 The explicit requirements include specific regulations, policies,
and training. The implicit ones aid the organizational culture in encouraging
appropriate organizational behavior when dealing with customers, suppliers,
employees, and others.
Sustainabilty Being able to
continue to operate, survive,
and adjust to significant
changes.
HR Advantages and Social Responsibilities Corporate social responsibility by HR has numerous advantages. One of the most important is the
ability to attract and retain employees.11 Socially responsible jobs are increasingly popular, especially with college students, who will be future workers.
One survey by Panetta Institute for Public Policy found that almost half of
the college students had their greatest interest in working for a more socially
responsible corporation, while others wanted to work for governmental or
nonprofit organizations.12 These statistics indicate how attracting individuals with social responsibilities before hiring may lead to lower turnover and
higher productivity when they become employees.
Sustainability is a key part of social responsibility, as well as playing a
key HR role in dealing with economic challenges. Sustainability is being able
to continue to operate, survive, and adjust to significant changes. Balancing
business needs and social factors, such as layoffs, job losses, business reputations, ethics, and other factors makes sustainability a part of HR in changing
business environments.13
Another evolving area in which HR is playing a social responsibility role is
in creating a “green” culture. Although that may seem unusual, participating
in environmental improvement efforts can enhance employees’ views of the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 10
26/06/10 3:26 PM
CHAPTER 1
11
Human Resource Management in Organizations
“Growing Green” in HR
Getting employees involved in green efforts is growing.
Such efforts may affect the organizational corporate
image with customers, employees, and throughout the
business community in the area. Also, these programs
can result in reduced operational costs linked to HR
policies on recycling, creating less waste and pollution,
reducing lighting and power usage, and many other
means. According to a survey of 2,500 hiring managers,
green programs also may create more jobs for employee
environmental specialists.
Firms that have emphasized green have found
that the effects on attracting, retaining, and motivating
workers of all types can be positive. For instance,
General Electric highlights its “Ecomagination”
on its recruiting website. In Chicago a number of
firms in different industries offer green-job training
HR perspective
programs for environmental specialists, as well as
other participants.
A broader value of playing a key green role is that
it can result in more organizational strategic emphasis.
Organizations such as Mitsubishi International,
Google, Emory University, and others have established
sustainability officers to lead environmental efforts. For
instance, Google switched a California facility to more
solar power, guided by those officers.
HR has a key role in green efforts. The need
to communicate, train, and enforce the relevant
green requirements with employees and managers
throughout the organization is important. Also, safety
and health issues may be affected by these efforts. In
summary, HR management will have an increasingly
green role in both large and small companies.14
social responsibility of a firm. Participation in different types of these efforts
also can aid in recruiting employees, especially those who have higher views of
such firms.15 As the HR Perspective discusses, the role of HR in green efforts
is growing in importance.
G L O B A L
Global Social Responsibility and HR As organizations have more and
more workers and businesses in various countries, social responsibility globally is becoming more of an HR issue. Global practices of social responsibility
are often conducted through HR and may include collecting/donating money
for local charities or national disasters and numerous other activities. Doing
these activities results in higher organizational images globally, better employee
morale and loyalty, and more competitive advantages with consumers.16
Customer Service and Quality Linked to HR
Linking HR to social responsibility, customer service, and quality significantly
affects organizational effectiveness. Having managers and employees focus
on customers contributes significantly to achieving organizational goals and
maintaining competitive advantages. In most organizations, service quality
is greatly influenced by individual employees who interact with customers.
Employee job satisfaction also can be influenced by positive customer satisfaction.17 Customers often consider continuity of customer service representatives
as important when making marketing and sales decisions.
Unfortunately, overall customer satisfaction with sales quality has declined
in the United States and other countries. For example, the decline in customer
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 11
26/06/10 3:26 PM
12
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
satisfaction has affected many of the U.S. airlines. Even though some airlines
have made efforts to improve services, customers continue to be rather skeptical of the improvements in the industry.18
Employee Engagement and HR Culture
What is evident from the previous discussions is that the engagement of
employees is a crucial goal and link to an effective organizational culture and
HR’s role in it. Employee engagement is the extent to which individuals feel
linked to organizational success and how the organization performs positively.
Numerous studies have shown that engaged employees are less likely to quit,
more likely to encourage other persons to become employees, and more likely
to commit to activities positively outside of their organizations. One study
found that highly engaged employees are almost 80% more likely to be top
performers and miss fewer work days.19 The unfortunate lack of a positive
culture can lead to more employee dissatisfaction, turnover, poor service, and
other undesirable outcomes and behaviors. That is why employee engagement
is such a crucial part of effective HR management and is linked to social
networking.
Social Networking and Engagement An integral part of employee engagement is social networking. This networking involves communicating to other
employees, nonwork friends, community contacts, and others. Previously,
social networking primarily was done through personal contacts as well as
oral communications. However, networking has become a massive issue for
employees and employers as technology has expanded through e-mailing, textmessaging, twitters, blogs, and many other formats.
Some employees, especially younger ones, use such technology to communicate almost constantly with others. This expansive use of technological
methods may create both good and bad images for employees and employers,
as well as work-related legal issues. One survey by Deloitte found that 60% of
executives believe they should know how workers use network profiles. Also,
75% of employers indicated that using social networks online makes creating
a negative company image easier.20
However, some organizations have found that using social networks online
can aid in recruiting new employees. Use of various types of technology can
lead to recruiting more people, as well as reducing recruiting costs.21 The use
of these technologies and issues in this area are discussed more in other chapters on specific HR resources and issues.
ORGANIZATIONAL ETHICS AND HR MANAGEMENT
Employee engagement
The extent to which
individuals feel linked to
organizational success and
how the organization performs
positively.
Closely linked with the strategic role of HR is the way managers and HR
professionals influence the ethics of people in organizations. How those ethics
affect work and lives for individuals may aid in producing more positive work
outcomes.22 As Figure 1-4 indicates, establishing HR ethical areas can lead to
organizational and individual consequences.23
The need for great attention to ethics has grown in the past few years, as
evidenced by the corporate scandals at numerous financial and investment
firms in the United States and globally. These scandals illustrate that ethical
lapses are not just symbolic; they affect numerous firms and employees. The
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 12
26/06/10 3:27 PM
CHAPTER 1
13
Human Resource Management in Organizations
Business Ethics and HR Management Consequences
F I G U R E 1- 4
BUSINESS ETHICS
HR Management Ethical Areas
Compensation
Development
Performance management
HR policies
Staffing
Training
Labor relations
Legal compliance
Consequences
Job satisfaction
Reduced turnover
Decreased absenteeism
LOGGING ON
Ethics & Policy Integration
Centre
The Ethics & Policy Integration Centre
is an online resource for ethical and
policy issues. Visit the website at
www.ethicaledge.com.
Organizational commitment
Higher job performance
Ethical decision making
expansion of the Internet has led to more publicity about
ethical issues, including ethics electronic job boards and
postings.24 An increase in ethics issues has been identified by
the Ethics Resource Center. One survey of 3,000 U.S. workers found that within a year, 52% had seen one incident of
misconduct and 36% had observed two or more ethical violations. The survey also reported that almost 70% of their
employers had done ethics training.25
Ethical Behavior and Organizational Culture
Numerous writers on business ethics consistently stress that the primary determinant of ethical behavior is organizational culture, which is the shared values
and beliefs in an organization mentioned earlier. Every organization has a
culture, and that culture influences how executives, managers, and employees
act in making organizational decisions. For example, if meeting objectives and
financial targets is stressed, then it should not be a surprise when executives
and managers fudge numbers or falsify cost records. However, a positive ethical culture exists in many organizations. When the following four elements of
ethics programs exist, ethical behavior is more likely to occur:
•
•
•
•
A written code of ethics and standards of conduct
Training on ethical behavior for all executives, managers, and employees
Advice to employees on ethical situations they face, often made by HR
Systems for confidential reporting of ethical misconduct or questionable
behavior
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 13
26/06/10 3:27 PM
14
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Cisco Makes Global Ethics
Important and Fun
Cisco Systems, a technology firm with more than
60,000 employees worldwide, has emphasized
ethics in interesting ways. Until a few years ago,
Cisco did ethics training and enforcement like
many other firms by using organization-required
sessions and procedures. However, Cisco now uses
a constantly available ethics program through its
firm communications, Internet, and even television
programs similar to American Idol.
To conduct its ethics awareness, Cisco enables
employees worldwide to view the Ethics Idol via
television on its intranet. Cartoon individuals
present different ethical situations and then have
“judges” give decisions. Employees vote on the
best answer to each situation. More than 10,000
Cisco employees participate voluntarily in these
network analyses. Many employees look at the
Ethics Idol after work rather than during business
hours. After the employees vote, Cisco’s ethics
office professionals then give the best answer
HR best practices
linked to Cisco company standards and compliance
requirements.
Using these creative and entertaining means has
enhanced awareness of ethical issues throughout
the firm. A new ethics document has been updated
regularly, and more than 90% of Cisco employees
have become certified in reviewing the code of the
firm. Merging ethics issues, technology, and regular
interactive training has led to ethical understanding
and behavior by Cisco employees. Other firms have
similar programs, but Cisco’s efforts are a model of
ethical training and engagement.
This creative ethics program is an expansion of
Cisco’s corporate responsibility efforts. For years
Cisco has been a leader in the “Corporate Citizens”
listing on business ethics, and one of only three firms
that have been recognized every year. Although
other firms have ethics programs, Cisco’s broad
efforts illustrate how expanding ethical training and
engagement of employees can be effective.26
An ethical business culture is based first on organizational mission and
values. Other related factors can include shareholders, long-term perspectives,
process integrity, and leadership effectiveness.27 The roles of boards, CEOs,
other executives, and HR leaders are vital in setting the culture for ethics globally as well as locally. Training of employees is crucial, and how they respond
to situations may be linked to their expectations, motivations, and other factors.28 As the HR Best Practices indicates, Cisco has emphasized ethics using
creative and effective means throughout its global business world.
Ethics and Global Differences
G L O B A L
Differences in legal, political, and cultural values and practices in different
countries often raise ethical issues for global employers who must comply
with both their home-country laws and the laws of other countries. With the
changes in the global economy in the past few years, a France-based entity, the
Organization for Economic Cooperation (OECD), has emphasized the effects
of ethics. The OECD has recommended that global multinational firms establish and implement stricter ethical standards to aid business development.29
The different legal, political, and cultural factors in other countries can
lead to ethical and legal conflicts for global managers. Some global firms have
established guidelines and policies to reduce the payments of bribes, but even
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 14
26/06/10 3:27 PM
CHAPTER 1
15
Human Resource Management in Organizations
those efforts do not provide detailed guidance on handling the situations that
can arise.
HR’s Role in Organizational Ethics
Organizations that are seen as ethical in the way they operate have longerterm success. Because people in organizations are making ethical decisions on
a daily basis, HR management plays a key role as the “keeper and voice” of
organizational ethics. All managers, including HR managers, must deal with
ethical issues and be sensitive to how they interplay with HR activities. Instead
of relying just on HR policies or laws, people must be guided by values and
personal behavior “codes,” including these two questions:
•
•
Does the behavior or result meet all applicable laws, regulations, and
government codes?
Does the behavior or result meet both organizational standards and
professional standards of ethical behavior?
There are a number of different views about the importance of HR in
ensuring that ethical practices, justice, and fairness are present throughout
HR practices. Figure 1-5 identifies some of the most frequent areas of ethical
misconduct involving HR activities.
Ethical issues pose fundamental questions about fairness, justice, truthfulness, and social responsibility. Just complying with a wider range of
requirements, laws, and regulations cannot cover every ethical situation that
executives, managers, HR professionals, and employees will face. Yet, having
all the elements of an ethics program may not prevent individual managers or
executives from engaging in or failing to report unethical behavior. Even HR
staff members may be reluctant to report ethics concerns, primarily because of
fears that doing so may affect their current and future employment.
Critical for guiding ethical decisions and behavior is training. Firms such
as Best Buy, Caterpillar, and others have training for all employees via the
Internet or in person. How to address difficult and conflicting situations is part
F I G U R E 1- 5
Examples of HR-Related Ethical Misconduct Activities
Compensation
Misrepresenting hours
and time worked
Falsifying work
expense reports
Personal bias in
performance appraisals
and pay increases
Deliberate inappropriate
overtime classifications
Accepting personal
gains/gifts from vendors
Employee Relations
Employees lying to
supervisors and
coworkers
Executives/managers
e-mailing false public
information to customers
and vendors
Misusing/stealing
organizational assets
and supplies
Intentionally violating
safety/health regulations
Staffing and
Equal Employment
Discriminatory favoritism
in hiring and promotion
Sexual harassment of
other employees
EEO discrimination in
recruiting and interviewing
Conducting inappropriate
background investigations
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 15
26/06/10 3:27 PM
16
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
of effective HR management training efforts.30 To help HR professionals deal
with ethical issues, the Society for Human Resource Management has developed a code of ethics for its members and provides information on handling
ethical issues and policies.31
HR Ethics and Sarbanes-Oxley The Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) was passed
by Congress to make certain that publicly traded companies follow accounting
controls that could reduce the likelihood of illegal and unethical behaviors. A
number of HR facets must be managed in line with SOX. The biggest issues
are linked to executive compensation and benefits, but SOX sections 404, 406,
802, and 806 require companies to establish ethics codes, develop employee
complaint systems, and have antiretaliation policies for employees who act as
whistle blowers to identify wrongful actions. HR has been involved in routing
people through the massive compliance verification effort that has occurred.
Numerous other local, state, and federal laws may relate to organizational
and employee ethical issues. Some additional federal laws include the False
Claims Act, Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, and others. Given all these laws,
regulations, and issues, a broad study of ethics is philosophical, complex, and
beyond the scope of this book. The intent here is to concisely identify ethical
aspects of HR management. Various ethical issues in HR management are also
highlighted throughout the text as appropriate.
CURRENT AND FUTURE HR MANAGEMENT
CHALLENGES
As the way HR is managed in organizations changes, some challenges are affecting all employers. Responding effectively requires a competent HR presence to
deal with the challenges. A wide range of factors are putting more planning,
administrative, and cost pressures on organizations both in the United States and
globally. Some of these new challenges and increased pressures are discussed next.
Organizational Cost Pressures and Restructuring
An overriding theme facing managers and organizations is to operate in a “costless” mode, which means continually looking for ways to reduce costs of all
types—financial, operations, equipment, and labor. Pressures from global competitors have forced many U.S. firms to close facilities, use international outsourcing, adapt their management practices, increase productivity, and decrease
labor costs in order to become more competitive. The growth of information
technology, particularly that linked to the Internet, has influenced HR management as it handles the number, location, and required activities of employees.
These shifts have caused some organizations to reduce the number of
employees, while at the same time scrambling to attract and retain employees
with different capabilities than were previously needed. Responding to organizational cost pressures and restructurings, as well as the other HR challenges,
has resulted in the transformation of HR management in organizations.
Economics and Job Changes
The shifts in the U.S. and global economy in the past years have changed
the number and types of jobs present in the United States. The recession in
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 16
26/06/10 3:27 PM
CHAPTER 1
17
Human Resource Management in Organizations
2007–2009 affected many industries such as automotive and financial firms.
In general, the United States has continued to have private- and public-sector
jobs that are service economy in nature, and many of the additional jobs to
be filled in the next several years will be in the service industry rather than
manufacturing firms.
Occupational Shifts Projections of growth in some jobs and decline in others
illustrate the shifts occurring in the U.S. economy. Figure 1-6 lists occupations
that are expected to experience the greatest growth in percentage and numbers
for the period ending in 2016. Most of the fastest-growing occupations percentage-wise are related to information technology and health care. However,
when the growth in the number of jobs is compared to the percentage growth,
an interesting factor is evident. The highest growth of jobs by percentage is
in occupations that generally require more education and expertise training,
whereas the numerical growth of several jobs is in occupations requiring less
education and jobs that are lower-skilled.
Another aspect of the shifting economy is revealed in the types of jobs that
have the greatest decline in numbers. They include stock clerks, cashiers, packers, file clerks, and farmers/ranchers.32 These declines reflect shifts in economic
factors and how those jobs are being combined with others or eliminated due
to business changes.
Workforce Availability and Quality Concerns Various parts of the United
States face significant workforce shortages that exist due to an inadequate supply of workers with the skills needed to perform the jobs being added. It may
not be that there are too few people—only that there are too few with many
F I G U R E 1- 6
Fastest Growth in Job Changes to 2016
Percentage Increase in Jobs
Increase in Job Numbers
Network systems/data
communications analysts
53%
Registered nurses
587,000
Personal/home care aides
51%
Retail salespersons
557,000
Home health aides
49%
Customer service reps
545,000
Computer software engineers
44%
Food preparations workers
452,000
Veterinary technologists
41%
Office clerks
404,000
Personal financial advisors
41%
Personal/home care aides
389,000
Makeup artists
40%
Home health aides
384,000
Medical assistants
35%
Postsecondary teachers
382,000
Source: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 17
26/06/10 3:27 PM
18
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
of the skills being demanded. For instance, one survey of more than 2,000
employers found that the hardest jobs to fill are engineers, nurses, technicians,
teachers, and sales representatives.33
Even though many Americans are graduating from high school and college, employers are concerned about the preparation and specific skills of
new graduates. Comparisons of international test results show that students
in the United States perform slightly above average in math and science, but
well below students in some other directly competitive nations. Also, graduates with degrees in computers, engineering, and the health sciences remain
in short supply relative to the demand for them. That is another reason why
international outsourcing has grown. Unless major improvements are made to
U.S. educational systems, U.S. employers will be unable to find enough qualified workers for the growing number of skilled jobs of all types. That is why
talent management and development has become one of the most important
issues emphasized by HR management.
Talent Management and Development A broad focus of HR professionals is on talent management and development to address the workforce and job
changes. Despite the economic pressures, the emphasis on talent management
has appeared on the HR scene in organizations of all sizes and in all industries.
Some forces behind the emphasis on talent management have included:
•
•
•
•
The impending retirement of baby boomers worldwide
Shortages of skilled workers of certain types and at certain levels
Increasing global competition for human resource talent
Growth in technology capable of automating talent management processes
These and other factors have forced organizations to develop a more strategic,
integrated, and automated approach to talent management.
Whether it involves attracting, recruiting, and hiring qualified talented
individuals, or training and developing employees for current and future jobs,
talent management is crucial. A survey by McKinsey and Company of 200
companies found that better-performing firms hired more qualified people,
established more specific performance expectations, and worked to link
employees to corporate culture and strategies.34 Further discussion of talent
management occurs in later chapters.
Growth in Contingent Workforce Contingent workers (temporary workers, independent contractors, leased employees, and part-timers) represent
about one-fourth of the U.S. workforce. Many employers operate with a core
group of regular employees who have critical skills, and then expand and
shrink the workforce by using contingent workers.
The number of contingent workers has grown for many reasons. One reason is the economic factor. Temporary workers are used to replace full-time
employees, and many contingent workers are paid less and/or receive fewer
benefits than regular employees. For instance, omitting contingent workers from health care benefits saves some firms
LOGGING ON
20% to 40% in labor costs.
Development Dimensions
Another reason for the increased use of contingent
International
workers
is that it may reduce legal liability for some
Development Dimensions International
employers.
As more and more employment-related lawsuits
provides resources for globalization of
have
been
filed,
employers have become more wary about
organizations and HR. Visit the website
adding
regular
full-time employees. By using contract
at www.ddiworld.com.
workers, including those in other countries, employers may
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 18
26/06/10 3:27 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
19
reduce a number of legal issues regarding selection, discrimination, benefits,
discipline, and termination.
Globalization of Organizations and HR
G L O B A L
Expatriate A citizen of
one country who is working
in a second country and
employed by an organization
headquartered in the first
country.
Host-country national A
citizen of one country who is
working in that country and
employed by an organization
headquartered in a second
country.
Third-country national
A citizen of one country
who is working in a second
country and employed by an
organization headquartered in
a third country.
The internationalization of business has proceeded at a rapid pace. Many U.S.
firms, both large and small, receive a substantial portion of their profits and
sales from other countries. Firms such as Coca-Cola, Exxon, Mobil, Microsoft,
and General Electric derive half or more of total sales and profits from outside the United States. The reverse is also true. For example, Toyota, based
in Japan, has grown its market share and its number of jobs in the United
States and North America. Also, Toyota, Honda, Nissan, and other Japanese
automobile manufacturers, electronics firms, and suppliers have maintained
operations in the United States, whereas Chrysler and General Motors have
had to reduce major operations.
The globalization of business has shifted from trade and investment to the
integration of global operations, management, and strategic alliances, which
has significantly affected the management of human resources. Individuals
from other countries are employees. There are three types of global workers:
expatriate, host-country national, and third-country national.
An expatriate is a citizen of one country who is working in a second
country and employed by an organization headquartered in the first country.
Experienced expatriates can provide a pool of talent that can be tapped as the
organization expands its operations more broadly into even more countries.
A host-country national is a citizen of one country who is working in that
country and employed by an organization headquartered in a second country.
Host-country nationals often know the culture, politics, laws, and business
customs better than an outsider would.
A third-country national is a citizen of one country who is working in a second country and employed by an organization headquartered in a third country.
For example, a U.S. citizen working for a British oil company as a manager in
Norway is a third-county national. Staffing with third-country nationals shows
a truly global approach.
Attracting global talent has created political issues. For instance, U.S.
employers are having a difficult time hiring enough engineers and educated
tech workers, but U.S. federal legislation restricts the quota for high-skilled
workers to be admitted from other countries in light of the large amount of
illegal immigration and high numbers of unemployed U.S. workers that are
occurring.
Global Economic Factors Economic factors are linked to different political,
legal, cultural, and economic systems. In many developed countries, especially
in Europe, employment restrictions and wage levels are high. When labor costs
in the United States are compared with those in Germany and Korea, the differences are significant, as Figure 1-7 shows. As a result of these differences,
many U.S. and European firms are moving jobs to lower-wage countries and
other continental locations.
Critics of globalization cite the extremely low wage rates paid by the
international firms and the substandard working conditions that exist in some
underdeveloped countries. Various advocacy groups have accused global firms
of being “sweatshop employers.” Thus, some global employers have made
efforts to ensure that foreign factories adhere to more appropriate HR standards, while others have not. Global employers counter that even though the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 19
26/06/10 3:27 PM
20
Environment of Human Resource Management
SECTION 1
Hourly Compensation Costs for Manufacturing Production Workers
F I G U R E 1- 7
Germany
$37.66
$30.17
Australia
U.K.
$29.43
Countries
France
$28.57
Canada
$28.19
U.S.
$24.59
Japan
$19.75
$6.58
Korea
Taiwan
Phillipines
$0.00
$2.92
$1.10
$5.00
$10.00
$15.00
$20.00
$25.00
$30.00
$35.00
$40.00
Hourly Costs (in U.S. Dollars)
Source: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov.
wage rates in some countries are low, their employees often receive the highest
wages and experience the best working conditions that exist in those local
countries. Also, they argue, more people have jobs in the host countries, which
allows them to improve their living standards.
Global Legal and Political Factors Firms in the United States, Europe,
and elsewhere are accustomed to relatively stable political and legal systems.
However, many nations function under turbulent and varied legal and political systems. International firms in many industries have dramatically increased
security for both operations and employees. Terrorist threats and incidents
have significantly affected airlines, travel companies, construction firms, and
even retailers such as McDonald’s. HR management must respond to such
concerns as part of transnational operations and risk management efforts.
Therefore, HR-related efforts vary in character and stability. Compliance
with laws and company actions on wages, benefits, union relations, worker
privacy, workplace safety, and other issues illustrate the importance of HR
management when operating transnationally. As a result, it is crucial for HR
professionals to conduct a comprehensive review of the political environment
and employment laws before beginning operations in a country. The role and
nature of labor unions should be a part of that review.
Workforce Demographics and Diversity
The U.S. workforce has been changing dramatically. It is more diverse racially
and ethnically, more women are in it than ever before, and the average age
of its members is increasing. As a result of these demographic shifts, HR
management in organizations has had to adapt to a more varied labor force
both externally and internally. In addition to the issues discussed in the following sections, this growing diversity and aging of the workforce has raised
employer concerns and means that HR is having to devote more time and
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 20
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
21
effort to ensuring that nondiscriminatory policies and practices are followed.
The effective management of diversity issues in organizations is getting more
attention, as will be highlighted in later chapters.
Racial/Ethnic Diversity Racial and ethnic minorities account for a growing
percentage of the overall labor force, with the percentage of Hispanics equal
to or greater than the percentage of African Americans. Immigrants will continue to expand that growth. An increasing number of individuals characterize
themselves as multiracial, suggesting that the American “melting pot” is blurring racial and ethnic identities.
Racial/ethnic differences have also created greater cultural diversity because
of the accompanying differences in traditions, languages, religious practices, and
so on. For example, global events have increased employers’ attention to individuals who are Muslim, and more awareness and accommodation for Islamic
religious beliefs and practices have become a common concern. Workforce
diversity is further discussed in Chapter 4.
Women in the Workforce Women constitute about 50% of the U.S. workforce, but may be a majority in certain occupations. For instance, the membership of HR professionals in the Society for Human Resource Management
(SHRM) is more than 75% female.35 Additionally, numerous women workers are single, separated, divorced, or widowed, and therefore are “primary”
income earners. A growing number of U.S. households include “domestic partners,” who are committed to each other though not married and who may be of
the same or the opposite sex. Many of the women in these partnerships, as well
as many who are married, have partners or spouses who also are employed.
For many workers in the United States, balancing the demands of family
and work is a significant challenge. Although that balancing has always been
a concern, the increased number of working women and dual-career couples
has resulted in greater tensions for many workers, both male and female.
Employers have had to respond to work/family concerns in order to retain
employees. Responses have included greater use of job sharing, the establishment of child-care services, increased flexibility in hours, and varied work-life
programs.
Aging Workforce In many economically developed countries, the population is aging, resulting in a significantly aging workforce. In the United States,
during the second decade of the twenty-first century, a significant number of
experienced employees will be retiring, changing to part-time, or otherwise
shifting their employment. Replacing the experience and talents of longerservice workers is a growing challenge facing employers in all industries.
This loss of longer-service workers is frequently referred to as a “brain
drain,” due to the capabilities and experience of these workers, and employers
are having to develop programs to retain them, have them mentor and transfer
knowledge to younger employees, and find ways for them to continue contributing by limited means. One study found that 65% of baby boomers want to
continue working part-time and avoid full-time employment.36
HR Technology
Greater use of technology has led to organizational use of a human resource
management system (HRMS), which is an integrated system providing
information used by HR management in decision making. This terminology
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 21
26/06/10 3:28 PM
22
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
emphasizes that making HR decisions, not just building databases and using
technology, is the primary reason for compiling data in an information system.
Purposes for Expanding HR Technology The rapid expansion of HR
technology serves two major purposes in organizations. One relates to administrative and operational efficiency, and the other to effectiveness. The first
purpose is to improve the efficiency with which data on employees and HR
activities are compiled. The most basic example is the automation of payroll
and benefits activities. Another common use of technology is tracking EEO/
affirmative action activities. Beyond those basic applications, the use of Webbased information systems has allowed the HR unit in organizations to become
more administratively efficient and communicate more quickly to employees.
The second purpose of the use of HR technology is related to strategic HR
planning. Having accessible data enables HR planning and managerial decision making to be based to a greater degree on information rather than relying
on managerial perceptions and intuition.
Greater Uses of HR Technology The greater uses of technologies are affecting how HR activities are performed in many ways. To illustrate, numerous
Wikis, Blogs,
Twitters, and HR
The explosive growth of the Internet has resulted in many
employees and managers participating in wikis, blogs,
twitters, text-messaging, and other techniques. Some of
the HR aspects of the Internet are highlighted here.
In a wiki, which is a widely available website
for individuals to make comments, employees can
communicate both positive and negative messages
on many topics. Employers have used wikis, such as
Wikipedia and other sources, to increase the exchange
of ideas and information among a wide range of
individuals. Wikis are one example of collaborative
HR. This process of collaboration can lead to HR
professionals from several different organizations
jointly working to address shared business problems
and interacting regularly with other professionals.
Blogs are Web logs kept by individuals or groups
to post and exchange information on a range of
topics. People create and use more than one million
blogs daily. The subjects of blogs vary. An example
of company use would be CEOs or HR executives
exchanging information with employees immediately
on operational or other important occurrences. Many
bloggers are young and college-educated. Often, HR
HR online
professionals are not as involved in blogs as some
other employees, but they are having to ramp up their
awareness and usage of this format.
An even newer technology tool is twitter, which
is a microblog that allows people to send and receive
tweets. Basically, a tweet is a quick message of less than
140 characters through which individuals quickly send
information to others. Whether such information is valid,
positive or negative, or useful is a topic of continuing
controversy. Some firms use twitters to send out policy
changes, competitive services details, and many other
organizational messages, but individuals can use
twitters inappropriately and send critical, obscene, or
even harassing details to other employees.
These technology tools and others create significant
HR issues, including ethical and disciplinary actions.
Firms must establish policies and regulations on how all
of this technology can and should be used. For example,
IBM has established guidelines directing that the use of
twitters must be responsible, protect privacy, and correct
mistakes made by individual tweets. Throughout this text,
the various HR technology means will be discussed as
they apply to specific HR activities.37
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 22
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
23
firms provide a Web-based employee self-service program to their worldwide
staffs. Employees can go online to access and change their personal data, enroll
in or change benefits programs, and prepare for performance reviews. As discussed in the HR Online box, the explosive use of wikis, blogs, twitters, and
other technology is affecting HR significantly. Additional examples of how
various HR activities are being transformed by technology will be presented
throughout the chapters of this text.
Measuring HR Impact through Metrics
Traditionally, much of HR has focused on administrative activities, and on
counting them, such as the number of people hired, total benefits costs, and
so on. However, as HR has grown in importance and changed, it has had to
develop measurements of its results, including financial, in order to justify its
activities. Whether it is measuring the cost of hiring someone, calculating the
turnover costs when persons leave the firm, or doing a return-on-investment
analysis of training results and expenses, HR has had to become more analytical and develop metrics that measure the HR efforts, much like financial
officers measure their responsibilities. HR metrics are discussed as part of
Chapter 2, as well as throughout the text.
MANAGING HR IN ORGANIZATIONS
In a real sense, every manager in an organization is an HR manager. Sales
managers, head nurses, drafting supervisors, college deans, and accounting
supervisors all engage in HR management, and their effectiveness depends in
part on the success of organizational HR systems. However, it is unrealistic
to expect a nursing supervisor or an engineering manager to know about the
nuances of equal employment regulations or how to design and administer a
compensation and benefits system. For that reason, many organizations have
people in an HR department who specialize in these activities, but HR in
smaller organizations may be somewhat different.
Smaller Organizations and HR Management
In the United States and worldwide, small businesses employ more than 50%
of all private-sector employees and generate new jobs each year.38 In surveys
over several years by the U.S. Small Business Association (SBA), the issues
identified as significant concerns in small organizations were consistent: having sufficient numbers of qualified workers, the rapidly increasing costs of
benefits, rising taxes, and compliance with government regulations. Notice
these concerns have an HR focus, especially when governmental compliance
with wage/hour, safety, equal employment, and other regulations are considered. HR efforts through recruiting, employee empowerment, and training
have been found to contribute positively to sales growth in various small
service industry firms.39 As a result, for many smaller organizations, HR issues
are often significant.
However, not every small organization is able to maintain an HR department. In a company with an owner and only three employees, the owner
usually takes care of HR issues. As an organization grows, often a clerical
employee is added to handle payroll, benefits, and required HR recordkeeping.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 23
26/06/10 3:28 PM
24
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
If new employees are hired, supervisors and managers usually do the recruiting, selecting, and training. These HR activities reduce the time that supervisors
and managers have to focus on operations, sales and marketing, accounting,
and other business areas. Thus, for both small and large employers, numerous
HR activities are being outsourced to specialized vendors. Typically, at 80 to
100 employees, an organization will need to designate a person to specialize
in HR management. Other HR jobs are added as the company gets larger and
as HR technology increasingly becomes available for small- and medium-sized
organizations.
HR Cooperation with Operating and Line Managers
In departments such as accounting, network technology, operations, customer
service, and others, cooperation between line and operating managers, supervisors, executives, and HR staff is necessary for HR efforts to succeed. In many
cases, the HR professionals and staff members design processes and systems
that the operating managers must help implement. The exact division of labor
between HR and other departments varies from organization to organization.
Throughout this book, figures labeled “Typical Division of HR
Responsibilities” illustrate how HR responsibilities in various areas may be
divided in organizations having specialized HR departments. The first such
example, Figure 1-8, shows how the responsibilities for a familiar activity—
recruiting planning—might be divided between the HR department and the
operating managers in an organization.
How HR Is Seen in Organizations
For a number of years, HR departments and individuals have been viewed
in different ways, both positive and negative. HR management is necessary,
especially due to the huge number of government regulations enacted over
the past decades. However, the role of protecting corporate assets against the
many legal issues often puts HR management in an enforcement role that may
be seen as restrictive and administratively focused.
F I G U R E 1- 8
Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Recruiting
HR Unit
Forecasts recruiting needs
Prepares copy for recruiting ads,
campaigns, and Internet resources
Plans and conducts recruiting efforts
Audits and evaluates all recruiting
activities
Managers
Anticipate needs for employees to fill
vacancies, including capabilities needed
of applicants
Relate with existing employees on
possible applicant referrals
Assist in recruiting efforts with
information about job requirements
Review success/failure of recruiting
activities
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 24
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
25
Negative Views of HR The legal compliance role and other administrative
aspects of HR staff can create conflicting views. The negative perception by
some employees, managers, and executives is that HR departments and personnel are too bureaucratic, too administratively focused, too detail-oriented, too
costly, and not effective change agents.40 Various authors have referred to HR
departments as “dinosaurs” or “gatekeepers” who build silos and resist changes.
These critics do not see HR as making significant organizational contributions.
Unfortunately, these views are accurate in some HR departments. Those
HR departments concern themselves with the “administrivia” of personnel
policies and practices—which companies are increasingly outsourcing to
contractors who can do these tasks more cheaply and efficiently. Frequently,
HR managers are seen as being more concerned about activities than results,
and HR efforts as too seldom linking to employee, managerial, and business
performance organizational metrics. As would be expected, numerous HR
professionals have criticized these views as being too negative and not what
HR is actually doing in many organizations.
Positive, Contributing Views of HR Despite many criticisms, HR can be
respected if done well and truly brought into the realm of business strategy.
HR can and should be a special part of any organization, which means viewing the people and their talents as an opportunity for creating greater organizational competitive advantages. That is why HR in many organizations has
recognized the need to change even more to overcome the negative images.
As previously indicated, economic, global, workforce, and other aspects are
increasingly creating challenging practices for HR professionals.41
Key for a more positive view is for HR to expand as a business contributor, as will be highlighted in the following sections. One leader in creating
this view, among others, has been Dave Ulrich. He and other advocates have
emphasized that HR needs to become more of a change agent and shift positively how HR impacts organizatons.42 The different roles of HR and how they
need to be changing and expanding are discussed next.
HR MANAGEMENT ROLES
Several roles can be fulfilled by HR management. The nature and extent of
these roles depend on both what upper management wants HR management
to do and what competencies the HR staff have demonstrated. Three roles are
typically identified for HR. The focus of each of them, as shown in Figure 1-9,
is as follows:
•
•
•
Administrative: Focusing on clerical administration and recordkeeping,
including essential legal paperwork and policy implementation.
Operational and employee advocate: Managing most HR activities
in line with the strategies and operations that have been identified by
management and serving as employee “champion” for employee issues
and concerns.
Strategic: Helping to define the strategy relative to human capital and its
contribution to organizational results.
The administrative role traditionally has been the dominant role for HR.
However, as Figure 1-9 indicates, a broader transformation in HR is needed
so that significantly less HR time and fewer HR staff are used just for clerical
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 25
26/06/10 3:28 PM
26
SECTION 1
F I G U R E 1- 9
Administrative
Personnel practices
and procedures
Legal compliance
forms and paperwork
Environment of Human Resource Management
Roles of HR Management
Operational Actions
Managing employee
relationship issues
Employee advocate
Strategic HR
Organizational/business
strategies
HR strategic planning
Evaluation of HR
effectiveness
administration. The emphasis on the operational and employee advocate role is
growing in most organizations. The greatest challenge is for more strategic HR
management. The biggest barriers to HR becoming more strategic, according
to one study, are transaction of administrative tasks (42%), lack of strategic
HR involvement (31%), and insufficient HR budgets (22%).43 A closer look
at each of the HR roles and how these roles are being transformed follows.
Administrative Role of HR
The administrative role of HR management has been heavily oriented to processing and recordkeeping. This role has given HR management in some organizations the reputation of being staffed by paper shufflers who primarily tell
managers and employees what cannot be done. If limited to the administrative
role, HR staff are seen primarily as clerical and lower-level administrative
aides to the organization. Two major shifts driving the transformation of the
administrative role are greater use of technology and outsourcing.
Technology Transforming HR To improve the administrative efficiency of
HR and the responsiveness of HR to employees and managers, more HR functions are becoming available electronically or are being done on the Internet
using Web-based technology. Technology is being used in most HR activities,
from employment applications and employee benefits enrollments to e-learning
using Internet-based resources.
Outsourcing of HR Increasingly, many HR administrative functions are
being outsourced to vendors. This outsourcing of HR administrative activities
has grown dramatically in HR areas such as employee assistance (counseling),
retirement planning, benefits administration, payroll services, and outplacement services.
The primary reasons why HR functions are outsourced are to save money
on HR staffing, to take advantage of specialized vendor expertise and technology, and to be able to focus on more strategic HR activities. These activities
are being outsourced to firms both in the United States and worldwide. Such
contracting for HR services is an evolving practice that continues to change
the administrative HR functions for many employers, as discussed further in
Chapter 2.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 26
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
27
Operational and Employee Advocate Role for HR
HR often has been viewed as the “employee advocate” in organizations. As
the voice for employee concerns, HR professionals traditionally may serve as
“company morale officers,” but they spend considerable time on HR “crisis
management,” dealing with employee problems that are both work-related
and not work-related. Employee advocacy helps ensure fair and equitable
treatment for employees regardless of personal background or circumstances.
Sometimes the HR advocate role may create conflict with operating managers. However, without the HR advocate role, employers could face even more
lawsuits and regulatory complaints than they do now.
The operational role requires HR professionals to cooperate with various
departmental and operating managers and supervisors, to identify and implement needed programs and policies in the organization. Operational activities
are tactical in nature. Compliance with equal employment opportunity and
other laws is ensured, employment applications are processed, current openings are filled through interviews, supervisors are trained, safety problems are
resolved, and wage and benefit questions are answered. These efforts require
matching HR activities with the strategies of the organization.
Strategic Role for HR
Differences between the operational and strategic roles exist in a number of
HR areas. The strategic HR role means that HR professionals are proactive
in addressing business realities and focusing on future business needs, such
as strategic planning, compensation strategies, the performance of HR, and
measuring its results. However, HR often does not help formulate strategies
for the organization as a whole; instead it merely carries them out through
HR activities.
Many executives, managers, and HR professionals are increasingly seeing
the need for HR management to become a greater strategic contributor to
the “business” success of organizations. Even not-for-profit organizations,
such as governmental and social service entities, must manage their human
resources in a business-oriented manner. In fact, it has been suggested that
the HR function should be managed as its own business. Therefore, a large
number of senior HR executives are selected from outside HR experience.
Doing this means that these individuals have a business focus, not just HR
experience.44
HR should be responsible for knowing what the true cost of human capital
is for an employer. For example, it may cost two times key employees’ annual
salaries to replace them if they leave. Turnover is something HR can help control, and if it is successful in saving the company money with good retention
and talent management strategies, those may be important contributions to
the bottom line of organizational performance.
“Contributing at the Table” The role of HR as a strategic business partner
is often described as “having a seat at the table,” and contributing to the strategic directions and success of the organization. That means HR is involved
in devising strategy in addition to implementing strategy. Part of HR’s contribution is to have financial expertise and to produce financial results, not just
employee morale or administrative efficiencies. Therefore, a significant concern for chief financial officers (CFOs) is whether HR executives are equipped
to help plan and meet financial requirements.45
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 27
26/06/10 3:28 PM
28
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
However, even though this strategic role of HR is recognized, many organizations still need to make significant progress toward fulfilling it. Some
examples of areas where strategic contributions can be made by HR are:
•
Evaluating mergers and acquisitions for organizational “compatibility,”
structural changes, and staffing needs
• Conducting workforce planning to anticipate the retirement of employees at
all levels and identify workforce expansion in organizational strategic plans
• Leading site selection efforts for new facilities or
transferring operations to international outsourcing
LOGGING ON
locations based on workforce needs
HRN Management Group
• Instituting HR management systems to reduce
Information on strategic issues for HR,
administrative time, equipment, and staff by using HR
including news and success stories for
technology
key HR decision makers, is available by
•
Working with executives to develop a revised sales
linking to the HRN Management Group
compensation and incentives plan as new products or
website at www.hronline.com.
services are rolled out to customers
HR MANAGEMENT COMPETENCIES AND CAREERS
As HR management becomes more complex, greater demands are placed on
individuals who make HR their career specialty. Despite the HR criticism and
concerns mentioned earlier, a significant number of individuals have made HR
their career field. Even readers of this book who do not become HR managers
and professionals will find it useful to know about the competencies required
for effective HR management.
HR Competencies
The transformation of HR toward being more strategic has implications for
the competencies needed by HR professionals. Views of HR have changed over
the years as the needed competencies and the results have differed. Research
has indicated that HR professionals at all levels need the following: 46
•
•
•
Strategic knowledge and impact means
Legal, administrative, and operational capabilities
Technology knowledge and usage abilities
Senior HR leaders may need additional capabilities and competencies.
According to an overview from a SHRM study, senior HR leaders also need:
(a) more business, strategic, HR, and organizational knowledge; (b) ability to
lead changes due to credibility; and (c) ethical behavior and results orientation/
performance.47
For individuals with HR as their career, these competencies help establish
their value as professional resources. The changes in organizations and the
workforce mean that HR as a career field is being altered and will continue to
require more efforts by HR professionals at all levels.
HR Management as a Career Field
A variety of jobs exists within the HR career field, ranging from executive
to clerical. As an employer grows large enough to need someone to focus
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 28
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
29
primarily on HR activities, the role of the HR generalist emerges—that is,
a person who has responsibility for performing a variety of HR activities.
Further growth leads to the addition of HR specialists, or individuals who have
in-depth knowledge and expertise in limited areas of HR. The most common
areas of HR specialty, in order of frequency, are benefits, employment and
recruitment, and compensation.48Appendix F contains examples of HR-related
job descriptions of both a generalist and a specialist.
HR jobs can be found in corporate headquarters as well as in field and
subsidiary operations. A compensation analyst or HR director might be
found at a corporate headquarters. An employment manLOGGING ON
ager for a manufacturing plant and a European HR manager for a global food company are examples of field and
HR Certification Institute
subsidiary HR professionals. The two types of jobs have
For information on the HRCI
different career appeals and challenges, which may affect
certification process, go to
the recruiting, selection, promotions, and development of
www.hrci.org.
individuals.
HR Professionalism and Certification
Depending on the job, HR professionals may need considerable knowledge
about employment regulations, finance, tax law, statistics, and information
systems. In most cases, they also need extensive knowledge about specific
HR activities. The broad range of issues faced by HR professionals has made
involvement in professional associations and organizations important. For
HR generalists, the largest organization is the Society for Human Resource
Management (SHRM). Public-sector HR professionals tend to be concentrated
in the International Personnel Management Association (IPMA). Two other
prominent specialized HR organizations are the WorldatWork Association and
the American Society for Training and Development (ASTD).
One characteristic of a professional field is having a means to certify that
members have the knowledge and competence needed in the profession. The
CPA for accountants and the CLU for life insurance underwriters are examples. Certification can be valuable to individuals and useful to employers as
they select and promote certified individuals.49 The most well-known certification programs for HR generalists are administered by the Human Resource
Certification Institute (HRCI), which is affiliated with SHRM. More than
100,000 professionals have an HRCI certification.
HR generalist A person who
has responsibility for performing
a variety of HR activities.
HR specialist A person who
has in-depth knowledge and
expertise in a limited area
of HR.
HRCI Certification The most widely known HR certifications are the
Professional in Human Resources (PHR) and the Senior Professional in
Human Resources (SPHR), both sponsored by HRCI. Annually, thousands
of individuals take the certification exams. HRCI also sponsors a Global
Professional in Human Resources (GPHR) certification. Eligibility requirements for PHR, SPHR, and GPHR certifications have been updated. These
requirements, effective 2011, are shown in Figure 1-10.
Additionally, eligible individuals must pass the appropriate exam.
Appendix A identifies test specifications and knowledge area covered by
the PHR and SPHR. Readers of this book can identify specific competencies for the HRCI outline to aid them in getting a PHR or SPHR. Certification
from HRCI also exists for global HR professionals in the GPHR. Global
certification recognizes the growth in HR responsibilities in organizations
throughout the world and covers appropriate global HR subject areas noted
through SHRM.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 29
26/06/10 3:28 PM
30
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
HR Certifications at a Glance
F I G U R E 1- 10
The certification exams test on experience-based knowledge; therefore,
you must possess a minimum of two years of professional (exempt-level) HR
experience.
Exam
Eligibility
Requirements
Profile of a
Successful
Candidate*
Professional
in Human
Resources
(PHR®)
Senior
Professional
in Human
Resources
(SPHR®)
Global
Professional in
Human
Resources
(GPHR®)
Minimum of two
years of
professional
(exempt-level)
HR experience.
Minimum of two
years of
professional
(exempt-level)
HR experience.
Must hold a
current PHR or
SPHR
certification.
At least 51% of
your daily work
activities are
within the HR
function.
At least 51% of
your daily work
activities are
within the HR
function.
At least 51% of
your daily work
activities are
within the HR
function.
Has two to four
years of
professional
(exempt-level)
generalist
experience
Has six to eight
years of
progressive
professional
(exempt-level)
experience
Has at least two
years of
professional
(exempt-level)
experience in
international
HR practices.
Focuses on
program
implementation
rather than
creation.
Designs and plans
rather than
implements.
Has core
knowledge of the
organization’s
international
HR activities.
Focuses within
the HR function
rather than
organization-wide
Makes decisions
that have an
impact within
and outside the
organization.
Develops and
implements
international HR
strategies that
affect
internation al
HR assignments
and operations.
*In addition to meeting the exam eligibility requirements, successful exam candidates usually have the above
work experience.
WorldatWork Certifications The WorldatWork Association has certifications emphasizing compensation and benefits. The four certifications are as
follows:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 30
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
•
•
•
•
31
Certified Compensation Professional (CCP)
Certified Benefits Professional (CBP)
Certified Work-Life Professional (CWLP)
Certified Global Remuneration (CGR)
Other HR Certifications Increasingly, employers hiring or promoting HR
professionals are requesting certifications as a “plus.” HR professionals feel
that various HR certifications give them more credibility with corporate peers
and senior managers. Additional certification programs for HR specialists
and generalists are sponsored by various organizations, and the number of
certifications is being expanded.50 For specialists, some well-known programs
include the following:
•
Certified Recognition Professional (CRP) sponsored by the Recognition
Professionals International
• Certified Employee Benefits sponsored by the International Foundation
of Employee Benefits Plans
• Certified Professional in Learning and Performance sponsored by the
American Society for Training and Development
• Certified Safety Professional (CSP) and Occupational Health and Safety
Technologist (OHST) sponsored by the American Society of Safety
Engineers
• Certified Professional Outsourcing (CSO) provided by the Human
Resource Outsourcing Association
• Certified Graphics Communications Manager (CGCM) and Certified
Mail Manager (CMM) sponsored by the International Personnel
Management Association
Most individuals who want to succeed in the field must update their
knowledge continually. One way of staying current on HR is to tap information in current HR literature and relevant associations, as listed in
Appendix B of this book. Overall, certifying knowledge is a trend in numerous professions, and HR illustrates the importance of certification by making many different types available. Given that many people may enter HR
jobs with limited formal HR training, certifications help both individuals
and their employers to make HR management a better performing part of
their organizations.
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
HR management ensures that human talent is
used effectively and efficiently to accomplish
organizational goals.
As an organization core competency, human
resources has a unique capability that creates high
value and differentiates an organization from
competitors in areas such as productivity, quality/
service, employee skills, and innovative changes.
Human capital is the collective value of the
capabilities, knowledge, skills, life experiences,
and motivation of an organizational workforce.
• HR management activities can be grouped
as follows: strategic HR management; equal
employment opportunity; staffing; talent management; compensation and benefits; health,
safety, and security; and employee and labor
relations.
• As part of organizational culture, HR plays a
significant role through affecting human values,
competitive advantages, and global cultures.
• Contributions by HR can include productivity
improvement, meeting social responsibilities,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 31
26/06/10 3:28 PM
32
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
enhancing customer service and quality, and
expanding employee engagement.
• Ethical behavior is crucial in HR management,
and HR professionals regularly face a number
of ethical issues and consequences both domestically and globally.
• Numerous HR challenges exist currently, including organizational cost pressures, economics and
job changes, talent management and development, technology expansion, and measuring HR.
• All organizations need HR management, but
larger ones are more likely to have a specialized
HR function.
C R I T I C A L
HR management must fulfill three roles:
(1) administrative, (2) operational and employee
advocate, and (3) strategic.
• All levels of HR professionals need competencies in strategic knowledge and impacts;
capabilities in legal, administrative, and operational areas; and technology knowledge abilities. Senior HR leaders need these areas plus
others to be effective.
• Current knowledge about HR management
is required for professionals in the HR career
field, and professional certification has grown
in importance for HR generalists and specialists.
T H I N K I N G
1. Discuss several areas in which HR can affect
organizational culture positively or negatively.
2. Give some examples of ethical issues that you
have experienced in jobs, and explain how HR
did or did not help resolve them.
3. Why is it important for HR management to
transform from being primarily administrative
and operational to becoming a more strategic
contributor?
H R
•
E X P E R I E N T I A L
Your company, a growing firm in the financial services industry, is extremely sensitive to the issues
surrounding business ethics. The company wants
to be proactive in developing a business ethics
training program for all employees both to ensure
the company’s reputation as an ethical company in
the community and to help maintain the industry’s
high standards. As the HR Director and someone
who values the importance of having all employees
trained in the area of business ethics, you are in
charge of developing the ethics training program.
A C T I V I T I E S
4. Assume you are an HR director with a staff
of seven people. A departmental objective is
for all staff members to become professionally
certified within a year. Using Internet resources
of HR associations such as www.shrm.org and
www.WorldatWork.org, develop a table that
identifies four to six certifications that could be
obtained by your staff members, and show the
important details for each certification.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
It needs to be a basic program that can be presented to all employees in the company. Resources
for business ethics information can be found at
www.business-ethics.org/primer1.html.
1. What legislative act prompted many U.S. companies to develop internal ethical policies and
procedures?
2. What are key concepts related to business
ethics that should be considered in the development of the ethics training program?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 32
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
Human Resource Management in Organizations
33
C A S E
HR, Culture, and Business Results Success at Google, Scripps, and UPS
Firms in a variety of industries have been recognized as being among the Most Admired
Companies by Fortune magazine. Others have
been highlighted as being the Best Companies to
Work For by Fortune or as Optimas Award winners by Workforce Management. These recognitions contain some common elements because of
how HR management has contributed to organizational success and is being positively viewed by
employees. Three examples are highlighted here.
One recognized firm is Google, which is well
known by many individuals because of its Internet
components. Google has an HR image as a creative contributor to business objectives through its
work environment guided by HR. According to the
head of HR at Google, Lazio Bock, the overriding
key of HR at Google is its emphasis on organizational culture and business objectives. The focus of
Google HR is on giving its employees flexibility to
produce results, not just following core job requirements. Consequently, HR at Google has established
innovative efforts for its people and has made the
administrative part of HR efficient. Minimizing
numerous HR administrative forms, data, and
reports by using technology has occurred, which
would be expected in a prominent technology firm.
At Google, HR communicates to its employees
extensively about business objectives, organizational results, and relevant current information.
Because many of the Google employees are stock
shareholders also, they have a personal interest
in Google being a successful business. Thus they
continuously want to know the operational results
by seeing current reports, data, and information.
Overall, Google’s HR approach is unique in comparison to the approaches at other companies
recognized by Fortune, but its success illustrates
that how HR is established and operates can be a
key to organizational success.
A different firm with a variety of organizations
and a strong HR culture is Scripps Network, a
prominent television and communications corporation. At Scripps, HR plays a core role in
establishing strategic goals and efforts. Even when
Scripps has merged separate media firms, HR has
focused on getting the cultures of the two entities
to integrate effectively.
Several HR functions are used to support
the culture and core values at Scripps. One is
an active pay-for-performance system to reward
employees at higher job levels with base pay
increases, annual incentives, and long-term incentives. Another key part of HR efforts at Scripps
is that HR emphasizes leadership development
throughout the firm. Additionally, the firm has
widely used work variability efforts such as worklife balance, telecommuting, and worker flexible
schedules. These are done as part of a core value
at Scripps of “compassion/support.”
A different firm with an extended history of
effectively integrating corporate culture and HR is
UPS, the transportation and logistics delivery firm
that operates worldwide. Its culture is different
from the cultures of Google and Scripps; however,
for more than a decade, UPS has been recognized
for its corporate integrity, culture, and HR inclusion with employees.
UPS has emphasized linking HR with business
objectives and uses communication and intranet
programs to ensure that employees are kept
constantly informed on business objectives and
workforce challenges. One well-recognized component at UPS is the established codes of conduct
that are consistently reviewed with all employees.
These reviews include specific examples of ethical
situations that employees may face and how to
respond to them. Annually, managers complete a
“conduct code” report that asks specific questions
about ethical problems that have arisen during
the year.
These three firms are in different industries,
have different cultures, and use a variety of HR
efforts. However, each of them has been recognized for implementing HR as core to their organizational cultures and successful business results.51
QUESTIONS
1. How does the integration of HR with the
organizational culture contribute to the
success of Google, Scripps, and UPS? To find
ideas, go to the corporate website for each
of these companies and search for additional
insights.
2. Discuss how some of the cultural facets
mentioned compare to those among employers
you have worked for, and explain the difference
in the views of these various employers.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 33
26/06/10 3:28 PM
34
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Phillips Furniture
Sysco
This case describes a small company that has
grown large enough to need a full-time HR person.
You have been selected to be the HR manager, and
you have to decide what HR activities are needed
and the role HR is to play. (For the case, go to
www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
As a large food services and distribution firm,
Sysco had to revise its HR management. Review
this case and identify how the Sysco changes
modified HR’s importance. (For the case, go to
www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Based on “Where the Jobs Are,” HR
Magazine, March 2009, 18; Peter
Coy, Help Wanted,” BusinessWeek,
May 11, 2009, 40–45; “HR’s
Insight into the Economy,” SHRM
Workplace Visions, No. 4 (2008),
www.shrm.org/research.
2. Alan Clardy, “Human Resource
Development and the ResourceBased Model of Core Competencies,”
Human Resource Development
Review, 7 (2008), 387–407.
3. “What Is Human Capital?” SHRM
Knowledge Center, August 22, 2008,
www.shrm.org/TemplatesTools.
4. Sheila Bonini, et al., “Rebuilding
Corporate Reputations,” The
McKinsey Quarterly, June 2009,
www.mckinseyquarterly.com.
5. Scott Flander, “The HR Personality,”
Human Resource Executive,
February 2008, 1, 20–32.
6. Charles Rothrock and David
Gregory, “How Corporate Culture
Affects Organizational Value,”
SHRM White Paper, April 1, 2006,
www.shrm.org.
7. “Creativity and Innovation,” SHRM
Workplace Visions, No. 1 (2007),
1–8.
8. Geert Hofstede, Culture’s
Consequences: Comparing Values,
Behaviors, Institutions, and
Organizations Across Cultures,
2nd ed. (Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage,
2001); John W. Bing, “Hofstede’s
Consequences: The Impact of His
Work on Consulting and Business
Practices,” Academy of Management
Executive, February 2004, 80–87.
9. Michael Mandel, “Productivity’s Up
and That’s a Worry,” BusinessWeek,
May 25, 2009, 22–23.
10. Dirk Matten and Jeremy Moon,
“‘Implicit and Explicit’ CSR: A
Conceptual Framework for a
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Comparative Understanding of
Corporate Social Responsibility,”
Academy of Management Review,
33 (2008), 404–424.
Adrienne Fox, “Corporate Social
Responsibility Pays Off,” HR
Magazine, August 2007, 43–47.
“Socially Responsible Jobs Most
Popular,” USA Today, May 14,
2009, 6D.
“Can Sustainability Initiatives
Survive in a Tough Economy?”
SHRM Workplace Visions, No. 2
(2009), 1–6.
Based on “Green Jobs and Programs
on the Rise,” WorldatWork
Newsline, April 22, 2009; Don
Sanford and Sara Duffy, “Going
Green: A Means to Attract and
Retain,” WorkSpan, May 2009,
100–106; Nancy H. Woodword,
“New Breed of Human Resource
Leader: Going Green . . .,” HR
Magazine, June 2008, 52–61.
Kjell A. Brekke and Karine Nyborg,
“Attracting Responsible Employees:
Green Productions as Labor Market
Screening,” Resource & Energy
Economics, 30 (2008), 509–526.
“Social Responsibility and HR
Strategy,” SHRM Workplace Visions,
No. 2 (2007), 1–8.
Rebecca M.J. Wells, “Outstanding
Customer Satisfaction: The Key to a
Talented Workforce?” Academy of
Management Perspectives, August
2007, 87–89.
Jenna McGregor, “When Service
Means Survival,” BusinessWeek,
March 2, 2009, 26–33.
“Highly Engaged Workers More
Productive, Less likely to Quit,”
WorldatWork Newsline, April 2,
2009.
Lydell C. Bridgeford, “Employers,
Workers Clash over Social
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
Networks,” Employee Benefit News,
June 9, 2009, http:ebn-benefitsnews
.com.
Lauren Leader-Chivee and Ellen
Cowan, “Networking the Way to
Success: On-line Social Networks
for Workplace and Competitive
Advantage,” People and Strategy, 30
(2008), 40–46.
K. Koonmee, et al., “Ethics
Institutionalized, Quality of
Work Life, and Employee Related
Outcomes,” Journal of Business
Research, 63 (2010), 20–26.
Sean Valentine, “Human Resource
Management, Ethical Context,
and Personnel Consequences,”
forthcoming Journal of Business
Research Online, 62 (2009).
Theresa Minton Eversole, “JobBoard Industry Addresses Ethical
Concerns,” 2008 HR Trendbook, 30.
Ethics Resource Center, www.ethics
.org.
Based on Michael O’Brien, “‘Idol’izing Ethics,” Human Resource
Executive Online, May 16, 2009.
Alexandria Ardichvilli, et al.,
“Characteristics of Ethical Business
Cultures,” Journal of Business
Ethics, 85 (2009), 445–451.
Scott Sonenshein, “The Role
of Construction, Intuition, and
Justification in Responding to
Ethical Issues at Work,” Academy
of Management Review, 32 (2007),
1022–1040.
Frank Kilmo, “Stricter Ethical
Standards Called Key to Global
Recovery,” February 18, 2009, HR
News, www.shrm.org.
Jean Thilmany, “Supporting
Ethical Employees,” HR Magazine,
September 2007, 105–112.
To view the code of ethics and its
development, go to www.shrm.org.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 34
26/06/10 3:28 PM
CHAPTER 1
35
Human Resource Management in Organizations
32. “Occupational Employment
Projections to 2016,” Monthly
Labor Review, November 2007,
www.bls.gov.
33. “The Hardest Jobs to Fill in
America,” Forbes, June 4, 2009,
www.Forbes.com.
34. Mary Siegfried, “Skilled Talent, Not
Technology, Drives Value,” Inside
Supply Management, May 2009,
26–27; McKinsey and Company,
The Talent Factor in Purchasing,
2007, www.McKinsey.com.
35. For composition of HR membership
in SHRM, go to www.shrm.org.
36. Karen Colligan, “Is Your Company
Ready for the Brain Drain?”
Workspan, October 2008, 97–99.
37. Based on a variety of publications,
including www.wikipedia.com;
Frank Giancola, “Getting Up to
Speed on the HR Blogosphere,”
WorldatWork, March 31,
2009, www.worldatwork.org;
and “Managing the Tweets,”
BusinessWeek, June 1, 2009, 20–21.
38. Small Business by the Numbers and
other reports from the U.S. Small
Business Administration,
www.sba.gov.
39. Levent Altinay, et al., “Exploring the
Relationship Between the Human
Resource Practices and Growth
in Small Service Firms,” Service
Industries Journal, 28 (2008),
919–937.
40. For example, see John Sullivan,
“HR’s Dinosaurs,” Workforce
Management, March 26, 2007,
58ff.; Keith Hammond, “Why We
Hate HR,” Fast Company, August
2005, 40.
41. Leon Rubis, “HR Is Easier Said than
Done, Says Jack Welch,” May 5,
2009, HR News, www.shrm.org.
42. Dave Ulrich, “Are You a Change
Agent?” Workforce Management,
June 9, 2008, 22–23.
43. “Examining Strategic Versus
Transitional Approaches to HR,”
Proven Results: Research Meets
Real World (Norcross, GA:
EmployEase, 2009), www
.employease.com.
44. Jessica Marquez, “Not the Usual
Suspects,” Workforce Management,
November 5, 2007, 23–30.
45. David McCann, “Memo to CFOs:
Don’t Trust HR,” March 10, 2009,
www.CFO.com.
46. Dave Ulrich, et al., HR
Competencies (Alexandria, VA:
SHRM, 2008).
47. Amanda Benedict, et al., “Leading
Now, Leading the Future: What
Senior HR Leaders Need to Know,”
SHRM Executive Summary,
February 2009, 1–23.
48. HR Department Benchmarks and
Analysis (Washington, DC: Bureau
of National Affairs). For more
details, go to www.bna.com.
49. Kris Dunn, “What Are HR
Certifications Worth?” Workforce
Management Online, December
2007, www.workforce.com.
50. “A New Seat at the Table,”
Employee Benefit News, September
1, 2008, 28–32.
51. Fay Hansen, “Special Report: The
HR Profession—HR at America’s
Most Admired Companies,”
Workforce Management, June 23,
2008, 1, 24–32; Bob King, “Packard:
Creating a Great Culture Makes
for Great TV,” Workspan, October
2008, 23–28; Richard Stolz, “What
HR Will Stand For,” Human
Resource Executive, January 2003,
20–28.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 35
26/06/10 3:28 PM
C H A P T E R
2
Strategic HR
Management
and Planning
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Summarize the strategic planning process and how it
drives the organizational activities.
•
Outline how strategic HR management is linked to the
organizational strategies.
•
Discuss how internal and external environmental factors
affect HR strategies.
•
List HR strategic challenges faced by modern
organizations.
•
Explain how technology is affecting HR management
practices and employees.
•
Identify how organizations can measure and assess the
effectiveness of HR management practices.
36
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 36
26/06/10 3:30 PM
HR Headline
Strategic Utilization of Talent Benefits
Health Care Organization
L
Courtesy of Lee Memorial Health System.
ee Memorial Health System tapped its
workers’ heads and hearts to resuscitate
the organization. In 2008, economic conditions put Ft. Myers’s largest employer on life
support, and this key provider of health care
turned to its employees to reduce costs and
prevent layoffs.
Because front-line workers are closer to the
action than supervisors, they can more easily
spot inefficiencies and waste. Lee Memorial’s
HR staff encouraged middle managers to hold
honest, frank discussions with their staff to
explain the urgency of the situation. Getting
the attention of employees was not especially difficult because many of them had been personally touched by
the national economic crisis. Helping employees make the connection
between organizational health and their job security led to outstanding
results for both the hospital and its staff.
Employees and physicians involved in a lean/Six Sigma project identified areas for cost reduction. Improved patient flow saved the hospital $5
million. Modifying the employee Paid Time Off (PTO) program to be consistent with other local employers saved $4 million. In total, Lee Memorial
Health System reduced costs by $45 million and increased revenues by
$25 million. A major success was that Lee Memorial saved 200 positions
that had been slated for layoffs.
The approach of Lee Memorial’s managers in actively soliciting and
engaging employees demonstrates the value of sharing information about
organizational business conditions with employees and giving them a
stake in the outcomes. Putting the survival of the organization on every
employee’s radar allowed Lee Memorial to gain a competitive advantage
through effective utilization of its human resources.1
37
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 37
26/06/10 3:33 PM
38
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
The strategy an organization follows is its proposition for how to compete
successfully and thereby survive and grow. Several different approaches to
strategy formation exist. Most organizations have a relatively formal process
for developing a written strategy encompassing a 5-year period with objectives
and goals for each unit.
Strategic decisions relate to using resources in such a way that the
organization can outperform its competitors. Organizations seek to achieve
and maintain a competitive advantage in the marketplace by delivering
high-quality products and services to their customers in a way that competitors cannot duplicate. Strategies might include revising existing products,
acquiring new businesses, or developing new products or services using
existing capabilities. Other strategic approaches might be to maintain a
secure position with a single stable product (like WD-40) or to emphasize a
constant stream of new products (like Apple). These are all viable strategies
for different businesses, but the strategies chosen will determine the number,
nature, and capabilities of people needed in the organization. Further, the
people already in the organization may limit the strategies that might be
successful.2
Regardless of which specific strategies are adopted for guiding an organization, having the right people in the right place at the right time will be critical
to make the overall strategies work. If a strategy requires worker skills that
are currently not available in the company, it will require time to find and hire
people with those skills. Strategic HR management entails providing input
into organizational strategic planning and developing specific HR initiatives
to help achieve the organizational goals. While it seems important to consider
Strategy An organization’s
HR in the overall organizational strategy, estimates are that only 30% of HR
proposition for how to
professionals are full strategic partners. Their primary role remains that of
compete successfully and
providing input to top management.3
thereby survive and grow.
Although HR administrative and legally mandated tasks are important,
strategic HR means adding value by improving the performance of the business. Some businesses are highly dependent on human
capital for a competitive advantage; others are less so. For
LOGGING ON
example, the productivity of a steel mill depends more on
People Trak—Strategic
P
gic HR
the efficiency of furnaces and quality of raw materials than
Software
S
on human resources. However, every business strategy must
TThis firm provides strategic
gic human
be carried out by people, and therefore human capital is a
resources management and planning
vital element to business success. An important aspect of
software for organizations.
ns. Visit their
strategic HR management covered in this chapter is the
website at www.people-trak.com/
-trak.com/
measurement and determination of the value of human
strategic_hr.asp.
capital and HR practices.4
STRATEGIC PLANNING
Strategic planning
The process of defining
organizational strategy and
allocating resources toward its
achievement.
Strategic planning is the process of defining an organizational strategy, or
direction, and making decisions on allocating the resources of the organization (capital and people) to pursue this strategy. Successful organizations
engage in this core business process on an ongoing basis. The plan serves
as the roadmap that gives the organization direction and aligns resources.
The process involves several sequential steps that focus on the future of the
organization.5
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 38
26/06/10 3:34 PM
CHAPTER 2
39
Strategic HR Management and Planning
FIGURE 2-1
Strategic Planning Process
Organizational Mission
SWOT Analysis
Establish Goals and
Objectives
Formulate
Organizational Strategy
Formulate Supporting
Functional Strategies
Implement
Evaluate and
Reassess
Strategy Formulation
Organizational mission
The core reason for the
existence of the organization
and what makes it unique.
The strategic planning cycle typically covers a 5-year time frame, and management considers both internal and external forces when formulating the strategic
plan. Figure 2-1 shows the strategic planning process for the organization.6
The guiding force behind the strategic planning process is the organizational
mission, which is the core reason for the existence of the organization and what
makes it unique. The mission statement is usually determined by the organizational founders or leaders and sets the general direction for the organization.
The planning process begins with an assessment of the current state of the
business and the environmental forces that may be important during the planning cycle. Analysis of the strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats
(SWOT) is a typical starting point because it allows managers to consider
both internal and external conditions, which are discussed in more detail
later in the chapter. The analysis helps managers to formulate a strategic plan
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 39
26/06/10 3:34 PM
40
SECTION 1
Strategic HR management
Refers to the use of employees
to gain or maintain a
competitive advantage.
Environment of Human Resource Management
that considers the organizational ability to deal with the situation at hand.7
The planning process is an ongoing cycle with managers continuously monitoring and responding to changes in the environment and competitive conditions.
Managers then determine the objectives for the planning cycle and formulate organization-level strategies to accomplish those objectives. Each function
within the organization then formulates strategies that will link to and support
the organization-level strategies. The strategic plan is evaluated periodically
because conditions may change and managers must react to the ever-changing
environment.
Strategic HR management refers to the use of human resource management
(HRM) practices to gain or keep a competitive advantage. Talent acquisition, talent deployment, talent development, and rewarding talent are all strategic HRM
approaches that can impact the organizational ability to achieve its strategic objectives.8 The focus of HR initiatives is evolving from a traditional emphasis to a
strategic emphasis, as detailed in Figure 2-2. Because business strategies affect HR
FIGURE 2-2
Traditional HR versus Strategic HR
FOCUS
TRADITIONAL HR
STRATEGIC HR
Micro
Macro
Narrow skill application
Broad skill application
Organization
Administration
Compliance
Transactional
Tactical
Strategic
Planning
Diagnostic
Analytical (metrics)
Consultative
Head count
Cost-based
Exploitable resource
Contributors
Asset-based
Critical resource
Planning outlook
Short-term
Low-risk
Traditional: utilizes triedand-true approaches
Long-term
High-risk
Experimental: tries novel
approaches
HR systems and practices
Routine, traditional
Reactive
Responds to stated needs
Adaptive, innovative
Anticipatory, proactive
Recognizes unstated needs
Traditional HRM
generalists and specialists
Other specialties
Business acumen
Comprehensive HRM body
of knowledge
Organizational development
View of organization
Critical skills
View of employees
Education and training
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 40
26/06/10 3:34 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
41
plans and policies, consideration of human resource issues should be part of the
strategy formulation process. Strategic HR deals with the contributions that HR
strategies make to achieving organizational effectiveness and competitive advantage and how these HR contributions are accomplished. Therefore, HR should
be involved in implementing strategies that affect and are influenced by people.9
An important element of strategic HRM is to develop processes in the
organization that help align individual employee performance with the organizational strategic objectives. When employees understand the organizational
priorities, they can better contribute by applying their skills to advance the
organizational strategic goals. Employees who understand the “big picture”
can make decisions that will contribute to the objectives of the firm. HRM
practices that facilitate this include talent development and reward systems
that channel employee efforts toward the organizational bottom line.10
Strategic Competencies for HR Professionals The HR professional
wears many hats and must possess a wide variety of skills to successfully
contribute at the strategic planning table. The following six primary strategic
competencies are critical for HR professionals:11
•
•
•
•
•
•
Credible Activist: challenges assumptions and offers a point of view
Culture and Change Steward: shapes the organizational culture, makes
changes happen
Talent Manager/Organization Designer: acquires and deploys talent,
embeds capabilities into the organizational structure
Strategy Architect: recognizes business trends, forecasts potential
obstacles to business success, and builds overall strategy
Operational Executor: efficiently and effectively carries out tactical HR
activities
Business Ally: understands the business value chain, and establishes
internal partnerships with line managers
Operationalizing HR Management Strategies Specific HR management
strategies depend on the strategies and plans of the organization. Figure 2-3
highlights some common areas where HR should develop and implement
appropriate strategies.12 To contribute in a meaningful way in the strategic
planning process, HR professionals provide the perspective and expertise to
managers by performing the following functions:
•
Understand the business: Knowing the financials and key drivers of business
success are important to understanding the need for certain strategies.
• Focus on the key business goals: Programs that have the greatest
relevance to business objectives should get priority.
• Know what to measure: Metrics are a vital part of assessing success, which
means picking those measures that directly relate to the business goals.
• Prepare for the future: Strategic thinking requires preparing for the
future, not focusing on the past—except as a predictor of the future.
HR AS ORGANIZATIONAL CONTRIBUTOR
In organizations where there are identifiable core competencies related to
people, HR practices play a significant strategic role in enhancing organizational effectiveness. Effective management of talent provides managers with
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 41
26/06/10 3:34 PM
42
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Strategic Human Resource Management
FIGURE 2-3
Organization/Senior Management
Mission statement
Objectives/strategies
Human Resources
Mission statement
Objectives/strategies
Strategic Level
Staffing
Total rewards
Employee/labor
relations
Training and
development
Performance
management
Operational Level
Staffing
Total rewards
Employee/labor
relations
Training and
development
Performance
management
Measurement
Effectiveness
Efficiency
Legal compliance
high-quality human resources to carry out the organizational strategies. As
discussed in Chapter 1, strategic HR management plays a significant role in
the following strategies:
•
•
•
Organizational productivity
Customer service and quality
Financial contributions.
High-Performance Work Practices
A wide array of data from both academics and consulting firms shows that
HR practices really do make a significant difference to business outcomes.
Many HR “Best Practices” are identified in chapters throughout this book.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 42
26/06/10 3:34 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
43
The examples will illustrate how HR strategies that foster these practices pay
off for both employers and employees. Some recognized HR best practices
include:13
•
•
•
•
•
Incentive compensation: Pay-for-performance systems that tie employee
rewards directly to successful performance of job responsibilities
Training: Talent development programs to ensure that all employees have
the proper knowledge, skills, and abilities to perform their jobs and to
grow with the organization
Employee participation: Soliciting and using employee ideas and
suggestions to give employees a sense of importance and value to the
organization
Selectivity: Setting stringent hiring standards to maintain a high level
of quality when bringing employees into the organization
Flexible work arrangements: Providing alternative work schedules to help
employees balance their personal and professional lives
Organizations that implement such practices have increased return on assets
by 5% and reduced employment turnover by 20%. Research has also shown
that market value, return on equity, and other operational performance measures are better in organizations that adopt high-performance work practices.14
HR Effectiveness and Financial Performance
Effectiveness The ability
to produce a specific desired
effect or result that can be
measured.
Efficiency The degree to
which operations are done in
an economical manner.
Effectiveness for organizations is a measure of the ability of a program, project, or task to produce a specific desired effect or result that can be measured.
Efficiency is the degree to which operations are done in an economical manner.
Efficiency can also be thought of as a short-term measure that compares inputs
and costs directly against outputs and benefits. HR management and financial
executives work together to make certain that HR practices contribute financially to organizational effectiveness.
There are many different ways of measuring the financial contributions
of HR and many challenges associated with doing so. Return on investment
(ROI) is a common measure used by financial professionals to assess the value
of an investment. For example, if a firm invests $20,000 for a supervisory
training program, what does it gain in lower worker compensation costs,
lower legal costs, higher employee productivity, and lower employee turnover?
The benefits of HR programs are not always immediately visible which is
what makes measuring HR’s impact such a challenge. However, efforts should
be made to financially assess HR practices.15 Later in this chapter the discussion of HR metrics will highlight some specific HR measurement approaches.
The HR Perspective discusses an interesting approach at IBM to harness the
power of numbers in managing human resources.
ENVIRONMENTAL ANALYSIS
Environmental scanning
The assessment of internal
and external environmental
conditions that affect the
organization.
Before the managers in an organization begin strategic planning, they
study and assess the dynamics of the environment in which they operate
to better understand how these conditions might affect their plans. The
process of environmental scanning helps to pinpoint strengths, weaknesses,
opportunities, and threats that the organization will face during the planning horizon.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 43
26/06/10 3:35 PM
44
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
HR perspective
Numbers Add Up
for IBM
Turning workers into numbers sounds not only
difficult but also somewhat insensitive and heartless.
However, mathematical models are helping IBM to
harness human resources and allow its employees to
thrive. IBM has long relied on detailed data and
sophisticated algorithms to manage its supply chain and
manufacturing processes, but the business has changed.
IBM has shifted to a focus on services rather than
building computer hardware. This increases the need
to optimize the workforce so that the right individuals
are available when customers need specific talents.
Building a profile for each employee involves
determining the specific knowledge and strengths of
each worker. Résumés and project records are used to
identify skills and experiences. Online calendars, cell
phones, and PDAs show how employees use their time
and who they interact with. Call records and emails
define the social network each employee has developed.
This inventory of talent can be used by managers to
better schedule work and create project teams.
Think of the manager who needs to deploy a team
to work on assignment for a particular client. She could
sit down and put the dates and skills needed into the
talent inventory system. The results would come back
telling her which workers are available with the right
skill set, whether several proposed team members have
worked together in the past, and how much they are
paid. She would then be able to configure the ideal
team within the budget limits.
Talent development could be enhanced by reviewing the combination of skills and experiences that high
performers possess. To build the strength of the talent
pipeline, employees could be “cloned” to duplicate
successful employees based upon their profiles.
The social networks of employees could be tapped
to identify prospective employees or customers.
Scheduling of workers would be aided by defining
their skills and matching them to the thousands of
small tasks that need to be accomplished on each
project.
Although IBM has just begun mining the data and
building the mathematical models to utilize human
resources, the future will be based less on guesswork
and more on proven formulas for success.16
The internal environment includes the quality and quantity of talent, the
organizational culture, and the talent pipeline and leadership bench strength.
The external environment includes many economic, political, and competitive
forces that will shape the future. Figure 2-4 shows the HR elements of a SWOT
analysis.17
Internal Environmental Analysis
The strengths and weaknesses of the organization represent factors within the
organization that either create or destroy value. When assessing the internal
environment, managers evaluate the quantity and quality of human resources,
HR practices, and the organizational culture. The organizational culture is
discussed at greater length in Chapter 1.
The strength of the talent pipeline is particularly important as the organization plans its future. Fulfilling strategic objectives is impossible without
sufficient skills and talent. Leadership development and succession planning
programs ensure that high-quality talent will be available to carry out the
strategy. Effective development programs can reduce the high failure rate
of people in leadership positions. Selecting individuals with the right talents
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 44
26/06/10 3:35 PM
CHAPTER 2
45
Strategic HR Management and Planning
FIGURE 2-4
HR Factors in the SWOT Analysis
Strengths
Intellectual capital
Loyal, committed employees
Innovative, adaptive employees
High-performance practices
Weaknesses
Lack of skilled employees
Lack of leadership pipeline
Outdated talent management
practices
Opportunities
Market position
Unexplored markets
Global expansion
Technology advances
Threats
Legal mandates and restrictions
Competitor power
Economic uncertainty
Talent shortage
and teaching them leadership skills can improve the quality of leaders and
promote strategic success. Succession planning is the process of identifying
a plan for the orderly replacement of key employees. The succession plan is
the blueprint for managing the internal talent pipeline. Managers identify
individuals who can fulfill new roles in the future and include them in the
succession plan. This internal pool of talent is the reserve needed to meet the
objectives in the strategic plan.18 Succession planning is explained in greater
detail in Chapter 9.
External Environmental Analysis
Opportunities and threats emerge from the external environment and can
impact the outcomes for the organization. Many of these forces are not within
the organizational control, but must be considered in the scanning process.
Dealing with uncertainty in the external environment is becoming a critical
skill for planners.19 The external environmental scan includes an assessment
of economic conditions, legislative/political influences, demographic changes,
and geographic and competitive issues, as shown in Figure 2-5.
Succession planning The
process of identifying a plan
for the orderly replacement of
key employees.
Economic Conditions The prevailing business climate will affect strategic
planning because the future is shaped by current conditions. Productivity
levels, interest rates, economic growth, consumer prices, inflation, and unemployment rates affect the business outlook. Access to credit, capital, and labor
affect the organizational ability to grow and to provide desired rewards to
employees. During times of high economic growth, labor and material shortages are more likely. During economic downturns, resources are underutilized
and organizations seek to increase productivity and to lower costs. When
facing difficult economic conditions, firms may react by implementing severe
workforce reductions, compensation cuts, and other drastic measures to
remain viable.20 These actions have strategic implications for the organization
because they may leave the organization vulnerable when the economy
improves.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 45
26/06/10 3:35 PM
46
SECTION 1
FIGURE 2-5
Environment of Human Resource Management
Areas of External Environmental Scan
Economic
Legislative & Political
Demographic
Geographic & Competitive
Inflation rates can influence the revenue stream for the organization as well
as employee expectations regarding compensation. As the unemployment rate
rises, the number of qualified people looking for work increases. This poses
challenges for the organizations because the sheer volume of applicants can
overwhelm the selection process.
Legislative/Political Influences An expanding and often bewildering collection of government regulations affects the labor market and organization
practices. Consideration of current and pending legislation should be a part of
the assessment process because new mandates might impact how the organization operates during the planning horizon.
Legislation regarding taxes, labor unions, compensation, benefits, employment, and safety and health affect the HR practices in all organizations. Many
aspects of the employment relationship are regulated, and strategic planning
must be done with these restrictions in mind. The social and regulatory priorities of political parties also influence how business operates, with particular
programs gaining or losing support. In summary, an organization considers
a complex variety of government policies, regulations, and laws during the
strategic planning process.
Demographic Changes Significant demographic changes are occurring that
will impact the composition of the future workforce. The U.S. Census Bureau
projects that by 2042 non-Hispanic whites will no longer comprise the majority of the U.S. population.21 These population shifts and demographic changes
can affect the organizational strategy in several ways. Consumer demographics
influence the demand for products and services. For example, as the population ages, demand for medical services and assistive devices will increase.
Workforce demographics will also affect the quality and quantity of labor
available to the organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 46
26/06/10 3:35 PM
CHAPTER 2
47
Strategic HR Management and Planning
HR best practices
NASA Launches Workforce
Realignment
In 2010 the space shuttle program will be discontinued
and thousands of NASA engineers and scientists will
be affected. The Constellation program, which will
succeed the space shuttle program, will not launch for
5 years. If the skilled shuttle staffers decide to retire
rather than wait for the replacement program, NASA
will face a serious knowledge gap.
NASA administrators must determine what people
and skills will be needed to develop the Constellation
program. Employees who do not have the critical
skills may be allowed to leave or laid off. However, a
congressional ban prohibits massive layoffs at the space
agency. Also, a government panel is studying manned
spaceflight programs to determine if the shuttle should
truly be taken out of service.
All of the uncertainty facing NASA and its employees
creates a major challenge of keeping employees
engaged and committed. Leaders have been making
themselves more visible, holding “all-hands” meetings,
and communicating more frequently. Websites provide
news on the transition and help employees to find new
jobs. HR staff is working with managers to map the
skills for the next program and comparing them to
the skills of the current workers. They have found that
systems engineering and project management skills
are lacking, and they are developing training to fill the
skill shortages. Fortunately, training for the transition
has not disrupted current operations. The remainder of
transition period will be devoted to transferring those
skills to the retained employees.
In addition to the tangible transition issues, there
are intangible issues such as dealing with fear of the
unknown, breaking up of teams that have worked
together for years, and grief for the end of a program
that many individuals worked on their entire careers.
Dealing with the stress and honoring the value of the
shuttle program are helping employees to maintain
morale and optimism while facing a new frontier.22
Among the factors influencing workforce diversity are age, gender, generational differences, race, and ethnicity. Managers assess changes in the
workforce composition because the diverse needs and expectations of a heterogenous workforce require creative and flexible solutions. A one-size-fits-all
approach to recruitment, compensation, training, and performance management will no longer be effective. The anticipated retirement of baby boomers
in the near future will leave many organizations without sufficient skilled
talent. NASA faces a serious workforce issue, and the HR Best Practices box
describes their strategy for dealing with it.
LOGGING ON
Society for Human Resource
Management
The Society for Human Resource
Management is the largest association
devoted to Human Resource
Management. Some of the most essential
and comprehensive resources available
for Human Resource professionals are
contained within the SHRM website at
www.shrm.org.
Geographic and Competitive Concerns The local
industrial base and economic conditions affect the strategic planning process. Where an organization locates its
operations plays a role in how well it will perform. Being
located in an industry hub (like Silicon Valley for IT firms)
provides the infrastructure and supply base the organization needs to succeed. The local industry is centered on the
particular industry, and resources, including skilled talent,
are more readily available. If operations are located in a
sparsely populated area, the organization will face staffing
challenges if the strategy involves substantial growth. An
understanding of geographic advantages and disadvantages
can help managers develop appropriate plans.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 47
26/06/10 3:35 PM
48
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Competitors exist in both the product and labor markets. Competition
in the product market determines the potential for the organization. If the
organization is in a highly competitive industry (such as consumer electronics),
strategies for growth rely heavily on innovation and driving down product
costs. Competition in the labor market establishes the pricing for high-quality
talent and determines the availability of workers. A detailed competitive
analysis in both product and labor markets provides important information to
managers regarding the possibility of meeting strategic objectives.
GLOBAL COMPETITIVENESS AND STRATEGIC HR
G L O B A L
The globalization of business has meant that more organizations now operate
across borders with ties to foreign operations, international suppliers, vendors,
employees, and other business partners. A global presence can range from
importing and exporting to operating as a multinational corporation (MNC).
An MNC, sometimes called a “transnational corporation,” is a corporation
that has facilities and other assets in at least one country other than its home
country. Because human resources are considered assets, the definition of
MNC covers a large number of companies.
Global Framework
Mastering the global complexities of managing human resources is important not
only for HR results, but also for the overall success of the organization. Companies
operating globally must deliver basic HR services while also overcoming various
operational, cultural, and organizational obstacles.23 Even organizations that
operate primarily in the domestic market face pressure from foreign competitors.
The supply chain is increasingly internationally dispersed, and foreign business
practices influence operations in the United States. Technology advances have
eliminated many barriers to operating on a global scale. In addition, workers from
numerous countries may seek employment in the United States, and managers and
HR professionals must be prepared to deal with the needs of this labor force.24
Having a global HR mind-set means looking at HR issues from an
international perspective, using ideas and resources throughout the world,
and ensuring openness to other cultures and ideas. To effectively compete
on an international scale, the organization needs expertise to administer all
HR activities in a wide range of nations. Policies and practices should be
established to address the unique demands for operating in a global context.
Managers determine which policies should be standardized and which should
be tailored for each locale.25 For example, the organization may decide to standardize talent development and succession planning but permit local managers
to establish compensation and labor relations policies. An ideal international
approach strikes a balance between home-country and host-country policies
that utilizes the best practices within the organization.
The following sections address specific issues that should be considered
when formulating international strategies.
Multinational
corporation (MNC) A
corporation that has facilities
and other assets in at least
one country other than its
home country.
Global Legal and Regulatory Factors
Globally-operating organizations must be aware of widely varying legal and regulatory systems due to politics, economic differences, and other factors. Emerging
economies, in particular, pose major challenges to smooth operations and reliable
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 48
26/06/10 3:35 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
49
conditions.26 Having to know about and comply with laws on many HR-related
issues is crucial. Therefore, senior executives and HR professional must review
each country’s legal and regulatory factors, both before and during ongoing
operations. Also they must be trained in how to deal with the nuances of the
requirements in each country.
Offshoring
Competitive pressure to lower costs has resulted in many jobs being moved
overseas in recent years. Offshoring is the relocation by a company of a business
process or operation from one country to another. Firms offshore the production of goods as well as the delivery of services to lower-wage countries. Call
centers in India are an example of business service offshoring to countries with
well-educated, English-speaking workers. Product and software development
projects are increasingly being offshored due to the loss of science and engineering talent in the United States. Predictions are that offshoring will increase
in the future, and few firms have plans to return offshored jobs to the home
country.27
Decisions to offshore operations are made as part of a broader strategic
assessment. Economic conditions in both the domestic and global marketplace, the loss of intellectual talent and institutional knowledge, and the
potential for lower quality are all issues that managers face. To maximize the
success of offshoring, organizations should utilize the following approaches:28
•
•
•
Design work processes to allow workers to hand off the project from one
to the next.
Open the channels of communication by investing in technologies to
support real-time interaction.
Build common ground by sharing knowledge across locations.
Global Staffing
Offshoring The relocation
by a company of a business
process or operation from one
country to another.
Staffing for global operations includes a wide variety of alternatives. The optimal solution is to combine the expertise of local employees with the organization-specific knowledge of employees from the home country (headquarters).
Some countries require that the organization employ a certain percentage of
workers from the host country. Figure 2-6 shows four strategic approaches to
international staffing. Each organization will use a staffing model that best fits
its culture and strategic goals.
An expatriate is an employee living and working in a different country
from where he or she is a citizen. Moving an employee to an overseas assignment for an extended period requires careful selection, training, and planning
to make the experience a success.29 The return of an expatriate (called repatriation) must be well planned and executed for the organization to gain the
benefits of the overseas assignment.
Leadership development is especially important for MNCs. It is becoming
more important for individuals in top management positions to have international experience so that they understand the worldwide marketplace. Effective
selection and development processes are needed to ensure that the right individuals are chosen for these roles. Leading across cultures requires specific
skills, and organizations should provide formal training along with expatriate
assignments to develop leaders who can achieve results in this demanding
environment.30
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 49
26/06/10 3:35 PM
50
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Strategic Approaches to International Staffing
FIGURE 2-6
Ethnocentric
Policy
Managers from headquaters staff key positions
Ensures control over subsidiary location operations
Eases transfer of policies from headquarters to subsidiary
Polycentric
Policy
Host-country nationals staff key positions
Reduces cultural mishaps and misunderstanding
Coordination with headquarters may be problematic
Geocentric
Policy
An international cadre of skilled managers are assigned
to global subsidiaries regardless of nationality
Leverages technical and managerial expertise
Regiocentric
Policy
Key positions are filled by individuals in the region of the
subsidary (i.e., European Union countries)
Capitalizes on cultural and language similiarities
within the region
HR PLANNING IN MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS
The overall purpose of a merger or acquisition is to generate shareholder value
by creating a more competitive, cost-efficient company by combining two existing companies. Strategic HRM can contribute to the success of mergers and
acquisitions (M&As). Research has clearly shown that the majority of M&As
fail to deliver on the expected financial, marketing, or product gains, with only
about one-third of companies reporting that they achieved their goals.31 A significant number of failed ventures can trace their roots to HR issues that were
not properly addressed such as loss of key staff, culture clashes, and poor communication. To maximize the chances of a successful integration, HR should be
involved before, during, and after the deal is completed. Figure 2-7 shows the
HR activities and focus during each stage of the merger process.
Before the Deal
Due diligence A
comprehensive assessment
of all aspects of the business
being acquired.
To determine whether or not the two organizations should combine, a rigorous
process of due diligence is conducted. Due diligence is a comprehensive assessment of all aspects of the business being acquired. Financial, sales and marketing, operations, and human resource staffs are all involved before the final
decision is made to merge or acquire the company. Each function determines
the assets and liabilities of the target company to ascertain whether there are
serious risks to the buyer. HR professionals review issues related to legal compliance, compensation and benefits programs, quality of talent, and labor contract
obligations. Early identification of potential problems such as underfunded
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 50
26/06/10 3:35 PM
CHAPTER 2
51
Strategic HR Management and Planning
HR Activities during M&A
FIGURE 2-7
Before the Deal
During Integration
Du
Post Integration
P
Conduct due
diligence
Assess risks
Identify
possible
conflicts
Address key
HR processes
Retain key
talent
Recognize
cultural
differences
Optimize
workforce
Identify and
establish new
culture
pension liabilities or incompatible labor agreements helps management plan
for an orderly transition. Due diligence is even more complex when the M&A
involves companies in different countries. A thorough, objective analysis of the
HR-related issues is critical to make good business decisions.32
During Integration
After the deal has been closed, the focus of HR activity switches to the
orderly transition of basic HR processes such as payroll and benefits migration. During the first 60 days after the acquisition, HR must deliver highquality administrative and operational support to employees and managers.
The immediate concerns are often about basic services needed to run the
operations. Frequent communication, employee hotlines, and guidance for
managers all contribute to employee retention and loyalty during the chaotic
early days of the transition. Early in the transition, managers focus on identifying key talent and establishing initiatives to retain these critical employees.
Retention bonuses, special assignments, and enhanced severance can be used
to keep key talent in place during the integration stage.33
Integrating HR information systems is important to provide managers with
information about employee capabilities, performance, and potential. The
acquiring organization cannot make optimum human resource assessments
without access to historical information on all employees. An inventory of
knowledge, skills, and expertise along with performance information provide
the data for making suitable assignments for employees from both organizations. Gathering all relevant HR information in a single database helps managers to analyze and compare employee skills and to make informed decisions
about which employees should be retained.
As the businesses are merged, culture conflicts will emerge. For example,
when HP and Compaq merged in 2001, cultural differences were recognized
and addressed. HP had a culture that fostered innovation by giving employees
autonomy and opportunities for professional development. Compaq, on the
other hand, was a fast-paced company that made decisions quickly. The merger
has been successful because of the blending of the best parts of the culture in
each company.34 Changing the organizational culture depends upon changing
behavior in the organization. Four important factors in changing culture are:35
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 51
26/06/10 3:35 PM
52
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
•
•
•
•
Define the desired behaviors: Provide behavioral examples of how
people are expected to act and tie these behaviors to the performance
management system.
Deploy role models: Select leaders that exemplify the desired behaviors
and make them visible throughout the organization.
Provide meaningful incentives: Reward the role models with recognition to
reinforce their behavior and to signal the rest of the organization.
Provide clear and consistent messages: Align what you say with what
you do and reward.
Post Integration
To realize the expected benefits of a merger, the months following the initial integration are critical. Culture changes started in the early days must be maintained.
Practical issues regarding talent management and development along with combining compensation systems will solidify the new, united organization. Failure to
effectively blend the workforces and move beyond the “us-and-them” mentality
can lead to inferior business results, a loss of shareholder value, and the failure
of the merger. Continued change efforts are needed to bring all employees to the
“one organization” mentality. Breaking down the barriers between the previous
practices at each organization and implementing the best from both organizations
will give employees a sense of value and importance. Ultimately, the outcomes of
the deal result from how HR issues are addressed.36 The HR Perspective details
the strategies that Dow uses to ensure that acquisitions deliver as promised.
Dow’s Formula for Successful
Acquisitions
Dow is a diversified chemical company with $49 billion
in annual revenues and 43,000 employees worldwide.
Since its founding in 1897, much of the company growth
has come through mergers and acquisitions. Because
Dow’s acquisition activities are central to its organizational
growth strategy, top leaders formulated an approach
to ensure success. Although significant emphasis was
placed on pre-deal activities, little was done to ensure the
post-deal success. Various employees in operating units
might work on the acquisition as a temporary assignment,
but would return to their regular jobs after the deal was
done. The implementation of the M&A Technology
Center provided a systematic approach to handle the
complicated process of acquiring and integrating new
companies into the Dow corporate structure.
The M&A Technology Center is staffed with a fulltime group of experts in the M&A process. Members
of the Center document the processes used, gather
HR perspective
data to assess results, capture and share “lessons
learned,” and create templates and tools for future use.
The Center oversees all acquisition activity at Dow by
drawing on the experience and skills of its staff. Due
to the success of the Center, Dow leaders took the
idea one step further and instituted the HR Center for
Mergers and Acquisitions to address the unique HR
tasks associated with integrating acquired companies.
Staffed with seasoned professionals who can assess
and make recommendations on issues related to labor
relations, compensation and benefits, training, change
management, and other HR disciplines, the HR Center
is involved from the very beginning of each potential
acquisition through final integration.
The HR Center surveys Dow business leaders each
year to assess the effectiveness of the process. Results
have been very positive and indicate that HR has added
high value to the M&A process at Dow.37
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 52
26/06/10 3:35 PM
CHAPTER 2
53
Strategic HR Management and Planning
STRATEGIC CHALLENGES
Because the objective of strategic planning is to anticipate future events and
conditions, managers should evaluate and revise the plan on a periodic basis.
Some have called into question the value of strategic planning in light of the
economic volatility in the recent past.38 However, organizations would fare
much worse with no plan in place. Recent events highlight the impact of environmental forces on organizations and emphasize the need to remain watchful
and attentive to changing conditions.
Attracting and retaining the right talent is an ongoing challenge as the needs
of the business change over time. The United States has continued to move from
a manufacturing economy to a service economy. This shifting economic base
leads to structural mismatches between workers and jobs. Workers with outdated skills are unable to fill the technical and health service jobs employers need.
Ongoing retraining can help overcome these problems if strategic planning has
identified them.39 Organizations need to plan for both the quantity and quality
of the workforce over the planning horizon. Having sufficient workers with the
right qualifications is essential to achieve the strategic plan. If the firm employs
too many people for its needs, a talent surplus exists; if too few, a talent shortage.
Because of the rapidly changing conditions, the organization may face a surplus
in some parts of the business while facing a shortage in others. Figure 2-8 shows
the tactics organizations might use to deal with talent supply imbalances.
FIGURE 2-8
Managing Talent Supply Imbalances
MANAGING A TALENT SURPLUS
MANAGING A TALENT SHORTAGE
Reduce employee work hours
or compensation
Increase employee work hours
through overtime
Attrition
Outsource to a third party
Freeze hiring
Implement alternative work
arrangements
Voluntary separation programs
Use contingent workers
(temporaries, independent
contractors)
Downsizing/reduction in force
(RIF)
Reduce employee turnover
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 53
26/06/10 3:35 PM
54
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Managing a Talent Surplus
A talent surplus can be managed within a strategic HR plan in a number of
ways. The reasons for the surplus will guide the ultimate steps taken by the
organization. If the workforce has the right qualifications but the sales revenue
has fallen, the primary strategies would involve retaining workers while cutting costs. However, if the workforce is not appropriately trained for the jobs
needed, the organization may lay off those employees who cannot perform the
work. Managers may use various strategies in a progressive fashion to defer
workforce reductions until absolutely necessary.40
Reduction in Work Hours or Compensation In order to retain qualified employees, managers may institute reduced work hours on a temporary
basis. Selected groups of employees may have their workweek reduced or all
employees can be asked to take a day or week off without pay. For example,
Zurn Plumbing Service, a small family-owned company, asked its 15 full-time
workers to take a day off without pay each week in order to keep all of them
on the payroll and avoid layoffs.41 When the economy improves, these skilled
employees will be available to handle the increased workload.
Across-the-board pay cuts can reduce labor costs while retaining skilled
employees. It is important that pay cuts start at the very top of the organization so that employees do not bear all of the hardship. Uniform pay cuts can
be felt as a shared sacrifice for the survival of the firm. Organizations may also
reduce employee benefits, such as eliminating matching 401K contributions
or raising employee health insurance premiums. HR should closely monitor
the situation and reinstate pay and benefits levels when the economic outlook
improves to maintain employee loyalty and a sense of fairness.
Attrition and Hiring Freezes Attrition occurs when individuals quit, die,
or retire and are not replaced. By use of attrition, no one is cut out of a job,
but those who remain must handle the same workload with fewer people.
Unless turnover is high, attrition will eliminate only a relatively small number
of employees in the short run, but it can be a viable alternative over a longer
period of time. Therefore, employers may combine attrition with a freeze on
hiring. Employees usually understand this approach better than they do other
downsizing methods.
Voluntary Separation Programs Organizations can reduce the workforce while also minimizing legal risks if employees volunteer to leave. Often
firms entice employees to volunteer by offering them additional severance,
training, and benefits payments. Early retirement buyouts are widely used
to encourage more senior workers to leave organizations early. As an incentive, employers may offer expanded health coverage and additional buyout
payments to employees so that they will not be penalized economically until
their pensions and Social Security benefits take effect. These programs are
viewed as a way to accomplish workforce reductions without resorting to
layoffs.
Voluntary separation programs appeal to employers because they can
reduce payroll costs significantly over time. Although the organization faces
some up-front costs, it does not incur as many continuing payroll costs. Using
such programs is also viewed as a more humane way to reduce staff than terminating long-service, loyal employees. In addition, as long as buyouts are truly
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 54
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
55
voluntary, the organization offering them is less exposed to age discrimination
suits. One drawback is that some employees the company would like to retain
might take advantage of a buyout.
Workforce Downsizing It has been given many names, including downsizing, rightsizing, and reduction in force (RIF), but it almost always means
cutting employees.42 Layoffs on a broad scale have occurred with frightening
regularity in recent years. Trimming underperforming units or employees as
part of a plan that is based on sound organizational strategies may make
sense. After a decade of many examples and studies, it is clear that downsizing has worked for some firms. However, it does not increase revenues; it
is a short-term cost-cutting measure that can result in a long-term lack of
talent. When companies cannibalize the human resources needed to change,
restructure, or innovate, disruption follows for some time. Also, downsizing
can hurt productivity by leaving “surviving” employees overburdened and
demoralized.
Best practices for companies carrying out layoffs include:43
•
•
•
•
•
Identify the work that is core to sustaining a profitable business.
Identify the knowledge, skills, and competencies needed to execute the
business strategy.
Protect the bottom line and the corporate brand.
Constantly communicate with employees.
Pay attention to the survivors.
A common myth is that those who are still around after downsizing are
so grateful to have a job that they pose no problems to the organization.
However, some observers draw an analogy between those who survive downsizing and those who survive wartime battles. Bitterness, anger, disbelief, and
shock all are common reactions. For those who survive workforce cuts, the
culture and image of the firm as a “lifetime” employer often are gone forever.44
Severance benefits and outplacement services may be offered by companies to cushion the shock of layoffs and protect the company from litigation.
Severance benefits are temporary payments made to laid-off employees to
ease the financial burden of unemployment. One common strategy is to offer
laid-off employees severance benefits that require employees to release the
organization from legal claims. Severance benefits are typically based upon
length of service with the company, often one or two weeks’ pay per year
of service. Outplacement services are provided to give displaced employees
support and assistance. Outplacement typically includes personal career
counseling, résumé preparation services, interviewing workshops, and referral
assistance. Such services are generally provided by outside firms that specialize
in outplacement assistance and whose fees usually are paid by the employer.
Assisting laid-off workers with gaining new employment can help to alleviate
the financial burden on employees and preserve the company image.45
Legal Considerations for Workforce Reductions
Severance benefits
Temporary payments made
to laid-off employees to
ease the financial burden of
unemployment.
HR must be involved during workforce adjustments to ensure that the
organization does not violate any of the nondiscrimination or other laws
governing workforce reductions. Selection criteria for determining which
employees will be laid off must comply with Title VII of the Civil Rights Act
as well as the Age Discrimination in Employment Act and the Americans with
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 55
26/06/10 3:36 PM
56
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Disabilities Act. A careful analysis and disparate impact review should be conducted before final decisions are made.46
There is no legal requirement to provide severance benefits, and loss of
medical benefits is a major problem for laid-off employees. However, under
the federal Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act (COBRA), displaced workers can retain their group medical coverage for up to 18 months
for themselves, and for up to 36 months for their dependents, if they pay the
premiums themselves. Federal stimulus programs in 2009 included enhanced
COBRA coverage for displaced workers.
Employers must also comply with the Older Workers Benefit Protection
Act (OWBPA) when implementing RIFs. The OWBPA requires employers to
disclose the ages of both terminated and retained employees in layoff situations, and a waiver of rights to sue for age discrimination must meet certain
requirements. The worker must be given something of value (“consideration”)
in exchange for the waiver of right to sue, typically severance benefits. When
laying off a group of employees, workers over age 40 who are being laid off
must be granted 45 days in which to consider accepting severance benefits and
waiving their right to sue.
To provide employees with adequate notice of plant closings or mass
layoffs, a federal law was passed, the Worker Adjustment and Retraining
Notification (WARN) Act. This law requires private or commercial organizations that employ 100 or more full-time workers who have worked more than
6 months in the previous year to give a 60-day notice before implementing a
layoff or facility closing that involves more than 50 people. However, workers
who have been employed less than 6 months in the prior year, as well as parttime staff members working fewer than 20 hours per week, are not counted
toward the total of 50 employees. Despite not being formally counted to determine implementation of the law, these individuals should still be given some
form of notice.47 The WARN Act imposes heavy fines on employers who do
not follow the required process and give proper notice.
Managing a Talent Shortage
Managing a shortage of employees seems simple enough—simply hire more
people. However, as mentioned earlier, there can be mismatches between
the qualifications needed by employers and the skills possessed by workers.
Manpower’s list of the 10 hardest jobs to fill in the United States includes
engineers, nurses, teachers, IT staff, and skilled trades.48 For these jobs, there
may not always be sufficient qualified workers to hire. Companies can use a
number of alternative tactics to manage a talent shortage:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Use overtime
Outsource work
Implement alternate work arrangements
Bring back recent retirees
Use contingent workers
Reduce turnover
The existing workers can work overtime to produce goods or services.
This strategy can work on a short-term basis but is not a solution for a
longer-term talent shortage. Workers may appreciate the extra hours and pay
for awhile, but eventually fatigue sets in and productivity and quality may
drop and injuries and absenteeism may increase. Reducing turnover of qualified employees should be an ongoing effort to maintain a talented workforce.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 56
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
57
Special attention may be required in times of talent shortages to hold on to
skilled employees.
Alternate work arrangements, nontraditional schedules that provide flexibility to employees, include job sharing and telecommuting. These are creative solutions to attract and retain skilled employees who want flexibility.
Employees are given more freedom in determining when and how they will
perform their jobs. These arrangements are not costly to the organization but
do require management support and planning to be effective.49 Retirees may
be rehired on a part-time or temporary basis to fill talent gaps. The advantage
is that these individuals are already trained and can be productive immediately.
Care must be taken not to interfere with pension payments or other benefits
tied to retirement.
The use of contingent employees, which are noncore employees who work
at an organization on a temporary or as-needed basis, can provide short-term
help. Professional employer organizations can lease employees to the firm,
which is often a good solution for technical talent. Independent contractors can
be hired on an as-needed basis to fill talent shortages. The use of independent
contractors must be managed closely to ensure compliance with wage and hour,
safety, and employee benefit statutes. When using contingent workers, special
efforts are needed to assimilate them into the workforce and avoid an “us-andthem” mentality. Contingent workers fill an important need and managers can
maximize their contributions through good employee relations practices.
Outsourcing involves transferring the management and/or routine performance of a business function to an external service provider. Organizations
in the United States outsource a wide variety of noncore
functions in order to reduce costs or to obtain skills and
expertise not available in the organization. A common
LOGGING ON
HR function that is outsourced is payroll. The organizaU.S. Department of Labor, Bureau
tion pays an outside firm to administer its payroll and
of Labor Statistics
does not incur the fixed cost of a payroll department.
This website contains data on workforce
Highly skilled and complex tasks may be outsourced to
composition and trends from the U.S.
a firm with greater know-how and economies of scale.50
Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor
Planning and executing outsourced tasks should include
Statistics. Visit the site at www.stats
HR to ensure legal compliance and appropriate employee
.bls.gov.
integration.
TECHNOLOGY CHALLENGES
Alternate work
arrangements Nontraditional
schedules that provide
flexibility to employees.
Outsourcing Transferring
the management and
performance of a business
function to an external service
provider.
Technological advances have a major impact on organizations. New methods
for communicating, processing information, and manufacturing have led to
economic development around the globe. Evolving technologies using math,
science, and the arts can improve life and living conditions. However, the
improvements created by technology often mean that people and organizations
must change in order to fully benefit from these advances. Evolutions in technology will continue to present exciting, but difficult challenges to managers.
Effects on Work and Organizations
Jobs have undergone major changes as a result of technology advances. In
many cases, monotonous, repetitive operations have evolved into complex
knowledge work that requires a new skill set. Work that previously was
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 57
26/06/10 3:36 PM
58
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
done by hand has been replaced by robotics and automation. Tool and die
makers, once prized for their intricate, precision hand work, are now utilizing
computer-aided design (CAD) and computer numerically controlled (CNC)
software to complete their tasks. Rather than having workers standing on the
assembly line alone performing small specialized tasks, today’s workplaces
utilize teams of workers collaborating and sharing a wide variety of tasks.
The skills needed in this work setting are very different from those of the past;
communication, collaboration, technical ability, and adaptability are necessary
for success in the future.51
The introduction of computers made redundant not only typewriters but
also the job of secretary and the lengthy process of creating, editing, and producing written correspondence. Digital imaging has changed the way medical
diagnostic tests are taken, read, and stored. A radiologist working remotely
can interpret images, and patients can be treated faster than ever before.52
Continuous improvement is an essential strategy for all organizations in the
production of goods or the delivery of services. Customer demands for new
product features, customized services, higher quality, and greater value mean
that employees must continually acquire knowledge and skills in a dynamic
environment.
Continuous improvement in an organization typically involves ongoing
efforts to develop and implement better methods. Recall the HR Headline and
Lee Memorial Health System’s use of continuous improvement processes to
enhance patient flow and reduce costs. Technology is enabling organizations
to improve work flow and process. Business process reengineering (BPR) is a
fundamental rethinking and radical redesign of business processes to achieve
dramatic improvements in cost, quality, speed, and service.53
Scheduling work, tracking time and attendance, and monitoring
employee productivity are all easier with the aid of technology. Workforce management software systems create and balance workloads that can save organizations significant labor costs by matching staffing levels to peak and nonpeak
service demands. This can lead to employee discontent because of the inconvenience of shortened workdays or nontraditional schedules for employees. Daycare arrangements may be disrupted, and employees may compete for prime
work schedules. HR and operations staff must work cooperatively to ensure
that steps taken to improve efficiency do not create employee relations issues.54
Effects on Communication
Technology has increased employee expectations regarding the speed and
frequency of communication from managers. Employees are no longer content to wait for the monthly company newsletter or find out the latest news
through formal channels. Company intranet portals can be a prime source
of information for employees and should be used to inform employees
about important events within the organization and the industry. The HR
Perspective discusses how Verizon Wireless uses its HR portal to enhance
employee communication.
Facebook, LinkedIn, and other social networking sites allow employees to
remain in constant contact with people inside and outside of the organization.
Instant messages and cell-phone texting allow for real-time communication.
The line between employees’ personal and professional lives becomes blurred as
these virtual communities are frequently accessed from the worksite. Potential
litigation and damage to the organizational reputation and brand pose risks
to the organization if access and content are not properly monitored.55
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 58
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
59
Strategic HR Management and Planning
HR perspective
Verizon Engages Employees
via Web Portal
Employee engagement, that is, employees’ involvement
with, commitment to, and satisfaction with work,
has been tied to retention, productivity, profits, and
sustainability. Engaged workers are willing to perform
at levels beyond their stated job requirements, are
more customer-focused, and produce higher-quality
and long-term financial results for the organization.
Therefore, organizations seeking to maximize employee
engagement must identify specific actions that can lead
to engagement.
An integral component in driving employee engagement is effective communication. Particularly in harsh
economic times, employees need to understand the
challenges faced by the organization so that they can
accept changes in compensation, work hours, and
performance expectations. Messages must be honest,
direct, and consistently address critical employee
concerns. The range of communications channels
provides multiple avenues for connecting with
employees and providing vital information that will
foster engagement.
Verizon Wireless, widely known for its engaged
workforce, has embraced the HR portal as a main
vehicle for communicating with its employees. The
company developed an online HR portal called “About
You.” Accessible through the intranet, About You allows
employees to make crucial connections between
their daily work performance and their Total Rewards
package. Real-time details about short-term incentive
payouts, wellness initiatives, development programs,
and other resources are available at their fingertips.
The HR portal is tied to Verizon’s HRIS which delivers
personalized employee information on demand. Selfservice tools like “To Do” lists that outline key tasks,
approving expense reports, and tracking time and
attendance simplify the employee’s life and cement
connections between the employee and the company.
The user interface mimics the online experience
outside the workplace for a seamless, familiar feel.
Verizon’s high level of employee engagement
results from utilizing technology to deliver its employeecentered, honest communication messages.56
The explosive growth of Twitter in a relatively short period of time shows how
quickly new communication channels emerge. Organizations must continually
monitor and adapt to these new communication technologies to connect with
customers and employees.
Effects on Work Processes
Monitoring employee actions and performance is much easier and less expensive due to technological advances. Transponders in semitrailer trucks can
record speed, mileage, and other operating data to evaluate driver performance.
Video surveillance to reduce employee misconduct such as theft or cheating,
or to track productivity is simple to implement. Computer use is routinely
monitored, and the Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM) found
that more than one-third of organizations have either disciplined or terminated
employees for improper use of company computers or Internet access.57
The majority of organizations have e-mail use policies in place and monitor employee e-mail use. In general, the courts have supported employer monitoring, and there are few legal restrictions on employer action. Organizations
typically address two issues—managing employee performance and creating
a positive work environment. Concerns about productivity and employee
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 59
26/06/10 3:36 PM
60
SECTION 1
FIGURE 2-9
Environment of Human Resource Management
Factors Involved in Proper Monitoring of Employee E-Mail
REASONS TO MONITOR
POTENTIAL PROBLEMS
The organization is legally responsible for
its employees’ conduct and must limit
exposure to liability (sexual harassment,
etc.)
Poorly implemented or excessive
monitoring can reduce trust and openness
Protect intellectual property and ensure
that proprietary information is not
disclosed to outside parties
Employer should not monitor employees’
external e-mail accounts, only those
hosted by the organization
Ensure that employees are productive
and using computer and Internet access
to perform their jobs
The blurring of personal and professional
time leads to employees working on
“their” time, and they expect to have
some personal time during the workday
U.S. laws may require monitoring for
financial reporting and compliance with
Sarbanes-Oxley
Legal standards vary around the world,
and global companies must comply with
numerous requirements
performance must be balanced with concerns for privacy and positive
employee relations. Monitoring can lead to a lack of trust and may discourage
creativity and the free exchange of ideas between employees. Figure 2-9 shows
some of the important factors involved in proper monitoring of employee
e-mail.58
Effects on HR Activities
Electronic human
resource management
systems (e-HRM) The
planning, implementation,
and application of information
technology to perform HR
activities.
Electronic human resource management systems (e-HRM) is the planning,
implementation, and application of information technology to perform HR
activities. Sometimes called virtual HRM or business-to-employee (B2E)
systems, using technology to support HR activities increases the efficiency
of the administrative HR function and reduces costs. Managers benefit from
the availability of relevant information about employees. Properly designed
e-HRM systems provide historical information on performance, pay, training, career progress, and disciplinary actions. Organizations can make better
HR-related decisions as a result. To maximize the value of technology, e-HRM
systems should be integrated into the overall IT plan and enterprise software
of the organization.59
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 60
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
61
Technology can be used to support every function within human resource
management. Recruiting and selection processes have changed dramatically
with Web-based job boards, online applications, and even online interviewing.
Training is now conducted with the aid of videos, podcasts, Web-enabled training programs, and virtual classrooms. Employee self-service has simplified benefit enrollment and administration by allowing employees to
find health care providers and file claims online. Succession
LOGGING ON
planning and career development are enhanced with realSocial Media Governance
time information on all employees and their potential career
This is an online database of social media
progression. One of the most important ways in which
policies from companies, governments,
technology can contribute to organizational performance
and nonprofit entities. Visit the website
is through the collection and analysis of HR-related data.
at www.socialmediagovernance.com/
Identifying trends and modeling future conditions help
policies.php.
managers to plan and optimize human resources.
MEASURING EFFECTIVENESS OF HR INITIATIVES
A long-standing myth perpetuates the notion that one cannot really measure
the value of HR practices. That myth has hurt HR’s credibility because it suggests that either HR efforts do not add value or they are too far removed from
business results to matter. That notion is, of course, untrue. HR, like all other
functions, must be evaluated by considering the results of its actions and the
value it adds to the organization. Unfortunately, the perceptions of managers
and employees in many organizations are mixed because HR has not always
measured and documented its contributions or communicated those results
to executives, managers, and employees. Further, accounting practices treat
expenditures on human capital and talent development as expenses rather
than capital investments. This encourages a consumption attitude rather than
a long-term investment strategy.60
People-related costs are typically the largest controllable expense in organizations. Effective management of these costs can make the difference in the
survival of the organization. Collecting and analyzing HR information can
pinpoint waste and improper allocation of human resources. It is important
that managers understand financial and operational measures that drive
the business and relate HR decisions to key performance indicators (KPIs).
Metrics, benchmarking, balanced scorecards, and audits can help the organization track HR performance and measure the value of HR practices.61
HR Metrics
HR metrics Specific
measures tied to HR
performance indicators.
HR metrics are specific measures tied to HR performance indicators. Metrics
are typically used to assess the HR function and results within the organization over time. A metric can be developed using costs, quantity, quality, timeliness, and other designated goals. Metrics can be developed to track both HR’s
efficiency and effectiveness. A pioneer in developing HR measurements, Jac
Fitz-Enz, has identified a wide range of HR metrics. A number of key HR
metrics are shown in Figure 2-10.62
HR and line managers collect and share the data needed to track performance. Data to track these measures come from several sources within the
organization. Financial data are needed to determine costs for various HR
activities. Performance and turnover data can be found in HR and operations
records. The real value in using metrics is not in the collection and reporting of
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 61
26/06/10 3:36 PM
62
Environment of Human Resource Management
SECTION 1
Key HR Metrics
FIGURE 2-10
HR Staff and Expenses
HR-to-employee ratio
Total HR staff
HR expenses per FTE
Compensation
Annual wage and salary increases
Payroll as a percentage of operating
expenses
Benefit costs as a percentage of payroll
Staffing
Number of positions filled
Time to fill
Cost per hire
Annual turnover rate
Training
Hours of training per employee
Total costs for training
Percentage of employees participating
in tuition reimbursement program
Retention and Quality
Development
Average tenure of employees
Percentage of new hires retained for
90 days
Performance quality of employees in
first year
Positions filled internally
Percentage of employees with career
plan
the results. It is the analysis and the interpretation of the data that can lead to
improvements in human capital utilization.63 Information and historical data
are reviewed and studied to determine the reasons for current performance
levels and to learn how to improve in the future. HR can help line managers
to understand and interpret the results of these measures and translate these
findings into effective steps toward improvement.
Unlike financial reporting, there is no standard for the implementation
and reporting of HR measures. Managers choose what and how to report to
employees, investors, and other interested parties. This lack of consistency in
HR reporting makes it difficult to evaluate an organization and to compare
HR practices across organizations.64 The following characteristics should be
considered when developing HR metrics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Accurate data can be collected.
Measures are linked to strategic and operational objectives.
Calculations can be clearly understood.
Measures provide information valued by executives.
Results can be compared both externally and internally.
Measurement data drive HR management efforts.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 62
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
Strategic HR Management and Planning
63
HR and Benchmarking
Benchmarking is the process of comparing the business processes and outcomes
to an industry standard or best practice. In other words, the organization
compares itself to “best-in-class” organizations that demonstrate excellence
for a specific process. Benchmarking is focused on external practices that
the organization can use to improve its own processes and practices. When
implementing benchmarking, managers should be careful to find organizations
with similar contexts, cultures, operations, and size. Practices that would work
effectively in an organization of 500 employees might not transfer very well
to an organization with 5,000 employees. The organization should study and
choose benchmarks that will have the greatest impact on the organizational
performance.65
About half of HR professionals report that their organizations collect
benchmark data on a planned, periodic basis while the rest collect it as
needed. Major obstacles to collecting benchmarks are uncertainty about how
to collect the information and what information to collect.66 Using benchmarking, HR effectiveness is best determined by comparing ratios and measures from year to year. In that way, the organization can track improvements
and results from implementing specific HR practices. While benchmarking
helps the organization compare its results to other organizations, it does not
provide the cause or reason for the relative standing of the organization. So,
it is a starting point, not the end point, for improving the organizational HR
function.
HR and the Balanced Scorecard
One effective approach to the measurement of the strategic performance of
organizations, including their HR departments, is the balanced scorecard. The
balanced scorecard is a framework organizations use to report on a diverse
set of performance measures. Organizations that use a balanced scorecard
recognize that focusing strictly on financial measures can limit their view.
The balanced scorecard balances financial and nonfinancial measures so that
managers focus on long-term drivers of performance and organizational sustainability. As shown in Figure 2-11, the balanced scorecard measures performance in four areas:
•
Benchmarking Comparing
the business results to
industry standards.
Balanced scorecard A
framework used to report a
diverse set of performance
measures.
Financial measures: Traditional financial measures such as profit and loss,
operating margins, utilization of capital, return on investment, and return
on assets are needed to ensure that the organization manages its bottom
line effectively.
• Internal business processes: Product and service quality, efficiency
and productivity, conformance with standards, and cycle times
can be measured to ensure that the operation runs smoothly and
efficiently.
• Customer relations: Customer satisfaction, loyalty, and retention
are important to ensure that the organization is meeting
customer expectations and can depend on repeat business from its
customers.
• Learning and growth activities: Employee training and development,
mentoring programs, succession planning, and knowledge creation and
sharing provide the necessary talent and human capital pool to ensure the
future of the organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 63
26/06/10 3:36 PM
64
SECTION 1
F I G U R E 2 - 11
Environment of Human Resource Management
Balanced Scorecard Framework
Internal Processes
Customer Relations
Operational effectiveness
Conformance to standards
Customer satisfaction
Customer loyalty
Vision and
Strategy
Learning and Growth
Employee capabilities
Institutional knowledge
Financial
Profit and loss
Utilization of capital
Organizational results in each of these areas determine if the organization
is progressing toward its strategic objectives. For example, some firms have
noticed that when survey results show a decline in employee satisfaction, several months later there is a decline in customer loyalty and repeat customer
sales. Or expenditures in employee leadership development training can be
linked to lower employee turnover and reduced time to hire managers from
outside the organization.
More than 60% of organizations claim to use a balanced scorecard
approach. Firms as diverse as Blue Cross, Verizon, and the Mayo Clinic have
used this approach to align performance measures with their organizational
strategy.67 Using the balanced scorecard requires spending considerable time
and effort to identify the appropriate HR measures in each of the four areas
and how they tie to strategic organizational success. The balanced scorecard
should align with company goals and focus on results. To be effective, the
HR scorecard should address three elements—accountability, validity, and
actionable results.68 However, regardless of the time and effort spent trying to
develop and use objective measures in the balanced scorecard, subjectivity in
what is selected and how the measures are interpreted can still occur.
Human Capital Effectiveness Measures
To fulfill its role as a strategic business partner, HR must quantify things that
traditional accounting does not account for. Human resources often provide
for both the biggest value and the biggest cost to organizations. Many of the
metrics previously discussed reflect people-related costs. Measuring the value
is more challenging but equally important.69 Assessing the value of human
resources demonstrates the importance of implementing effective HR practices
to maintain a high-quality, engaged workforce.
Human capital refers to the collective value of the intellectual capital (competencies, knowledge, and skills) of the employees in the organization. This
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 64
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
65
Strategic HR Management and Planning
capital is the constantly renewable source of creativity and innovativeness in
the organization but is not reflected in its financial statements.
Revenue per employee is a basic measure of human capital effectiveness.
The formula is Revenue/Head Count (full-time employee equivalents). It is
a measure of employee productivity and shows the sales revenue generated
by each full-time employee. This measure is commonly used in government
reporting (see Bureau of Labor Statistics, BLS) as well as by organizations to
track productivity over time. If revenues increase but employee head count
remains constant, productivity would increase.
A widely used financial measure that can be applied to measure the contribution and cost of HR activities is return on investment (ROI), which is a
calculation showing the value of investments in human resources. It can also
be used to show how long it will take for the activities to pay for themselves.
The following formula can be used to calculate the potential ROI for a new
HR activity:
ROI =
C
A+B
where:
A = Operating costs for a new or enhanced system for the time period
B = One-time cost of acquisition and implementation
C = Value of gains from productivity improvements for the time period
Return on investment
(ROI) Calculation showing
the value of an investment.
Human capital value
added (HCVA) Calculated
by subtracting all operating
expenses except for labor
expenses from revenue and
dividing by the total full-time
head count.
Human capital return
on investment (HCROI)
Directly shows the operating
profit derived from investments
in human capital.
Human economic value
added (HEVA) Wealth
created per employee.
ROI is stressed because it is used in most other functions in an organization
and is the “language” used by financial staff and top management. It allows
managers to choose among various investment opportunities to determine the
best use of funds.
Human capital value added (HCVA) is an adjusted operating profitability figure calculated by subtracting all operating expenses except for labor
expenses from revenue and dividing by the total full-time head count. It shows
the operating profit per full-time employee. Because labor is required to generate revenues, employment costs are added back into operating expense. The
formula for HCVA is:
Revenue – (Operating Expense – (Compensation + Benefit Costs))
Full-Time Head Count
Human capital return on investment (HCROI) directly shows the amount
of profit derived from investments in labor, the leverage on labor cost. The
formula for HCROI uses the same adjusted operating profitability figure as
for HCVA, but it is divided by the human capital cost:
Revenue – (Operating Expense – (Compensation + Benefit Costs))
(Compensation + Benefits Costs)
Human economic value added (HEVA) shows the wealth created per
employee. It shows how much more valuable the organization has become
due to the investment in human capital. Wealth is the net operating profit of a
firm after the cost of capital is deducted. Cost of capital is the minimum rate
of return demanded by shareholders. When a company is making more than
the cost of capital, it is creating wealth for shareholders. An HEVA approach
requires that all policies, procedures, measures, and methods use cost of
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 65
26/06/10 3:36 PM
66
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
capital as a benchmark against which their return is judged. Human resource
decisions can be subjected to the same analysis. The formula for HEVA is:
Net Profit after Taxes – Cost of Capital
Full-Time Head Count
Many financial measures can be tracked and reported to show the contribution human resources make to organizational results. Without such
measures, it would be difficult to know what is going on in the organization,
identify performance gaps, and provide feedback. Managers should require the
same level of rigor in measuring HR practices as they do for other functions
in the organization.70
Regardless of the time and effort placed on HR measurement and HR metrics, the most important consideration is that HR effectiveness and efficiency
must be measured regularly for managers to know how HR is contributing to
organizational success.
HR Audit
HR audit A formal research
effort to assess the current
state of HR practices.
One general means for assessing HR is through an HR audit, which is similar
to a financial audit. An HR audit is a formal research effort to assess the current
state of HR practices in an organization. This audit is used to evaluate how well
activities in each of the HR areas (staffing, compensation, health and safety,
etc.) have been performed, so that management can identify areas for improvement. An HR audit often helps smaller organizations without a formal HR
professional to identify issues associated with legal compliance, administrative
processes and recordkeeping, employee retention, and other areas.
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
The strategy an organization follows is its
proposition for how to compete successfully and
thereby survive and grow.
HR should be involved in the development and
implementation of strategic decisions throughout the organization.
Strategic planning is a core business process
that results in a road map of organizational
direction.
Strategic HR management (HRM) refers to the
use of HRM practices to gain or keep a competitive advantage by aligning individual employee
performance with the organizational strategic
objectives.
Environmental scanning helps to pinpoint
strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats
that the organization will face during the planning horizon.
• During an external environmental scan, HR
managers identify the effects of economic
conditions, legislative/political influences,
demographic changes, and geographic and competitive issues.
• Mastering the global complexities of managing
human resources is important for both HR results
and the overall success of the organization.
• HR plays a crucial role in mergers and acquisitions, particularly in dealing with integration
and organizational culture issues.
• Managing a talent surplus may require reducing
work hours, downsizing through use of attrition and hiring freezes, voluntary separation
programs, and workforce downsizing.
• Managing a talent shortage may be addressed
through overtime, reducing turnover, using contingent workers, and outsourcing.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 66
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
• Advances in technology have affected job
design, communication, work processes, and
HR activities.
• HR effectiveness must be measured using HR
metrics that consider both strategic and operational effectiveness.
• Benchmarking allows an organization to compare its practices against “best practices” in
C R I T I C A L
different organizations, and HR audits
used to get a comprehensive overview
activities.
• The balanced scorecard can be a
framework to measure and report on
organizational performance measures.
T H I N K I N G
1. Discuss how technology has changed jobs in an
organization where you have worked. What are
some HR responses to those changes?
2. What steps can HR professionals take to
ensure that mergers and acquisitions are
successful? How can HR help during the
integration process?
3. How can an organization maintain its image
while dealing with a talent surplus? If layoffs
are necessary, what would you recommend
H R
67
Strategic HR Management and Planning
E X P E R I E N T I A L
As the HR Director of a U.S.-based company that is
looking at global opportunities in China, you have
been asked by the company president to prepare
an outline for an HR strategic plan as part of the
company’s expansion process. You need to develop
an HR strategic plan that will integrate the goals,
objectives, and strategies of the HR Department
with those of the company. The plan also needs to
support the objectives of other departments within
can be
of HR
useful
diverse
A C T I V I T I E S
managers do to ensure that survivors remain
committed and productive?
4. As the HR manager for a multinational
corporation, you want to identify HR
competencies that are critical for global
companies. Visit the website for the World
Federation of People Management Association
(www.wfpma.com) to research the topic and to
identify differences in the body of knowledge
in different parts of the world.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
the company. To get ideas on how to develop an HR
strategic plan, go to www.workinfo.com.
1. What is the process to use for identifying the
components of the HR strategic planning
process?
2. What other company strategic objectives
must the HR strategic plan integrate and
support?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 67
26/06/10 3:36 PM
68
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
C A S E
Pioneers in HR Analytics
The power of HR metrics and analytics is an
untapped resource for many organizations. Human
resource information systems (HRIS) are commonly used to capture and store gigabytes of
data about employees, but few organizations have
mined their data to improve human capital decisions. Most business leaders and HR executives do
not make people decisions with the same level of
rigor and rationale as they do other business decisions, relying more on intuition and gut feelings.
This propagates the myth that the impact of human
resources on organizations is either not measurable or not significant. Financial, operational, and
marketing decisions all depend heavily on detailed
analysis and cost justification. The use of analytics
in human resource management can enhance the
strategic contribution of HR executives and lead
to better decisions and organizational outcomes.
At Superior Energy Services in New Orleans,
careful analysis of turnover data shattered previous beliefs about which employees were most
likely to quit. The organization was losing skilled
oilfield operators and supervisors faster than
semiskilled blue-collar workers. This discovery led
to implementation of training and coaching programs for supervisory employees, which resulted
in a 15% drop in turnover and improved the
bottom line of the company. Without this analytic
approach to turnover, attention would have been
focused on retaining blue-collar workers, which
would not have delivered such impressive results.
Thrivent Financial for Lutherans in
Minneapolis believed that turnover during the first
year of new hires’ careers was related to the previous experience they had in their disciplines. The
thinking was that if a customer service employee
had previously worked in customer service, she
was less likely to leave Thrivent in the first year.
Analytics dispelled that theory and Thrivent found
that the exact opposite was true. Employees with
previous experience in the discipline were leaving
at a faster rate than those without such experience. Although they have not determined the
causes, this data will help Thrivent’s leaders to
address the real issues. One answer will lead to
additional questions and lines of inquiry.
The food service and convenience company Wawa, Inc., assumed that turnover among
store clerks was tied to their hourly wage rate.
However, the number of hours worked in a week
was a much more significant factor in turnover.
Employees liked working part-time, and when
their work hours exceeded 30 hours per week,
they were more likely to quit. Wawa reduced instore turnover by 60% by scheduling employees
for less than 30 hours.
Concerns about an aging workforce and a
presumption that a high percentage of employees
would retire in the near term led the University of
Southern California to carefully analyze employee
demographic data. To their surprise, HR found
that the nontenured staff employees were, on
average, too young to begin retiring en masse.
Tenured faculty, while much older, are far more
likely to work past the age of 70. The anticipated
retirements are still a fact for USC to address.
However, managers can plan for this and develop
a longer-term transition plan because they are not
facing massive retirements in the near future.
The HR executives at Superior Energy Services,
Thrivent, Wawa, and USC are harnessing the
power of HR data and statistical models to better
understand the challenges facing their organizations. Long-held beliefs about the patterns of
employee actions and decisions can be analyzed
and either supported or debunked. Either way, the
organization can address the true issues only if
HR looks beyond the surface and digs deeper into
the sea of data. Overcoming the fear of numbercrunching and developing expertise with metrics
and analytics can separate winning organizations
from those that get left behind. HR professionals
who learn to interpret bits and bytes of employee
data will help their organizations succeed well
into the future.71
QUESTIONS
1. What are some reasons that more
organizations do not implement HR analytics?
How would you make the case for adopting
HR analytics?
2. How can HR professionals develop the needed
skills to analyze and interpret metrics? What
resources could an HR professional consult to
begin building expertise in this area?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 68
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
69
Strategic HR Management and Planning
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Where Do You Find the Bodies?
Xerox
This case identifies problems associated with
HR planning and recruiting in a tight labor
market. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/
management/mathis.)
This case highlights the challenges of employee
retention during stressful and unpredictable times
when Xerox was undergoing a significant shift in
its strategic focus. (For the case, go to www
.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Julie C. Ramirez, “Survival of the
Fittest,” Human Resource Executive,
April 2009, 30–35.
2. “. . . and HR Planning Is Less
Formal,” Personnel Today,
February 27, 2007, 1–3; Sumita
Ketkar and P. K. Sett, “HR
Flexibility and Firm Performance:
Analysis of a Multi-Level Causal
Model,” International Journal of
Human Resource Management, 20
(2009), 1009–1038.
3. Edward E. Lawler and John W.
Boudreau, “What Makes HR
a Strategic Partner?” People &
Strategy, 32 (2009), 14–22.
4. Beth Tootell, Meredith Blackler,
et al., “Metrics: HRM’s Holy Grail?
A New Zealand Case Study,”
Human Resource Management
Journal, 19 (2009), 375–392.
5. Erich Brockmann and Clifford Koen,
“Strategic Planning: A Guide for
Supervisors,” Supervision, August
2008, 3–9.
6. NetMBA, “The Strategic Planning
Process,” www.netmba.com.
7. Thomas Chermack and Bernadette
Kasshann, “The Use and Misuse of
SWOT Analysis and Implications
for HRD Professionals,”
Human Resource Development
International, 10 (2007),
383–399.
8. Juan Pablo Gonzalez and Garrett
Sheridan, “Get Off the Talent
Treadmill: Hardwiring Talent
Strategy to Business Strategy,”
Workspan, August 2008, 36–40;
Milton Perkins, “Aligning Workforce
Strategies with Business Objectives”
SHRM.org Research Articles,
December 7, 2009.
9. Bret J. Becton and Mike Schraeder,
“Strategic Human Resources
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
Management—Are We There
Yet?” Journal for Quality and
Participation, January 2009,
11–18.
Wendy Boswell, “Aligning Employees
with the Organization’s Strategic
Objectives: Out of Line of Sight, Out
of Mind,” International Journal of
Human Resource Management, 17
(2006), 1489–1511.
David Ulrich, Wayne Brockbank,
et al., HR Competencies: Mastery
of the Intersection of People and
Business (Alexandria, VA: SHRM,
2008).
Steve Williams, “A Working Model
of Strategic Human Resource
Management,” 2009, Unpublished
manuscript, Alliant International
University, San Diego, CA.
James Combs, Yongmei Liu, et al.,
“How Much Do High Performance
Work Practices Matter? A MetaAnalysis of Their Effects on
Organizational Performance,”
Personnel Psychology, 59 (2006),
501–528; Jason Shaw, Brian Dineen,
et al., “Employee-Organization
Exchange Relationships, HRM
Practices, and Quit Rates of Good
and Poor Performers,” Academy of
Management Journal, 52 (2009),
1016–1033.
Patrick Wright and Rebecca Kehoe,
“Human Resource Practices and
Organizational Commitment: A
Deeper Examination,” Cornell
University CAHRS Working Paper
Series, December 2007.
David McCann, “Memo to CFOs:
Don’t Trust HR,” March 10, 2009,
CFO.com.
Stephen Baker, “Management by
the Numbers,” BusinessWeek,
September 8, 2008, 32–38.
17. “Strategic Management—SWOT
Analysis” QuickMBA, 2007, www
.quickmba.com.
18. Fay Hansen, “Chief Concern:
Leaders,” Workforce Management,
July 20, 2009, 17–20; Robert
Barnett and Sandra Davis, “Creating
Greater Success in Succession
Planning,” Advances in Developing
Human Resources, 10 (2008),
721–739; Kris Jensen, “Making
Succession Plans Work for Your
Company,” Workspan, May 2009,
57–62.
19. Fay Hansen, “Strategic Workforce
Planning in an Uncertain World,”
Workforce Management Online, July
2009, www.workforce.com.
20. Adrienne Fox, “Avoiding Furlough
Fallout,” HRMagazine, September
2009, 36–40.
21. U.S. Census Bureau, Population
Division, “U.S. Population
Projections,” www.census.gov.
22. Bridget Mintz Testa, “New Orbit,”
Workforce Management, August 17,
2009, 16–20.
23. Tom Starner, “Thinking Globally,”
Human Resource Executive, January
2009, 40–42.
24. Marshall Goldsmith, “Human
Resources: The Big Issues,”
BusinessWeek, July 8, 2008.
25. SHRM Global Special Expertise
Panel, “Things to Think About in
International HR Management,”
2006–2007.
26. Damien DeLuca and Han Hu,
“Evaluate Workforces in Emerging
Economies,” HRMagazine,
September 2008, 65–70.
27. Conference Board, “Offshoring
Reaches the C-Suite,” 2007–2008
ORN Survey Report; Stephan
Manning, Silvia Massini, and Arie
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 69
26/06/10 3:36 PM
70
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Lewin, “A Dynamic Perspective on
Next-Generation Offshoring: The
Global Sourcing of Science and
Engineering Talent,” Academy of
Management Perspectives, August
2008, 35–54.
Kannan Srikanth and Phanish
Puranam, “Advice for Outsourcers:
Think Bigger,” The Wall Street
Journal, January 25, 2010, R7.
Susan Allerow and Rebecca
Rosenzwaig, “Effective International
HR Management,” Workspan,
December 2008, 85–92; G. A.
Gelade, P. Dobson, and K. Auer,
“Individualism, Masculinity, and
the Sources of Organizational
Commitment,” Journal of CrossCultural Psychology, 39, No. 5
(2008), 599–617.
Paula Caligiuri and Ibraiz Tarique,
“Predicting Effectiveness in Global
Leadership Activities,” Journal
of World Business, 44 (2009),
336–346; David Robinson and
Michael Harvey, “Global Leadership
in a Culturally Diverse World,”
Management Decision, 46 (2008),
466–480.
David Wentworth, “M&A Bounces
Back: What Have We Learned?”
Institute for Corporate Productivity
(i4cp) TrendWatcher, No. 478,
October 2, 2009; Harry Barkema
and Mario Schijven, “Toward
Unlocking the Full Potential
of Acquisitions: The Role of
Organizational Restructuring,”
Academy of Management Journal,
51 (2008), 696–722.
Jim Candler, “The Critical
HR Role in M&A . . . Made
Easier,” Workspan, August 2008,
43–45; John Nigh and Marco
Boschetti, “M&A Due Diligence:
The 360-Degree View,” Towers
Perrin Emphasis, 2006.
Christopher Kummer, “Motivation
and Retention of Key People in
Mergers and Acquisitions,” Strategic
HR Review, No. 6, 2008, 5–10.
Agata Stachowicz-Stanusch, “Culture
Due Diligence Based on HP/Compaq
Merger Case Study,” Journal of
Intercultural Management, April
2009, 64–81.
Aaron Falcione, “Post-Merger
Integration: Dealing with Culture,”
Workspan, September 2007, 75–79.
Bob Bundy, “The Culture of
Combination: Changing Behaviors
and Deal Success in Mergers and
Acquisitions,” WorldatWork Journal,
Second Quarter, 2007, 35–47.
37. Randolph Croyle and Ava Johnsey,
“Dow’s Novel Approach to
Managing the Human Element of
Mergers and Acquisitions,” Global
Business and Organizational
Excellence, May/June 2007, 18–26.
38. Joann Lublin and Dana Mattioli,
“Strategic Plans Lose Favor,” The
Wall Street Journal, January 25,
2010, B7.
39. Peter Coy, “Help Wanted,”
BusinessWeek, May 11, 2009,
40–45; Judy Keen, “After Layoffs
Many Workers Go Back to School
for a Fresh Start,” USAToday, April
8, 2009, 1A.
40. Edward Lawler, “Reducing Labor
Costs: Choosing the Right CostCutting Solution for Your Talent
Management Strategy,” Workspan,
June 2009, 20–25.
41. Raymund Flandez, “Small
Businesses Work Hard to Prevent
Layoffs,” The Wall Street Journal,
March 5, 2009, B5.
42. Deborah Stead, “BTW: ‘You’re
Fired,’” BusinessWeek, December
22, 2008, 15–16; Michael O’Brien,
“Determining Departures,”
Human Resource Executive, April
2009, 44–45; Geoffrey Love and
Matthew Kraatz, “Character,
Conformity, or the Bottom Line?
How and Why Downsizing Affected
Corporate Reputation,” Academy
of Management Journal, 52 (2009),
314–335.
43. Taleo/Human Capital Institute,
“Recessionary Management: The
Top Dos and DON’Ts for Managing
Talent in the Current Downturn,”
January 2009.
44. Susan Wells, “Layoff Aftermath,”
HR Magazine, November 2008,
37–41.
45. “Hewitt Survey Finds U.S.
Employers Still Offering Generous
Employee Severance Packages
Despite Economic Conditions,”
March 19, 2009, www
.hewittassociates.com.
46. Karyn Model, Elaine Reardon, and
Christopher Haan, “Navigating a
Reduction in Force: Understanding
the Economist’s Perspective,”
Employee Relations Law Journal,
Winter 2008, 16–26.
47. “The Worker Adjustment and
Retraining Notification Act: A Guide
to Advance Notice of Closings
and Layoffs,” U.S. Department of
Labor Employment and Training
Administration Fact Sheet, www
.doleta.gov.
48. Manpower, “2009 Talent Shortage
Survey Results,” www.manpower
.com.
49. Mark Schoeff, “Study: Flexibility
Programs Gain Ground in Hard
Times,” Workforce Management,
July 23, 2009.
50. Sandra Fisher, Michael Wasserman,
et al., “Human Resource Issues in
Outsourcing: Integrating Research
and Practice,” Human Resource
Management, 47 (2008), 501–523.
51. Margaret Hilton, “Skills for Work
in the 21st Century: What Does
the Research Tell Us?” Academy of
Management Perspectives, November
2008, 63–78; The Manufacturing
Institute, “People and Profitability: A
Time for Change,” 2009.
52. Brian Mahony, “Healthcare Thought
Leaders Predict the Impact of
Technology,” November 29, 2009,
www.trenderresearch.com.
53. David Savino, “The Role of
Technology as an Enabler in Job
Redesign,” Journal of Technology
Management and Innovation, 4
(2009), 14–23.
54. Vanessa O’Connell, “Retailers
Reprogram Workers in Efficiency
Push,” The Wall Street Journal,
September 10, 2008, A1; Adrienne
Hedger, “The Best Use of Time,”
Workforce Management, May 18,
2009, 44–47.
55. Andrew McIlvaine, “The
Generational Techno-Divide,”
Human Resource Executive Online,
July 1, 2009, www.hreonline.com;
Judy Payne, “Using Wikis and Blogs
to Improve Collaboration and
Knowledge Sharing,” Strategic HR
Review, No. 3, 2008, 5–12.
56. Antonio Poglianich and Matt
Antonek, “Rules of Engagement
in Turbulent Times: How Verizon
Wireless Uses a Robust HR Portal
for Employee Communication,”
Global Business and Organizational
Excellence, May/June 2009, 29–35.
57. SHRM Poll, “Has Your
Organization Disciplined Employees
for Improper Use of Technology?”
Society for Human Resource
Management, June 6, 2007.
58. William Smith and Filiz Tabak,
“Monitoring Employee Emails: Is
There Any Room for Privacy?”
Academy of Management
Perspectives, November 2009,
33–48.
59. Lexy Martin and Lia Goudy, “TimeHonored Truths,” Human Resource
Executive, June 16, 2009, 30–32.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 70
26/06/10 3:36 PM
CHAPTER 2
71
Strategic HR Management and Planning
60. Edward Gordon, “Accounting
Change Needed to Address Talent
Shortfalls,” Employee Benefits News,
January 2010, 12–13.
61. Bruce Ellig, “Speak the Language
of the CFO,” Workspan, July 2008,
57–62; Kate Feather, “Helping
HR to Measure Up: Arming the
Soft Function with Hard Metrics,”
Strategic HR Review, No. 1, 2008,
28–33.
62. SHRM, “Human Capital
Benchmarking Study: 2009,” Society
for Human Resource Management,
www.shrm.org.
63. Wayne Cascio and John Boudreau,
Investing in People: Financial Impact
of Human Resource Initiatives (Upper
Saddle River, NJ: FT Press, 2008).
64. John Dooney, “SHRM Symposium
on Human Capital Analytics,”
Society for Human Resource
Management, 2007,
www.shrm.org.
65. Robert Greene, “Human Resource
Management Strategies: Can We
Discover What Will Work Through
Benchmarking?” WorldatWork
Journal, Second Quarter, 2008,
6–15; Dilys Robinson, “Human
Capital Measurement: An Approach
That Works,” Strategic HR Review,
No. 6, 2009, 5–11.
66. SHRM Poll, “How Often Does
Your Organization Collect HR
Benchmarks/Metrics?” Society for
Human Resource Management,
February 13, 2008.
67. Nancy Lockwood, “The Balanced
Scorecard: An Overview,” SHRM
Research Briefly Stated, June 2006.
68. Margaret Fiester, “Balanced
Scorecards, Unclaimed Wages,
Data,” HRMagazine, December
2008, 24.
69. Debbie Whitaker and Laura Wilson,
“Human Capital Measurement:
From Insight to Action,”
Organization Development Journal,
Fall 2007, 59–64.
70. “Human Capital Strategy: Human
Capital Measurement,” November
30, 2007, www.humancapital
strategy.blogspot.com.
71. Based on: Bill Roberts, “Analyze
This!” HR Magazine, October 2009,
34–41.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 71
26/06/10 3:36 PM
C H A P T E R
3
Equal Employment
Opportunity
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Describe key provisions in Title VII of the Civil Rights Acts
of 1964 and 1991.
•
Show how women are affected by pay, job assignment, and
career issues in organizations.
•
Define the two types of sexual harassment and how
employers should respond to sexual harassment
complaints.
•
Identify two means that organizations are using to deal
with the aging of their workforces.
•
Discuss how reasonable accommodation is made when
managing individuals with disabilities and differing
religious beliefs.
•
Evaluate several arguments supporting and opposing
affirmative action.
•
Discuss why diversity training is important.
72
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 72
26/06/10 8:00 PM
HR Headline
Sexual Harassment
at the United Nations
T
(DANIEL GARCIA/AFP/Getty Images)
he United Nations (U.N.) is struggling
with a series of sexual harassment complaints as it strives to protect human
rights globally. The U.N.’s global staff includes
around 60,000 people stationed around the
world. These employees come from many
different cultures and backgrounds. The U.N.
handles sexual harassment problems differently from other large organizations. Many
U.N. managers have diplomatic immunity
that protects them from criminal prosecution
and from civil lawsuits as well; therefore, the
internal justice system of the organization is
the only one employees can use. This system
dates back to 1946 and employs a “bewildering array” of channels and processes. The net
effect has been many harassment cases that
have not been settled to anyone’s satisfaction.
For example, a female Syrian employee
filed a complaint against her boss in the
Kuwait office alleging he had made sexual
advances, grabbing and kissing her. He then
refused to renew her contract when she did
not respond. Ten days after a report found evidence of her accusations,
the supervisor resigned and could not be disciplined. In another case, a
French woman who was in Gaza for the U.N. complained she was harassed
by her director. She said he used binoculars to spy on her in her apartment, made sexually explicit comments, and groped her. The Director was
cleared at first after an investigation by a “colleague.” Another investigation
was stymied when the director reached mandatory retirement age. His
accuser’s employment contract ran out and was not renewed and the case
ended. In a final case to illustrate the problem, a translator for the U.N.
in Lebanon accused a U.N. security officer of rape, but her employment
contract expired before her appeal was heard; that was the end of the case.
73
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 73
26/06/10 8:01 PM
74
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Employees at the U.N. in the United States who have been harassed
have found that filing a suit in U.S. courts will not work because of the
diplomatic immunity.1 Sexual harassment is an international problem in
employment, but the U.N., regardless of whether it has a bigger problem
than other international organizations, has some unique difficulties in
dealing with it.
In the United States, using race, gender, disability, age, religion, and certain
other characteristics as the basis for choosing among people at work is generally illegal. Doing so can also be quite expensive, as fines and back wages can
be awarded as well as sizable law suit settlements. Inequality in the treatment
of people with different backgrounds has been an issue for many years, but it
was the Civil Rights Act of 1964 that started a legislative movement toward
leveling the playing field in employment. Initially focus was on race, gender,
and religion, but these characteristics were soon followed by age, pregnancy,
and individuals with disabilities. Since then numerous Executive Orders, regulations, and interpretations by courts have affected the employer/employee
relationship. Perhaps nothing has had the impact of Equal Employment
Opportunity (EEO) on HR during the same period of time. See Appendix C
for a listing of the relevant federal laws.
Employers have paid (and continue to pay) large amounts for violating
EEO laws. Familiarity with EEO requirements and ways to successfully manage workforce diversity are the goals and focus of this chapter.2
NATURE OF EQUAL EMPLOYMENT OPPORTUNITY (EEO)
At the core of equal employment is the concept of discrimination. The word
discrimination simply means “recognizing differences among items or people.”
For example, employers must discriminate (choose) among applicants for a
job on the basis of job requirements and candidates’ qualifications. However,
when discrimination is based on race, gender, or some other factors, it is illegal
and employers face problems. The following bases for protection have been
identified by various federal, state, and/or local laws:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Protected category A group
identified for protection under
EEO laws and regulations.
Race, ethnic origin, color (including multiracial/ethnic backgrounds)
Sex/gender (including pregnant women and also men in certain situations)
Age (individuals over age 40)
Individuals with disabilities (physical or mental)
Military experience (military status employees and Vietnam-era veterans)
Religion (special beliefs and practices)
Marital status (some states)
Sexual orientation (some states and cities)
These categories are composed of individuals who are members of a protected
category under EEO laws and regulations.
Discrimination remains a concern as the U.S. workforce becomes more
diverse. As Figure 3-1 indicates, there are two types of illegal employment discrimination: disparate treatment and disparate impact.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 74
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
75
Equal Employment Opportunity
FIGURE 3-1
Illegal Employment Discrimination
Protected Category Members
Disparate Treatment
Disparate Impact
Members of a group are unfairly
treated differently from others
in employment decisions
A policy results in substantially
different employment outcomes
for a particular group
Disparate Treatment
The first type of illegal discrimination occurs with employment-related situations in which either: (1) different standards are used to judge individuals,
or (2) the same standard is used, but it is not related to the individuals’ jobs.
Disparate treatment occurs when members of one group are treated differently
from others. For example, if female applicants must take a special skills test
not given to male applicants, then disparate treatment may be occurring.3
Often disparate treatment cases are based on evidence that an employer’s
actions were intentionally discriminatory. For example, a manufacturing firm
in Cleveland, Ohio, paid almost $1 million to settle an EEO lawsuit involving
20 people, charging that S&Z Tool & Die Company intentionally refused to
hire African Americans and women except in clerical jobs.4
Disparate treatment
Occurs when members of a
group are treated differently
from others.
Disparate impact
Occurs when members of
a protected category are
substantially underrepresented
as a result of employment
decisions that work to their
disadvantage.
Disparate Impact
Disparate impact occurs when members of a protected category are substantially underrepresented as a result of employment decisions that work to their
disadvantage. The landmark case that established the importance of disparate
impact as a legal foundation of EEO law is Griggs v. Duke Power, 1401 U.S. 424
(1971). The decision by the U.S. Supreme Court established two major points:
1. It is not enough to show a lack of discriminatory intent if the
employment tool results in a disparate impact that discriminates
against one group more than another or continues a past pattern of
discrimination.
2. The employer has the burden of proving that an
employment requirement is directly job related as a
“business necessity.” Consequently, the intelligence test
and high school diploma requirements of Duke Power
LOGGING ON
were ruled not to be related to the job.
Equal Employment Opportunity
Commission
This website provides information
on the EEOC. It includes details on
employment discrimination facts,
enforcement statistics, and technical
assistance programs. Visit the site at
www.eeoc.gov.
This and a number of other decisions make it clear that
employers must be able to document through statistical
analyses5 that disparate treatment and disparate impact
have not occurred.6 Knowing how to perform these analyses is important in order for employers to follow appropriate equal employment guidelines. See Appendix E for
information relating to these issues.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 75
26/06/10 8:01 PM
76
SECTION 1
FIGURE 3-2
Environment of Human Resource Management
EEO Concepts
Business Necessity
Job Relatedness
BFOQs (Bona Fide
Occupational Qualifications)
Helping to
Define EEO
Burden of Proof
Nonretaliatory Practices
Equal Employment Opportunity Concepts
Several basic EEO concepts have resulted from court decisions, laws, and regulatory actions. The four key areas discussed next (see Figure 3-2) help clarify
key EEO ideas.
Business Necessity and Job Relatedness A business necessity is a practice
necessary for safe and efficient organizational operations. Business necessity
has been the subject of numerous court decisions. Educational requirements
often are based on business necessity. However, an employer who requires a
minimum level of education, such as a high school diploma, must be able to
defend the requirement as essential to the performance of the job (job related),
which may be difficult. For instance, equating a degree or diploma with the
possession of math or reading abilities is considered questionable.
Further, employers are expected to use job-related employment practices. The Washington v. Davis case involved the hiring of police officers in
Washington, DC. The issue was a reading comprehension and aptitude test
given to all applicants for police officer positions. The test contained actual
material that the applicants would have to learn during a training program.
The city could show a relationship between success in the training program
and success as a police officer, although a much higher percentage of women
and blacks than white men failed this aptitude test.
The Supreme Court ruled that the City of Washington, DC, did not discriminate unfairly because the test was definitely job related. If a test is clearly
related to the job and tasks performed, it is not illegal simply because a greater
percentage of minorities or women do not pass it. The crucial outcome is that
the test must be specifically job related and cannot be judged solely on its
disparate impact.7
Business necessity
A practice necessary for safe
and efficient organizational
operations.
Bona Fide Occupational Qualification (BFOQ) Employers may discriminate on the basis of sex, religion, or national origin if the characteristic can be
justified as a “bona fide occupational qualification reasonably necessary to the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 76
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
77
normal operation of the particular business or enterprise.” Thus, a bona fide
occupational qualification (BFOQ) is a characteristic providing a legitimate
reason why an employer can exclude persons on otherwise illegal bases of
consideration.
What constitutes a BFOQ has been subject to different interpretations in
various courts. Legal uses of BFOQs have been found for hiring Asians to wait
on customers in a Chinese restaurant or Catholics to serve in certain religiousbased positions in Catholic churches.
Burden of Proof Another legal issue that arises when discrimination is
alleged is the determination of who has the burden of proof. Burden of proof
must be established to file suit against employers and establish that illegal
discrimination has occurred.
Based on the evolution of court decisions, current laws, and regulations the
plaintiff charging discrimination must:
• be a protected-category member, and
• prove that disparate impact or disparate treatment existed.
Bona fide occupational
qualification (BFOQ)
Characteristic providing a
legitimate reason why an
employer can exclude persons
on otherwise illegal bases of
consideration.
Burden of proof What
individuals who file suit
against employers must prove
in order to establish that illegal
discrimination has occurred.
Retaliation Punitive actions
taken by employers against
individuals who exercise their
legal rights.
Equal employment
Employment that is
not affected by illegal
discrimination.
Blind to differences
Differences among people
should be ignored and everyone
should be treated equally.
Affirmative action
Employers are urged to employ
people based on their race,
age, gender, or national origin
to make up for historical
discrimination.
Once a court rules that a preliminary case has been made, the burden of proof
shifts to the employer. The employer then must show that the bases for making
employment-related decisions were specifically job related and consistent with
considerations of business necessity.
Nonretaliation Employers are prohibited from retaliating against individuals who file discrimination charges. Retaliation occurs when employers take
punitive actions against individuals who exercise their legal rights. For example, an employee who had reported harassment by a supervisor was fired, but
the Supreme Court found that it is unlawful to discriminate against someone
who has “made a charge, testified, assisted, or participated in any manner in
an investigation, proceeding, or hearing.”8
To avoid charges of retaliation, the following actions are recommended for
employers:
•
•
•
Train supervisors on what retaliation is and what is not appropriate.
Conduct a thorough internal investigation of any claims and document
the results.
Take appropriate action when any retaliation occurs.
Progressing Toward Equal Employment Opportunity
After almost 50 years, equal employment continues to be a significant focus
of HR management. Discrimination, harassment, and retaliation lawsuits are
the legal actions most likely to affect employers. (See HR Perspective: “Officer
Dirt.”) The number of EEO complaints continues to rise, indicating that more
progress is needed to reduce employment discrimination.9
Not everyone agrees on the best way to achieve equal employment opportunity. There seems to be little disagreement that the goal is equal employment,
or employment that is not affected by illegal discrimination. However, the
way to achieve that goal is open to debate.10 One way is to use the “blind to
differences” approach, which argues that differences among people should
be ignored and everyone should be treated equally. The second common
approach is affirmative action, through which employers are urged to employ
people based on their race, age, gender, or national origin. The idea is to make
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 77
26/06/10 8:01 PM
78
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
HR perspective
“Officer Dirt”
When a former police officer suggested age discrimination was involved in his dismissal, the Kansas City Police
Department investigated and decided to fight the case.
They might have done a more thorough job, as later was
shown.
Anthony Hogan had been a police officer for
24 years. With the jury in state court listening, he
countered his supervisor’s denials with tape recordings he
had made during three meetings in which the supervisor
said Officer Hogan was “burned out,” “dragging his feet,”
and “no longer a fireball.” Another police official called
him “Officer Dirt” because he was “Older than Dirt.”
The jury ruled 10–2 in favor of the former officer
and awarded him $700,000 in actual damages and
$2 million in punitive damages. He settled for $1.95
million during an appeal.
EEOC officials expect an increase in discrimination
filings as legislation (e.g., the Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay
Act), economic pressures, and baby boomers reaching
retirement age change the landscape for such suits. The
case of “Officer Dirt” can provide some useful lessons
in dealing with similar claims:
•
•
Be thorough in the investigation: Check
performance evaluations for the past few years,
resist the temptation to talk to only one or two
people, and keep a record of interviews.
Do not demonize the claimant: Rather than
giving in to the tendency to view someone
negatively just because the person has brought
a claim, ask what the work record says.
Managers get emotional when accused of
discrimination, but the result of actions that are
not thought out can be a retaliation claim.
One manager notes that “workers are watching and
waiting to see how we handle the claim . . . we want
others to believe we did the right thing.”11
up for historical discrimination by giving groups who have been affected
enhanced opportunities for employment.
RACE/ETHNIC/NATIONAL ORIGIN
The focus now shifts to equal employment laws and necessary considerations
for managing HR in light of these laws.
Civil Rights Act of 1964, Title VII
Although the very first civil rights act was passed in 1866, it was not until
passage of the Civil Rights Act of 1964 that the keystone of antidiscrimination employment legislation was put into place. The Equal Employment
Opportunity Commission (EEOC) was established to enforce the provisions of
Title VII, the portion of the act that deals with employment.
Title VII of the Civil Rights Act states that it is illegal for an employer to:
1. fail or refuse to hire or discharge any individual, or otherwise
discriminate against any individual with respect to his compensation,
terms, conditions, or privileges of employment because of such
individual’s race, color, religion, sex, or national origin, or
2. limit, segregate, or classify his employees or applicants for employment in
any way that would deprive or tend to deprive any individual of employment
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 78
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
79
opportunities or otherwise adversely affect his status as an employee because
of such individual’s race, color, religion, sex, or national origin.
Title VII Coverage Title VII, as amended by the Equal Employment
Opportunity Act of 1972, covers most employers in the United States. Any
organization meeting one of the criteria in the following list is subject to rules
and regulations that specific government agencies have established to administer the act:
•
•
•
•
•
•
All private employers of 15 or more persons who are employed 20 or
more weeks a year
All educational institutions, public and private
State and local governments
Public and private employment agencies
Labor unions with 15 or more members
Joint labor/management committees for apprenticeships and training
Title VII has been the basis for several extensions of EEO law. For example, in 1980, the EEOC interpreted the law to include sexual harassment.
Further, a number of concepts identified in Title VII are the foundation for
court decisions, regulations, and other laws discussed later in the chapter. See
Appendix E for information on EEO enforcement.
Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478
Numerous executive orders require that employers holding federal government contracts not discriminate on the basis of race, color, religion, national
origin, or sex. An Executive Order is issued by the president of the United
States to provide direction to government departments on a specific area.
The Office of Federal Contract Compliance Programs (OFCCP) in the U.S.
Department of Labor has responsibility for enforcing nondiscrimination in
government contracts.
Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478 are major federal EEO efforts
for government contractors; many states have similar requirements for firms
with state government contracts.
Civil Rights Act of 1991
The Civil Rights Act of 1991 requires employers to show that an employment
practice is job related for the position and is consistent with business necessity. The act clarifies that the plaintiffs bringing the discrimination charges
must identify the particular employer practice being challenged and must
show only that protected-class status played some role in their treatment. For
employers, this requirement means that an individual’s race, color, religion,
sex, or national origin must play no role in their employment practices. This
act allows people who have been targets of intentional discrimination based
on sex, religion, or disability to receive both compensatory and punitive damages. One key provision of the 1991 act relates to how U.S. laws on EEO are
applied globally.
Managing Racial and National Origin Issues
The original purpose of the Civil Rights Act of 1964 was to address race and
national origin discrimination. This concern continues to be important today,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 79
26/06/10 8:01 PM
80
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
and employers must be aware of potential HR issues that are based on race,
national origin, and citizenship in order to take appropriate actions.
Employment discrimination can occur in numerous ways, from refusal to
hire someone because of the person’s race/ethnicity to the questions asked in a
selection interview. See Appendix D for examples of legal and illegal question
areas. For example, a trucking company settled a discrimination lawsuit by
African American employees who were denied job assignments and promotions because of racial bias. In addition to paying a fine, the firm must report
to the EEOC on promotions from part-time to full-time for dock worker jobs.
Sometimes racial discriminations can be more subtle. For example, some
firms have tapped professional and social networking sites to fill open positions. However, networking sites exclude many people. According to one
study, only 5% of LinkedIn users are black and 2% are Hispanic. This lack of
access to these sites can easily be viewed as racial discrimination.12
Under federal law, discriminating against people because of skin color is
just as illegal as discriminating because of race. For example, one might be
guilty of color discrimination but not racial discrimination if one hired lightskinned African Americans over dark-skinned people.
Racial/Ethnic Harassment The area of racial/ethnic harassment is such a
concern that the EEOC has issued guidelines on it. It is recommended that
employers adopt policies against harassment of any type, including ethnic
jokes, vulgar epithets, racial slurs, and physical actions. The consequences
of not enforcing these policies are seen in a case involving a small business
employer that subjected Latinos to physical and verbal abuse. Hispanic males
at the firm were subjected to derogatory jokes, verbal abuse, physical harm,
and other humiliating experiences. Settling the case was expensive for the
employer.
Contrast that case with another that shows the advantage of taking
quick remedial action. An employee filed a lawsuit against an airline because
coworkers told racist jokes and hung nooses in his workplace. The airline was
able to show that each time any employee, including the plaintiff, reported
problems, management conducted an investigation and took action against the
offending employees. The court ruled for the employer in this case because the
situation was managed properly.
Affirmative Action
Affirmative Action
The hiring of groups of people
based on their race, age,
gender or national origin.
Through affirmative action, employers are urged to hire groups of people
based on their race, age, gender, or national origin to make up for historical
discrimination. It is a requirement for federal government contractors to document the inclusion of women and racial minorities in the workforce. As part of
those government regulations, covered employers must submit plans describing their attempts to narrow the gaps between the composition of their workforces and the composition of labor markets where they obtain employees.
However, affirmative action has been the subject of numerous court cases and
an ongoing political and social debate both in the United States and globally.13
For example, a recent Supreme Court ruling held that race should not be
used to the detriment of individuals who passed an examination and were
qualified for promotions. In this case, the city of New Haven, Connecticut,
threw out the results of a test for promotion where more white firefighters
passed than blacks or Hispanics. The City claimed it had to junk the tests
because they would lead to an avalanche of lawsuits by black candidates who
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 80
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
81
had not passed. The court said fear of litigation was no reason to rely on race
to throw out the results.14
Supporters offer many reasons why affirmative action is important,
while opponents argue firmly against it. Individuals can examine the points
of both sides in the debate and compare them with their personal views of
affirmative action. The authors of this text believe that whether one supports
or opposes affirmative action, it is important to understand why its supporters believe that it is needed and why its opponents believe it should be discontinued. The reasons given most frequently by both sides are highlighted in
Figure 3-3.
Managing Affirmative Action Requirements
Affirmative action plan
(AAP) A document reporting
on the composition of an
employer’s workforce, required
for federal contractors.
FIGURE 3-3
Federal, state, and local regulations require many government contractors to
compile affirmative action plans to report on the composition of their workforces. An affirmative action plan (AAP) is a formal document that an employer
compiles annually for submission to enforcement agencies. Generally, contractors with at least 50 employees and $50,000 in government contracts annually
must submit these plans. Courts have noted that any employer may have a voluntary AAP, although employers must have such a plan if they are government
contractors. Some courts have ordered employers that are not government
The Debate about Affirmative Action
Arguments: Why Affirmative Action Is Needed
Affirmative action is needed to overcome past injustices or eliminate the effects of those injustices.
Affirmative action creates more equality for all persons, even if temporary injustice to some
individuals may result.
Raising the employment level of protected-class members will benefit U.S. society in the long run.
Properly used, affirmative action does not discriminate against males or whites.
Goals indicate progress is needed, not quotas.
Arguments: Why Affirmative Action Is Not Needed
Affirmative action penalizes individuals (males and whites) even though they have not been guilty
of practicing discrimination.
It is no longer needed as an African American has been elected President.
Affirmative action results in greater polarization and separatism along gender and racial lines.
Affirmative action stigmatizes those it is designed to help.
Goals become quotas and force employers to “play by the numbers.”
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 81
26/06/10 8:01 PM
82
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
contractors to submit required AAPs because of past discriminatory practices
and violations of laws.
The contents of an AAP and the policies flowing from it must be available
for review by managers and supervisors within the organization. Plans vary in
length; some are long and require extensive staff time to prepare.
M
Affirmative Action Plan Metrics A crucial but time-consuming part of
an AAP is the analyses. The availability analysis identifies the number of
protected-class members available to work in the appropriate labor markets
for given jobs. This analysis can be developed with data from a state labor
department, the U.S. Census Bureau, and other sources. The utilization analysis
E A S U R E
identifies the number of protected-class members employed in the organization and the types of jobs they hold.
Once all the data have been analyzed and compared, then underutilization statistics must be calculated by comparing the availability analysis with
the utilization analysis. It is useful to think of this stage as a comparison of
whether the internal workforce is a “representative sampling” of the available
external labor force from which employees are hired.
Using the underutilization data, goals and timetables
for reducing underutilization of protected-class individuals
must then be identified. Actions that will be taken to recruit,
LOGGING ON
hire, promote, and train more protected-class individuals
The Affirmative Action and
are described. The AAP must be updated and reviewed each
Diversity Project
year to reflect changes in the utilization and availability
A resource for opinions surrounding
of protected-category members. If the AAP is audited, the
the issues of affirmative action and its
employer must be prepared to provide additional details
cultural and economic aspects can be
and documentation. Appendix F provides information
found at http://aad.english.ucsb.edu.
about EEO enforcement.
SEX/GENDER DISCRIMINATION LAWS
AND REGULATIONS
A number of laws and regulations address discrimination based on sex or gender. Historically, women experienced employment discrimination in a variety
of ways. The inclusion of sex as a basis for protected-class status in Title VII
of the 1964 Civil Rights Act has led to various areas of legal protection for
women.
Pregnancy Discrimination
Availability analysis
Identifies the number of
protected-class members
available to work in the
appropriate labor markets for
given jobs.
Utilization analysis
Identifies the number of
protected-class members
employed in the organization
and the types of jobs they hold.
The Pregnancy Discrimination Act (PDA) of 1978 requires that any employer
with 15 or more employees treat maternity leave the same as other personal
or medical leaves. Closely related to the PDA is the Family and Medical Leave
Act (FMLA) of 1993, which requires that individuals be given up to 12 weeks
of family leave without pay and also requires that those taking family leave
be allowed to return to jobs (see Chapter 13 for details). The FMLA applies
to both men and women.
Courts have generally ruled that the PDA requires employers to treat pregnant employees the same as nonpregnant employees with similar abilities or
inabilities. Employers have been found to have acted properly when terminating a pregnant employee for excessive absenteeism due to pregnancy-related
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 82
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
83
illnesses, because the employee was not treated differently from other employees with absenteeism problems.
Equal Pay and Pay Equity
The Equal Pay Act of 1963 requires employers to pay similar wage rates for
similar work without regard to gender. A common core of tasks must be similar, but tasks performed only intermittently or infrequently do not make jobs
different enough to justify significantly different wages. Differences in pay
between men and women in the same jobs may be allowed because of:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Pay equity The idea that pay
for jobs requiring comparable
levels of knowledge, skill,
and ability should be similar,
even if actual duties differ
significantly.
Sexual harassment Actions
that are sexually directed, are
unwanted, and subject the
worker to adverse employment
conditions or create a hostile
work environment.
Differences in seniority
Differences in performance
Differences in quality and/or quantity of production
Factors other than sex, such as skill, effort, and working conditions
For example, a university was found to have violated the Equal Pay Act by
paying a female professor a starting salary lower than salaries paid to male
professors with similar responsibilities. In fact, the court found that the
woman professor taught larger classes and had more total students than some
of the male faculty members.15
Ledbetter v. Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. was a significant U.S. Supreme
Court decision on pay discrimination. Ledbetter, a female manager with
Goodyear in Alabama, claimed that she was subjected to pay discrimination because she received lower pay during her career back to 1979, even
though she did not file suit until 1998.16 The decision examined this view and
stated that the rights of workers to sue for previous years of paid discrimination are limited. However, in 2009 Congress passed the Lilly Ledbetter Fair
Pay Act that canceled the Supreme Court ruling. The new law effectively
eliminates the statute of limitations for employees to file pay discrimination
claims.17
Pay equity is the idea that pay for jobs requiring comparable levels of
knowledge, skill, and ability should be similar, even if actual duties differ
significantly. This theory has also been called comparable worth in earlier
cases. Some state laws have mandated pay equity for public-sector employees.
However, U.S. federal courts generally have ruled that the existence of pay differences between the different jobs held by women and men is not sufficient
to prove that illegal discrimination has occurred.
A major reason for the development of the pay equity idea is the continuing gap between the earnings of women and men. For instance, in 1980, the
average annual pay of full-time female workers was 60% of that of full-time
male workers. By 2008, the reported rate of about 80% showed some progress
but a continuing disparity.18 See Figure 3-4.
Sexual Harassment
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission has issued guidelines
designed to curtail sexual harassment. Sexual harassment refers to actions
that are sexually directed, are unwanted, and subject the worker to adverse
employment conditions or create a hostile work environment. Sexual harassment can occur between a boss and a subordinate, among coworkers, and
when nonemployees have business contacts with employees.
Most of the sexual harassment charges filed involve harassment of women
by men. However, some sexual harassment cases have been filed by men
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 83
26/06/10 8:01 PM
84
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Female Annual Earnings as Percentage of Male Earnings
Wage Ratio
FIGURE 3-4
0.9
0.8
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
1960
1965
1970
1975
1980
1985
1990
1995
Year
2000
2005 2010
(projected)
Source: U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, 2009, www.bls.gov.
against women managers and supervisors, and some have been filed by both
men and women for same-sex harassment.
Managing Sex/Gender Issues
The influx of women into the workforce has had major social, economic, and
organizational consequences. The percentage of women in the total U.S. civilian workforce has increased dramatically since 1950, to almost 50% today.
This growth in the number of women in the workforce has led to more sex/
gender issues related to jobs and careers. A significant issue is related to biology
(women bear children) and to tradition (women have a primary role in raising
children). A major result of the increasing share of women in the workforce is
that more women with children are working. According to the U.S. Bureau of
Labor Statistics, about three-fourths of women aged 25–54 are in the workforce. Further, about half of all women currently working are single, separated,
divorced, widowed, or otherwise single heads of households. Consequently, they
are “primary” income earners, not co-income providers, and must balance family and work responsibilities. This responsibility may affect managers’ perceptions of family/work conflict that may lead to promotability issues for women.19
To guard against pay inequities that are considered illegal under the Equal
Pay Act, employers should follow these guidelines:
•
•
•
•
•
Include all benefits and other items that are part of remuneration to
calculate total compensation for the most accurate overall picture.
Make sure people know how the pay practices work.
Base pay on the value of jobs and performance.
Benchmark against local and national markets so that pay structures are
competitive.
Conduct frequent audits to ensure there are no gender-based inequities
and that pay is fair internally.
Nontraditional Jobs The right to reassign women from hazardous jobs to
ones that may be lower paying but less hazardous because of health-related
concerns is another gender-related issue encountered by employers. Fears about
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 84
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
85
Equal Employment Opportunity
Women as Percentage of Total Employees by Selected Industries
FIGURE 3-5
Higher Percentages
Lower Percentages
Child day care
95.3 %
Taxi/ limousine services
11.6%
Home healt h care
89.1%
Aut omot ive repair
10.6%
Vet erinary services
81.7%
Const ruct ion
9.7%
Hospit als
76.7%
Landscaping services
8.6%
E lement ary and secondary schools
75.6%
Coal mining
7.2%
Pharmacies and drug st ores
64.8%
Rail t ransport at ion
5.9%
Travel/reservat ion services
61.6%
Logging
4.4%
Source: U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, 2008, www.bls.gov.
higher health insurance costs and possible lawsuits involving such problems
as birth defects caused by damage sustained during pregnancy have led some
employers to institute reproductive and fetal protection policies. However, the
U.S. Supreme Court has ruled that such policies are illegal. Also, having different job conditions for men and women is usually held to be discriminatory.
Figure 3-5 shows some of the occupations in which women constitute high
percentages and low percentages of those employed.
Jobs that pay well but are nontraditional jobs for women include: architects, computer programmers, software engineers, detectives, chefs, engineers,
computer repair, construction, building inspectors, machinists, aircraft pilots,
and firefighters.20
Glass ceiling Discriminatory
practices that have prevented
women and other protectedclass members from advancing
to executive-level jobs.
Glass Ceiling For years, women’s groups have alleged that women in workplaces encounter a glass ceiling, which refers to discriminatory practices that
have prevented women and other protected-class members from advancing to
executive-level jobs. Women in the United States are making some progress in
getting senior-level, managerial, and professional jobs. Nevertheless, women
hold only a small percentage of the highest-ranking executive management
jobs in big companies. By comparison, women hold a considerably lower percentage of the same kinds of jobs in France, Germany, Brazil, and many other
countries.
A related problem is that women have tended to advance to senior management in a limited number of support or staff areas, such as HR and corporate communications. Because executive jobs in these “supporting” areas tend
to pay less than jobs in sales, marketing, operations, or finance, the overall
impact is to reduce women’s career progression and income. Limits that keep
women from progressing only in certain fields have been referred to as “glass
walls” or “glass elevators.” These limitations are seen as being tied to organizational, cultural, and leadership issues.21
“Breaking the Glass” A number of employers have recognized that “breaking the glass,” whether ceilings, walls, or elevators, is good business for both
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 85
26/06/10 8:01 PM
86
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
women and racial minorities. Some of the most common means used to “break
the glass” are as follows:
•
•
•
•
•
Establish formal mentoring programs for women and members of racial/
ethnic minorities.
Provide opportunities for career rotation into operations, marketing,
and sales for individuals who have shown talent in accounting, HR, and
other areas.
Increase the memberships of top management and boards of directors to
include women and individuals of color.
Establish clear goals for retention and progression of protected-category
individuals and hold managers accountable for achieving these goals.
Allow for alternative work arrangements for employees, particularly
those balancing work/family responsibilities.
Individuals with Differing Sexual Orientations
As if demographic diversity did not place enough pressure on managers and
organizations, individuals in the workforce today have widely varying lifestyles that can have work-related consequences. Legislative efforts have been
made to protect individuals with differing lifestyles or sexual orientations from
employment discrimination, though at present only a few cities and states have
passed such laws.
One visible issue that some employers have had to address is that of individuals who have had or are undergoing sex-change surgery and therapy.
Federal court cases and the EEOC have ruled that sex discrimination under
Title VII applies to a person’s gender at birth. Thus, it does not apply to the new
gender of those who have had gender-altering operations. Sexual orientation
or sex-change issues that arise at work include the reactions of coworkers
and managers and ensuring that such individuals are evaluated fairly and not
discriminated against in work assignments, raises, training, or promotions.
Nepotism
Many employers have policies that restrict or prohibit nepotism, the practice
of allowing relatives to work for the same employer. Other firms require
only that relatives not work directly for or with each other or not be placed
in positions where collusion or conflict could occur. The policies most frequently cover spouses, brothers, sisters, mothers, fathers, sons, and daughters.
Generally, employer antinepotism policies have been upheld by courts, in spite
of the concern that they tend to discriminate against women more than men
(because women tend to be denied employment or to leave employers more
often as a result of marriage to other employees).22
Consensual Relationships and Romance at Work
Nepotism Practice of
allowing relatives to work for
the same employer.
When work-based friendships lead to romance and off-the-job sexual relationships, managers and employers face a dilemma: Should they “monitor”
these relationships to protect the firm from potential legal complaints, thereby
“meddling” in employees’ private, off-the-job lives? Or do they simply ignore
these relationships and the potential problems they present? These concerns
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 86
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
87
Equal Employment Opportunity
are significant, given a survey that found that about 40% of workers have
dated coworkers.23
Most executives and HR professionals (as well as employees) agree that
workplace romances are risky because they have great potential for causing
conflict. They strongly agree that romance must not take place between a
supervisor and a subordinate. Some employers have addressed the issue of
workplace romances by establishing policies dealing with them.24
Different actions may be appropriate if a relationship is clearly consensual
than if it is forced by a supervisor–subordinate relationship. One consideration
is the observation that consensual workplace romances can create hostile work
environments for others in organizations.
Dealing with Sexual Harassment
Sexual harassment is a significant concern in many organizations and can
occur in a variety of workplace relationships. As shown in Figure 3-6, individuals in many different roles can be sexual harassers. For example, third
parties who are neither employers nor employees have been found to be
harassers. Both customer service representatives and food servers have won
sexual harassment complaints because their employers refused to protect them
from regular sexual harassment by aggressive customers.
Most frequently, sexual harassment occurs when a male in a supervisory or managerial position harasses women within his “power structure.”
However, as noted earlier, women managers have been found guilty of sexually harassing male employees, and same-sex harassment also has occurred.
Court decisions have held that a person’s sexual orientation neither provides
nor precludes a claim of sexual harassment under Title VII. It is enough
that the harasser engaged in pervasive and unwelcome conduct of a sexual
nature.
FIGURE 3-6
Potential Sexual Harassers
Supervisors
Other
Employees
Customers
Employee
Former
Employees
Vendors
CoWorkers
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 87
26/06/10 8:01 PM
88
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Types of Sexual Harassment
Two basic types of sexual harassment have been defined by EEOC regulations
and a large number of court cases. The two types are different in nature and
defined as follows:
1. Quid pro quo is harassment in which employment outcomes are linked to
the individual granting sexual favors.
2. Hostile environment harassment exists when an individual’s work
performance or psychological well-being is unreasonably affected by
intimidating or offensive working conditions.
In quid pro quo harassment, an employee may be promised a promotion, a
special raise, or a desirable work assignment, but only if the employee grants
some sexual favors to the supervisor. The second type, hostile environment
harassment, may include actions such as commenting on appearance or attire,
telling jokes that are suggestive or sexual in nature, allowing revealing photos
and posters to be on display, or making continual requests to get together after
work that can lead to the creation of a hostile work environment. Rude and
discourteous behavior often is linked to sexual harassment.
As computer and Internet technology has spread, the number of electronic
sexual harassment cases has grown.25 Sexual harassment is increasingly occurring via e-mails and Internet access systems. Cyber sexual harassment may
occur when an employee forwards an e-mail joke with sexual content or
accesses pornographic websites at work and then shares content with other
employees. Cyber stalking, in which a person continually e-mails an employee
requesting dates and sending personal messages, is growing as instant messaging expands.
Many employers have policies addressing the inappropriate use of e-mail,
company computer systems, and electronic technology usage. Serious situations
have led to employee terminations. Once a company disciplined more than 200
employees and fired 50 of them for having e-mailed pornographic images and
other inappropriate materials using the company information system.
Many employers have equipped their computer systems with scanners
that screen for inappropriate words and images. Offending employees receive
warnings and/or disciplinary actions associated with “flagged” items.
Employer Responses to Sexual Harassment
Quid pro quo Sexual
harassment in which
employment outcomes are
linked to the individual
granting sexual favors.
Hostile environment
Sexual harassment in
which an individual’s work
performance or psychological
well-being is unreasonably
affected by intimidating or
offensive working conditions.
Employers must be proactive to prevent sexual and other types of harassment.
If the workplace culture fosters harassment, and if policies and practices do
not inhibit harassment, an employer is wise to reevaluate and solve the problem before lawsuits follow.
Only if the employer can produce evidence of taking reasonable care to
prohibit sexual harassment does the employer have the possibility of avoiding liability through an affirmative defense.26 Critical components of ensuring
such reasonable care include the following:
•
•
•
•
Establish a sexual harassment policy.
Communicate the policy regularly.
Train employees and managers on avoiding sexual harassment.
Investigate and take action when complaints are voiced.
As Figure 3-7 indicates, if an employee has suffered any tangible employment
action (such as being denied raises, being terminated, or being refused access to
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 88
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
89
Equal Employment Opportunity
FIGURE 3-7
Sexual Harassment Liability Determination
Sexual Harassment
(Quid pro quo or
hostile environment
occurred)
Legal Focus
Employee
Consequence
Employee
Suffered No
Tangible
Employment
Action
Employee
Suffered
Tangible
Employment
Actions
Employer
Action
Employer
Produced an
Affirmative
Defense
Employer
Produced No
Affirmative
Defense
Employer
Liability
Employer Is
Probably
Not Liable
Employer Is
Probably
Liable
Source: Virginia Collins, PhD, SPHR, and Robert L. Mathis, PhD, SPHR, Omaha, Nebraska.
training) because of sexual harassment, then the employer is liable. Even if the
employee has suffered no tangible employment action, if the employer has not
produced an affirmative defense, then employer liability still exists.
Harassment Likelihood
G L O B A L
Research suggests that some people are more likely to be sexually harassed
than others. For example, one study found that supervisors or women with
more workplace authority are more likely to be harassed.27 Further research
suggests that the likelihood of men to sexually harass, and the tolerance for
sexual harassment by women vary across countries. Fundamental differences
regarding power between men and women and a cultural support of sexual
harassment lead to very different sexual harassment situations from country
to country. According to this research, Canada, Denmark, Germany, The
Netherlands, Sweden, and the United States are likely to have relatively less
sexual harassment than countries like East Africa, Hong Kong, Indonesia,
Malaysia, Mexico, Turkey, and Yugoslavia.28
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 89
26/06/10 8:01 PM
90
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
INDIVIDUALS WITH DISABILITIES
The passage of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) in 1990 began the
laws and regulations on discrimination against individuals with disabilities.
These laws and regulations affect employment matters as well as public accessibility for individuals with disabilities.
Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA)
Organizations with 15 or more employees are covered by the provisions of the
ADA, which are enforced by the EEOC. The act applies to private employers,
employment agencies, and labor unions.29 State government employees are not
covered by the ADA, which means that they cannot sue in federal courts for
redress and damages. However, they may still bring suits under state laws in
state courts.
Essential job functions
Fundamental job duties.
Reasonable
accommodation
A modification to a job or
work environment that gives
a qualified individual an equal
employment opportunity to
perform.
Undue hardship Significant
difficulty or expense imposed
on an employer in making an
accommodation for individuals
with disabilities.
Disabled person Someone
who has a physical or mental
impairment that substantially
limits life activities, who has a
record of such an impairment,
or who is regarded as having
such an impairment.
ADA and Job Requirements Discrimination is prohibited against individuals with disabilities who can perform the essential job functions—the fundamental job duties—of the employment positions that those individuals hold
or desire. These functions do not include marginal functions of the position.
For a qualified person with a disability, an employer must make a
reasonable accommodation, which is a modification to a job or work environment that gives that individual an equal employment opportunity to perform.
EEOC guidelines encourage employers and individuals to work together to
determine what are appropriate reasonable accommodations, rather than
employers alone making those judgments.
Reasonable accommodation is restricted to actions that do not place an
undue hardship on an employer. An undue hardship is a significant difficulty
or expense imposed on an employer in making an accommodation for individuals with disabilities. The ADA offers only general guidelines in determining when an accommodation becomes unreasonable and will place undue
hardship on an employer.
ADA Restrictions and Medical Information The ADA contains restrictions on obtaining and retaining medically related information on applicants
and employees. Restrictions include prohibiting employers from rejecting
individuals because of a disability and from asking job applicants any question
about current or past medical history until a conditional job offer is made.
Also, the ADA prohibits the use of preemployment medical exams, except for
drug tests, until a job has been conditionally offered.
Who Is Disabled?
As defined by the ADA, a disabled person is someone who has a physical or
mental impairment that substantially limits that person in some major life
activities, who has a record of such an impairment, or who is regarded as
having such an impairment. Figure 3-8 shows the most frequent disabilities
identified in ADA charges.
However, it is not always concluded that people have disabilities when they
feel they are disabled. For example, in a case involving United Parcel Service,
the Court ruled that an employee who had high blood pressure but was on
blood pressure medications was not disabled under the ADA.30 Another U.S.
Supreme Court case found that an employee who had been fired for drug
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 90
26/06/10 8:01 PM
91
Equal Employment Opportunity
CHAPTER 3
Most Frequent ADA Disabilities Cited
FIGURE 3-8
Non-paralytic
orthopedic
8.6%
6.7%
Depression
4.2%
Impairment/Special
Diabetes
Heart/
cardiovascular
3.9%
Hearing
impairments
3.1%
Cancer
2.7%
Psychological
disorders
2.7%
2.5%
Vision
Epilepsy
0.0%
1.9%
2.0%
4.0%
6.0%
8.0%
10.0%
% of Total Cases
Source: Based on data from U.S. Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, 2009; see www.eeoc.gov for details.
addiction was not entitled to be rehired because his addiction was not a disability. The ADA does not protect current users of illegal drugs and substances,
but it does protect those who are recovering addicts.
Mental Disabilities A growing area of concern to employers under the
ADA is individuals with mental disabilities. A mental illness is often more
difficult to diagnose than a physical disability. Employers must be careful
when considering “emotional” or “mental health” factors such as depression
in employment-related decisions. They must not stereotype individuals with
mental impairments or disabilities but must instead base their evaluations on
sound medical information.
Amendments to ADA (ADAAA) Congress passed amendments to the ADA,
effective in 2009, that overruled several key cases and regulations. The effect
was to expand the definition of disabled individuals to include anyone with a
physical or mental impairment that substantially limits one or more major life
activities without regard for the ameliorative effects of mitigating measures
such as medication, prosthetics, hearing aids, and so on. Major life activities
include, among others, walking, seeing, breathing, working, sleeping, concentrating, thinking, and communicating.31
Genetic Bias Regulations
Related to medical disabilities is the emerging area of workplace genetic bias.
As medical research has revealed the human genome, medical tests have been
developed that can identify an individual’s genetic markers for various diseases.
Whether these tests should be used and how they are used can raise ethical issues.
Employers that use genetic screening tests do so for two primary reasons.
Some use genetic testing to make workers aware of genetic problems that
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 91
26/06/10 8:01 PM
92
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
may exist so that medical treatments can begin. Others use genetic testing to
terminate employees who may make extensive use of health insurance benefits
and thus raise the benefits costs and utilization rates of the employer. A major
railroad company, Burlington Northern Santa Fe, had to publicly apologize to
employees for secretly testing to determine if they were genetically predisposed
to carpal tunnel syndrome.
Genetic Information Nondiscrimination Act (GINA) Congress passed
GINA to limit the use of information by health insurance plans. Employers
are prohibited from collecting genetic information or making employment
decisions based on genetic decisions. “Genetic information” includes genetic
tests of the employee or family members and family medical history. It does not
apply to “water cooler talk,” or the inadvertent acquisition of information.32
Managing Disabilities in the Workforce
At the heart of managing individuals with disabilities is for employers to make
reasonable accommodations in several areas. Common means of reasonable
accommodation are shown in Figure 3-9. First, architectural barriers should not
prohibit disabled individuals’ access to work areas or restrooms. Second, appropriate work tasks must be assigned. Satisfying this requirement may mean modifying jobs, work area layouts, or work schedules or providing special equipment.
Key to making reasonable accommodations is identifying the essential job
functions and then determining which accommodations are reasonable so
that the individual can perform the core job duties. Fortunately for employers,
most accommodations needed are relatively inexpensive.33
Recruiting and Selecting Individuals with Disabilities Numerous
employers have specifically targeted the recruitment and selection of individuals
with disabilities. However, as the HR On-the-Job indicates, questions asked in
the employment process should be job related.
FIGURE 3-9
Common Means of Reasonable Accommodation
Modified Work Schedules
Special Equipment
Job Restructuring
Reasonable
Accommodation
Job Reassignment
Employer-Provided Assistance
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 92
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
93
Equal Employment Opportunity
ADA and Employment
Questions
The Americans with Disabilities Act prohibits asking
job applicants questions about past or current health
history until a conditional job offer is made. The
offer often is based on passing a physical exam or a
medical background check. Any physical or medical
requirements must be related to the specific job for
which the applicant is being considered.
Two HR areas that are affected are employment
applications and interviews. In these areas, a general
question such as the following is often used:
Can you perform the essential functions of the
job for which you are applying with or without
accommodation?
Several examples of specific questions concerning
disabilities that should and should not be asked in
employment interviews are shown in the following
chart. As is evident, the questions that should be asked
are specifically related to the job and address essential
job functions.
HR on-the-job
✗ DO NOT ASK
• Do you have any physical or mental disabilities?
• Why are you using crutches, and how did you
become injured?
• How many times were you absent due to
illness in the past two years?
• Have you been treated for any of the following
medical conditions?
• Have you ever filed for or collected workers’
compensation?
✓ DO ASK
• How would you perform the essential tasks of
the job for which you have applied?
• If hired, which tasks outlined in the job
description that you reviewed would be more
enjoyable and which ones most difficult?
• Describe your attendance record on your last job.
• Describe any problems you would have
reaching the top of a six-foot filing cabinet.
• What did your prior job duties consist of, and
which ones were the most challenging?
One common selection test is a physical abilities test, which can be challenged as discriminatory based on the ADA. Such physical tests must be specifically job related, and not general. For example, having all applicants lift
50-pound weights, even though only some warehouse workers will have to
lift that much, could be illegal. Also, rather than testing with barbells or other
artificial weights, the employer should use the actual 50-pound boxes lifted in
performing the specific jobs.
Employees Who Develop Disabilities For many employers, the impact
of the ADA has been the greatest when handling employees who develop
disabilities, not dealing with applicants who already have disabilities. As the
workforce ages, it is likely that more employees will develop disabilities. For
instance, a warehouse worker who suffers a serious leg injury while motorcycling away from work may request reasonable accommodation.
Employers must develop responses for handling accommodation requests
from individuals who have been satisfactory employees without disabilities,
but who now must be considered for accommodations if they are to be able to
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 93
26/06/10 8:01 PM
94
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
continue working. Handled inappropriately, these individuals are likely to file
either ADA complaints with the EEOC or private lawsuits.
Employees sometimes can be shifted to other jobs where their disabilities
do not affect them as much. For instance, the warehouse firm might be able
to move the injured repair worker to a purchasing inventory job inside so that
climbing and lifting are unnecessary. But the problem for employers is what
to do with the next worker who develops problems if an alternative job is not
available. Even if the accommodations are just for one employee, the reactions
of coworkers must be considered.
Individuals with Mental Disabilities More ADA complaints are being
filed by individuals who have or claim to have mental disabilities. The cases
that have been filed have ranged from individuals with a medical history
of paranoid schizophrenia or clinical depression to individuals who claim
that job stress has affected their marriage or sex life. Regardless of the type
of employees’ claims, it is important that employers respond properly by
obtaining medical verifications for claims of mental illnesses and considering
accommodation requests for mental disabilities in the same manner as accommodation requests for physical disabilities.
Individuals with Life-Threatening Illnesses The U.S. Supreme Court has
determined that individuals with life-threatening illnesses are covered by the
ADA. Individuals with leukemia, cancer, or AIDS are all considered as having disabilities, and employers must respond to them appropriately or face
charges of discrimination. Numerous individuals with life-threatening illnesses
may intend to continue working, particularly if their illness is forecast to be
multiyear in nature.
An additional requirement of the ADA is that all medical information be
maintained in files separated from the general personnel files. The medical files
must have identified security procedures, and limited access procedures must
be identified.
Management Focus on ADAAA Adaptation After the changes made by
ADAAA, less effort should be placed on determining whether an individual
is indeed disabled—the individual probably is disabled. Rather, management
should:
•
•
•
•
Define essential functions in advance.
Handle all requests for accommodation properly.
Interact with the employee with good faith and documentation.
Know and follow the reasonable accommodation rules.
AGE AND EQUAL EMPLOYMENT OPPORTUNITY
The populations of most developed countries—including Australia, Japan, most
European countries, and the United States—are aging. These changes mean
that as older workers with a lifetime of experiences and skills retire, HR faces
significant challenges in replacing them with workers having the capabilities
and work ethic that characterize many mature workers in the United States.
Employment discrimination against individuals age 40 and older is prohibited
by the Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA).
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 94
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
95
Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA)
The Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA) of 1967, amended in
1978 and 1986, prohibits discrimination in terms, conditions, or privileges of
employment against all individuals age 40 years or older working for employers having 20 or more workers. However, the U.S. Supreme Court has ruled
that state employees may not sue state government employers in federal courts
because the ADEA is a federal law. The impact of the ADEA is increasing as
the U.S. workforce has been aging.34 Consequently, the number of age discrimination cases has been increasing, according to EEOC reports.
A number of countries have passed age discrimination laws. For example,
age discrimination regulations in Great Britain focus on preventing age discrimination in recruitment, promotion, training, and retirement-related actions.35
As with most EEO issues, age discrimination details are continuing to be
defined by the various courts, with the Supreme Court having decided employers are not liable if the disparate age impact is due to “reasonable factors
other than age” (RFOA). The specific cases decided recently suggest that the
employee retains the heavier burden for proving that the adverse employment
action was taken because of the employee’s age.36 However, employers that
focus on recruiting or providing “preferential treatment” of older workers do
not violate the ADEA.
Older Workers Benefit Protection Act (OWBPA)
This law is an amendment to the ADEA and is aimed at protecting employees when they sign liability waivers for age discrimination in exchange
for severance packages. To comply with the act, employees must be given
complete accurate information on the available benefits.
For example, an early retirement package that includes a
waiver stating the employee will not sue for age discriminaLOGGING ON
tion if the employee takes the money for early retirement
Administration on Aging
must include a written, clearly understood agreement to
This government website provides
that effect.
information on aging and age
The impact of the OWBPA is becoming more evident.
discrimination from government
Industries
such as manufacturing and others offer early
agencies, associations, and
organizations. Visit the site at
retirement buyouts to cut their workforces. For instance,
www.aoa.gov.
Ford and General Motors have offered large buyouts of
which thousands of workers have taken advantage.
Managing Age Discrimination
One issue that has led to age discrimination charges is labeling older workers as “overqualified” for jobs or promotions. In a number of cases, courts
have ruled that the term overqualified may have been used as a code word
for workers being too old, thus causing them not to be considered for
employment. Also, selection and promotion practices must be “age neutral.”
Older workers face substantial barriers to entry in a number of occupations, especially those requiring significant amounts of training or ones
where new technology has been recently developed. In some cases involving
older employees, age-related comments such as “That’s just old Fred” or
“We need younger blood” in conversations were used as evidence of age
discrimination.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 95
26/06/10 8:01 PM
96
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
To counter significant staffing difficulties, some employers recruit older
people to return to the workforce through the use of part-time and other
scheduling options. During the past decade, the number of older workers holding part-time jobs has increased. It is likely that the number of older workers
interested in working part-time will continue to grow.
A strategy used by employers to retain the talents of older workers is
phased retirement, whereby employees gradually reduce their workloads and
pay levels. This option is growing in use as a way to allow older workers with
significant knowledge and experience to have more personal flexibility, while
the organizations retain them for their valuable capabilities. Some firms also
rehire their retirees as part-time workers, independent contractors, or consultants.37 Some provisions in the Pension Protection Act of 2006 allow pension
distributions for employees who are reducing their work hours.
RELIGION AND SPIRITUALITY IN THE WORKPLACE
Title VII of the Civil Rights Act identifies discrimination on the basis of religion as illegal. The increasing religious diversity in the workforce has put
greater emphasis on religious considerations in workplaces. However, religious
schools and institutions can use religion as a bona fide occupational qualification for employment practices on a limited scale. Also, employers must make
reasonable accommodation efforts regarding an employee’s religious beliefs
according to the U.S. Supreme Court.
Since the terrorist attacks in New York and Washington, DC, increased
discrimination complaints have been filed by Muslims because of treatment or
insults made by coworkers and managers.38 Religious cases also have addressed
the issues of beards, mustaches, and hair length and style. African American
men, who are more likely than white men to suffer from a skin disease that is
worsened by shaving, have filed suits challenging policies prohibiting beards
or long sideburns. Generally, courts have ruled for employers in such cases,
except where certain religious standards expect men to have facial hair. The
legal requirement to reasonably accommodate religious practices and beliefs
leads to different types of religious expression in the workplace and different
limits to accommodation.39
Managing Religious Diversity
Phased retirement
Approach in which employees
gradually reduce their
workloads and pay levels.
Employers increasingly are having to balance the rights of employees with
differing religious beliefs. One way to do that is to make reasonable accommodation for employees’ religious beliefs when assigning and scheduling
work, because many religions have differing days of worship and holidays.
For example, some firms have established “holiday swapping pools,” whereby
Christian employees can work during Passover or Ramadan or Chinese New
Year, and employees from other religions can work on Christmas. Other firms
allow employees a set number of days off for holidays, without specifying the
holidays in company personnel policies. Figure 3-10 indicates common areas
for accommodating religious diversity.
One potential area for conflict between employer policies and employee
religious practices is dress and appearance. Some religions have standards
about appropriate attire for women. Also, some religions expect men to have
beards and facial hair, which may violate company appearance policies.40
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 96
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
97
Equal Employment Opportunity
FIGURE 3-10
Managing Religion and Spirituality in Workplaces
Managing Religious Diversity in Workplaces
Accommodation of
Religious Beliefs in
Work Schedules
Respect for Religious
Practices Affecting
Dress and Appearance
Accommodation of
Religious Expression
in the Workplace
Another issue concerns religious expression. In the last several years,
employees in several cases have sued employers for prohibiting them from
expressing their religious beliefs at work. In other cases, employers have had to
take action because of the complaints by workers that employees were aggressively “pushing” their religious views at work, thus creating a “hostile environment.” Executives and owners of some firms have strong evangelical Christian
beliefs that are carried over into their companies. Some display crosses, have
Bible study groups for employees before work, sponsor Christian prayer groups,
and support other efforts. But such actions can lead to non-Christians feeling
discriminated against, thus creating a “hostile environment.” Other areas that
may need to be considered when dealing with religion at work are food, onsite religion-based groups, office decorations, and religious practices at work.41
MANAGING OTHER DISCRIMINATION ISSUES
Several different employment circumstances have resulted in a number of other
key areas of potential discrimination. Some of the key issues are immigration,
language, military status, sexual orientation, and appearance and weight.
Immigration Reform and Control Acts (IRCA)
The United States has always had a significant number of immigrants who
come to work in this country. The increasing number of immigrants who have
entered illegally has led to extensive political, social, and employment-related
debates. The existence of more foreign-born workers means that employers
must comply with the provisions of the Immigration Reform and Control Acts
(IRCA). Employers are required to obtain and inspect I-9 forms, and verify
documents such as birth certificates, passports, visas, and work permits. They
can be fined if they knowingly hire illegal aliens. E-verify is a federal government source that can be used for this verification.42 Federal contractors must
use it to verify employees legal status.
Visas and Documentation Requirements Various revisions to the IRCA
changed some of the restrictions on the entry of immigrants to work in U.S.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 97
26/06/10 8:01 PM
98
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
organizations, particularly organizations with high-technology and other
“scarce skill” areas. More immigrants with specific skills have been allowed
legal entry, and categories for entry visas were revised.
Visas are granted by U.S. consular offices (there are more than 200 such
offices throughout the world). Many different types of visas exist. Among
those most commonly encountered by employers are the B1 for business visitors, H-1B for professional or specialized workers, and L-1 for intracompany
transfers.
Usually an employer must sponsor the workers. Companies are not supposed to hire employees to displace U.S. workers, and they must file documents with the Labor Department and pay prevailing U.S. wages to the visa
holders. Despite these regulations, a number of unions and other entities view
such programs as being used to circumvent the limits put on hiring foreign
workers to displace U.S. workers. Given the volatile nature of this area,
changes in federal, state, and local laws are likely to continue to be discussed,
implemented, and reviewed in court decisions.43
Language Issues
As the diversity of the workforce increases, more employees have language
skills beyond English. Interestingly, some employers have attempted to restrict
the use of foreign languages, while other employers have recognized that bilingual employees have valuable skills
A number of employers have policies requiring that employees speak only
English at work. These employers contend that the policies are necessary for
valid business purposes. For instance, a manufacturer requires that employees
working with dangerous chemicals use English to communicate hazardous
situations to other workers and to read chemical labels.
The EEOC has issued guidelines clearly stating that employers may require
workers to speak only English at certain times or in certain situations, but the
business necessity of the requirements must be justified. Teaching, customer
service, and telemarketing are examples of positions that may require English
skills and voice clarity.
Some employers have found it beneficial to have bilingual employees so
that foreign-language customers can contact someone who speaks their language. Some employers do not pay bilingual employees extra, believing that
paying for the jobs being done is more appropriate than paying for language
skills that are used infrequently on those jobs. Other employers pay “language
premiums” if employees must speak to customers in another language. For
instance, one employer pays workers in some locations a bonus if they are
required to use a foreign language a majority of the time with customers.
Bilingual employees are especially needed among police officers, airline flight
personnel, hospital interpreters, international sales reps, and travel guides.
Military Status and USERRA
The employment rights of military veterans and reservists have been addressed
in several laws. The two most important laws are the Vietnam Era Veterans
Readjustment Assistance Act of 1974 and the Uniformed Services Employment
and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA) of 1994. Under the latter, employees are required to notify their employers of military service obligations.
Employers must give employees serving in the military leaves of absence protections under the USERRA, as Figure 3-11 highlights.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 98
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
99
Equal Employment Opportunity
F I G U R E 3 - 11
Uniformed Services Employment and Reemployment Rights
Act (USERRA) Provisions
Common Issues
Leaves of absence
Return to employment rights
Prompt reemployment on return
Protection from discharge/retaliation
Health insurance continuation
Continued seniority rights
LOGGING ON
Uniformed Services Employment
and Reemployment Rights Act
(USERRA)
For information on the U.S. Department of
Labor’s Uniformed Services Employment
and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA),
visit www.dol.gov/vets/programs/userra.
With the use of reserves and National Guard troops
abroad, the provisions of USERRA have had more impact
on employers. This act does not require employers to pay
employees while they are on military leave, but many firms
provide some compensation, often a differential. Many
requirements regarding benefits, disabilities, and reemployment are covered in the act as well.44
Sexual Orientation
Recent battles in a number of states and communities illustrate
the depth of emotions that accompany discussions of “gay rights.”45 Some states
and cities have passed laws prohibiting discrimination based on sexual orientation
or lifestyle. Even the issue of benefits coverage for “domestic partners,” whether
heterosexual or homosexual, has been the subject of state and city legislation. No
federal laws of a similar nature have been passed. Whether gays and lesbians have
any special rights under the equal protection amendment to the U.S. Constitution
has not been decided by the U.S. Supreme Court.
A related issue is dealing with transgender individuals who have had sexchange surgery. Court cases and the EEOC have ruled that sex discrimination under Title VII applies to a person’s gender at birth. Thus, it does not
apply to the new gender of those who have had gender-altering operations.
Transvestites and individuals with sexual behavior disorders are specifically excluded from being considered as disabled under the Americans with
Disabilities Act of 1990. However, some states and several cities have laws
prohibiting bias against transgender persons.46
Appearance and Weight Discrimination
Several EEO cases have been filed concerning the physical appearance of employees. Court decisions consistently have allowed employers to set dress codes as
long as they are applied uniformly. For example, establishing a dress code for
women but not for men has been ruled discriminatory. Also, employers should
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 99
26/06/10 8:01 PM
100
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
Discrimination against
“Caregivers”
The federal government is receiving increasing
complaints that new mothers are being discriminated
against on the job, but it is not just new mothers
who are complaining. Men also are complaining
that if they must care for an aging parent, they are
no longer considered on a “fast track” for promotion.
The complaints have been numerous enough that the
EEOC has issued guidance for employers on the issue
(available at the EEOC website under unlawful disparate
treatment of workers with caregiving responsibilities).
The phenomenon has even received its own label:
FRD, or family responsibility discrimination.
Cases under FRD usually involve an employee
who must care for a disabled spouse, aging parent, or
child. Classic complaints may include retaliation and
not being hired or promoted because of caregiving
responsibilities. The FRD issue arises as the “sandwich
generation,” employees with both children and aging
relatives, is appearing. Caregivers do not all file suits;
HR perspective
some try to hide the fact they are caring for someone in
hope of avoiding discrimination.
Family responsibility discrimination charges come
in many forms, but the allegations are usually that a
person has been disadvantaged in promotion, pay, or
work. The lawsuits are usually filed under Title VII or the
Family Medical Leave Act, but suits have been filed under
the ADA as well. The Supreme Court in 1971 held that
women with school-aged children could not be barred
from applying for jobs held by fathers of school-aged
children. Then the Civil Rights Act of 1991 gave employees
claiming sex discrimination the right to a jury trial and
damages for emotional suffering and punitive damages.
However, the issue of disparate treatment is not
always clear. For example, is a failure to promote a
young mother the result of her work history before her
current job, current job performance, caregiving, or
failure to apply for a specific job opening? This is the
type of debate going on in courtrooms regarding FRD.48
be cautious when enforcing dress standards for women employees who are
members of certain religions that prescribe appropriate and inappropriate dress
and appearance standards. Some individuals have brought cases of employment
discrimination based on height or weight. The crucial factor that employers must
consider is that any weight or height requirements must be related to the job,
such as when excess weight would hamper an individual’s job performance.47
Family Responsibility Discrimination (FRD)
The HR Perspective shows the emergence of a recently identified and labeled
discrimination based on complaints “caregivers” have about the way they are
treated at work. The EEOC has issued guidelines for employers. The phenomenon has been labeled family responsibility discrimination (FRD).
DIVERSITY TRAINING
Traditional diversity training has a number of different goals. One prevalent
goal is to minimize discrimination and harassment lawsuits. Other goals focus
on improving acceptance and understanding of people with different backgrounds, experiences, capabilities, and lifestyles.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 100
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
Equal Employment Opportunity
101
Components of Traditional Diversity Training
Approaches to diversity training vary, but often include at least three components. Legal awareness is the first and most common component. Here,
the training focuses on the legal implications of discrimination. A limited
approach to diversity training stops with these legal “do’s and don’ts.”
By introducing cultural awareness, trainers hope to build
greater understanding of the differences among people.
Cultural awareness training helps all participants to see and
accept the differences in people with widely varying cultural
LOGGING ON
backgrounds.
American Institute for Managing
The third component of diversity training—sensitivity
Diversity
training—is
more difficult. The aim here is to “sensitize”
The nation’s leading nonprofit think tank
people to the differences among them and how their words
dedicated to promoting and furthering
and behaviors are seen by others. Some diversity training
the field of diversity management can
includes exercises containing examples of harassment and
be found at www.aimd.org.
other behaviors.
Mixed Results for Diversity Training
The effects of diversity training are viewed as mixed by both organizations
and participants. A limited number of studies have been done on the effectiveness
of diversity training.49 There is some concern that the programs may be interesting or entertaining, but may not produce longer-term changes in people’s attitudes and behaviors toward others with characteristics different from their own.
Some argue that traditional diversity training more often than not has
failed, pointing out that it does not reduce discrimination and harassment
complaints. Rather than reducing conflict, in a number of situations diversity
training has heightened hostility and conflicts. In some firms, it has produced
divisive effects, and has not taught the behaviors needed for employees to
work well together in a diverse workplace.50
This last point, focusing on behaviors, seems to hold the most promise for
making diversity training more effective. For instance, dealing with cultural
diversity as part of training efforts for sales representatives and managers
has produced positive results. Teaching appropriate behaviors and skills in
relationships with others is more likely to produce satisfactory results than
focusing just on attitudes and beliefs among diverse employees.
Backlash against Diversity Training Efforts
The negative consequences of diversity training may manifest themselves
broadly in a backlash against all diversity efforts. This backlash takes two
main forms. First, and somewhat surprisingly, the individuals in protected
groups, such as women and members of racial minorities, sometimes see the
diversity efforts as inadequate and nothing but “corporate public relations.”
Thus, it appears that by establishing diversity programs, employers are raising
the expectation levels of protected-group individuals, but the programs are not
meeting the expectations.
On the other side, a number of individuals who are not in protected
groups, primarily white males, believe that the emphasis on diversity sets them
up as scapegoats for societal problems. Sometimes white males show hostility
and anger at diversity efforts. Diversity programs are widely perceived as
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 101
26/06/10 8:01 PM
102
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
benefiting only women and racial minorities and taking away opportunities
for men and nonminorities. This resentment and hostility is usually directed at
affirmative action programs that employers have instituted.51
Trainers emphasize that the key to avoiding backlash in diversity
efforts is to stress that people can believe whatever they wish, but at work
their values are less important than their behaviors. Dealing with diversity
is not about what people can and cannot say; it is about being respectful to
others.
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Equal employment is an attempt to level the
field of opportunity for all people at work.
Disparate treatment occurs when members of a
protected category are treated differently from
others.
Disparate impact occurs when employment
decisions work to the disadvantage of members
of protected categories.
Employers may be able to defend their management practices using business necessity, job
relatedness, and bona fide occupational qualifications (BFOQ).
Title VII of the 1964 Civil Rights Act was the
first significant equal employment law. The Civil
Rights Act of 1991 both altered and expanded
on the 1964 provisions.
Affirmative action has been intensely litigated,
and the debate continues today.
Several laws on sex/gender discrimination have
addressed issues regarding pregnancy discrimination, unequal pay for similar jobs, and sexual
harassment.
It is vital that employers train all employees on what constitutes sexual harassment,
promptly investigate complaints, and take
action when sexual harassment is found to have
occurred.
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
As more women have entered the workforce,
sex/gender issues in equal employment have
included both discrimination through pay inequity and discrimination in jobs and careers.
The Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA)
requires that most employers identify the essential
functions of jobs and that they make reasonable
accommodations for individuals with disabilities
unless doing so would result in undue hardship.
Age discrimination against persons older
than age 40 is illegal, according to the Age
Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA).
The Immigration Reform and Control Acts
(IRCA) identify employment regulations affecting workers from other countries.
A number of other concerns have been addressed
by laws, including discrimination based on religion, military status, and other factors.
Individuals with disabilities represent a significant number of current and potential employees.
Employers must make reasonable accommodations for individuals with disabilities,
including those with mental or life-threatening
illnesses.
Diversity training has had limited success, possibly because it too often has focused on beliefs
rather than behaviors.
T H I N K I N G
1. If your employer asked you to review the
decision not to hire an African American
applicant for a job, what would you need to
consider?
2. Explain why you agree or disagree with affirmative action and how affirmative action may
be affected by growing workforce diversity.
A C T I V I T I E S
3. From your own experience or that of someone
you know, give examples of the two types of
sexual harassment.
4. Use this text and the U.S. Department of
Justice website (www.usdoj.gov/crt/ada/) to
identify what is reasonable accommodation
and how it is determined.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 102
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
H R
103
Equal Employment Opportunity
E X P E R I E N T I A L
The leadership in your company has changed as the
result of a merger of your company with another
company. The other company provides services similar to those provided by your company; however,
the workforce demographic varies from that of your
existing employees. For instance, the other company
in the merger has a culture that recognizes and supports domestic partners. You have received a request
to prepare a Diversity Initiative Plan. As HR Manager,
you are aware that your existing employees will have
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
issues and concerns and that you will need to institute some new policies, practices, and procedures. A
resource for information on developing a Diversity
Initiative Plan and diversity training is www.diversitycentral.com.
1. What should the plan include?
2. What diversity training programs should be
offered to assist the employees of both companies in merging the two companies together?
C A S E
Religious Accommodation?
As immigrants continue to come to the United
States from many different cultures and religions,
differences will cause some challenges and problems. One area where this has occurred is with
Islamic culture and religion in the meat processing
industry.
A plant (a fresh chicken facility) belonging to
Tyson Foods, Inc., in Shelbyville, Tennessee, is one
example. The company hired about 250 people
from Somalia. A long-running civil war in their
country has forced many Somalis to settle in the
United States as refugees, and many Somalis are
Muslim.
The union at the plant requested replacing the
paid holiday Labor Day with Eid ul-Fitr, a religious holiday marking the end of the Muslim holy
month of Ramadan. The request was brought up
as part of negotiations for a new labor contract,
and was part of the overall contract proposal
approved by union members. The plant is often
open on Labor Day anyway to meet consumer
demand during the barbeque season. Along with
holiday pay, the workers also received time and a
half for hours worked on Labor Day.
The EEOC says employers may not treat
people more or less favorably because of their religion. However, religious accommodation may be
warranted unless it would impose an undue hardship on the employer. Flexible scheduling, voluntary time swaps, transfers, and reassignments are
possible means of accommodation, along with
other policies and practices.
Tyson’s consideration of exchanging Labor
Day for Eid ul-Fitr brought strong reactions from
non-Muslim workers and the general public. The
union voted again on the issue and overwhelmingly
voted to reinstate Labor Day as a paid holiday.
The company’s solution was to have eight paid
holidays, including a “personal holiday” that could
be either the employee’s birthday, Eid ul-Fitr, or
another day approved by the employee’s supervisor.
That compromise was acceptable to the workers.
Another company that faced similar issues is
JBS-SWIFT, a meat packer with plants in Grand
Island, Nebraska, and Greeley, Colorado. That
company also hired many Somali Muslims. The
issue there was prayer time. In Greeley, the Muslim
workers demanded time to pray at sundown—a
requirement during Ramadan. The plant works
three shifts. More than 300 workers walked out
when they were told they could not have the time
to pray. More than 100 were fired later, not for
walking out but for not returning to work. The
walkout touched off protests from workers of different faiths who thought the request for religious
accommodation was too much.
The EEOC ruled that JBS-SWIFT had violated
the civil rights of the employees it had fired. The
company was found to have denied religious
accommodation and retaliated against workers
who complained. JBS-SWIFT has since set up special prayer rooms at its plants and allows Muslim
workers to meet their religious obligations, which
include prayers five times daily.52
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 103
26/06/10 8:01 PM
104
SECTION 1
Environment of Human Resource Management
QUESTIONS
1. What is the legal basis for the EEOC to hold
that JBS-SWIFT had violated the employees’
civil rights?
2. Contrast the solutions to the Tyson situation
and the JBS-SWIFT situation. Which is likely
to have the greatest positive impact on the
company and why?
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Keep on Trucking
Mitsubishi Believes in EEO—Now
This case illustrates the problems that can be
associated with the use of employment tests that
have not been validated. (For the case, http://www
.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
This case shows the problems Mitsubishi had
with sexual harassment in the United States. (For
the case, http://www.cengage.com/management/
mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Steve Stecklow, “Sexual Harassment
Cases Plague the U.N.,” The Wall
Street Journal, May 21, 2009, A1.
2. Scott E. Page, “Making the
Difference: Applying a Logic of
Diversity,” Academy of Management
Perspectives, November 2009, 6–20.
3. Margaret M. Pinkham, “Employers
Should Take Care When Making
Decisions about Caregivers,”
Employee Relations Law Journal,
Summer 2008, 35–40.
4. Mike Tobin, “S&Z Settles 2003 Bias
Case,” The Cleveland Plain Dealer,
August 26, 2006, C1.
5. Mary Birk, “RIFS: Use Statistical
Analysis to Avoid Disparate Impact
Based on Age,” Legal Report Society
for Human Resources Management,
April 2008, 5–8.
6. Anne Lindberg, “Disparate Impact
or Disparate Treatment: Either Way
Leads to Court,” Trend Watcher,
July 10, 2009, 1–5.
7. Washington, Mayor of Washington,
DC v. Davis, 74 U.S. 1492 (1976).
8. Cynthia Marcotte Stamer, “Supreme
Court Decision May Open Doors to
More Retaliation Claims,” Employee
Benefit News Legal Alert, July 31,
2009, 1–5.
9. “Discrimination Charges on the Rise,”
Benefit News.com Employee Benefit
News, September 15, 2007, 82; Sam
Hananei, “Federal Job Discrimination
Complaints Hit Record,” Yahoo!
News, March 11, 2009, 1–2.
10. Lilia M. Corting, “Unseen Injustice:
Incivility as Modern Discrimination
in Organizations,” Academy of
Management Review, January 2008,
55–75.
11. Robert J. Grossman, “Defusing
Discrimination Claims,” HR
Magazine, May 2009, 47–51.
12. Fay Hansen, “Discriminatory Twist
in Networking Sites Puts Recruiters
in Peril,” Work Force Management,
September 2009, 1–5.
13. Gail Heriot, “Affirmative Action
Backfires,” The Wall Street Journal,
August 24, 2007, A15; Jonathan
Kaufman, “Fair Enough?” The Wall
Street Journal, June 14–15, 2008, A1.
14. C. Tuna, N. Koppel, and M.
Sanserino, “Job-Test Ruling Cheers
Employers,” The Wall Street Journal,
July 1, 2009, B1; Adam Liptak,
“Justices Find Bias Against Whites,”
The Denver Post, June 30, 2009, 1A.
15. EEOC v. Eastern Michigan
University, No. 98-71806 (E.D.
Mich., September 3, 1999).
16. Allen Smith, “Pay Bias Figures
Prominently in New Supreme Court
Forum,” HR News, September 26,
2009, www.shrm.org/hrnews.
17. “New Law Makes Companies More
Vulnerable to Complaints of Pay
Discrimination,” March 2009, www
.towerswatson.com, 1–4.
18. “Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act Signed
into Law 1/29/2009,” www
.compensationresources.com, 1;
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
Jonathan A. Segal, “I Did It,
But . . . ,” HR Magazine, March
2008, 91–95.
J. Hoobler, S. Wayne, and G.
Lemmon, “Bosses’ Perceptions of
Family/Work Conflict and Women’s
Promotability: Glass Ceiling Effects,”
Academy of Management Journal,
October 2009, 939–957.
“Nontraditional Occupations for
Women 2008,” Ceridian Abstracts,
April 2009, www.hrcompliance
.ceridian.com, 1–5.
Eddy S. W. Ng, “Why Organizations
Choose to Manage Diversity:
Toward a Leadership-Based
Theoretical Framework,” Human
Resource Development Review,
March 2008, 58–78; S. Pichler,
P. Simpson, and L. Stroh, “The
Glass Ceiling in Human Resources:
Exploring the Link Between
Women’s Representation in
Management and the Practices
of Strategic HRM and Employee
Involvement,” Human Resource
Management, Fall 2008, 463–479.
L. Grensing-Pophal, “All in the
Family,” HR Magazine, September
2007, 66–70.
“Nearly 40% of Workers Have Had
Workplace Romance,” Newsline,
January 31, 2007, www.spherion.com.
P. Dvorak, B. Davis, and L. Radnofsky,
“Firms Confront Boss-Subordinate
Love Affairs,” The Wall Street Journal,
October 27, 2008, B5.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 104
26/06/10 8:01 PM
CHAPTER 3
105
Equal Employment Opportunity
25. Jennifer Thiel, “Harassment Claim
Advances,” HR Magazine, October
2008, 99.
26. “Model Discrimination and
Harassment Policy,” Ceridian
Abstracts, www.hrcompliance
.ceridian.com, 1–3.
27. Allen Smith, “Study: Women
Supervisors Are More Likely to Be
Harassed,” www.shrm.org, 1.
28. Harsh Luther and Uipan Luther, “A
Theoretical Framework Explaining
Cross-Cultural Sexual Harassment:
Integrating Hofsteds and Schwartz,”
Journal of Labor Research, Winter
2007, 169–188.
29. Stephanie Overman, “EEOC
Opinion: Mandated Health
Assessments Violate ADA,”
Employee Benefit News, July 2009,
1 and 48.
30. Murphy v. United Parcel Service, 527
U.S. 516 (1999).
31. Andrew Slobodien and Katie
O’Brien, “The ADA Amendments
Act of 2008 and How It Will
Change the Workplace,” Employee
Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008,
32–39.
32. Bill Leonard, “The Stealth Statute,”
HR Magazine, December 2008,
47–51; Ann Murrary and Leah
Singleton, “Employers Beware: New
Antidiscrimination Legislation Has
Been Passed,” Employee Relations
Law Journal, Winter 2008, 27–31;
Cynthia Stamer, “Group Health
Plans Will Face Challenges with
GINA,” Employee Benefit News
Legal Alert, May 8, 2009, 1–4.
33. Kelly M. Butler, “10 Million Ways
to Fill the Talent Gap,” Employee
Benefit News, March 2007, 22;
Laurence P. Postol, “ADAAA Will
Result in Renewed Emphasis on
Reasonable Accommodations,”
SHRM Legal Report, January 2009,
1–6.
34. Jennifer Levitz, “More Workers Cite
Age Bias After Layoffs,” The Wall
Street Journal, March 11, 2009, D1.
35. Rosemary Lucas and Shobana
Keegan, “Probing the Basis for
Differential Pay Practices of
Younger Workers in Low Paying
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
Hospitality Firms,” Human Resource
Management Journal, 18, (2008),
386–404.
Heidi Gattau-Fox, “U.S. Supreme
Court’s Age Discrimination Decision
Is Good News for Employers,” Blair
D Holm Labor and Employment
Law Update, August 2009, 2–3;
Cara Woodson Welch, “The Supreme
Court Weighs in on Total Rewards,”
Workspan, July 2008, 20–23.
G. Wood, A. Wilkerson, and
M. Harcourt, “Age Discrimination
and Working Life: Perspectives
and Contestations—A Review of
the Contemporary Literature,”
International Journal of
Management Reviews, Volume 10,
2008, 425–442.
David Migoya, “EEOC: Swift
Acted with Bias,” The Denver Post,
September 1, 2009, 7B.
Eileen Kelly, “Accommodating
Religious Expression in
the Workplace,” Employer
Responsibility and Rights Journal,
20 (2008), 45–56.
Mark Downey, “Keeping the Faith,”
HR Magazine, January 2008, 85–88.
Robert Grossman, “Religion at
Work,” HR Magazine, December
2008, 27–33.
Bruce Finley, “Immigration Checks
Rise,” The Denver Post, June 1,
2009, 1; Anna Gorman, “Businesses
Flock to E-Verify,” Casper StarTribune, May 17, 2009, C2.
“Jobs and Immigrants,” The Wall
Street Journal, April 4, 2007,
A14; Pia Orrenius and Madeline
Zavondny, “Does Immigration
Affect Wages?” Labour Economics,
14, (2007), 757–773; Scott Wright,
“Worksite Enforcement of US
Immigration Law,” Employee
Relations Law Journal, Autumn
2008, 66–102.
Thomas McKinney, “The USERRA
Minefield,” Human Resource
Executive, October 2, 2008, 8.
Diane Cadrain, “Sexual Equity in
the Workplace,” HR Magazine,
September 2008, 44–48; Bill
Leonard, “Workplace Diversity
Library—Sexual Orientation,”
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
SHRM Knowledge Center, April 19,
2007, www.shrm.org.
Nancy Day and Patricia Greene,
“A Case for Sexual Orientation
Diversity Management in Small
and Large Organizations,” Human
Resource Management, Fall 2008,
637–654.
Catherine Arnst, “Bias of the Bulge,”
BusinessWeek, April 28, 2008,
22; Lisa Finkelstein, et al., “Bias
Against Overweight Job Applicants,”
Human Resource Management,
Summer 2007, 203–222; Mark
Roehling, Richard Posthuma, and
James Dulebohn, “Obesity Related
‘Perceived Disability’ Claims,”
Employee Relations Law Journal,
Spring 2007, 30–51.
Stephanie Armour, “More Employers
Face Caregiver Related Suits,”
USA Today, October 25, 2007, 3B;
Stephan Barlas, “Caregivers Unite,”
Human Resource Executive,
June 16, 2008, 53–55;
C. W. VonBerger, W. T. Marver, and
R. Howard, “Family Responsibilities
Discrimination: The EEOC
Guidance,” Employee Relations Law
Journal, Summer 2008, 14–34.
Rohini Anand and Mary-Francis
Winters, “A Retrospective of
Corporate Diversity Training from
1964 to the Present,” Academy
of Management Learning and
Education, September 2008,
356–373.
Susan Awbrey, “The Dynamics of
Vertical and Horizontal Diversity in
Organization and Society,” Human
Resource Development Review, 6
(2007), 7–32.
Carol Kulik, et al., “The Rich Get
Richer: Predicting Participation
in Voluntary Diversity Training,”
Journal of Organizational Behavior,
Volume 28 (2007), 753–769.
Tom Wray, “Learning to Adapt:
Companies Acclimate to a Changing
Workforce,” The National
Provisioner, November 1, 2008,
1–2; David Migoya, “EEOC: SWIFT
Acted with Bias,” The Denver Post,
September 1, 2009, 7B.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 105
26/06/10 8:01 PM
S
E
C
T
I
O
N
2
Jobs and Labor
Chapter 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
Chapter 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
Chapter 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
Chapter 7
Selecting Human Resources
107
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 107
21/07/10 8:50 PM
C H A P T E R
4
Workers, Jobs,
and Job Analysis
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Explain how the diversity of the workforce affects HR
management functions.
•
Identify components of work flow analysis that must be
considered.
•
Define job design and identify common approaches to
varying job design.
•
Describe different types of work teams and HR facets that
must be considered.
•
Discuss how telework and work flexibility are linked to
work-life balancing efforts.
•
Describe job analysis and the stages and methods used in
the process.
•
List the components of job descriptions.
108
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 108
26/06/10 4:00 PM
HR Headline
Work-Life Balancing
J
(© Getty Images/Jupiter Image)
obs must be balanced with work-life
issues. Workforce demographics of
employees by racial/ethnic background,
age, and gender, indicate that organizations
must adjust to the fact that employees want to
increase flexibility in their work schedules to
accommodate the life outside the job.
A comprehensive study of more than 500
organizations and their employees by the
Institute for Corporate Productivity identified
two reasons employees want flexible work:
(1) much of their work does not require being
in the office all of the time, or (2) they have
long commutes. Using occupational groups,
the study identified that approximately threefourths of professional employees and half
of administrative employees wanted flexible
schedules. Women were another group that
wanted more flexibility.
A change that has affected work is the
growth in telecommuting. Through greater
use of technology, more employees are working outside of the workplace. For instance,
managers and other employees may work
from home, an elder parent’s apartment, a
client’s facility, an airport conference room,
a work suite in a hotel resort, or even a vacation location. Thus, balancing workers and
jobs with technology and flexibility in work
schedules and location is likely to increase
in importance, affecting both organizational
and individual performance.1
109
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 109
26/06/10 4:03 PM
110
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Throughout organizations of all types, the composition of workers and jobs
is shifting in nature. As the HR Headline shows, these shifts are likely to continue growing in the next years, requiring changes in the way some HR functions are done. Relevant changes in the workforce follow.
WORKFORCE COMPOSITION
The existing U.S. workforce is changing, and projections indicate that more
shifting will occur in the next few years.2 To analyze the composition of workers
and jobs in the United States, the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS) undertakes studies to identify current and future projected compositions. Because of
economic shifts and their effects in different industries, some types of workers
are scarce but in high demand, while others are available in excessive numbers.
According to studies by the BLS and various industry groups, health care
and health-related jobs are increasing, in part because of the aging U.S. population. The rapid growth in technology is creating a need for more workers
with special technical capabilities. However, many manufacturing industries,
such as automobile and airline firms, have had significant decline in numbers
of jobs and workers. These and other factors make it likely that the workforce
composition will continue to change.
Another worker-related shift results from the U.S. workforce becoming
more diverse. As organizations develop or increase global operations, diversity
in the workforce is becoming more prominent. Diversity reflects the differences in human characteristics and composition in an organization. The tangible indicators of diversity that employers must consider include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Race/ethnicity
National origin/immigration
Age/generational differences
Gender—men and women
Marital and family status
Sexual orientation
Disabilities
Religion
In addition, individuals can be multicultural and be included in several groups.
Business Contribution of Diverse Workers
Diversity Differences
in human characteristics
and composition in an
organization.
Different organizations approach the management of diversity from several
perspectives.3 As Figure 4-1 shows, the continuum can run from resistance to
creation of an inclusive diversity culture.
For diversity to succeed, the most crucial component is seeing it as a
commitment throughout the organization, beginning with top management.4
Diversity results must be measured, and management accountability for
achieving results must be emphasized and rewarded. For instance, PepsiCo, a
large food and beverage company, has developed and implemented a Diversity
and Inclusion Council so that diversity considerations are part of all strategic
efforts. PepsiCo also has regular diversity celebrations, newsletters, and other
events. This inclusion of diversity issues throughout the company contributes
to PepsiCo’s success with employees, managers, and customers.5
One survey found that more than 60% of firms were committed to diversity
and almost 50% of senior managers recognized the business case for diversity.6
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 110
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
111
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
Various Approaches to Diversity and Their Results
FIGURE 4-1
Approach
Ignore Diversity
Status quo is
protected
Possible legal
issues are
increased
Diversity is not
important
Results
Begin the
Process of
Dealing with
Diversity
Diversity
training is
provided
Affirmative
action
compliance
occurs
Protected
classes are a
focus
Conflicts and
problems
occur
Build
Acceptance
of Diversity
Diversity pays
off for
company
Conflicts are
reduced
Internal
problem
solving takes
place
Solve Diversity
Issues and
Create an
Inclusive Culture
Diversity
permeates the
company
Problems are
approached
proactively
Everyone gets
along
Business results
improve
However, the “business case” for diversity must be linked to key business
goals and strategies and organizational results.7 The business case for diversity
includes the following:
•
•
•
•
Diversity allows new talent and ideas from employees of different
backgrounds, which can enhance organizational performance.
Diversity helps recruiting and retention because protected-class
individuals often prefer to work in organizations with coworkers of
various demographics.
Diversity allows for an increase of market share because customers can
be attracted to purchase products and services with varied demographic
marketing activities.
Diversity can lead to lower costs because there may be fewer
discrimination lawsuits.
The results of increased diversity for organizations, work groups, individuals, and society/community must be considered. An example of an organization that has utilized diversity is NASA/Goddard Space Flight Center. Diversity
at Goddard is a core value and part of its business objectives.8 Goddard has
engaged in recruiting diverse individuals and integrating them through training and other HR actions, which include establishing communications and
bulletin board systems that enhance diversity efforts.
One concern with diversity programs is that they may be perceived as benefiting only certain groups of persons and not others. Diversity actions must
be well thought out and address both the positive and negative aspects of such
programs, given the workforce composition of many organizations.9
Race and Ethnicity
Significant race and ethnic shifts in the U.S. population will occur in the next
several decades. By the year 2050, racial/ethnic groups currently in the minority
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 111
26/06/10 4:04 PM
112
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Resolving Language
Barriers Pays Off
A firm that has been recognized by a national
competitive workforce award is Nebraska Furniture
Mart (NFM). Selling furniture, appliances, and many
home items, NFM needs numerous individuals to work
a wide range of hours every week. Owned primarily by
the well-known investor Warren Buffet, NFM has been
operating in Nebraska, Iowa, and Kansas.
When NFM expanded from Omaha to Kansas City, it
encountered a major turnover of Hispanic employees in its
Kansas City operation. As turnover increased, reductions
in work quality and productivity resulted. Management
recognized that the concerns of both Hispanic customers
and employees needed to be better addressed.
Executives, managers, and HR professionals at
NFM recognized that they needed to do a better job
HR best practices
of attracting, retaining, and training Hispanic workers.
They created a three-part effort called “Bienvenido a
la Familia de NFM” (Welcome to Our NFM Family).
They also expanded recruiting efforts, using Hispanic
newspapers. In addition, NFM hired a bilingual
interpreter as part of HR, and then offered employees
free basic English classes.
The results of these efforts over several years have
been very positive, resulting in more recruiting and
less turnover of Hispanic workers. Work-related quality
and productivity also have increased, particularly in
the warehouse where many Hispanic people work.
Responding to racial/ethnic diversity in terms of a
specific group enhanced HR and organizational
performance in NFM.10
will likely make up more than 50% of the U.S. population. The Census Bureau
says whites represent 67% of the population currently, but will be at approximately 48% in 2050. The Hispanic population will increase dramatically, to
about 39% of the overall population, and will exceed the African American
population. The Asian population will triple to about 9% by 2050.11
These statistics indicate that accommodating racial/ethnic differences
are a part of everyday life, and such efforts do bring results. For example, a
Michigan manufacturing firm dealt with racial tensions between whites and
workers of other ethnic/racial backgrounds. Initially, few nonwhites attended
company social events, and if they did, they sat apart from the white population. However, after five years of diversity training and other HR efforts,
people of all races and ethnic groups were interacting more frequently and
working together more effectively. This example illustrates why efforts to integrate people of different types must be made.12 Integrated work groups, social
events, electronic communications, and other approaches can be used to help
with conflict. The HR Best Practices illustrates how Nebraska Furniture Mart
has successfully worked with its Hispanic/Latino employees.
Immigrant Workers Another racial/ethnic factor is the growth in the number of immigrants to the United States and other developed countries. The
United States has always had a significant number of immigrants who have
come to work in this country. The increasing number of immigrants entering
illegally has led to extensive political, social, and employment-related issues. In
the United States, one concern is the large number of illegal immigrants hired
to fill certain jobs at low cost, despite availability of unemployed U.S. workers.
With the growth in racial/ethnic immigrants projected to increase and with the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 112
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
113
likelihood of more changes in immigration laws, HR professionals will have
to monitor and manage the immigrant issue as it applies to both company and
industry.
Generational Differences
Much has been written about the expectations of individuals in different age
groups and generations. For employers, these varied expectations present challenges, especially given economic, global, technology, and other changes in the
workplace. Some common age/generational groups are labeled as follows:
•
•
•
•
Matures (born before 1946)
Baby boomers (born 1946–1964)
Generation Xers (born 1965–1980)
Generation Yers (millenials) (born 1981–2000)
As the economy and industries have changed, the aging of the U.S. workforce has become a significant concern. Workers over age 55 are delaying
retirement more often, working more years, and/or looking for part-time work
or phased retirement. Economic conditions are the predominant reasons why
these workers are bypassing the “normal” retirement age of 65.13 As older and
more experienced employees retire in the future, employers will face increasing
gaps as they try to replace the experience and capabilities of baby boomers.
Generational differences in expectations are likely to add to challenges and
conflicts in organizations. For instance, many baby boomers and matures are
concerned about security and experience, while younger people have different
concerns. Generation Yers are often seen as the “why” generation; they expect
to be rewarded quickly, use more technology, and often ask more questions
about why managers and organizations make the decisions they do. Consider
the dynamics of a mature manager directing generation X and Y individuals,
or generation X managers supervising older, more experienced baby boomers as well as generation Y employees. However, it is crucial to be aware that
stereotyping these individuals by generations may not reflect how actual individuals view their jobs and produce organizational results.14
Managing Multigenerational Workforce What the discussion of generations suggests is that managers must be aware of the possible opportunities as
well as the challenges with a multigenerational workforce in an organization.
Firms are engaging in activities to enhance multigenerational and managerial
effectiveness as described in Figure 4-2. For example, Border’s Group bookstores and a Virginia hospital have had good experiences, because of expanded
training, with different generations of individuals working together.15
The generation gaps may be less severe than many articles suggest. How
much such gaps are reduced relates to supervisor/subordinate/coworker relationships and how employees of all types are engaged in the organization
through training work teams and by other means.16
Gender Workforce Diversity
Women are becoming a greater percentage of workers in the U.S. workforce;
they comprise more than 46% of the total employed individuals. However,
men average more work time daily than do women.17 Interestingly, as the economic and labor market has been shifting, the job fields dominated by men
have been hit harder than those consisting mostly of women. Male workers
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 113
26/06/10 4:04 PM
114
SECTION 2
FIGURE 4-2
Jobs and Labor
Positive Multigenerational Management Activities
Positive Multigenerational Management Activities
Integrating generational individuals
Recognizing employees’ different
expectations
Developing varied mentoring means
Adapting training methods to reflect
generational capabilities
Utilizing younger persons’ technology
skills to aid baby boomers
Supporting individual career
expectations that vary by groups
Openly addressing generational issues
Establishing multigenerational work
groups and projects
are more heavily represented in manufacturing, farming, and other “maledominated” industries, so male employees have been impacted more severely
by the market shifts than women employees with their higher rates of participation in industries such as health care and education.
From this follows some of the gender issues that occur in organizations.
First, women overall have lower average pay than men due to the nature of
their jobs and work hours. Second, in some industries and countries, women
make up a much smaller percentage of senior executives and managers in
many organizations and occupations. Over the past decade more women have
become managers, but women comprise only about 10% or less of senior
level executive and board members.18 Some of the wage gap between men and
women is due to the greater family/home responsibilities that females have to
meet. One survey found that more than 40% of working mothers would take
pay cuts to have more time with their children.19
Both women and men also are increasingly facing the need to aid older
family members, as matures and baby boomers encounter health disabilities
and other problems. Addressing work and family issues is part of work-life
balancing, which is examined later in this chapter in the discussion of workforce flexibility in jobs.
NATURE OF JOBS AND WORK
One way to visualize an organization is as an entity that takes inputs from the
surrounding environment and then, through some kind of “work,” turns those
inputs into goods or services. Work is effort directed toward accomplishing
results.
Work Effort directed toward
accomplishing results.
Work flow analysis Study
of the way work (inputs,
activities, and outputs) moves
through an organization.
Work Flow Analysis
Work flow analysis is the study of the way work moves through an organization. Usually, it begins with an examination of the quantity and quality of
the desired and actual outputs (goods and services). Then the activities (tasks
and jobs) that lead to the outputs are evaluated to see if they are achieving
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 114
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
115
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
the desired outputs. Finally, the inputs (people, material, information, data,
equipment, etc.) must be assessed to determine if they make the outputs and
activities better and more efficient.
An integrating work flow analysis is likely to lead to better employee
involvement, greater efficiency, and more customer satisfaction as organizational work is divided into jobs so that it can be coordinated. A job is a
grouping of the tasks, duties, and responsibilities that constitutes the work
assignment for an employee. Tasks, duties, and responsibilities may change
over time; therefore, jobs may change and may increase or decrease in number.
If internal changes do not happen, an organization is probably failing
to adapt to the shifting business and competitive environment and may be
becoming outmoded or noncompetitive. As an example, at Southwest Airlines,
organizational values and strategies are tied to having involved employees
working in a flexible enjoyable culture that delivers dependable service at low
fares. Southwest employees have a high degree of flexibility in how they perform their work as workload demands shift. Other airlines, such as American
and United, have higher fares, fewer service amenities, and employees with
more narrowly defined jobs. The way work is done and how jobs are designed
and performed vary significantly under these two approaches, and the differences impact the number of jobs and people needed.
Technology and Work Flow Analysis A factor that must be considered
in work flow analysis in organizations is technology. The information-based
systems used by many employees make work flow different from what it
was in previous years. Sometimes the differences are positive and highly
productive, but technology also can reduce work flow and productivity. For
example, consider the amount of time some employees spend on personal use
of technology such as text-messaging, twitters, and personal websites such
as Facebook. Such usage can distract workers and may reduce work-related
productivity.
Job Grouping of tasks, duties,
and responsibilities that
constitutes the total work
assignment for an employee.
Business process
reengineering (BPR)
Measures for improving
such activities as product
development, customer
service, and service delivery.
Business Process Reengineering After work flow analysis provides an
understanding of how work is being done, reengineering generates the needed
changes in the operations. The purpose of business process reengineering (BPR)
is to improve such activities as product development, customer service, and
service delivery. BPR consists of three phases:
1. Rethink: Examine how the current organization of work and jobs affects
customer satisfaction and service.
2. Redesign: Analyze how jobs are put together, the work flow, and how
results are achieved; then redesign the process as necessary.
3. Retool: Look at new technologies (equipment, computers, software, etc.)
as opportunities to improve productivity, service quality, and customer
satisfaction.
LOGGING ON
Prosci Learning Center
An online resource for material on the
topic of business process reengineering
can be found at www.prosci.com.
Because of the desire to improve HR efficiency and
effectiveness, BPR is increasingly being applied to HR
management. Although implementation of reengineering
can be difficult, if done well it can aid work success. For
instance, firms such as AT&T and a mid-sized Italian bank
have done reengineering that has been successful for both
the organization and the workforce.20
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 115
26/06/10 4:04 PM
116
Jobs and Labor
SECTION 2
JOB DESIGN
Job design refers to organizing tasks, duties, responsibilities, and other elements into a productive unit of work. Identifying the components of a given
job is an integral part of job design. Job design receives attention for three
major reasons:
•
•
•
Job design Organizing
tasks, duties, responsibilities,
and other elements into a
productive unit of work.
Job design can influence performance in certain jobs,
especially those where employee motivation can make a substantial
difference.
Job design can affect job satisfaction. Because people are more satisfied
with certain job elements than others, identifying what makes a “good”
job becomes critical. Reduced turnover and absenteeism also can be
linked to effective job design.
Job design can impact both physical and mental health. Problems that
may require assistance such as hearing loss, backache, leg pain, stress,
high blood pressure, and even heart disease sometimes can be traced
directly to job design.
Managers play a significant role in job design because often they are the
people who establish jobs and their design components. They must make sure
that job expectations are clear, that decision-making responsibilities and the
accountability of workers are clarified, and that interactions with other jobs
are integrated and appropriate.21
The nature and characteristics of both jobs and people should be considered when job design is done. As Figure 4-3 indicates, managers can influence
or control job characteristics, but not people characteristics.
FIGURE 4-3
Some Characteristics of People and Jobs
Job Characteristics
(Management can control)
Tasks
Authority/
responsibility
Policies/
procedures
Tools
Variety
Time
requirements
Social
opportunities
Working
conditions
Stress
People Characteristics
(Management cannot control)
Motivation
Interests
Energy
level
Personality
variables
Physical
characteristics
Honesty
Conscientiousness
Intelligence
Satisfaction
predisposition
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 116
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
117
Workers and Job Design
Organizations are employing a variety of workers, and not just full-time ones.
Depending on economic and competitive factors, the types of workers in one
firm may include:
•
•
•
•
•
Full-time employees
Part-time employees
Independent contractors
Temporary workers
Contingent workers
Although some organizations still use the traditional approach of employing
full- and part-time workers, many firms are making significant use of independent, temporary, and contingent individuals. These persons are not employees
but generally work at-will or on limited contracts, and they may be working
for other employers as well. A contingent worker is someone who is not an
employee, but a temporary or part-time worker for a specific period of time
and type of work.
According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, contingent workers are a
part of “alternative workers” who may be on-call, working through an employment agency, or operating as independent contractors.22 A number of contingent workers have contracts with employers that establish their pay, hours, job
requirements, limitations, and time periods. As mentioned in Chapter 1, more
employers are using contingent or temporary workers. Estimates are that up to
50% of some types of jobs are performed by contingent workers who are not
regular employees. Nike, Kelly Services, and Earthlink are examples of firms
that are using more contingent workers.23
Person-Job Fit Not everyone would enjoy being an HR manager, an engineer, a nurse, or a drill-press operator. But some people like and do well at each
of these jobs. The person-job fit is a simple but important concept of matching
characteristics of people with characteristics of jobs. If a person does not fit a
job, theoretically either the person can be changed or replaced or the job can
be altered. However, though an employer can try to make a “round” person fit
a “square” job, it is hard to successfully reshape people. By redesigning jobs,
the person-job fit may sometimes be improved more easily. For example, bank
tellers talk to people all day; an individual who would rather not talk to others all day may do better in a job that does not require so much interaction
because that part of the bank teller job probably cannot be changed. Different
people will consider some jobs “good” and others “bad.” As a result, people
will fit different kinds of work.
Contingent worker
Someone who is not an
employee, but a temporary or
part-time worker for a specific
period of time and type of
work.
Person-job fit Matching
characteristics of people with
characteristics of jobs.
Job-Person Match Matching people with jobs they like and fit can have
positive consequences. Higher or lower turnover rates in the first few months
of employment are often linked to recruiting and selection screening efforts.
Then, once individuals have been placed in jobs, other job/work factors
affect retention. Because individuals spend significant time on their jobs, they
expect to have modern equipment, technology, and good working conditions.
Physical and environmental factors such as space, lighting, temperature, noise,
and layout can affect retention of employees as well as their work.
Additionally, workers want a safe work environment, in which risks of accidents and injuries have been addressed. That is especially true for employees
in such industries as manufacturing, agriculture, utilities, and transportation,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 117
26/06/10 4:04 PM
118
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
which have higher safety risks than do many service industries and office environments.
Common Approaches to Job Design
One approach for designing or redesigning jobs is to simplify the job tasks
and responsibilities. Job simplification may be appropriate for jobs that are to
be staffed with entry-level employees. However, making jobs too simple may
result in boring jobs that appeal to few people, causing high turnover. Several
other approaches also have been used as part of job design.
Job Enlargement and Job Enrichment Attempts to alleviate some of the
problems encountered in excessive job simplification fall under the general
headings of job enlargement and job enrichment. Job enlargement involves
broadening the scope of a job by expanding the number of different tasks
to be performed. Job enrichment is increasing the depth of a job by adding
responsibility for planning, organizing, controlling, or evaluating the job.
Some examples of job enrichment are:
•
•
•
•
•
Job enlargement
Broadening the scope of a
job by expanding the number
of different tasks to be
performed.
Job enrichment Increasing
the depth of a job by adding
responsibility for planning,
organizing, controlling, or
evaluating the job.
Job rotation Process of
shifting a person from job
to job.
Job sharing Scheduling
arrangement in which two
employees perform the work
of one full-time job.
Giving the employee an entire job rather than just a piece of the work
Allowing the employee more flexibility to perform the job as needed
Increasing the employee’s accountability for work by reducing external
control
Expanding assignments for employees to do new tasks and develop
special areas of expertise
Directing feedback reports to the employee rather than only to management
Job Rotation One technique that can break the monotony of an otherwise
simple routine job is job rotation, which is the process of shifting a person
from job to job. There are several advantages to job rotation with one being
that it develops an employee’s capabilities for doing several different jobs. For
instance, some firms have been successful at using job rotation for employees
with disabilities in special assembly lines and different work requirement
times.24 Even people without disabilities can be adaptable and change jobs and
careers internally in appropriate ways. Clear policies that identify for employees the nature and expectations of job rotations are more likely to make job
rotation work.25
Job Sharing Another alternative used is job sharing, in which two employees
perform the work of one full-time job. For instance, a hospital allows two
radiological technicians to fill one job, and each individual works every other
week. Such arrangements are beneficial for employees who may not want or
be able to work full-time because of family, school, or other reasons. The keys
to successful job sharing are that both “job sharers” must work effectively
together and each must be competent in meeting the job requirements.
Characteristics of Jobs
A model developed by Hackman and Oldham focuses on five important design
characteristics of jobs. Figure 4-4 shows that skill variety, task identity, and
task significance affect the meaningfulness of work; autonomy stimulates
responsibility; and feedback provides knowledge of results. Each aspect can
make a job better for the jobholder to the degree that it is present.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 118
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
119
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
Job Characteristics Model
FIGURE 4-4
Job Characteristics
(enriched jobs)
•
Skill variety Extent to
which the work requires
several different activities for
successful completion.
Task identity Extent to
which the job includes a
“whole” identifiable unit of
work that is carried out from
start to finish and that results
in a visible outcome.
Task significance Impact
the job has on other people.
Autonomy Extent of
individual freedom and
discretion in the work and its
scheduling.
Feedback The amount of
information employees receive
about how well or how poorly
they have performed.
•
•
•
•
Psychological States
Skill variety
Task identity
Task significance
Experienced
meaningfulness
Autonomy
Experienced
responsibility
Feedback
Knowledge
of results
Desired Outcomes
Motivation
Performance
Satisfaction
Skill variety is the extent to which the work requires several different
activities for successful completion. For example, lower skill variety exists
when an assembly-line worker performs the same two tasks repetitively.
Skill variety is not to be confused with multitasking, which is doing several
tasks at the same time with computers, telephones, personal organizers,
and other means. The impact of multitasking for an employee may be
never getting away from the job—not a “better” outcome for everyone.
Task identity is the extent to which the job includes a “whole” identifiable
unit of work that is carried out from start to finish and that results in a
visible outcome. For example, when a customer calls with a problem, a
customer specialist can handle the stages from maintenance to repair in
order to resolve the customer’s problem.
Task significance is the impact the job has on other people. A job is
more meaningful if it is important to other people for some reason. For
instance, police officers may experience more fulfillment when dealing
with a real threat than when merely training to be ready in case a threat
arises.
Autonomy is the extent of individual freedom and discretion in the work
and its scheduling. More autonomy leads to a greater feeling of personal
responsibility for the work.
Feedback is the amount of information employees receive about how well
or how poorly they have performed. The advantage of feedback is that it
helps employees to understand the effectiveness of their performance and
contributes to their overall knowledge about the work.
Using Worker Teams in Jobs
Typically, a job is thought of as something done by one person. However,
where appropriate, jobs may be designed for teams to take advantage of
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 119
26/06/10 4:04 PM
120
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
the increased productivity and commitment that can follow such a change.
Organizations can assign jobs to teams of employees instead of just individuals. Some firms have gone as far as dropping such terms as workers and
employees, replacing them with teammates, crew members, associates, and
other titles that emphasize teamwork.
As organizations have changed, the types of teams have changed as well.
Having global operations with diverse individuals and using technology
advances have affected the nature of teams contributing to organizational
projects. For example, one survey found that about one-third of the different
types of teams possible were used in major HR projects.26
Special Types of Teams There are several types of teams that function outside the scope of members’ normal jobs and meet from time to time. One is the
special-purpose team, which is formed to address specific problems, improve
work processes, and enhance the overall quality of products and services. Often,
special-purpose teams are a mixture of employees, supervisors, and managers.
The self-directed team is composed of individuals who are assigned a
cluster of tasks, duties, and responsibilities to be accomplished. Unlike specialpurpose teams, self-directed work teams become entities that use regular
internal decision-making processes. Use of self-directed work teams must be
planned well and fit the culture of the organization.
The virtual team is composed of individuals who are separated
geographically but linked by communications technology. The success of
virtual work teams depends on a number of factors, including training of
team members, planning and managing virtual tasks and projects, and using
technology for expansion of teamwork. However, some research has identified that virtual teams can lead to unresolved problems, less productivity, and
miscommunications.27
G L O B A L
Special-purpose team
Organizational team formed
to address specific problems,
improve work processes, and
enhance the overall quality of
products and services.
Self-directed team
Organizational team composed
of individuals who are
assigned a cluster of tasks,
duties, and responsibilities to
be accomplished.
Virtual team Organizational
team composed of individuals
who are separated
geographically but linked by
communications technology.
Global Teams Global operations have resulted in an increasing use of virtual
teams. Members of these teams seldom or never meet in person. Instead, they
“meet” electronically using Web-based systems. With global teams, it is important
for managers and HR to address various issues, including who is to be chosen for
the teams, how they are to communicate and collaborate online and sometimes
in person, and what tasks and work efforts may be done with these teams.28
Teams and Work Efforts As the use of teams has grown, creating ones
that contribute to organizational performance is important. Factors that
affect the work team success and performance increasingly have become part
of HR.29 Figure 4-5 highlights some common team elements related to team
performance.
The use of work teams has been a popular form of job redesign in the
last decade. Improved productivity, increased employee involvement, greater
coworker trust, more widespread employee learning, and greater employee use
of knowledge diversity are among the potential benefits.30 In a transition to
work teams, efforts are necessary to define the areas of work, scope of authority, and goals of the teams. Also, teams must recognize and address dissent,
conflict, and other problems.31
The role of supervisors and managers changes with use of teams because
of the emergence or development of team leaders. Rather than giving orders,
often the team leader becomes a facilitator to assist the team, to mediate and
resolve conflicts among team members, and to interact with other teams and
managers elsewhere.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 120
26/06/10 4:04 PM
CHAPTER 4
121
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
FIGURE 4-5
Encouraging Team Performance Success
Choose a Variety of Employees
Different levels
Various jobs
Geographic locations
ⴙ
Encourage Creative Collaboration
New approaches
Changes in processing
Interactive means
Leads to
Team Performance
Accomplishing expectations
Meeting timelines
Measuring performance results
LOGGING ON
Team Building, Inc.
This website provides information
for team building services and team
building training products. Visit the site
at www.teambuildinginc.com.
Teams can be enhanced through task responsibility, discussion structures, and cooperation efforts. Age and educational diversity can expand task-relevant information and
team performance bases.32 However, some organizations
have noted a lack of willingness of team members to share
information with those who are different from themselves.
To counteract such problems, diversity training for teams and
their members could be part of the design when establishing
and managing teams.33
JOBS AND WORK SCHEDULING
Considerations that can affect job design for both employers and employees
are how the work is to be done, the time during which work is scheduled, and
the location of employees when working. One factor changing how and when
work is done is technology, including the creation of telework for some people.
Telework
Telework Employees work
with technology via electronic,
telecommunications, and
Internet means.
Individuals who may be working at home or at other places illustrate telework,
which means that employees work via electronic, telecommunications, and
Internet means. The use of technology for telework is expected to grow,
with almost 70% of private-sector respondents predicting more usage of IT
resources in telework.34 Some employers are allowing employees to telecommute one or more days a week. Telecommuting allows employees to work
from home when bad weather or widespread health issues (e.g., pandemic
flu) prevents them from coming to office facilities.35 Common advantages of
telework for employers are highlighted in Figure 4-6.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 121
26/06/10 4:05 PM
122
SECTION 2
FIGURE 4-6
Jobs and Labor
Telework Advantages for Employers
Business Impacts
Improves business/employee
productivity
Reduces organizational costs
Saves on paid travel and
commuting time
Reduces environmental and energy
costs and effects
Provides work services at varied hours
Employee Impacts
Aids individual retention and reduces
turnover
Expands employee recruitment
“area” and attractiveness
May enhance employee job
satisfaction and morale
Enhances employees’ personal lives
and health
Teleworking Considerations As more employers use telework, there are
both advantages and concerns to consider. Several firms have found that
telework can cut costs and raise productivity. For example, Home Shopping
Network has 900 telecommuters in three states and has increased productivity and employee applicant desirability. This is why, according to one survey,
almost 40% of organizations offer some telecommuting.36
However, the working relationship with teleworkers should begin with a
carefully worded policy. This is necessary because the fact that managers have
less direct supervision of teleworkers raises a number of issues and employee
concerns. Such a policy must consider work time use, evaluation of performance, handling of expenses, and other factors.
Additional issues affect employees and their relationships with coworkers and managers. One is overwork when having to balance home and work
requirements. Maintaining employee motivation when individuals are not physically present at company facilities also
LOGGING ON
can be challenging and may increase employee stress. This
The Telework Coalition
is a special concern for global employees. Also, the 15-hour
This coalition is a nonprofit organization
time zone difference between the United States and some
committed to advancing the growth and
Asian countries may make it difficult for global employees
success of telecommuting. Visit their
to participate in conference calls or do extensive travel for
site at www.telcoa.org.
meetings.
Work Schedule Alternatives
Different types of work schedules have been developed for employees in different occupations and areas. The traditional U.S. work schedule of 8 hours a
day, 5 days a week, is in transition. Workers in various occupations may work
less or more than 8 hours at a workplace, and may have additional work at
home.
The work schedules associated with jobs vary. Some jobs must be performed during “normal” daily work hours and on weekdays, while others
require employees to work nights, weekends, and extended hours. Hours
worked vary globally as well. As the HR Perspective indicates, there are significant differences in the hours worked in different countries. Given the global
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 122
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
HR perspective
Global Work Schedule
Differences
The number of work hours in a week and a year varies
from country to country. Some of the differences in
annual work hours are illustrated in the following chart.
Annual Hours Worked by Employed Person by Country
• Korea
• Mexico
• Italy
• The
United
States
• Japan
123
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
2,305 hours
1,871 hours
1,824 hours
1,794 hours
• Canada
• Australia
• France
• Germany
1,736 hours
1,722 hours
1,561 hours
1,433 hours
1,785 hours
• The
Netherlands
1,392 hours
These numbers are interesting when other countries are
compared with the United States. What is thought of as
the “normal” U.S. work schedule is 40 hours per week,
up to 50 weeks per year, excluding vacation time,
making about 2,000 hours annually. However, the
numbers of 1,794 hours in the United States and those
in other countries may be affected by extended time-off
polices set by laws and/or policies of employers.37
The European Union (EU) has issued the Working
Time Directive, which states that employees in EU
countries should work a maximum of 48 hours a week.
However, EU workers can opt out of the maximum. For
instance, France has had a law limiting working hours
to 35 hours a week, but because exceptions have been
made, the weekly average in different firms sometimes
is lower or higher than 35. Notice that workers in other
countries average different numbers of work hours.
Given the global organizations in many industries,
the differences in work hours must be considered
across countries. Doing so means that work scheduling
expectations and policies may have to be different for
an operation in different countries.
nature of many organizations, HR must adjust to different locations because
of the international variations. Organizations are using many different work
scheduling arrangements, based on industry demands, workforce needs, and
other organizational factors.38 These different types include shift work and the
compressed workweek.
Shift Work A common work schedule design is shift work. Many organizations need 24-hour coverage and therefore may schedule three 8-hour shifts
per day. Most of these employers provide some form of additional pay, called
a shift differential, for working the evening or night shifts. Some types of shift
work have been known to cause difficulties for some employees personally,
such as weariness, irritability, lack of motivation, and illness.39 Nevertheless,
some employers must have 24-hour, 7-day coverage, so shift work is likely to
continue to be an option.
Compressed workweek
A workweek in which a full
week’s work is accomplished
in fewer than five 8-hour days.
Compressed Workweek One type of work schedule design is the
compressed workweek, in which a full week’s work is accomplished in
fewer than five 8-hour days. Compression usually results in more work hours
each day and fewer workdays each week, such as four 10-hour days, a 3-day
week, or 12-hour shifts. One survey in chemical industry plants found that
96% of the workers who shifted to 12-hour schedules did not wish to return
to 8-hour schedules.40 However, 12-hour schedules have led to sleep difficulties, fatigue, and an increased number of injuries.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 123
26/06/10 4:05 PM
124
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Work Flexibility and Scheduling
Flexible work schedules allow organizations to make better use of workers by
matching work demands to work hours. One type of scheduling is flextime, in
which employees work a set number of hours a day but vary the starting and
ending times. In some industries, flextime allows more employees to be available at peak times when more customers and clients are present. The flexibility
has aided in recruiting and retaining key staff members.41
Employees Working at Home As part of organizational job restructurings,
economic conditions, and work-life considerations, a number of individuals
work at their home locations. Estimates are that more than 15 million employees work from home either full-time or part-time. While some may be selfemployed, others are full-time or part-time employees of firms. For instance, a
senior HR professional for Hewlett-Packard leads a team of 40 professionals
in compensation and benefits who support full-time employees in more than
50 countries. His approach requires regular teleworking and personal communications, as well as planning and communicating with executives and others
primarily from home.42
Employer Policies on Flexible Work Schedules Flexible scheduling
allows organizational and HR managers to choose when, where, and how
workers will perform their jobs, while still covering workloads.43 With work
flexibility and home work, electronic monitoring of activities and performance
may be necessary. For instance, at a call-service firm, home-based employees
are monitored on their use of phones through electronic links and get unpaid
time off for taking personal breaks. Restrictions such as these are designed to
keep workers meeting employers’ requirements.44 Employers still must comply
with federal and state compensation laws when using flexible schedules.
Flextime Scheduling
arrangement in which
employees work a set number
of hours a day but vary starting
and ending times.
Work-Life Balancing For many employees throughout the world, balancing
their work and personal lives is a significant concern. According to several surveys of workers and executives, work-life balance is one of the top ten concerns
in most countries.45 Another survey found that work-life balance is the second
most important item for executives, with only compensation being more important. A lack of sufficient work-life balance was cited by more than 40% of surveyed employees, and almost half said they might quit their current employers
in an effort to get better work-life balance.46 Single parents, especially women,
may face more work-life balancing issues than some other employees.47
Thousands of employees, both in large global firms like IBM and HewlettPackard and in many smaller firms, have flexible work schedules and/or use
technology to work from locations away from the workplace as a way to help
balance work and personal lives. Firms such as Xerox and J.M. Smucker give
employees paid time off for community volunteer work. Numerous health
care firms allow employees to adjust their work schedules in order to address
personal, family, health, and other issues.48
JOB ANALYSIS
While job design attempts to develop jobs that fit effectively into the flow of
the organizational work, the more narrow focus of job analysis centers on using
a formal system to gather data about what people do in their jobs. The basic
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 124
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
125
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
Job Analysis in Perspective
FIGURE 4-7
JOB ANALYSIS
Methods
Questionnaires
Interviews
Observation
Logs/diaries
Sources of Data
Employees
Supervisors
Managers
Job analyst
Conducted by
Job analyst (HR)
Outside consultant
Supervisor/manager
Used for
Job Descriptions
Job Specifications
Used for
EEO/ADA
HR planning
Recruiting
Selection
Compensation
Training
Peformance
management
Health, safety,
and security
Employee/labor
relations
building block of HR management, job analysis, is a systematic way of gathering
and analyzing information about the content, context, and human requirements
of jobs. Most other functions in HR are based on and affected by job analysis.
An overview of job analysis is shown in Figure 4-7. The value of job
analysis begins as the information is compiled into job descriptions and job
specifications for use in virtually all HR activities.
Purposes of Job Analysis
Job analysis Systematic way
of gathering and analyzing
information about the
content, context, and human
requirements of jobs.
Job analysis has grown in importance as the workforce and jobs have changed.
To be effective, HR planning, recruiting, and selection all should be based on
job requirements and the capabilities of individuals identified by job analysis.
In EEO matters, accurate details on job requirements are needed, as the credentials in job descriptions can affect court decisions.49 Additionally, compensation, training, and employee performance appraisals all should be based on
the specific identified needs of the jobs. Job analysis also is useful in identifying job factors and duties that may contribute to workplace health/safety and
employee/labor relations issues. Information coming from job analyses that
can be helpful in making the distinction among jobs includes the following:
•
•
Work activities and behaviors
Interactions with others
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 125
26/06/10 4:05 PM
126
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
•
•
•
•
•
•
Performance standards
Financial and budgeting impact
Machines and equipment used
Working conditions
Supervision given and received
Knowledge, skills, and abilities needed
Job Analysis Responsibilities
Job analysis requires a high degree of coordination and cooperation between
the HR unit and operating managers. The assignment of responsibility for job
analysis depends on who can best perform various parts of the process. In
large companies, the HR unit supervises the process to maintain its integrity
and writes the job descriptions and specifications for uniformity. The managers review the efforts of the HR unit to ensure accuracy and completeness.
They also may request new job analyses when jobs change significantly. In
small organizations, managers may perform all job analysis responsibilities.
Figure 4-8 shows a typical division of responsibilities in organizations with
an HR unit.
Different types of job analysis are used as part of HR efforts. The most
traditionally and widely used method is task-based job analysis. But some
have emphasized the need for competency-based job analysis. Both types of
job analysis are discussed next. Task-based analysis is still the most widely
used method.
Task-Based Job Analysis
Task Distinct, identifiable
work activity composed of
motions.
Duty Work segment
composed of several tasks that
are performed by an individual.
FIGURE 4-8
Task-based job analysis is the most common form and focuses on the tasks,
duties, and responsibilities performed in a job. A task is a distinct, identifiable
work activity composed of motions, whereas a duty is a larger work segment
composed of several tasks that are performed by an individual. Because both
tasks and duties describe activities, it is not always easy or necessary to distinguish between the two. For example, if one of the employment supervisor’s
Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Job Analysis
HR Unit
Coordinates job analysis
Writes job descriptions and
specifications for review by managers
Periodically reviews job descriptions
and specifications
Reviews managerial input to ensure
accuracy
May seek assistance from outside
experts for difficult or unusual
analyses
Managers
Complete or help complete job analysis
information
Review job descriptions and
specifications and maintain their
accuracy
Request new analyses as jobs change
Use job analysis information to identify
performance standards
Provide information to outside experts
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 126
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
127
duties is to interview applicants, one task associated with that duty would
be asking job-related questions. Responsibilities are obligations to perform
certain tasks and duties. Task-based job analysis seeks to identify all the tasks,
duties, and responsibilities that are part of a job.
Competency-Based Job Analysis
Unlike the traditional task-based approach to analyzing jobs, the competency
approach considers how knowledge and skills are used. Competencies are
individual capabilities that can be linked to performance by individuals or
teams.
The concept of competencies varies widely from organization to organization. The term technical competencies is often used to refer to specific knowledge and skills of employees. For example, the following have been identified
as behavioral competencies:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Responsibilities Obligations
to perform certain tasks and
duties.
Competencies Individual
capabilities that can be linked
to enhanced performance by
individuals or teams.
Customer focus
Team orientation
Technical expertise
Results orientation
Communication effectiveness
Leadership
Conflict resolution
Innovation
Adaptability
Decisiveness
The competency approach attempts to identify the competencies have been
identified as driving employee performance.50 For instance, many supervisors
talk about employees’ attitudes, but they have difficulty identifying exactly
what they mean by “attitude.” A variety of methodologies are used to help
supervisors articulate examples of competencies and how those factors affect
performance.51
Unlike the traditional task-based job analysis, one purpose of the competency approach is to influence individual and organizational behaviors in the
future. The competency approach may be more broadly focused on behaviors, rather than just on tasks, duties, and responsibilities. Some of the more
comprehensive competency-based job analysis components may extensively
include knowledge, skills, abilities, and personality characteristics.52
Integrating Technology and Competency-Based Job Analysis As
jobs continue to change, technology expands, and workers become more
diverse, it may be that there will be a more integrated use of both job analysis
approaches. Another factor that will contribute to the use of both types of
job analysis is that strategic competencies are identified for some jobs, not
just performing job tasks and duties. In the future, people
doing jobs are more likely to need integrated job analyLOGGING ON
sis means, rather than just one approach.53 The decision
Job Analysis.net
about whether to use a task-based or competency-based
A resource for conducting a job
approach to job analysis is affected by the nature of jobs
analysis, including different types of
and how work is changing. However, task-based analysis is
methods, legal issues, questionnaires,
likely to remain more widely used as it is the most defenand job descriptions, can be found at
sible legally, and it is the primary focus of the remainder of
www.jobanalysis.net.
this chapter.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 127
26/06/10 4:05 PM
128
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
IMPLEMENTING JOB ANALYSIS
The process of job analysis must be conducted in a logical manner, following
appropriate management and professional psychometric practices. Analysts
usually follow a multistage process, regardless of the specific job analysis
methods used. The stages for a typical job analysis, as outlined in Figure 4-9,
may vary somewhat with the number of jobs included. Each of the phases is
discussed next.
Planning the Job Analysis
Prior to the job analysis process itself is the planning done to gather data from
managers and employees. Probably the most important consideration is to
identify the objectives of the job analysis, which might be as simple as updating job descriptions or as comprehensive as revising the compensation programs in the organization. Whatever the purpose identified, the effort needs
the support of top management.
FIGURE 4-9
Stages in the Job Analysis Process
I. Planning the Job Analysis
A. Identify objectives of job analysis
B. Obtain top management support
II. Preparing For and Introducing Job Analysis
A. Identify jobs and methodology
B. Review existing job documentation
C. Communicate process to managers/employees
III. Conducting the Job Analysis
A. Gather job analysis data
B. Review and compile data
IV. Developing Job Descriptions and Job Specifications
A. Draft job descriptions and specifications
B. Review drafts with managers and employees
C. Finalize job descriptions and recommendations
V. Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions and Job Specifications
A. Update job descriptions and specifications as organization changes
B. Periodically review all jobs
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 128
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
129
Preparing for and Introducing the Job Analysis
Preparation for job analysis includes identification of the jobs to be analyzed.
Next reviewing organization charts, existing job descriptions, previous job
analysis information, and other resources is part of the planning. This phase
also identifies those who will be involved in conducting the job analysis and
the methods to be used. A key part is identifying and communicating the process to appropriate managers, affected employees, and others.
Conducting the Job Analysis
If questionnaires are used, it is often helpful to have employees return them
to supervisors or managers for review before giving them back to those conducting the job analysis. Questionnaires should be accompanied by a letter
explaining the process and instructions for completing and returning them. If
interviews are used, they may occur after the return of the questionnaires, in
order to clarify more details. Once data from job analyses are compiled, the
information should be sorted by job, organizational unit, and job family.
Developing Job Descriptions and Job Specifications
At the fourth stage, the job analysts draft job descriptions and job specifications. Generally, organizations find that having managers and employees write
job descriptions is not recommended for several reasons. First, it reduces consistency in format and details, both of which are important given the legal consequences of job descriptions. Second, managers and employees vary in their
writing skills so they may write the job descriptions and job specifications to
reflect what they do and what their personal qualifications are, not what the
job requires. However, completed drafts should be reviewed with managers
and supervisors, and then employees, before they are finalized.
Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions
and Job Specifications
Once job descriptions and specifications have been completed and reviewed
by all appropriate individuals, a system must be developed for keeping them
current and posted on a firm’s intranet source. One effective way to ensure
that appropriate reviews occur is to use current job descriptions and job
specifications as part of other HR activities. For example, each time a vacancy
occurs, the job description and specifications should be reviewed and revised
as necessary before recruiting and selection efforts begin. Similarly, in some
organizations, managers and employees review job descriptions during performance appraisal interviews.
JOB ANALYSIS METHODS
Another consideration is the method to be used. Job analysis information
about what people are doing in their jobs can be gathered in a variety of
ways. Traditionally the most common methods have been observation, interviewing, and questionnaires. However, the expansion of technology has led to
computerization and Web-based job analysis information resources. The use of
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 129
26/06/10 4:05 PM
130
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
a combination of these approaches depends on the situation and the organization.54 Each of these methods is discussed next.
Observation
With the observation method, a manager, job analyst, or industrial engineer
observes the individual performing the job and takes notes to describe the
tasks and duties performed. Use of the observation method is limited because
many jobs do not have complete and easily observed job duties or job cycles.
Thus, observation may be more useful for repetitive jobs and in conjunction
with other methods.
Work Sampling One type of observation, work sampling, does not require
attention to each detailed action throughout an entire work cycle. This method
allows a manager to determine the content and pace of a typical workday
through statistical sampling of certain actions rather than through continuous
observation and timing of all actions. Work sampling is particularly useful for
routine and repetitive jobs.
Employee Diary/Log Another observation method requires employees to
“observe” their own performances by keeping a diary/log of their job duties,
noting how frequently those duties are performed and the time required for
each one. Although this approach sometimes generates useful information, it
may be burdensome for employees to compile an accurate log. The logging
approach can be technology-based, reducing some of the problems.
Interviewing
The interview method requires a manager or an HR specialist to talk with the
employees performing each job. A standardized interview form is used most
often to record the information. Both the employee and the employee’s supervisor must be interviewed to obtain complete details on the job.
Sometimes, group or panel interviews are used. A team of subject matter
experts (SMEs) who have varying insights about a group of jobs is assembled
to provide job analysis information. This option may be particularly useful for
highly technical or complex jobs. For instance, the competency approach may
use interviewing to identify dimensions that are more than task-based. Because
the interview method can be quite time consuming, combining it with one of
the other methods is common.
Questionnaires
The questionnaire is a widely used method of gathering data on jobs. A survey
instrument is developed and given to employees and managers to complete.
The typical job questionnaire often covers the areas shown in Figure 4-10.
The questionnaire method offers a major advantage in that information
on a large number of jobs can be collected inexpensively in a relatively short
period of time. However, the questionnaire method assumes that employees
can accurately analyze and communicate information about their jobs. Using
interviewing and observation in combination with the questionnaire method
allows analysts to clarify and verify the information gathered in questionnaires.
Position Analysis Questionnaire (PAQ) The Position Analysis
Questionnaire is a specialized instrument that incorporates checklists. Each
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 130
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
131
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
FIGURE 4-10
Typical Areas Covered in a Job Analysis Questionnaire
Duties and Percentage of Time Spent on Each
Contact with Other People
• Regular duties
• Special duties performed less frequently
• Internal contacts
• External contacts
Supervision
Physical Dimensions
• Supervision given to others
• Supervision received from others
• Physical demands
• Working conditions
Decisions Made
Jobholder Characteristics
• Records and reports prepared
• Materials and equipment used
• Financial/budget responsibilities
•
•
•
•
Knowledge
Skills
Abilities
Training needed
job is analyzed on 27 dimensions composed of 187 “elements.” The PAQ has
a number of divisions, each containing numerous job elements.
The PAQ focuses on “worker-oriented” elements that describe behaviors
necessary to do the job rather than on “job-oriented” elements that describe
the technical aspects of the work. Although its complexity may deter potential
users, the PAQ can be used to conduct validity studies on selection tests. It
also may contribute to internal pay fairness because it considers the varying
demands of different jobs.
Managerial Job Analysis Questionnaire Because managerial jobs often
differ from jobs with clearly observable routines and procedures, some specialized job analysis methods exist. One well-known method is the Management
Position Description Questionnaire (MPDQ). Composed of more than 200
statements, the MPDQ examines a variety of managerial dimensions, including decision making and supervising.
Computerized Job Analysis Systems
With the expansion of information technology and Web-based resources,
computerized job analysis systems have been developed. An important feature
of technological job analysis is the specificity of data that can be gathered
and compiled into a job analysis database. As a result, a technology-based job
analysis system can often reduce the time and effort involved in writing job
descriptions. These systems often store banks of job duty statements that relate
to each of the task and scope statements of the questionnaires. The use of
computerized methods will likely continue to grow because of the advantages
offered (see the later section on O*Net).
Combination Methods
A number of different ways to obtain and analyze information about a job exist.
Each method has strengths and weaknesses, and a combination of methods
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 131
26/06/10 4:05 PM
132
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
HR online
O*Net Resources
for Employers
Since the recent expansion of the O*Net databases for
employers, this resource contains data on more than
800 occupations, classified by industry. Included in the
occupational categories are the following:
•
Task statements or importance, relevance,
and frequency
• Abilities (work activities, knowledge, skills,
and work content)
• Training, work experiences, and education
• Interests and work values, work styles,
and job zones
O*Net can be used in different ways. For example,
one way is to see what abilities will be needed in
certain jobs. More than 50 abilities are listed, including
arm-hand steadiness, fluency of ideas, time sharing,
visualization, written and oral comprehension, and
speech clarity. Employers can use the abilities and the
other components to generate data for some parts of job
analysis and for developing job descriptions.
O*Net also now contains the Dictionary of
Occupational Titles (DOT) and has hundreds of jobs
descriptions. For example, on HR jobs, the DOT and
O*Net have listed details on occupations such as
Employee Relations Specialist and Human Resource
Advisor. For these and all other types of jobs, an
extensive list of tasks and detailed work activities is
provided. A Spanish version database is available to
aid with diverse workers and jobs. The details provided
give supervisors, managers, and HR professionals
a valuable resource as they develop or revise job
descriptions, compare recruiting advertisements,
develop training components, and perform other HR
activities. In summary, O*Net is a database of worker
attributes and job characteristics to describe jobs and
the skills workers will need to perform them. It can be
accessed at www.onetcenter.org.55
generally may be more appropriate than one method alone. Regardless of the
methods used, job analysis provides the information necessary to develop job
descriptions and job specifications.
Job Analysis and O*Net
A variety of resources related to job analysis are available from the U.S.
Department of Labor (DOL). The resources have been developed and used
over many years by various entities. Functional job analysis uses a competency approach to job analysis. A functional definition of what is done in a
job can be generated by examining the three components of data, people, and
things. The levels of these components traditionally have been used to identify
and compare important elements of more than 120 jobs in the Dictionary
of Occupational Titles (DOT). But O*Net is now the main DOL resource
available and provides employers with a wide range of useful items, as
noted in the HR Online description.
Although not specifically a job analysis, O*Net is a database compiled by
the U.S. Department of Labor to provide basic occupational data that covers
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 132
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
133
more than 800 occupations based on the Standard Occupational Classification
(SOC) developed by the government. O*Net also provides extensive links to
additional resources on workplace issues.
BEHAVIORAL AND LEGAL ASPECTS OF JOB ANALYSIS
Job analysis involves determining what the “core” job is. A detailed examination of jobs, although necessary, sometimes can be a demanding and disruptive
experience for both managers and employees, in part because job analysis can
identify the difference between what currently is being performed in a job and
what should be done. This is a major issue about job analysis for some people,
but it is not the only concern. Thus, some behavioral factors that can affect
job analysis are discussed next.
Current Incumbent Emphasis
A job analysis and the resulting job description and job specifications should
not describe just what the person currently doing the job does and that person’s qualifications. The incumbent may have unique capabilities and the
ability to expand the scope of the job to assume more responsibilities, and the
employer might have difficulty finding someone exactly like that individual if
the person left. Consequently, it is useful to focus on core duties and necessary
knowledge, skills, and abilities by determining what the job would be if the
incumbent were to quit or be moved to a different job.
“Inflation” of Jobs and Job Titles
People have a tendency to inflate the importance and significance of their jobs.
Because job analysis information is used for compensation purposes, both
managers and employees hope that “puffing up” jobs will result in higher pay
levels, greater “status” for résumés, and more promotional opportunities.
Inflated job titles also can be used to enhance employees’ images without
making major job changes or pay adjustments.56 For instance, banking and
financial institutions often use officer designations to enhance status. In one
small Midwestern bank, an employee who had three years’ experience as
a teller was “promoted” with no pay increase to Second Vice President of
Customer Service. In effect, she became the lead teller when her supervisor was
out of the bank, and now could sign more customer account forms, but her
duties and compensation were basically the same.
An additional concern is the use of offbeat titles. For example, what is a
“group idea management director,” “chief transformation officer,” or “marketing evangelist”? What does a “human character manager” really do? These
examples illustrate how job titles may be misleading, both inside and outside
the place of employment. Titles should convey a clear view of what a job
involves.
Employee and Managerial Anxieties
Both employees and managers have concerns about job analysis. Through
job analysis, the job description is supposed to identify what is done in a
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 133
26/06/10 4:05 PM
134
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
job. However, it is difficult to capture all facets of a job in which employees
perform a variety of duties and operate with a high degree of independence.
Employee Fears One fear that employees may have concerns the purpose of
a detailed investigation of their jobs. Some employees fear that an analysis of
their jobs will put a straitjacket on them, limiting their creativity and flexibility
by formalizing their duties. However, having accurate, well-communicated job
descriptions can assist employees by clarifying their roles and the expectations
within those roles. One effective way to handle anxieties is to involve the
employees in the revision process.
Often the content of a job may reflect the desires and skills of the incumbent employee. For example, in one firm, an employee promoted to customer
service supervisor continued to spend considerable time answering customer
calls, rather than supervising employees taking the calls. As part of job analysis discussions, the operations manager discussed the need for the supervisor
to train the employees on handling special customer requests and to delegate
more routine duties to others.
Managerial Straitjacket One primary concern of managers and supervisors is that the job analysis and job descriptions will unrealistically limit
managerial flexibility. Because workloads and demands change rapidly,
managers and supervisors want to be able to move duties to other employees, cross-train employees, and have more dynamic, flexible means available
to accomplish work. If job descriptions are written or used restrictively,
some employees may use an omission to limit managerial flexibility. In
some organizations with unionized workforces, very restrictive job descriptions exist.
Because of such difficulties, the final statement in many job descriptions
is a miscellaneous clause that consists of a phrase similar to “Performs other
duties as needed upon request by immediate supervisor.” This statement covers unusual situations in an employee’s job. However, duties covered by this
phrase cannot be considered essential functions under legal provisions including the Americans with Disabilities Act, as discussed next.
Legal Aspects of Job Analysis
Chapter 3 on equal employment laws, regulations, and court cases emphasized that legal compliance must focus on the jobs that individuals perform.
The Uniform Guidelines on Employee Selection Procedures make it clear that
HR requirements must be tied to specific job-related factors if employers
are to defend their actions as a business necessity. This approach has direct
impact on job descriptions and persons with disabilities who may apply for
those jobs.
Job Analysis and the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) One result
of the ADA is increased emphasis by employers on conducting job analyses,
as well as developing and maintaining current and accurate job descriptions
and job specifications.
The ADA requires that organizations identify the essential job functions,
which are the fundamental duties of a job. These do not include the marginal
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 134
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
135
functions of the positions. Marginal job functions are duties that are part of a
job but are incidental or ancillary to the purpose and nature of the job. Job
analysts, HR staff members, and operating managers must evaluate and make
decisions when information on three considerations is not clear. The three
major considerations used in determining essential functions and marginal
functions are as follows:
•
•
•
Percentage of time spent on tasks
Frequency of tasks done
Importance of tasks performed
Job analysis also should identify the physical demands of jobs. For example, the important physical skills and capabilities used on the job of nursing
representative could include being able to hear well enough to aid clients and
doctors. However, hearing might be less essential for a heavy equipment operator in a quarry.
An important part of job analysis is obtaining information about what
duties are being performed and what percentage of time is devoted to each
duty. As the ADA suggests, the percentage of time spent on a duty generally indicates its relative importance. Another consideration is the ease or
difficulty of assigning a duty to be performed by someone else, or in a different job.
Job Analysis and Wage/Hour Regulations Typically, job analysis identifies the percentage of time spent on each duty in a job. This information helps
determine whether someone should be classified as exempt or nonexempt
under the wage/hour laws.
As will be noted in Chapter 11, the federal Fair Labor Standards Act
(FLSA) and most state wage/hour laws indicate that the percentage of time
employees spend on manual, routine, or clerical duties affects whether
they must be paid overtime for hours worked in excess of 40 hours a
week. To be exempt from overtime, the employees must perform their
primary duties as executive, administrative, professional, or outside sales
employees. Primary has been interpreted to mean occurring at least 50%
of the time
Other legal-compliance efforts, such as those involving workplace safety
and health, can also be aided through the data provided by job analysis. In
summary, it is difficult for an employer to have a legal staffing system without
performing job analysis. Truly, job analysis is the most basic HR activity and
the foundation for most other HR activities.
JOB DESCRIPTIONS AND JOB SPECIFICATIONS
Marginal job functions
Duties that are part of a job
but are incidental or ancillary
to the purpose and nature of
the job.
The output from analysis of a job is used to develop a job description and
its job specifications. Together, these two documents summarize job analysis
information in a readable format and provide the basis for defensible jobrelated actions. They also identify individual jobs for employees by providing
documentation from management.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 135
26/06/10 4:05 PM
136
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
HR on-the-job
Writing Job Descriptions
Although not the most exciting part of HR management,
developing and maintaining current job descriptions
is important. Some key suggestions for writing a job
description that includes the essential functions and
duties of a job follow:
•
•
•
Compose specific duty statements that contain
most of the following elements:
• A precise action verb and its object
• The frequency of the duties and the expected
outcomes
• The tools, equipment, aids, and processes to
be used
Be logical: If the job is repetitive, describe
the tasks as they occur in the work cycle. For
varied jobs, list the major tasks first and follow
those with the less frequent and/or less
important tasks in order.
Use proper details: Make sure the description
covers all the meaningful duties of the job, but
avoids too many details.
•
•
•
•
•
Be specific: For example, instead of saying
“Lifts heavy packages,” say “Frequently lifts
heavy packages weighing up to
50 pounds.”
Use the active voice: Start each statement with
a functional verb in the present tense (thirdperson singular)—for instance, “Compiles,”
“Approves,” or “Analyzes.” Avoid terms like
handles, maintains, and processes.
Describe, do not prescribe: Say “Operates
electronic imaging machine,” not “Must know
how to operate electronic image machine.”
(The latter is a job specification, not a job
description.)
Be consistent: Define terms like may, occasionally,
and periodically.
Prepare a miscellaneous clause: This clause
provides flexibility and may be phrased as
follows: “Performs other related duties as
assigned by supervisory personnel.”
Job Descriptions
In most cases, the job description and job specifications are combined into one
document that contains several sections. A job description identifies the tasks,
duties, and responsibilities of a job. It describes what is done, why it is done,
where it is done, and, briefly, how it is done. The HR On-the-Job shows suggestions for writing job descriptions.
Job description
Identification of the tasks,
duties, and responsibilities
of a job.
Job specifications The
knowledge, skills, and abilities
(KSAs) an individual needs to
perform a job satisfactorily.
Performance standards
Indicators of what the job
accomplishes and how
performance is measured
in key areas of the job
description.
Job Specifications
While the job description describes activities to be done, the job specifications
list the knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) an individual needs to perform a
job satisfactorily. KSAs include education, experience, work skill requirements,
personal abilities, and mental and physical requirements. Accurate job specifications identify what KSAs a person needs to do the job, not necessarily the
current employee’s qualifications.
Performance Standards
Performance standards flow directly from a job description and indicate what
the job accomplishes and how performance is measured in key areas of the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 136
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
137
job description. If employees know what is expected and how performance is
to be measured, they have a much better chance of performing satisfactorily.
Unfortunately, performance standards are often not developed as supplemental items from job descriptions. Even if performance standards have been
identified and matched to job descriptions, they must be communicated to
employees if the job descriptions are to be effective HR tools.
Job Description Components
A typical job description contains several major parts. The following content
presents an overview of the most common components.
Identification The first part of the job description is the identification section, in which the job title, department, reporting relationships, location, and
date of analysis may be given. Usually, it is advisable to note other information
that is useful in tracking jobs and employees through HR systems. Additional
items commonly noted in the identification section are job code, pay grade,
exempt/nonexempt status under the Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA), and the
EEOC classification (from the EEO-1 form).
General Summary The second part, the general summary, is a concise statement of the general responsibilities and components that make the job different from others. One HR specialist has characterized the general summary
statement as follows: “In thirty words or less, describe the essence of the job.”
Often, the summary is written after all other sections are completed so that a
more complete overview is prepared.
Essential Job Functions and Duties The third part of the typical job
description lists the essential functions and duties, generally in order of importance. It contains clear, precise statements on the major tasks, duties, and
responsibilities performed. Writing this section is the most time-consuming
aspect of preparing job descriptions.
Job Specifications The next portion of the job description gives the qualifications needed to perform the job satisfactorily. The job specifications typically
are stated as: (1) knowledge, skills, and abilities; (2) education and experience;
and (3) physical requirements and/or working conditions. The components
of the job specifications provide information necessary to determine what
accommodations might and might not be possible under the Americans with
Disabilities Act.
Disclaimers and Approvals The final section on many job descriptions
contains approval signatures by appropriate managers and a legal disclaimer. This disclaimer allows employers to change employees’ job duties
or to request employees to perform duties not listed, so that the job description is not viewed as a contract between the employer and the employee.
Figure 4-11 contains a sample job description and job specifications for a
Customer Service Supervisor. Also, Appendix G has sample HR-related job
descriptions.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 137
26/06/10 4:05 PM
138
SECTION 2
F I G U R E 4 - 11
Jobs and Labor
Sample Job Description
Identification Section
Position Title: Customer Service Supervisor
Department: Marketing/Customer Service
Reports To: Marketing Director
EEOC Class: O/M
FLSA Status: Exempt
General Summary
Supervises, coordinates, and assigns work of employees to ensure customer
service department goals and customer needs are met.
Essential Job Functions
1. Supervises the work of Customer Service Representatives to enhance performance by
coordinating duties, advising on issues or problems, and checking work. (55%)
2. Provides Customer Service training for company employees in all departments. (15%)
3. Creates and reviews reports for service orders for new and existing customers. (10%)
4. Performs employee performance evaluations, training, and discipline. (10%)
5. Follows up with customer complaints and issues and provides resolutions. (10%)
6. Conducts other duties as needed by guided by Marketing Director and executives.
Knowledge, Skills, and Abilities
• Knowledge of company products, services, policies, and procedures.
• Knowledge of marketing and customer programs, data, and results.
• Knowledge of supervisory requirements and practices.
• Skill in completing multiple tasks at once.
• Skill in identifying and resolving customer problems.
• Skill in oral and written communication, including Spanish communications.
• Skill in coaching, training, and performance evaluating employees.
• Skill in operating office and technological equipment and software.
• Ability to communicate professionally with coworkers, customers and vendors.
• Ability to work independently and meet managerial goals.
• Ability to follow oral and written instructions.
• Ability to organize daily activities of self and others and to work as a team player.
Education and Experience
Bachelor’s degree in business or marketing, plus 3–5 years of industry experience. Supervisory, marketing,
and customer service experience helpful.
Physical Requirements
Percentage of Work Time Spent on Activity
0–24%
25–49%
50–74%
75–100%
Seeing : Must be able to see well enough to
read reports.
X
Hearing : Must be able to hear well enough
to communicate with customers, vendors
and employees.
X
Standing/Walking : Must be able to move
about department.
X
Climbing/Stooping/Kneeling : Must be able
to stoop or kneel to pick up paper products
or directories.
X
Lifting/Pulling/Pushing : Must be able to lift up
to 50 pounds.
X
Fingering/Grasping/Feeling : Must be able to
type and use technical sources.
X
Working Conditions: Normal working conditions absent extreme factors.
Note: The statements herein are intended to describe the general nature and level of work being performed, but are
not to be seen as a complete list of responsibilities, duties, and skills required of personnel so classified. Also, they do
not establish a contract for employment and are subject to change at the discretion of the employer.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 138
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
139
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Diversity management focuses on organizational efforts to ensure that all people are valued
regardless of their differences.
The “business case” for diversity is built on its
ability to allow new talent and ideas, aid in
employee attraction and retention, allow for an
increase in market share, and lead to lower costs.
The workforce composition is becoming more
diverse based on race/ethnicity, age, gender, and
other life components.
Work is organized into jobs for people to do. Work
flow analysis and business process reengineering
are both approaches used to check how well this
has been done.
Job design involves developing jobs that people
like to do. It may include simplification, enlargement, enrichment, rotation, or sharing.
Designing jobs so that they incorporate skill
variety, task identity and significance, autonomy,
and feedback is important for both employers
and employees.
The use of work teams and virtual teams is
growing in organizations throughout the United
States and globally.
Work-related teams are aiding organizational
and managerial productivity and growth, despite
some problems that may occur.
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Telework, whereby employees work with technology, is leading to more work flexibility.
Work scheduling through flextime allows
employees to work more at home, which enhances their work-life balancing activities.
Job analysis is a systematic investigation of the
content, context, and human requirements of a job.
Task-based job analysis focuses on the tasks,
duties, and responsibilities associated with jobs.
Competency-based job analysis focuses on basic
characteristics that can be linked to enhanced
performance, such as technical and behavioral
competencies.
The job analysis process has five stages, beginning
with planning and ending with maintaining and
updating job descriptions and job specifications.
A number of methods of job analysis are used,
with interviews and questionnaires being the
most popular.
Both the behavioral reactions of employees and
managers and legal-compliance issues must be
considered as part of job analysis.
The end products of job analysis are job descriptions, which identify the tasks, duties, and
responsibilities of jobs, and job specifications,
which list the knowledge, skills, and abilities
needed to perform a job satisfactorily.
T H I N K I N G
1. Describe how diversity of workers has been
impacting organizations, including organizations for which you have worked recently.
2. For many individuals, the nature of work and
jobs is changing. Describe these changes, some
reasons for them, and how they are affecting
both HR management and individuals.
3. Explain how you would conduct a job
analysis in a company that has never had job
H R
•
E X P E R I E N T I A L
You have recently assumed the role of HR Manager
in your company. In reviewing the company records,
you note that the job descriptions were last updated
5 years ago. The Company President has taken the
A C T I V I T I E S
descriptions. Utilize the O*Net as a resource
for your information.
4. You need to convince upper management
of the usefulness of a companywide diversity
program. How will you define diversity,
and what arguments can be made for so
defining it? Use the website www.diversityinc
.com and other sources to gather the necessary
information.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
position that there is no need to update the job
descriptions. However, you also note that the company has grown by 50% during the last 5 years,
resulting in many changes, including some in job
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 139
26/06/10 4:05 PM
140
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
functions. You want to build a business case to
convince the Company President of the need to
update the job descriptions. To help you build your
case, use the information on the purpose of job
descriptions at www.hrtools.com.
1. How can job descriptions be used as a management tool?
2. What role do job descriptions have in helping
companies comply with various legal issues?
C A S E
ROWE and Flexible Work and Success at Best Buy
Best Buy is a large national retailer with many
full-time and part-time employees in more than
1,000 stores. Beginning several years ago, Best
Buy has made major changes in its work schedules. Rather than emphasizing fixed hours, Best
Buy increased use of flexible work hours in its corporate headquarters and stores. Based on the success of an initial experimental program with 300
employees in some departments, the changes have
evolved into a more broadly used program labeled
ROWE—Results Only Work Environment.
At the heart of ROWE is the philosophy of
focusing on employees getting their work done,
not just meeting clock hours. To implement
ROWE, managers and employees have had to
identify performance result expectations and measures for all jobs. The focus of ROWE has been on
how people make judgments on work to be done
and the time at work to do it. The core focus of
ROWE is employee performance meeting expectations, not just being at work.
The HR payoff of ROWE has been significant.
According to metrics, voluntary employee turnover has declined in some divisions by as much as
75% to 90% over several years. Average worker
productivity in the same period increased over
one-third. Some other key results of the ROWE
plan have been:
•
•
•
Increased customer satisfaction because of the
work-results focus of Best Buy employees
Higher employee morale and engagement
because of the ability to place work and life
demands in balance
Higher managerial performance because of
the attention to results, not just on training
schedules and regulations
For some employees and managers with family
responsibilities and personal interests, one of the
greatest advantages of the ROWE program is the
ability for them to achieve better work-life balance.
From mothers of school-aged children to single
males involved in hobbies and sports, employees
can adjust schedules to meet their personal and
professional needs. For instance, one employee
left often in early afternoon in order to participate
in entertainment activities. Other employees have
finished work and gone hunting or golfing during
the “normal workweek” because they had completed their work requirements. Obviously, these
persons can make expansive use of technology for
doing their work anywhere, such as getting messages while at family or sporting events, responding quickly to job-related questions, and providing
immediate work-related information.
The ROWE program now has been expanded
to include retail store managers and workers.
Doing so has meant making some modifications
to ensure that sufficient salespersons are available
to serve customers at a wide range of days and
times. But with Best Buy retail stores previously
experiencing a turnover rate of 60% plus, adapting to ROWE has been important. It has helped
with recruiting store employees, retaining them
so that turnover has decreased, and enhancing
customer service.
In summary, the change in the culture at Best
Buy to focus on results, employee success, and
greater work flexibility has made Best Buy one
of the best places for many people to shop and
work. How this program will expand and modify
as economic, workforce diversity, and jobs change
will be interesting to observe.57
QUESTIONS
1. Discuss how a ROWE-type program would
fit in organizations where you have worked.
Explain why it would or would not work.
2. Identify factors in the ROWE program that
might make using it for retail employees
more difficult than using it for managers
and employees in corporate offices, technical
centers, and nonretail jobs and locations.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 140
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
141
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
The Reluctant Receptionist
Jobs and Work at R.R. Donnelley
This case illustrates how incomplete job analysis and
job descriptions create both managerial and employee
problems. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/
management/mathis.)
This case describes how a printing firm had to
increase productivity and redesign jobs. (For
the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/
mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Kathleen Koster, “Flex Schedules
Key to Corporate Performance,”
Employee Benefit News, May 28,
2009, http://ebn.benefitnews.com/
news; “Survey Results: Flexible
Work Arrangements,” Institute for
Corporate Productivity, 2008, 3–8,
www.i4cp.com.
2. “Employment Projections” U.S.
Bureau of Labor Statistics,
www.bls.gov.
3. David A. Harrison and Katherine
L. Klein, “What’s the Difference?
Diversity Constructs as
Separation, Variety, or Disparity
in Organizations,” Academy of
Management Review, 22 (2007),
1199–1228.
4. Eddy S.W. Nig, “Why Organizations
Choose to Manage Diversity,”
Human Resource Development
Review, 7 (2008), 58–78.
5. Robert Rodriguez, “Diversity Finds
Its Place,” HR Magazine, August
2006, 56–61.
6. Kathy Gurchiek, “Putting Diversity
into Practice Stymies Many Firms,”
HR News, August 27, 2007,
www.shrm.org/hrnews.
7. Bill Leonard, “Diversity Initiatives
Must Grow from Key Business
Goals,” SHRMOnLine, April 29,
2009, www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines;
Ellen F. Curtis and Janice L.
Dreachslin, “Integrative Literature
Review: Diverse Management
Interventions and Organizational
Performance,” Human Resource
Development Review, 7 (2008),
107–134.
8. Lynn M. Shore, et al., “Diversity in
Organizations: Where Are We Now
and Where Are We Going?” Human
Resource Management Review, 22
(2007), 1199–1228; Sharon Wong,
“Diversity—Making Space for
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
Everyone at NASA/Goddard Space
Flight Center . . .,” Human
Resource Management, 47 (2008),
389–399.
Gill Kilton and Anne-Marie Greene,
“The Costs and Opportunities
of Doing Diversity Work in
Mainstream Organizations,”
Human Resource Management
Journal, 19 (2009), 159–175;
Orlando C. Richard, et al.,
“The Impact of Racial Diversity
on Intermediate and Long-Term
Performance,” Strategic
Management Journal, 28 (2007),
1213–1233.
Based on Terence F. Shea,
“Dismantling Language Barriers,”
HR Magazine, November 2008,
48–52.
“An Older and More Diverse
Nation by Mid-Century,” U.S.
Census Bureau News, August 14,
2008, www.census.gov.
Sherri B. Welch, “Diversity as
Business Strategy: Company
Faced Racial Tensions Head-on,”
Workforce Week, April 2009,
www.workforce.com; G. M. Combs
and J. Griffith, “An Examination
of Interracial Contact,” Human
Resource Development Review, 6
(2007), 222–244.
Tara Kalwarski, “Retirement: Not
When It Used to Be?” Business
Week, November 3, 2008, 96;
Stephen Miller, “60 Percent of Older
Workers Delay Retirement,” HR
Disciplines, March 23, 2009,
www.shrm.org.
“Managing Across the Generations,”
HR Compliance, May 14, 2009,
www.ceridian.com; “Gen Y Creates
Need for Cultural Overhaul,”
WorldatWork Newsline, January
11, 2008, www.worldatwork.org/
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
waw; “Generation X: Magic or
Mayhem in the Middle,” 2009,
www.talentAnarchy.com.
Nancy Lockwood, et al., “The
Multigenerational Workforce:
Opportunity for Competitive
Success,” SHRM Research Quarterly,
First Quarter, 2009, 1–10; Robert
J. Grossman, “Keep Pace with Older
Workers,” HR Magazine, May 2008,
39–46.
Frank Giancola, “The Generation
Gap: More Myth than Reality,”
Human Resource Planning, 29
(2006), 32; Susan A. Murphy,
Leading a Multigenerational
Workforce (Washington, DC:
AARP, 2007).
American Time Use Survey, U.S.
Department of Labor, 2008, www
.bls.gov/tus/#news.
George Desvaux, et al., “A Business
Case for Women,” The McKinsey
Quarterly, September 2008, 1ff.;
Philip N. Cohen and Matt
Huffman, “Working for the
Woman? Female Mangers and
the Gender Wage Gap,” American
Sociological Review, 72 (2007),
681–704.
“43% of Working Moms Would
Take Pay Cuts to Spend Time
with Kids,” May 8, 2008,
www.careerbuilder.com; Jean
Kimmel and Rachel Connnelly,
“Mother’s Time Choices,” Journal
of Human Resources, 62 (2007),
643–681.
Eugene A. Hall, et al., “How to
Make Reengineering Really
Work,” The McKinsey Quarterly,
September 2008, www
.mckinseyquarterly.com.
George McCormick, et al., “The
Manager’s Impact on Job and
Organization Design,” WorldatWork
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 141
26/06/10 4:05 PM
142
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2007,
82–91.
For more details and data on
contingent employees, go to www
.bls.gov.
Fay Hansen, “A Permanent Strategy
for Temporary Hires,” Workforce
Management, February 26, 2007,
25–32.
Allysson M. Costa and Cristobal
Mirrales, “Job Rotation in
Assembly Lines Employing Disabled
Workers,” International Journal of
Production Economics, 112 (2009),
1016.
Margaret Fiester, “Job Rotation,
Total Rewards, Measuring
Value,” HR Magazine, August
2008, 33.
Kathy Gurchiek, “HR Structure
Reflects Organizational Size,”
HR News, June 15, 2009,
www.shrm.org.
Michael O’Brien, “Long-Distance
Relationship Troubles,” Human
Resource Executive Online, July 7,
2009, www.hrexecutive.com.
Billie Williamson, “Managing at
a Distance,” BusinessWeek, July
27, 2009, 64–65; Lynda Gratton,
“Working Together . . . When
Apart,” The Wall Street Journal,
June 16, 2007, R4.
“Innovative Work Teams in a
Challenging Business Environment,”
SHRM Workplace Visions, 2009,
No. 1, 1–6.
Ramon Rico, et al., “Team Implicit
Coordination Processes,” Academy
of Management Review, 33 (2008),
163–184.
Marjo Sinokki, “The Association
Between Team Climate at Work
and Mental Health,” Occupational
and Environmental Medicine, 66
(2009), 523–526; Christopher M.
Barnes and John R. Hollenbeck,
“Sleep Deprivation and DecisionMaking Teams,” Academy of
Management Review, 34 (2009),
56–66l.
Jessica Mesmert-Magnus and
Leslie A. DeChurch, “Information
Sharing and Team Performance:
A Meta-Analysis,” Journal of
Applied Psychology, 94 (2009),
535–546; Erick Kearney, et al.,
“When and How Diversity
33.
34.
35.
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
Benefits Teams,” Academy of
Management Journal, 52 (2009),
581–598.
Andrew R. McIlvane, “The Problem
with Diverse Teams,” Human
Resource Executive Online, June 2,
2009, www.hreonline.com.
Rita Zeidner, “Telework
Influencing Technology
Investments,” HR Magazine,
July 2008, 22.
Heidi Russell Rafferty, “Experts:
Telework Might Hold Key to
Pandemic Solution,” HR News,
May 7, 2009, www.shrm.org/
publications.
Lorrie Lykins and Mark Vickers,
“Can Telework Cut Costs and Raise
Productivity in Today’s Economy?”
Trend Watcher, March 6, 2009,
www.i4cp.com.
Based on “Annual Hours
Worked per Employed Person,
1997 and 2007,” Labor Market
Indicators, Organization for
Economic Cooperation and
Development, 2009,
www.oecd.org.
Terrance M. McMenamin, “A Time
to Work: Recent Trends in Shift
Work and Flexible Schedules,”
Monthly Labor Review, December
2007, 3–14.
“Extended Unusual Work Shifts,”
U.S. Occupational Safety & Health
Administration, September 7, 2005,
www.osha.gov.
Martin Moore-Ede, et al.,
“Advantages and Disadvantages
of Twelve-Hour Shifts, A Balanced
Perspective,” 2007, www.ciridian
.com.
“Innovative Workplace
Flexibility Options for Hourly
Workers,” Corporate Voices for
Working Families, 2009, www
.cvworkingfamilies.org/
publications.
Euan Hutchinson, “‘People People’
Work at Home, Too,” HR Magazine,
September 2008, 60–62.
E. Jeffrey Hill, et al., “Defining and
Conceptualizing Work Flexibility,”
Community, Work, and Family, 11
(2008), 149–163.
Sue Shellenbarger, “Work at
Home: Employers Watch,” The
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
Wall Street Journal, July 30, 2008,
D1ff.
Beth A. Heinen and Rebecca
R. H. Mulvaney, “Global Factors
Influencing Work-Life Policies and
Practices,” WorldatWork Journal,
First Quarter, 2008, 34–41; Sheri
Gaster and Virginia G. McMorrow,
“Expatriates Assignments
Influence on Work-Life Balance,”
WorldatWork Journal, Fourth
Quarter, 2008, 62–69.
Kathleen Koster, “Work-Life
Balance Key for Employees,”
Employee Benefit News,
May 7, 2009, http://ebn
.benefitnews.com; Maggie C.
Moore and Nancy R. Lockwood,
“Work/Life Balance: A Global
Perspective,” HRM Research,
April 1007, www.shrm.org/
research.
Jean Kimmel and Rachel
Connelly, “Mothers’ Time
Choices,” Journal of Human
Resources, 62 (2006), 643–681;
Melanie A. Hulbert, “Unveiling
Gendered Assumptions in the
Organizational Implementation
of Work-Life Policies,” WorldatWork
Journal, First Quarter, 2009,
42–54.
For examples, see Sherry Sullivan
and Lisa Mainiero, “Benchmarking
Ideas for Fostering Family-Friendly
Workplaces,” Organizational
Dynamics, 36 (2006), 45–62; Pamela
Babcock, “Elder Care at Work,”
HR Magazine, September 2008,
111–113.
Lamb v. Boeing Co., No. 5-18431
(4th Cir., Jan. 11, 2007).
Douglas W. Crisman, “Using
Competencies to Drive Talent
Management,” Workspan, December
2006, 11.
Garry Kranz, “Calling on
Experts,” Workforce
Management, June 2008, www
.workforce.com.
“Competency Modeling and Job
Analysis: Current Trends and
Debates in the Academic
Literature,” ICF International,
2009, www.icfi.com.
Juan L. Sanchez and Edward L.
Levine, “What Is (or Should Be) the
Difference Between Competency
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 142
26/06/10 4:05 PM
CHAPTER 4
143
Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis
Modeling and Traditional Job
Analysis?” Human Resource
Management Review, 19 (2009),
53–63.
54. Jason C. Kovac, “The Purpose of
Job Analysis,” Workspan, December
2006, 11.
55. For details, go to the website
listed in the boxed feature, as well
as www.dol.gov and www
.onetcenter.org. The value of
O*Net is identified in various
publications, including Max Maller,
The Manager’s Guide to HR,
Chapter 1 (Alexandria, VA: SHRM,
2009).
56. Arthur D. Martinez, et al., “Job
Title Inflation,” Human Resource
Management Review, 18 (2008),
19–27.
57. Based on Lynn Gresham, “Best Buy
Puts Work-Life Balance on New
Axis,” Employee Benefit Advisor,
March 2007, 24–26; Michelle
Conlin, “Smashing the Clock,”
BusinessWeek, December 11, 2006,
60–68.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 143
26/06/10 4:05 PM
C H A P T E R
5
Human Resource
Planning and Retention
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Define HR planning and outline the HR planning process.
•
Describe the means for assessing the external and internal
workforce in HR planning.
•
Identify methods for forecasting HR supply and demand
levels.
•
Explain the nature of the psychological contract and how
motivation is linked to individual performance.
•
Describe different kinds of turnover and how turnover
can be measured.
•
Identify the six drivers of retention and ways retention
measurement can occur.
144
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 144
17/07/10 5:47 PM
HR Headline
Need More Workers?
A
(AP Photo/Toby Talbot)
s economic conditions have
changed negatively for many
organizations, they have had to
cut jobs and workers. One industry that
has made many reductions has been
the automotive industry. Yet, employers in some other industries have had a
continuing shortage of workers.
One illustration of such problems is
in the milk producing industry as well
as other agricultural employers. Many
U.S. individuals, even if they are unemployed, do not want to work in jobs
such as those in these industries, since
they have relatively low pay rates and
the working conditions tend to be outdoors or in warehouses. Therefore,
U.S. dairy farmers have had to use immigrants from Latin countries to fill
40% of their jobs, but the use of immigrants has created HR issues due to
state and federal laws regarding employment of illegal immigrants.
Employers in other industries also are needing workers. Some construction companies, health care organizations, and technology employers are facing shortages of qualified individuals. Attracting, recruiting,
and retaining good employees are crucial. For instance, Google, the large
technology employer, estimated that it could lose a significant number of
employees to technology competitors such as Facebook, Twitter, or new
firms. Whatever the industry, where more workers are needed, HR efforts
should be expanded.
Employers in different industries face staffing issues emphasizing HR
planning and retention. As industry and economic conditions continue to
change, planning and retention will only increase in importance.1
145
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 145
17/07/10 5:48 PM
146
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
Staffing an organization is an HR activity that is both strategic and operational in nature. As the HR Headline indicates, HR planning is important in a
wide variety of industries and firms. HR planning affects what employers do
when recruiting, selecting, and retaining people, and, of course these actions
affect organizational results and success.
The challenges caused by changing economic conditions during recent
years show why HR workforce planning should occur.2 A study by Watson
Wyatt that found that it does occur in more than 80% of organizations in
more than 30 countries. However, only one-fourth of smaller U.S.-based
companies had formal HR plans.3 Planning in small firms is more informal,
as shown below.
HUMAN RESOURCE PLANNING
Human resource planning is the process of analyzing and identifying the need
for and availability of human resources so that the organization can meet its
objectives. The focus of HR planning is to ensure the organization has the
right number of human resources, with the right capabilities, at the right
times, and in the right places. In HR planning, an organization must consider
the availability and allocation of people to jobs over long periods of time, not
just for the next month or even the next year.4
Additionally, as part of the analyses, HR plans can include several
approaches. Actions may include shifting employees to other jobs in the
organization, laying off employees or otherwise cutting back the number of
employees, retraining present employees, and/or increasing the number of
employees in certain areas. Factors to consider include the current employees’
knowledge, skills, and abilities and the expected vacancies resulting from
retirements, promotions, transfers, and discharges. To do this, HR planning
requires efforts by HR professionals working with executives and managers.
The HR Best Practices box illustrates how several firms have made HR planning important.
Organizational Size and HR Planning
Human resource
planning Process of
analyzing and identifying the
need for and availability of
human resources so that the
organization can meet its
objectives.
The need for HR planning in larger organizations is especially important.
For example, in a review, the U.S. government’s Corps of Engineers, with a
workforce of 35,000, was found to have an outdated strategic HR plan. Also,
it had not done an organization-wide needs analysis for current and future
workforce. If adjustments to foreseeable changes were not made, people or
even entire divisions could be working at cross-purposes with the rest of the
organization.5
An illustration of an effective HR planning emphasis can be seen in
Walgreens, the large retail drugstore chain. This firm has had an aggressive
business plan. Since each Walgreens store must be staffed with pharmacists,
managers, and customer service employees, the firm’s HR planning has
involved identifying how and where to find enough pharmacists to fill openings caused by turnover and retirement, as well as how to staff new stores.
Walgreens illustrates that part of HR planning is identifying the knowledge,
skills, and abilities (KSAs), as well as experience and other capabilities, for
current and future jobs.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 146
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
147
Human Resource Planning and Retention
HR best practices
Effective HR Planning for the
Workforce Future
Important HR functions in many organizations revolve
around staffing: recruiting, employing, and retaining
employees. More than half of the HR professionals in
a Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM)
survey identified efforts in those areas as the most
important HR activities in their firms. Forecasting the
need for employees and identifying how to retain them
are components of these functions. Several examples
illustrate their importance.
At Valero Energy, employee turnover was projected
to increase significantly over a 5-year period. This
forecast triggered an increase in HR planning. Within
2 years, Valero had established the means, linked to
its strategic HR planning, to build its workforce for an
additional 3 years.
Another firm that has used HR planning effectively
is Corning, Inc., a worldwide technology firm with
more than 25,000 employees. This firm used HR
planning globally to identify that hiring more engineers
in Taiwan instead of the United States would be better
and less expensive, given the pay levels and the supply
of potential U.S. engineering employees.
In a different industry, Chicago-based CNA Financial
identified that it would have an insufficient number
of underwriters in 2 years at its current turnover rate,
and that more than 80% of its safety engineers were
eligible to retire. To address these concerns, extensive
planning was undertaken for reducing turnover in
both occupations and identifying sources for possible
recruits. As a result, the turnover rates at CNA in both
groups dropped significantly, and relevant training and
development efforts were expanded.
These examples reinforce how HR planning
can help meet future workforce supply and demand
in terms of employees. Also, increasing employee
retention by reducing turnover can aid in enhancing
organizational performance and effective HR
management.6
Small Business HR Planning In a smaller business, even though the owner/
manager knows on a daily basis what is happening and what should be done,
planning is still important. One difficult area for HR planning in small businesses is family matters and succession. Particular difficulties arise when a
growing business is passed from one generation to another, resulting in a mix
of family and nonfamily employees.
Key to successful transition in a small business is having a clear HR plan.
In small businesses, such a plan includes incorporating key nonfamily members in HR planning efforts because nonfamily members may have important
capabilities and expertise that family members do not
possess. Planning for the attraction and retention of these
LOGGING ON
“outsiders” may be vital to the future success of smaller
Human Resource Planning
H
anning
organizations.
Society
S
Small businesses may use the HR planning process,
IInformation and resources
es on building
which is discussed next. But in very small organizations, too
a strategic HR plan are available at
often the process is much more intuitive and is done entirely
www.hrps.org.
by the top executives, who often are family members, which
may eliminate nonfamily members from the process.
HR Planning Process
The steps in the HR planning process are shown in Figure 5-1. Notice that the
process begins with considering the organizational strategic planning objectives.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 147
17/07/10 5:48 PM
148
SECTION 2
FIGURE 5-1
Jobs and labor
HR Planning Process
Review Organizational HR Strategic Plans
Assess External and Internal Workforce
External conditions and influences
Internal workforce capabilities and KSAs
Compile HR Planning Forecasts
Demands for human resources
Supply of human resources
Develop HR Staffing Plans and Actions
Employee retention and turnover utilization
Recruiting sources and means
Selection process and actions
Then the possible available workforce must be evaluated by identifying both
the external and internal workforce.
Once those assessments are complete, forecasts must be developed to identify both the demand for and supply of human resources. Management then
formulates HR staffing plans and actions to address imbalances, both shortterm and long-term. One means of developing and measuring HR planning
is use of a team of subject matter experts (SMEs) to increase the validity and
reliability of the HR planning results.7 Specific strategies may be developed to
fill vacancies or deal with surplus employees. For example, a strategy might
be to fill 50% of expected vacancies by training employees in lower-level jobs
and promoting them into more advanced anticipated openings.
Finally, HR plans are developed to provide specific direction for the
management of HR activities related to employee recruiting, selection, and
retention. The most telling evidence of successful HR planning is a consistent
alignment of the availabilities and capabilities of human resources with the
needs of the organization over shorter or longer periods of time.
ASSESSING THE EXTERNAL WORKFORCE
The first stage of HR planning is to examine organization objectives and plans.
If a network technology firm plans to double its number of client accounts
from 100 to 200 in a 3-year period, that firm also must identify how many
and what types of new employees will be needed to staff the expanded services,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 148
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
149
locations, and facilities. Several common external factors to be considered are
highlighted next.
Economic and Governmental Factors
The general cycles of economic recession and economic boom in different
businesses affect HR planning. Factors such as interest rates, inflation, and
economic decline or growth affect the availability of workers and should figure into organizational and HR plans and objectives. There is a considerable
difference between finding qualified applicants in a 4% unemployment market and in a 9% unemployment market. As the unemployment rate rises, the
number of qualified people looking for work increases, often making it easier
to fill some jobs. But those hired may receive lower pay and benefits than in
their previous jobs.
A broad array of government regulations affects the labor supply and
therefore HR planning. As a result, HR planning must be done by individuals
who understand the legal requirements of various government regulations. In
the United States and other countries, tax legislation at local, state, and federal
levels affects HR planning. Pension provisions and Social Security legislation
may change retirement patterns and funding options. Elimination or expansion of tax benefits for job-training expenses might alter some job-training
activities associated with workforce expansions. In summary, an organization
must consider a wide variety of government policies, regulations, and laws
during the HR planning process.
Competitive Evaluations
When making HR plans, employers must consider a number of geographic
and competitive concerns. The net migration into a particular region is important. For example, in the past decade, the populations of some U.S. cities in the
South, Southwest, and West have grown rapidly and have provided sources of
labor. However, areas in the Northeast and Midwest have experienced declining populations.
Direct competitors are another important external force in HR planning.
Failure to consider the competitive labor market and to offer pay scales and
benefits competitive with those of organizations in the same general industry
and geographic location may cost a company dearly in the long run.
Finally, the impact of international competition must be considered as part
of environmental scanning. Global competition for labor intensifies as global
competitors shift jobs and workers around the world, as illustrated by the
outsourcing of jobs from the United States to countries with cheaper labor.
Changing Workforce Considerations
As mentioned in the previous chapter, significant changes in the workforce,
both in the United States and globally, must be considered when doing
external assessments for HR planning. Shifts in the composition of the
workforce, combined with the use of different work patterns, have created
workplaces and organizations that are notably different from those of a
decade ago.
Many organizations face major concerns about having sufficient workers
with the necessary capabilities. When scanning the potential and future workforce, it is important to consider a number of variables, including:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 149
17/07/10 5:48 PM
150
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
•
•
•
•
•
Aging of the workforce
Growing diversity of workers
Female workers and work-life balancing concerns
Availability of contingent workers
Outsourcing possibilities
LOGGING ON
T Sloan Center on
The
n Aging
and Work
a
FFor research and resources
ces on
managing the talents of the various
generations in the workforce,
orce,
visit this site at
www.bc.edu/research/agingandwork.
When considering these factors, it is important to analyze
how they affect the current and future availability of workers with specific capabilities and experience. For instance,
in a number of industries, the median age of highly specialized professionals is over 50 years, and the supply
of potential replacements with adequate education and
experiences is not sufficient to replace such employees as
they retire. One global study found that less than 15% of
surveyed firms have planned for workforce shortages due
to the “brain drain” created by the retirement of existing
older workers.8
ASSESSING THE INTERNAL WORKFORCE
Analyzing the jobs that will need to be done and the capabilities of people who
are currently available in the organization to do them is the next part of HR
planning. The needs of the organization must be compared against the labor
supply available both inside and outside the organization.
Current and Future Jobs Audit
The starting point for evaluating internal workforce strengths and weaknesses is an audit of the jobs being done in the organization. A comprehensive
analysis of all current jobs provides a basis for forecasting what jobs will need
to be done in the future. Much of the data in the audit should be available
from existing staffing and organizational databases. The following questions
may be some key ones addressed during the internal assessment:
•
•
•
•
•
•
What jobs exist now and how essential is each job?
How many individuals are performing each job?
What are the reporting relationships of jobs?
What are the vital KSAs needed in the jobs?
What jobs will be needed to implement future organizational strategies?
What are the characteristics of those anticipated jobs?
Employee and Organizational Capabilities Inventory
As HR planners gain an understanding of the current and future jobs that will
be necessary to carry out organizational plans, they can conduct a detailed
audit of current employees and their capabilities. The basic source of data on
employees is available in the HR records in the organization. The HR Online
illustrates the growth of technology in obtaining such data.
An inventory of organizational skills and capabilities may consider a number of elements. The following ones are important:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 150
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
151
Human Resource Planning and Retention
Technology Expanding
Employee Skills Databases
Both employers and employees are using the expansion
of technology as part of workforce-related factors.
Technological systems and software related to HR planning
and talent management are growing about 15% a year.
Some examples of the uses of such technology follow.
For employees, dramatic growth in information
technology (IT) methods is occurring. Aon Corporation
surveyed 800 employees using Web 2.0 social media.
The study found that more than two-thirds of both
younger and older workers were using technology
for job-related purposes. Aon recommended that
employees use technology means such as textmessaging, blogs, wikis, and twitters to identify and
enhance their skills and productivity.
Skills databases are an increasingly popular tool
being used to track employee talent. The concept is
simple: Put employees’ skills and technical expertise,
prior jobs, training, coaching aptitude, certifications,
geographical experience, languages, career aspirations,
and other topics in a database, and then use analyses of
•
•
•
HR online
this information as part of HR forecasting for individual
capabilities. These databases also can be evaluated to
fill jobs or can be analyzed to identify strengths and
weaknesses of a division or even the whole company.
Some systems rely on managers to enter and update
employee information in the database, but managers
sometimes fail to do so or withhold information,
fearing they might lose their most skilled employees
to someone else in the company. Other approaches
request employees to enter their skills and proficiency
levels, and then managers review the reports. However,
employees, because of either personal confidentiality
concerns or being overworked, may not always enter
their skills data accurately.
In spite of such difficulties, obtaining and utilizing
IT data on employees’ skills can aid both managers
and employees in HR planning and forecasting. Then
using those HR plans and forecasts may enhance the
identification, engagement, and retention of both
existing workers and potential employees.9
Individual employee demographics (age, length of service in the
organization, time in present job)
Individual career progression (jobs held, time in each job, education and
training levels, promotions or other job changes, pay rates)
Individual performance data (work accomplishment, growth in skills,
working relationships)
All the details on an individual employee’s skills that go into a databank may
affect that person’s career. Therefore, the data and their use must meet the same
standards of job-relatedness and nondiscrimination as those met when the
employee was initially hired. Furthermore, security measures must ensure that
sensitive information is available only to those who have a specific use for it.
Managers and HR staff members can gather data on individual employees
and aggregate details into a profile of the current organizational workforce.
This profile may reveal many of the current strengths and deficiencies of
people in the organization. For instance, a skills mismatch may be identified in
which some workers are either overqualified or underqualified for their jobs.10
The profile also may highlight potential future problems. For example, if some
specialized expertise, such as advanced technical skills, is absent in many
workers, the organization may find it difficult to take advantage of its changing technological developments; or if a large group of experienced employees
are all in the same age bracket, their eventual retirements about the same time
might lead to future “gaps” in the organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 151
17/07/10 5:48 PM
152
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
FORECASTING HR SUPPLY AND DEMAND
The information gathered from scanning the external environment and
assessing internal strengths and weaknesses is used to predict HR supply and
demand in light of organizational objectives and strategies. Forecasting uses
information from the past and the present to identify expected future conditions. Projections for the future are, of course, subject to error. Fortunately,
experienced people usually are able to forecast with enough accuracy to positively affect long-range organizational planning.
Forecasting Using information from the past and the
present to identify expected
future conditions.
Forecasting Methods and Periods
Forecasting methods may be either judgmental or mathematical, as Figure 5-2
shows. Methods for forecasting human resources range from a manager’s best
FIGURE 5-2
HR Forecasting Example Methods
Judgmental Methods
Estimates can be either top-down or bottom-up, but essentially people who are in a position to
know are asked, “How many people will you need next year?”
The rule of thumb method relies on general guidelines applied to a specific situation within the
organization. For example, a guideline of “one operations manager per five reporting supervisors”
aids in forecasting the number of supervisors needed in a division. However, it is important to
adapt the guideline to recognize widely varying departmental needs.
The Delphi technique uses input from a group of experts whose opinions of forecasted situations
are sought. These expert opinions are then combined and returned to the experts for a second
anonymous opinion. The process continues through several rounds until the experts essentially
agree on a judgment. For example, this approach is used to forecast effects of technology on HR
management and staffing needs.
Nominal groups, unlike the Delphi method, require experts to meet face to face. Their ideas may
be cited independently at first, discussed as a group, and then compiled as a report.
Mathematical Methods
Statistical regression analysis makes a statistical comparison of past relationships among
various factors. For example, a statistical relationship between gross sales and number of
employees in a retail chain may be useful in forecasting the number of employees that will be
needed if the retailer’s sales increase 15% or decrease 10%.
Simulation models are representations of real situations in abstract form. For example, an
econometric model of the growth in software usage would lead to forecasts of the need for
software developers. Numerous simulation methods and techniques are available.
Productivity ratios calculate the average number of units produced per employee. These
averages can be applied to sales forecasts to determine the number of employees needed. For
example, a firm could forecast the number of needed sales representatives using these ratios.
Staffing ratios can be used to estimate indirect labor. For example, if the company usually uses
one clerical person for every 25 production employees, that ratio can be used to estimate the
need for clerical employees.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 152
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
153
guess to a rigorous and complex computer simulation. Despite the availability
of sophisticated judgmental and mathematical models and techniques, forecasting is still a combination of quantitative methods and subjective judgment.
The facts must be evaluated and weighed by knowledgeable individuals, such
as managers or HR planners, who use the mathematical models as tools and
make judgments to arrive at decisions.
HR forecasting should be done over three planning periods: short
range, intermediate range, and long range. The most commonly used planning period of six months to one year focuses on short-range forecasts for
the immediate HR needs of an organization. Intermediate- and long-range
forecasting are much more difficult processes. Intermediate-range plans usually project one to three years into the future, and long-range plans extend
beyond three years.
Forecasting the Demand for Human Resources
The demand for employees can be calculated for an entire organization and/
or for individual units in the organization. For example, a forecast might indicate that a firm needs 125 new employees next year, or that it needs 25 new
people in sales and customer service, 45 in production, 20 in accounting and
information systems, 2 in HR, and 33 in the warehouse. The unit breakdown
obviously allows HR planners to better pinpoint the specific skills needed than
does the aggregate method.
Demand for human resources can be forecast by considering specific openings that are likely to occur. The openings (or demands) are created when new
jobs are being created or current jobs are being reduced. Additionally, forecasts
must consider when employees leave positions because of promotions, transfers, turnovers, and terminations.
An analysis is used to develop decision rules (or “fill rates”) for each job or
level. For example, a decision rule for a financial institution might state that
50% of branch supervisor openings will be filled through promotions from
customer service tellers, 25% through promotions from personal bankers, and
25% from new hires. Forecasters must be aware of multiple effects throughout
the organization, because as people are promoted from within, their previous
positions become available. Continuing the example, forecasts for the need for
customer service tellers and personal bankers would also have to be developed.
The overall purpose of the forecast is to identify the needs for human resources
by number and type for the forecasting period.
Forecasting the Supply of Human Resources
Once human resources needs have been forecast, then availability of qualified
individuals must be identified. Forecasting availability considers both external
and internal supplies. Although the internal supply may be somewhat easier
to calculate, it is important to calculate the external supply as accurately as
possible.
External Supply The external supply of potential employees available to
the organization needs to be identified. Extensive use of government estimates of labor force populations, trends in the industry, and many more
complex and interrelated factors must be considered. Such information is
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 153
17/07/10 5:48 PM
154
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
often available from state or regional economic development offices, including these items:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Net migration into and out of the area
Individuals entering and leaving the workforce
Individuals graduating from schools and colleges
Changing workforce composition and patterns
Economic forecasts for the next few years
Technological developments and shifts
Actions of competing employers
Government regulations and pressures
Circumstances affecting persons entering and leaving the workforce
Internal Supply Figure 5-3 shows in general terms how the internal supply can be calculated for a specific employer. Estimating internal supply
considers the number of external hires and the employees who move from
their current jobs into others through promotions, lateral moves, and terminations. It also considers that the internal supply is influenced by training
and development programs, transfer and promotion policies, and retirement
policies, among other factors. In forecasting the internal supply, data from
the replacement charts and succession planning efforts are used to project
potential personnel changes, identify possible backup candidates, and keep
track of attrition (resignations, retirements, etc.) for each department in an
organization.
FIGURE 5-3
Estimating Internal Labor Supply for a Given Unit
Current
Staffing
Level
⫺
Projected
Outflows
This Year
Source of
Inflows
⫹
Projected
Inflows
This Year
⫽
Internal
Supply for
Next Year
Source of
Outflows
The Unit
External hires
Internal transfers
Promotions
Recalls
Employees In
Promotions
Turnover
Terminations
Demotions
Retirements
Deaths
Layoffs
Current
Staffing Level
Employees Out
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 154
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
155
INDIVIDUAL WORKERS AND ORGANIZATIONAL
RELATIONSHIPS
Relationships between individuals and their employers can vary widely from
favorable to unfavorable. The individual’s performance is a major part of why
the employer wants the individual to stay or go. Competent employees who
are satisfied with their employers, who know what is expected, and who have
reduced turnover potential are assets to the organization. But just as individuals in an organization can be a competitive advantage, they can also be
a liability. When few employees are satisfied with their jobs, when people are
constantly leaving, and when the employees who do remain work ineffectively,
the organization faces a competitive disadvantage.
Understanding the relationships between individuals and organizations is
more than just academically interesting. The economic health of most organizations depends on the efforts of employes with the ability and motivation
to do their jobs well. The exchanges in the relationship between an employee
and an employer affect both of them.11 Two considerations in these relationships include the psychological contract and motivation, which can help with
understanding employee retention.
Psychological Contract
A concept that has been useful in discussing individuals’ relationships with
their employers is that of a psychological contract, which refers to the unwritten expectations employees and employers have about the nature of their work
relationships. The psychological contract can create either a positive or negative relationship between an employer and an individual. It is based on trust
and commitment that leads to meeting both the employer’s and employee’s
expectations and needs.12
Unwritten psychological contracts between employers and employees
encompass expectations about both tangible items (e.g., wages, benefits,
employee productivity, and attendance) and intangible items (e.g., loyalty, fair
treatment, and job security). Employers may attempt to detail their expectations through handbooks and policy manuals, but those materials are only
part of the total “contractual” relationship.
Psychological contract
The unwritten expectations
employees and employers
have about the nature of their
work relationships.
The Changing Psychological Contract Traditionally, employees expected
to exchange their efforts and capabilities for secure jobs that offered
competitive pay, a solid range of benefits, and career progression within an
organization, among other factors. But as some organizations have changed
in economic terms, they have had to address various organizational crises by
downsizing and eliminating workers who had given long and loyal service.
Consequently, in these firms, a growing number of remaining employees
are questioning whether they should remain loyal to and stay with their
employers.
When individuals feel that they have some control and perceived rights
in the organization, they are more likely to be committed to the organization
and utilize their knowledge, skills, and abilities to accomplish performance
results.13 A psychological contract recognizes the following components:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 155
17/07/10 5:48 PM
156
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
Employers Provide
Employees Contribute
• Competitive compensation
• Continuous skill improvement
and benefits
and increased productivity
• Flexibility to balance work
• Reasonable time with the
and home life
organization
• Career development
• Extra efforts and results when
opportunities
needed
Psychological contracts can be strengthened and employee commitment
enhanced when the organization is involved in a cause the employee values
highly. Conversely, psychological contracts can be violated, not only in reaction
to personal mistreatment, but from a perception that the organization has abandoned an important principle or cause. For instance, when unethical or illegal
behavior of upper management occurs, the psychological contract is violated.
Thus, employees may feel anger, distrust, reduced loyalty and commitment,
and increased willingness to leave. Also, social exchange relationships in organizations can be affected by psychological contract breaches and violations.14
G L O B A L
Global Psychological Contract Concerns With many organizations
having global operations, the psychological contract becomes more complicated. Employees in foreign countries and expatriate employees from the
United States have varying psychological contract expectations. For expatriates, if the organizational expectations are not made clear prior to their relocation, more of them will be likely to quit within the first year or demand return
to their home country.15
An additional concern for multinational firms is to meet the psychological contract expectations of individuals in different cultures and countries.
Consider the number of jobs that have been shifted from the United States and
Europe to China, India, Romania, Mexico, the Philippines, Brazil, and other
countries with different global factors. Being aware of varying psychological
contract issues with foreign employees is important if global HR efforts are
to be successful.
Individual Employee Performance and Motivation
The idea of a psychological contract between the individual employee and the
organization helps clarify why people might stay or leave a job. But for an
employer to want to keep an employee, that person must be performing well.
The HR unit in an organization exists in part to provide ways to analyze and
address the performance and motivation of individual employees.
Individual Performance Factors The three major factors that affect how a
given individual performs are illustrated in Figure 5-4. They are: (1) individual
ability to do the work, (2) effort expended, and (3) organizational support.
The relationship of those factors is widely acknowledged in management
literature as follows:
Performance (P) = Ability (A) × Effort (E) × Support (S)
Individual performance is enhanced to the degree that all three components are
present with an individual employee, and diminished if any of these factors is
reduced or absent. For instance, if several production workers have the abilities to
do their jobs and work hard, but the organization provides outmoded equipment
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 156
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
157
Human Resource Planning and Retention
FIGURE 5-4
Components of Individual Performance
Effort Expended
Motivation
Work ethic
Attendance/turnover
Job design
Individual Performance
(including quantity and
quality)
Individual Ability
Talents
Interests
Personality characteristics
Organizational Support
Training and development
Equipment and technology
Performance standards
Management and coworkers
or the management style of supervisors causes negative reactions by the workers,
the lack of organizational support may reduce individual performance.
An example of how this performance equation can work in a positive way is
seen in the link between individual motivation and organizational support in the
form of coworkers. Studies have shown that the motivation of poor-performing
employees can be improved when these employees work more intensely with
a group of better-performing workers. The link between individual motivation
and organizational support has important HR management implications.16
Motivation The desire
within a person causing that
person to act.
Individual Motivation and Management Implications The desire
within a person causing that person to act is called motivation. People usually
act to reach a goal, which means that motivation is a goal-directed drive that
seldom occurs in a void. The words need, want, desire, and drive are all similar
to motive, from which the word motivation is derived. Approaches to understanding motivation vary because different theorists have developed their own
views and models.17 Each approach has contributed to the understanding of
human motivation, and details on different approaches can be found in various organizational behavior textbooks.
Motivation is complex and individualized, and managerial strategies and
tactics must be broad-based to address the motivation concerns of individuals
at work. Factors that can inhibit motivation and work performance include a
worker’s capacities and determination to get work done regardless of difficulties.18 For instance, with a poor-performing employee, managers must determine whether inadequate individual behavior is due to employee deficiencies,
inconsistent reward policies, or low desire for the rewards offered.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 157
17/07/10 5:48 PM
158
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
By having supportive supervisors and managers who serve as mentors, concerns about motivations can be better addressed with employees.19
Understanding motivation is important because employee engagement can
affect both performance and retention. Fostering motivation can improve performance and can reduce turnover.
Many organizations spend a considerable amount of money to “motivate”
their employees, using a wide range of tactics. For example, some firms hire
motivational speakers to inspire employees, and “motivational coaches” command fees of up to $50,000 a speech. Other employers give employees items
such as T-shirts, mugs, or books as motivators. However, such efforts may or
may not be effective in improving employees’ job satisfaction and loyalty.
Many employees rely on the unspoken psychological contract, and their
hope that the employer will honor this “agreement” affects their job satisfaction
and motivation. One survey found that 45% of the surveyed workers indicated
that personal job satisfaction was their main motivation for job performance.20
Nature of Job Satisfaction
Job satisfaction A positive
emotional state resulting
from evaluating one’s job
experiences.
Attitude survey A survey
that focuses on employees’
feelings and beliefs about
their jobs and the organization.
Organizational
commitment The degree
to which employees believe
in and accept organizational
goals and desire to remain
with the organization.
In its most basic sense, job satisfaction is a positive emotional state resulting
from evaluating one’s job experiences. Job dissatisfaction occurs when one’s
expectations are not met. For example, if an employee expects clean and safe
working conditions, that employee is likely to be dissatisfied if the workplace
is dirty and dangerous.
Dimensions of job satisfaction frequently mentioned include worker relationships, pay and benefits, performance recognition, and communications
with managers and executives. Sometimes job satisfaction is called morale,
which appears to have declined somewhat in recent years in some firms due
to economic factors and changes in the elements of the employee-employer
relationship. Frequently cited reasons for decline in morale include more
demanding and stressful work, fewer relationships with management, and less
confidence in compensation and other rewards.21 Depending on the job, the
work-life balancing mentioned earlier also can lead to either positive or negative effects in workers’ job satisfaction.22
One way employers address job satisfaction, and ultimately retention, is
by regularly surveying employees. One specific type of survey used by many
organizations is an attitude survey, which focuses on employees’ feelings and
beliefs about their jobs and the organization. Once the survey results are
compiled, management responds to the results. If the employer takes responsive actions, employees may view the employer more positively; however, if
management ignores the survey results, their inaction can lead to less employee
job satisfaction.23
Organizational Commitment and Job Satisfaction The degree to which
employees believe in and accept organizational goals and want to remain with
the organization is called organizational commitment. Job satisfaction influences organizational commitment, which in turn affects employee retention
and turnover. As Figure 5-5 depicts, the interaction of the individual and the
job determines levels of job satisfaction and organizational commitment.
Engagement and Loyalty A related idea is employee engagement, which is
the extent to which an employee feels linked to organizational success. Surveys
have shown that levels of employee engagement range from 15% to 45% for
highly engaged workers, and 5% to 20% for disengaged ones.24
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 158
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
159
Human Resource Planning and Retention
FIGURE 5-5
Factors Affecting Job Satisfaction and Organizational Commitment
Ability
The Individual
Motivation
Support
The Job
Design
Job elements
Job Satisfaction/
Dissatisfaction
Organizational
Commitment
Retention/
Turnover
Engaged employees may be seen as “loyal” employees who are more than
just satisfied with their jobs; they are pleased with the relationships with their
employers. In changing labor markets, employers find that turnover of key
people occurs more frequently when employee loyalty is low. For example, the
Federal Office of Personnel Management has used engagement efforts with
retirement-eligible employees to defer their departures, which reduces turnover.25 Excessive turnover makes clear the importance of having an engaged
and committed workforce.
A logical extension of organizational engagement focuses more specifically
on continuance commitment factors. These are the factors that influence decisions to remain with or leave an organization, and ultimately they are reflected
in employee retention and turnover statistics. The relationships among satisfaction, commitment, and turnover have been affirmed
across cultures, full- and part-time workers, genders, and
LOGGING ON
occupations. Organizational engagement and commitment
can be seen as essential in retaining employees in organizaLoyalty Research Center
L
nter
tions. Individuals who are not as satisfied with their jobs
TThis research center provides
ovides employee
or who are not as committed to the organization are more
lloyalty/employee engagement
ement research
likely to withdraw from the organization. Understanding
and consulting services. Visit their site
at www.loyaltyresearch.com.
h.com.
engagement and commitment in relation to turnover is one
facet of retention efforts for managers.
EMPLOYEE TURNOVER
Turnover The process in
which employees leave an
organization and have to be
replaced.
Turnover occurs when employees leave an organization and have to be replaced.
Many organizations have found that turnover is a costly problem. For instance,
health care firms experienced over 30% turnover annually in one state. Just in
registered nurse jobs, the turnover cost in the state was more than $125 million per year, with individual nurse turnover costs being $32,000 per person.26
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 159
17/07/10 5:48 PM
160
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
The extent to which employers face high turnover rates and costs varies by
organization and industry. For higher-level executives and professionals, turnover costs can run as much as two times the departing employees’ annual salaries, and rates often are linked to executive job expectations and needed skills
changes.27 In many service industries, the turnover rates and costs are frequently
very high. In the retail industry, turnover in some companies averages more
than 100% a year for part-time workers and around 75% a year for full-time
workers. The U.S. supermarkets, fast-food restaurants, and other retail service
industry firms spend billions of dollars each year to deal with worker turnover.
Types of Employee Turnover
Turnover is classified in a number of ways. One classification uses the following
categories, although the two types are not mutually exclusive:
• Involuntary Turnover
• Voluntary Turnover
Employees are terminated for poor
performance or work rule violations
Employees leave by choice
Involuntary turnover is triggered at all levels by employers terminating
workers due to organizational policies and work rule violations, excessive
absenteeism, performance standards that are not met by employees, and
other issues. Voluntary turnover too can be caused by many factors, some
of which are not employer controlled. Common voluntary turnover causes
include job dissatisfaction, pay and benefits levels, supervision, geography,
and personal/family reasons. Career opportunities in other firms, when
employees receive unsolicited contacts, may lead to turnover for individuals,
especially those in highly specialized jobs such as IT.28 Voluntary turnover
may increase with the size of the organization, most likely because larger
firms are less effective in preventing turnover and have more employees who
are inclined to move.
Another view of turnover classifies it based on whether it is good or bad
for the organization:
• Functional Turnover
• Dysfunctional Turnover
Lower-performing or disruptive
Key individuals and high performers
employees leave
leave at critical times
Not all turnover is negative for organizations; on the contrary, functional turnover represents a positive change. Some workforce losses are desirable, especially if those who leave are lower-performing, less reliable, and/or disruptive
individuals.29 Of course, dysfunctional turnover also occurs. That happens
when key individuals leave, often at crucial times. For example, a software
project leader who leaves in the middle of a system upgrade in order to take a
promotion at another firm could cause the system upgrade timeline to slip due
to the difficulty of replacing the employee and could also lead other software
specialists in the firm to seek out and accept jobs at competitive firms.
Employees quit for many reasons, only some of which can be controlled by
the organization, so another classification uses the following terms to describe
types of turnover:
• Uncontrollable Turnover
Employees leave for reasons
outside the control of the
employer
• Controllable Turnover
Employees leave for reasons
that could be influenced by the
employer
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 160
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
161
Human Resource Planning and Retention
Some examples of reasons for turnover the employer cannot control include:
(1) the employee moves out of the geographic area, (2) the employee decides
to stay home with young children or an elder relative, (3) the employee’s
spouse is transferred, and (4) the employee is a student worker who graduates
from college. Even though some turnover is inevitable, employers recognize
that reducing turnover saves money, and that they must address the turnover
that is controllable. Organizations are better able to keep employees if they
deal with the concerns of those employees that might lead to the controllable
turnover.
Turnover and “Churn” Hiring new workers while laying off others is
called churn. This practice raises a paradox in which employers complain
about not being able to find skilled workers while they are laying off others.
As organizations face economic and financial problems that result in layoffs,
the remaining employees are more likely to consider jobs at other firms.30 In
this situation, turnover is more likely to occur, and efforts are needed to keep
existing employees. HR actions such as information sharing, opportunities
for more training/learning, and emphasis on job significance can be helpful in
lowering turnover intentions of individuals.31
Measuring Employee Turnover
The U.S. Department of Labor estimates that the cost of replacing an employee
ranges from one-half to five times the person’s annual salary.32 The turnover
rate for an organization can be computed as a monthly or yearly cost. The following formula, in which separations means departures from the organization,
is widely used:
Number of employee separations during the year
Total number of employees at midyear
× 100
Common turnover rates range from almost 0% to more than 100% a year
and vary among industries. As a part of HR management systems, turnover
data can be gathered and analyzed in a number of different ways, including
the following categories:
•
•
•
•
Churn Hiring new workers
while laying off others.
Job and job level
Department, unit, and location
Reason for leaving
Length of service
•
•
•
•
Demographic characteristics
Education and training
Knowledge, skills, and abilities
Performance ratings/levels
Two examples illustrate why detailed analyses of turnover are important.
A manufacturing organization had a companywide turnover rate that was
not severe, but 80% of the turnover occurred within one department. That
imbalance indicated that some specific actions on training supervisors and
revising pay levels were needed to resolve problems in that unit. In a different
organization, a global shipping/delivery firm found ways to reduce turnover
of sales and service employees. The actions of that firm reduced its turnover
29%, which contributed to an annual savings of more than $18 million in
direct and indirect costs.33 In both of these examples, the targeted turnover
rates declined as a result of employer actions taken in response to the turnover
analyses that were done.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 161
17/07/10 5:48 PM
162
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
Model for Costing Lost Productivity
FIGURE 5-6
Job Title: ______________________
A.
B.
C.
D.
Typical annual pay for this job
Percentage of pay for benefits multiplied by annual pay
Total employee annual cost (add A ⴙ B)
Number of employees who voluntarily quit the job in the past
12 months
E. Number of months it takes for 1 employee to become fully productive
F. Per person turnover cost (multiply [E ⴜ 12] ⴛ C ⴛ 50%*)
G. Annual turnover cost for this job (multiply F ⴛ D)
__________
__________
__________
__________
__________
__________
__________
*Assumes 50% productivity throughout the learning period (E).
HR Metrics: Determining Turnover Costs
M E A S U R E
A major step in reducing the expense of turnover is to decide how the organization is going to record employee departures and what calculations are
necessary to maintain and benchmark the turnover rates. Determining turnover costs can be relatively simple or very complex, depending on the nature
of the efforts made and the data used.
Figure 5-6 shows a model for calculating the cost of productivity lost to
turnover. If a job pays (A) $20,000 and benefits cost (B) 40%, then the total
annual cost for one employee (C) is $28,000. Assuming that 20 employees have quit in the previous year (D) and that it takes three months for 1
employee to be fully productive (E), the calculation results in a per person
turnover cost (F) of $3,500. Overall, the annual lost productivity (G) would
be $70,000 for the 20 individuals who have left. In spite of the conservative
and simple nature of this model, it easily makes the point that turnover is
costly. As another example, if 150 tellers in a large bank corporation leave in
a year, calculations done according to this model produce turnover costs of
more than $500,000 a year.
Detailing Turnover Costing Other areas to be included in calculating
detailed turnover costs are also available.34 Some of the most common areas
considered include the following:
•
•
•
Separation costs: HR staff and supervisory time, pay rates to prevent
separations, exit interview time, unemployment expenses, legal fees for
separations challenged, accrued vacation expenditures, continued health
benefits, and others
Vacancy costs: Temporary help, contract and consulting firm usage,
existing employee overtime, and other costs until the person is replaced
Replacement costs: Recruiting and advertising expenses, search fees,
HR interviewer and staff time and salaries, employee referral fees,
relocation and moving costs, supervisor and managerial time and salaries,
employment testing costs, reference checking fees, preemployment
medical expenses, relocation costs, and others
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 162
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
•
•
163
Training costs: Paid orientation time, training staff time and pay, costs of
training materials, supervisor and manager time and salaries, coworker
“coaching” time and pay, and others
Hidden/indirect costs: Costs that are not obvious, such as reduced
productivity, decreased customer service, additional unexpected employee
turnover, missed project deadlines, and others
These turnover metrics illustrate that turnover is a crucial HR and managerial
issue that must be constantly evaluated and addressed.
Not all turnover is negative. Turnover of low performers should be considered positive. There may be an “optiLOGGING ON
mal” amount of useful turnover in order to replace low
TalentKeepers
T
performers and add part-time or contract workers with
FFor Web-based employee
e
special capabilities to enhance workforce performance.35
rretention solutions, visit
HR professionals should take actions to reduce negative
www.talentkeepers.com.
m.
turnover and to address the retention of key employees.
RETENTION OF HUMAN RESOURCES
Retention of employees as human resources is part of HR staffing and planning efforts. Turnover, as the opposite of retention, often has been seen as a
routine HR matter requiring records and reports. However, what was once
a bothersome detail has become a substantial HR issue for many employers.
Thus, organizations are being forced to study why employees leave and why
they stay. Sometimes an individual in the HR area is assigned to specifically
focus on retention to ensure that it receives high priority.
Myths and Realities about Retention
Keeping good employees is a challenge that all organizations share and that
becomes even more difficult as labor markets change. Unfortunately, some
myths have arisen about what it takes to retain employees. Some of the most
prevalent myths and realities are as follows:
1. Money is the main reason people leave. Money certainly is a vital HR
tool, and if people feel they are being paid inadequately, they may be
more likely to leave. But if they are paid close to the competitive level
they expect, other parts of the job become more important.
2. Hiring has little to do with retention. This is not true. Recruiting and
selecting the people who fit the jobs and who are less likely to leave
in the first place, and then orienting them to the company, can greatly
increase retention. It is important to select for retention.
3. If you train people, you are only training them for another employer.
Developing skills in employees may indeed make them more
marketable, but it also tends to improve retention. When an employer
provides employees with training and development assistance, job
satisfaction may increase and employees are more likely to stay,
particularly if they see more future opportunities internally.
4. Do not be concerned about retention during organizational change.
That is exactly the time to worry about retention. Although some
people’s jobs may have to be cut because of economic organizational
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 163
17/07/10 5:48 PM
164
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
factors, the remaining employees that the company would like to keep
may have the most opportunity and reason to leave voluntarily. For
example, during a merger or acquisition, most workers are concerned
about job security and their employer’s future. If they do not feel a
part of the new organization early on, many may leave or evaluate
alternatives.
5. If solid performers want to leave, the company cannot hold them.
Employees are best viewed as “free agents,” who indeed can leave when
they want. The key to keeping solidly performing employees is to create
an environment in which they want to stay and grow.
Drivers of Retention
Because both people and jobs are so varied, managers and HR professionals need to realize that individuals may remain or leave their employment
for both job-related and personal reasons. For instance, if employees choose
to leave an organization for family reasons (e.g., because a spouse is transferring or to raise children), there may be a limited number of actions the
employer can take to keep them on the job. However, there are significant
actions that an employer can take to retain employees in many other circumstances. Figure 5-7 illustrates some of these “drivers” of retention, or areas
in which employers can take action to strengthen the possibility of keeping
employees.
The actual reasons that people stay or leave vary according to job groupings, industry and organizational issues, geographical global aspects, and other
factors. For instance, a survey of executives by Robert Half International
found that the most common factors that caused satisfactory employees to
quit their jobs were unhappiness with management, limited career advancements and recognition, insufficient pay and benefits, and job boredom.36 This
survey illustrates that many of the factors involved in retention drivers are
organizational and management factors within the employer’s control.
FIGURE 5-7
Drivers of Retention
Organizational and
Management Factors
Employee-Supervisor
Relationships
Job and Work-Life
Rewards: Compensation,
Benefits, and Performance
Retention
Career Training and
Development
Employer Policies
and Practices
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 164
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
165
Organizational and Management Factors A number of organizational/
management factors influence individuals in their decisions to stay with or
leave their employers. Organizations that have clearly established goals and
hold managers and employees accountable for accomplishing results are
viewed as better places to work, especially by individuals wishing to progress
both financially and career-wise. Further, effective management provides the
resources necessary for employees to perform their jobs well.37 These factors
reflect workplace commitment by employees, which leads to more positive
organizational views in the industry and communities.
Other organizational components that affect employee retention are related
to the management of the organization. Some organizations see external events
as threatening, whereas others see changes as challenges requiring responses.38
The latter approach can be a source of competitive advantage, especially if an
organization is in a growing, dynamic industry. Another organizational factor
that can affect employee job performance and potential turnover intentions
is “organizational politics.”39 This can include managerial favoritism, having
to be involved in undesirable activities, taking credit for what others do, and
other actions that occur in many departments and organizational settings.
A final factor affecting how employees view their organizations is the
quality of organizational leadership. Often, leaders have an identified strategic
plan that guides how the firm responds to changes. If a firm is not effectively
managed, then employees may be disappointed by the ineffective responses
and inefficiencies they deal with in their jobs. A survey of 700 workers identified that “bad bosses” who do not give employees recognition for accomplishments or who fail to keep promises can lead to almost 40% of the workers
being dissatisfied and more likely to look for other jobs.40
Work Relationships Work relationships that affect employee retention
include supervisory/management support and coworker relations. A supervisor or manager builds positive relationships and aids retention by being fair
and nondiscriminatory, allowing work flexibility and work-family balancing, giving feedback that recognizes employee efforts and performance, and
supporting career planning and development.
Additionally, many individuals build close relationships with coworkers.
Such work-related friendships do not appear on employee records, but these
relationships can be an important signal that a workplace is positive. Overall,
what this means is that it is not just where people work, but also with whom
they work, that affects employee retention. If individuals are not linked with
or do not relate well to their coworkers, there is greater likelihood for turnover
to occur.41
Job and Work-Life Many individuals have seen a decline in job security during the past decade. All the downsizings, layoffs, mergers and acquisitions, and
organizational restructurings have affected employee loyalty and retention.
As coworkers experience layoffs and job reductions, the anxiety levels of the
remaining employees rise. Consequently, employees start thinking about leaving before they too get cut. Organizations in which job continuity and security
are high tend to have higher retention rates.
Some jobs are considered “good” and others are thought to be “bad,”
but not all people agree on which jobs are which. As mentioned previously,
the design of jobs and peoples’ preferences can vary significantly. Job design
factors that can impact retention include the following:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 165
17/07/10 5:48 PM
166
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
HR perspective
Global Retention
The same core elements that affect retention in the
United States are important across the globe according
to a McKinsey Global Institute study. Higher turnover
and lower retention rates can be seen among expatriate
employees working outside their home countries. Also,
repatriating those who have been overseas only to return
to less-than-ideal situations later in the United States is
another source of international retention difficulties.42
Retention can also be a challenge in countries
where national workers staff the firms. India with its
large global economic market illustrates what kinds
of difficulties can occur. Estimates are that service
industries in India will encounter a shortfall in one
year of 500,000 employees who are qualified for jobs
in those industries, which include financial services,
information technology, and retail, among others.
•
•
•
•
One would think that given the large Indian
population, recruitment and retention would not be
problems. But the need for individuals with special
skills in cities such as Mumbai, Delhi, and others is
creating major issues. Firms are giving 12% to 15%
yearly pay increases to many key workers in order to
retain them; in addition, they are using both yearly and
longer-term incentives for more senior-level employees.
The retention situation in India is expected
to expand to other countries as global economic
conditions improve and change, and the global market
continues to grow. For instance, a survey of 32,000
employers in 26 countries indicated that almost onethird of them would have hired more professional
staff members if they had been available. So, global
attraction and retention are growing HR concerns.43
A knowledge, skills, and abilities mismatch, either through
overqualification or underqualification, can lead to turnover.
Job accomplishments and workload demands that are dissatisfying or
stressful may impact performance and lead to turnover.
Both timing of work schedules and geographic locations may contribute
to burnout of some individuals but not others.
The ability of employees to balance work and life requirements affects
their job performance and retention.
Numerous examples could be given on how each of these items affect retention, but one example comes from a survey of chief financial officers on the
impact of these issues in their firms. In this survey, work-life flexibility efforts
were seen as creating significant retention, recruitment, and productivity
results.44 This study illustrates that how organizations address jobs can drive
retention efforts, including global retention as discussed in the HR Perspective.
Rewards: Compensation, Benefits, and Performance The tangible
rewards that people receive for working come in the form of pay, incentives,
and benefits. Employees often cite better pay or benefits as the reason for
leaving one employer for another. Employers do best if they offer competitive
pay and benefits, which means they must be close to what other employers
are providing and what individuals believe to be consistent with their capabilities, experience, and performance. If compensation is not close, often defined
as within 10% to 15% of the “market” rate, turnover is likely to be higher.
However, the reality of compensation is a bit more complex than it seems
at first glance. For instance, one study of public-sector employees identified
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 166
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
Human Resource Planning and Retention
167
that broad reward programs, not just pay and benefits, aided with workforce
retention in difficult economic situations.45 A number of employers have used
a wide range of special benefits and perks to attract and retain employees.
For example, Student Media Group in Delaware added work-related plasma
television screens, videogame players, and free soda and snacks as part of
a special rewards package to create more positive views to aid in retaining
employees.46
Another part of rewards generally is that individuals need to be satisfied
with both the actual levels of pay and the processes used to determine pay.
That is why the performance management systems and performance appraisal
processes in organizations must be designed so they are linked to compensation increases. To strengthen links between organizational and individual
performance, an increasing number of fast-growing private-sector firms are
using variable pay and incentives programs.47 Some programs offer cash
bonuses or lump-sum payments to reward extra performance, which also aids
with retention efforts.
Another rewards aspect that affects retention is employee recognition,
which can be both tangible and intangible. Tangible recognition comes in
many forms, such as “employee of the month” plaques and perfect-attendance
certificates. Intangible and psychological recognition includes feedback from
managers and supervisors that acknowledges extra effort and performance,
even if monetary rewards are not given. For instance, one firm, Fairmont
Hotels and Resorts, is using a “Serviceplus Colleague Recognition Program”
to engage its 30,000 employees. Different types of recognitions include “Star
of the Month” and “Memory Maker” for significant service. For such recognition, a small amount of money (under $50) and other types of rewards
are given. An employee survey has shown significant increases in positive
employee views of both their jobs and the Fairmont firm.48
Career Training and Development Many employees in all types of jobs
consistently indicate that organizational efforts to aid their career training and
development can significantly affect employee retention. Opportunities for
personal growth lead the list of reasons why individuals took their current jobs
and why they stay there. In one survey, nearly one-third of workers identified
the lack of career advancement opportunities to be the most important reason
for potentially changing employers.49
Training and development efforts can be designed to indicate that employers are committed to keeping employees’ knowledge, skills, and abilities current. Also, training and development can help underused employees attain new
capabilities. Such a program at Southwest Airlines has been very successful.
Recruiters were reassigned to different departments, which resulted in their
generating sales and revenues in flight operations and other areas.50
Organizations address training and development in a number of ways.
Tuition aid programs, typically offered as a benefit by many employers,
allow employees to pursue additional educational and training opportunities.
These programs often contribute to higher employee retention rates because
the employees’ new knowledge and capabilities can aid the employer. Also,
through formal career planning efforts, employees discuss with their managers
career opportunities within the organization and career development activities
that will help them to grow.
Career development and planning efforts may include formal mentoring
programs. For instance, information technology (IT) organizations are using
career development programs so that IT individuals can expand their skills
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 167
17/07/10 5:48 PM
168
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
outside of technical areas. Programs in some firms cover communication and
negotiation tactics, which gives the employees additional capabilities that
are needed in managerial and other jobs.51 Companies can help reduce attrition by showing employees that they are serious about career advancement
opportunities.
Employer Policies and Practices A final set of factors found to affect
retention is based on the employer relations policies that exist. Such areas as
the reasonableness of HR policies, the fairness of disciplinary actions, and the
means used to decide work assignments and opportunities all affect employee
retention. If individuals feel that policies are unreasonably restrictive or are
applied inconsistently, they may be more likely to look at jobs offered by other
employers.
The increasing demographic diversity of U.S. workplaces
makes the nondiscriminatory treatment of employees
LOGGING ON
important, regardless of gender, age, and other characterisRetensa
R
tics. The organizational commitment and job satisfaction
FFor resources and newsletters
letters on
of ethnically diverse individuals are affected by perceived
current trends in employee
c
ee retention
discriminatory treatment. A number of firms have recogstrategies, visit this site at
nized that proactive management of diversity issues results
www.retensa.com.
in greater retention of individuals of all backgrounds.
MANAGING RETENTION
The foregoing sections summarized the results of many studies and popular
HR practices to identify factors that can cause retention difficulties. Retention
matters because turnover can cause poor performance in otherwise productive
units. Now our focus turns toward the keys to managing retention as part of
effective HR management.
Retention Assessment and Metrics
M E A S U R E
To ensure that appropriate actions are taken to enhance retention, management decisions require data and analyses rather than subjective impressions,
anecdotes of selected individual situations, or panic reactions to the loss of key
people. Examples of data for analyzing retention are highlighted in Figure 5-8.
Discussion on some of these sources follows.
The analysis of turnover data is an attempt to get at the cause of retention
problems. Analysis should recognize that turnover is a symptom of other factors that may be causing problems. When the causes are treated, the symptoms
can go away.
Some of the first areas to consider when analyzing data for retention include
the work, pay/benefits, supervision, and management systems. Common methods of obtaining useful perspectives are employee surveys, exit interviews, and
first-year turnover evaluations.
Employee Surveys Employee surveys can be used to diagnose specific
problem areas, identify employee needs or preferences, and reveal areas in
which HR activities are well received or viewed negatively. Whether the surveys are on general employee attitudes, job satisfaction, or specific issues, the
survey results must be examined as part of retention measurement efforts. For
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 168
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
169
Human Resource Planning and Retention
FIGURE 5-8
Retention Measurement and Assessment Sources
Occupational Types
Department Specialties
Demographics/Characteristics
Experience Components
Retention Returns on
Investments
Employee Replacement Costs
Training/Development Analyses
Possible HR Retention Metrics
example, a growing number of “mini-surveys” on specific topics are being sent
via e-mail questionnaires, blogs, and other means.
Regardless of the topics in a survey, obtaining employee input provides
managers and HR professionals with data on the “retention climate” in an
organization. By obtaining data on how employees view their jobs, their
coworkers, their supervisors, and organizational policies and practices, these
surveys can be starting points for reducing turnover and increasing the length
of time that employees are retained. Some employers conduct attitude surveys
yearly while others do so intermittently.
By asking employees to respond candidly to an attitude survey, management is building employees’ expectations that actions will be taken on the
concerns identified. Therefore, a crucial part of conducting an attitude survey
is providing feedback to those who participated in it. It is especially important that even negative survey results be communicated to avoid fostering the
appearance of hiding the results or placing blame.
Exit interview An interview
in which individuals who are
leaving an organization are
asked to give their reasons.
Exit Interviews One widely used means for assisting retention assessment
efforts is the exit interview, in which individuals who are leaving the organization are asked to give their reasons. HR must regularly summarize and analyze
the data by category (e.g., reasons for leaving, department, length of service,
etc.) to provide managers and supervisors with information for improving
company efforts. As described in the HR On-the-Job feature, the exit interview
process should contain some important aspects.
Many HR departments regularly contact former employees who were
valuable contributors, as they may be willing to provide more information on
questionnaires that are e-mailed to their homes or in telephone conversations
conducted some time after they have left the organization.52 For instance, one
health care firm contacts former employees within 60 days after they have
left. Many times these follow-up conversations reveal the “real” reasons for
departures, other than what was said in the exit interviews. This health care
firm also has a program through which ex-employees are invited to return as
“alumni” and have lunch with former coworkers, which has led to a number
of departed individuals indicating they would like to return to the firm because
the jobs they took elsewhere did not turn out to be as “promising” as they had
anticipated. Thus, rehiring can be aided by ongoing efforts such as e-mails, exit
interview follow-ups, and continuing contacts with good former employees.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 169
17/07/10 5:48 PM
170
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
HR on-the-job
Conducting Exit Interviews
Departing employees may be reluctant to divulge
their real reasons for leaving. A skilled HR interviewer
may be able to gain useful information that departing
employees do not wish to share with managers and
supervisors. The following suggestions may be useful
when conducting exit interviews:
•
•
•
Decide who will conduct the exit interview
and when the discussion will occur. Often
these interviews occur on the last day or so
of a departing individual’s employment.
Emphasize that the information provided
by the departing employee will be treated
confidentially and used to make improvements.
Utilize a checklist or a set of standard
questions so that the information can be
summarized. Typical areas covered include
reasons for leaving, supervision, pay, training,
liked and disliked aspects of the job, and
details on the organization to which the
employee is moving.
When doing the actual exit interview, numerous
questions can be asked. Ones typically asked of individuals
include the following:
•
•
•
•
Why are you leaving as an employee?
What have you liked and disliked about your
job and managers?
What company actions have made you and
other employees more or less positive?
What would or would not lead you to
recommend the employer to future possible
hires?
First-Year Turnover Evaluations A special type of retention assessment
focuses on first-year employees. It is not unusual for turnover to be high
among newer employees during their first year. Sometimes the cause of departure is voluntary; for example, individuals may identify a mismatch between
what they expected in their jobs and managers and what actually occurs, or
between their perceptions of the new job and its reality. Other times individuals are involuntarily removed in the first year. Some causes can be excessive
absenteeism and poor performance, mismatches with job requirements, and
conflicts with other employees and managers. If these situations occur too
often, HR may need to reevaluate its recruiting and selection processes, as well
as its job previews to make sure they are realistic.53
Overall, focus on first-year retention and turnover is useful because
individuals who stay for a year are more likely to extend their employment
and have greater retention beyond the first year. Also, effective first-year
efforts may lead to future career development, higher performance, and other
positive retention factors.
Retention Evaluation and Follow-Up
Management can take numerous actions to deal with retention issues. The
choice of a particular action depends on the analysis of the turnover and
retention problems in a particular organization and should be custom tailored
for that organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 170
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
171
Human Resource Planning and Retention
Tracking of intervention results and adjustment of intervention efforts
should be part of retention evaluation and follow-up. Some firms use pilot
programs to see how changes affect retention before extending them to the
entire organization. For instance, to test the effect of flextime scheduling on
employee turnover, a firm might try flexible scheduling in one department. If
the turnover rate in that department drops in comparison to the turnover rates
in other departments still working set schedules, the firm might extend the use
of flexible scheduling to other departments.
Retention evaluation and follow-up are key facets of the broader organizational HR planning and staffing. Effective retention management can
have major impacts on the integrated HR attraction, recruiting, and selection
processes.
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
HR planning involves analyzing and identifying
the need for and availability of human resources
so that the organization can meet its objectives.
When developing HR plans, it is important to
examine potential HR availability, both external
and internal.
When assessing external labor supply sources,
economic, governmental, competitive, and workforce composition changes should be analyzed.
Assessing internal strengths and weaknesses as a
part of HR planning requires auditing and inventorying current jobs and employee capabilities.
The supply and demand for human resources
can be forecast with a variety of methods and
for differing periods of time.
Psychological contracts are unwritten expectations that employees and employers have about
the nature of their work relationships.
The components of individual performance are
individual ability, effort expended, and organizational support.
Motivation deals with the needs and desires of
human behavior and managerial and organizational factors.
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
•
•
The interaction between individuals and their
jobs affects both job satisfaction and organizational commitment. The extent to which
employees feel linked to organizational success
can affect employee engagement and loyalty.
Turnover occurs when employees leave an
organization and must be replaced. It can be
classified in a number of ways, but it should be
measured and its costs determined.
Increasing employee retention or reducing turnover is important in HR management.
Drivers of retention include organizational, managerial, and job factors that may affect employees’
work-life balancing; compensation and other
rewards; career training and development; and
employer policies and practices.
Retention of employees is a major focus of
HR management efforts in organizations, as
demonstrated by the use of retention measures, including employee surveys and exit
interviews.
Managing retention should include evaluation
and tracking of both retention actions and turnover follow-up.
T H I N K I N G
1. Discuss the major components of HR planning
and forecasting efforts.
2. Describe your expectations for a job. How well
does your employer meet the expectations you
bring to the psychological contract?
3. If you became the new manager at a restaurant
with high employee turnover, what actions
A C T I V I T I E S
would you take to increase retention of
employees?
4. As the HR manager, you must provide the
senior management team with turnover costs for
the following high-turnover position. Use
Web sites such as
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 171
17/07/10 5:48 PM
172
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
www.talentkeepers.com and www
.keepemployees.com, to calculate turnover and
analyze the variables involved. Also identify
any other data that might be relevant, and
then discuss how you would reduce the
turnover.
H R
E X P E R I E N T I A L
Your company has reaped the benefits of having
long-term, tenured employees, but many of them
are now approaching retirement. It is anticipated
that approximately 20% of the company’s workforce will retire in the next 3 to 5 years. In reviewing the remaining workforce through HR planning
efforts, you have become aware of work-life balance issues that need to be reviewed and addressed.
The Company President has requested that you
prepare a Retention Plan outlining these issues as
Position: Machine Operator
Number of employees: 250
Number of turnovers: 85
Average wage: $11.50/hour
Cost of benefits: 35% of payroll
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
well as ways to address them. Resources to help
you address the issues in the Retention Plan can be
found at www.workfamily.com.
1. What steps will you take to identify key priorities in the work-life balance issues?
2. How will you present a business case to gain
management support for addressing those issues
in order to help retain existing workers and to
fill the positions vacated by retiring employees?
C A S E
Accenture—Retaining for Itself
Accenture is a firm that provides a wide range of
consulting and services to organizations worldwide. With more than 170,000 employees, the
firm has clients in 120 countries that receive
many HR and other consulting services. Among
others, these services include organizational, strategic, and change management analyses; leadership training and development; and technology
assistance and supply chain assistance. Large and
small client organizations also outsource various
operational functions to Accenture instead of
performing them internally with employees. Thus,
Accenture has many individuals who serve as consultants and support experts on specialized areas
and industries.
Because of its many professional consulting and support staff members, Accenture has
to manage its own human resources effectively
in order to serve both itself and its clients. The
rapid growth of this widespread firm has caused
Accenture to hire up to 60,000 employees in
just one year due to the expansion of clients and
the need to replace employees who have left to
become employees at other firms, to become independent consultants, or to work as employees at
client firms.
What Accenture does for its own employees
illustrates one reason why it is widely used by
clients. At the heart of Accenture’s approach for
itself is to consider its employees as a virtual
workforce. This means that numerous employees work in many different places at different
times, often using work-life balancing, technology
resources, and work-related job flexibility. With
offices in more than 150 cities worldwide, the
work locations and schedules vary so much that
numerous Accenture consultants have to reserve
a desk at an office when they need to be there.
Otherwise, many employees are encouraged to
work outside offices.
The out-of-office environment presents an
extensive HR challenge for Accenture in terms of
engaging its employees. Many consultant employees work intermittently with a variety of managers
and coworkers, in teams as large as 1,000 consultants, throughout multiple countries.
To practice retention in its own firm, Accenture
does extensive training and development of employees. All new Accenture workers participate in “New
Joiner Orientation” where they learn what is expected
of them, do sample client projects with coworkers,
and become linked to personal career counselors.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 172
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
173
Human Resource Planning and Retention
Career training and development efforts include
a wide range of activities, access to Accenture’s
“Career Marketplace” website, and training in how
to work effectively on different types of projects and
in global locations. The value of these activities is
shown in the fact that almost 39% of Accenture’s
open U.S. jobs are filled by current employees who
change and/or increase their job levels.
What Accenture’s employee retention program
emphasizes is that the firm does not just consult
about HR and other services for clients, but also
does for itself what many current and potential
clients need to do, which is to view HR planning
and retention as crucial for organizational success
and growth.54
QUESTIONS
1. Identify how some Accenture-type efforts
have and have not occurred in your current
and previous workplaces. Also, discuss why
focusing on employee retention pays off for
Accenture clients, and not just for Accenture
itself.
2. Go to the Accenture website, www.accenture
.com, to research and gather job- and careerrelated information that might need to be
adapted by other employers. As part of this
research, examine how Accenture markets
itself to current and potential employees.
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
The Clothing Store
Alegent Health
This case describes the approach of one firm to
improving employee retention. (For the case, go to
www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
This case discusses how Alegent, a large
nonprofit health care system, improved employee
retention and reduced turnover. (For the case, go
to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Based on Susan J. Wells, “Say Hola to the Majority
Minority,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 38–45;
Miriam Jordan, “Got Workers? Dairy Farms Run Low
on Labor,” The Wall Street Journal, July 30, 2009, A13;
Scott Morrison, “Google Searches for Staffing Answers,”
The Wall Street Journal, May 19, 2009, B1; and Anton
Trianovski, “Skilled Trades Seek Workers,” The Wall Street
Journal, August 19, 2008, B1.
2. Fay Hansen, “Strategic Workforce Planning in an
Uncertain World,” Workforce Management Online,
July 2009, www.workforce.com.
3. Carol Morrison, “The Time to Plan Is Now,” Trend
Watcher, April 17, 2009, www.i4cp.com.
4. For an overview, see Robert J. Greene, “Ensuring Future
Work Viability,” WorldatWork Journal, Fourth Quarter,
2007, 23–33.
5. “Corps of Engineers Needs to Update Its Workforce
Planning . . .,” Human Capital, U.S. Government
Accountability Office, May 2008, www.goa.gov.
6. Based on HR’s Evolving Role in Organizations and
Its Impact on Business Strategy, SHRM, 2008,
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
www.shrm.org/surveys; Carolyn Hirschman, “Putting
Forecasting in Focus,” HR Magazine, March 2007,
44–49.
Kenneth J. Zulz and Thomas J. Chernack, “Development
and Initial Validation of an Instrument for Human Capital
Planning,” Human Resource Development Quarterly, 19
(2008), 7–33.
Pamela Babcock, “Workforce Planning Remains
Largely Unaddressed Global Challenge,”
SHRM Staffing Management, December 2007,
www.shrm.org/ema.
Based on Lydell C. Bridgeford, “Point-and-Click
Productivity,” Employee Benefit News, June 15, 2009,
18–19; Ed Frauenheim, “HR Technology: Talent Tools Still
Essential,” Workforce Management, April 20, 2009, 20.
Arne L. Kallenberg, “The Mismatched Worker: When
People Don’t Fit Their Jobs,” Academy of Management
Perspectives, February 2008, 24–40.
Jacqueline A.M. Coyle-Shapiro and Lynn M. Shore,
“The Employee-Organization Relationship,” Human
Resource Management Review, 17 (2007), 166–179.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 173
17/07/10 5:48 PM
174
SECTION 2
Jobs and labor
12. S. Lester, et al., “Managing Employee Perceptions
of the Psychological Contract over Time,” Journal of
Organizational Behavior, 28 (2007), 191–208.
13. “The Employment Relationship: Implications
for the Psychological Contract,” SHRM Research,
May 2008.
14. Tanguy Dulac, et al., “Not All Responses to Breach
Are the Same,” Academy of Management Journal,
51 (2008), 1079–1098.
15. S. Chi and S. Chen, “Perceived Psychological
Contract Fulfillment and Job Attitudes Among
Repatriates,” International Journal of Manpower,
28 (2007), 474–488.
16. B. Weber and G. Hertel, “Motivation Gains of
Inferior Group Members: A Meta-Analytical Review,”
Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 93 (2007),
973–993.
17. Piers Steel and Cornelius König, “Integrating Theories
of Motivation,” Academy of Management Review,
31 (2006), 889–913.
18. Brian A. Altman and Mesut Akdere, “Towards a
Theoretical Model of Performance Inhibiting Workplace
Dynamics,” Human Resource Development Review,
7 (2008), 408.
19. Thomas Zagenczk, “Mentors, Supervisors, and Role
Models: Do They Reduce the Effects of Psychological
Contract Breach?” Human Resource Management
Journal, 19 (2009), 237–259.
20. “Workers Want Personal Satisfaction More than
Money,” WorldatWork Newsline, May 22, 2009,
www.worldatwork.org.
21. For a more detailed review of job satisfaction factors,
see “2009 Employee Job Satisfaction: Understanding the
Factors That Make Work Gratifying,” SHRM Research,
2009, www.shrm.org.; Daniel C. Ganseter, “Measurement
Challenges for Studying Work-Related Stressors and
Strains,” Human Resource Management Review,
18 (2008), 259–270.
22. Remus Ilies, et al., “The Spillover of Daily Job Satisfaction
onto Employees’ Family Lives,” Academy of Management
Journal, 52 (2009), 87–102.
23. Rebecca R. Hastings, “Employee Surveys: Prepare to Act,”
HR Disciplines, June 15, 2009, www.shrm.org.
24. Frank Giancola, “Employee Engagement: What You Need
to Know,” Workspan, October 2007, 55–59.
25. For more information, see Nancy R. Lockwood,
“Leveraging Employee Engagement for Competitive
Advantage,” SHRM Research, No. 1, 2007, 1–11.
26. “Estimating Turnover Costs,” www.keepemployees.com.
27. M. D. Burton and C. H. Beckman, “Leaving a Legacy,”
American Sociological Review, 72 (2007), 239–266.
28. Tae Hean Lee, et al., “Understanding Voluntary Turnover,”
Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008), 651–671.
29. Kris Dunn, “Good Versus Bad Turnover,” Workforce
Management Online, July 2007, www.workforce.com.
30. Charlie O. Trevor and Anthony Nyberg, “Keeping
Your Headcount When All About You Are Losing
Theirs,” Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008),
259–276.
31. Thomas Ng and Marcus M. Butts, “Effectiveness
of Organizational Efforts to Lower Turnover
Intentions,” Human Resource Management,
48 (2009), 289–310.
32. For details on industries, types of jobs, and other
components, go to www.dol.gov.
33. “Global Shipping and Delivery Giant . . .,” Talent
Keepers Retention Case Study, www.talentkeepers.com.
34. For detailed examples, go to www.talentkeepers.com,
www.shrm.org, and www.keepemployees.com. Also see
“Tool: The Cost of Turnover,” Workforce Management,
November 2003, www.workforce.com.
35. John Sullivan, “Not All Turnover Is Equal,” Workforce
Management, May 21, 2007, 42; W. S. Siebert and
Nikolay Zubanov, “Searching for the Optimal Level of
Employee Turnover,” Academy of Management Journal,
5 (2009), 294–313.
36. “Unhappiness with Management, Limited Advancement
Cited as Top Reasons Employees Quit,” WorldatWork
Study, January 21, 2009, www.worldatwork.org.
37. For an overview, see Sandra L. Fornes, et al., “Workplace
Commitment: A Conceptual Model Developed from
Integrative Review of Research,” Human Resource
Development Review, 7 (2008), 339.
38. Sarah E. Needleman, “Allying Workers Fears During
Uncertain Times,” The Wall Street Journal, October 6,
2008, B5.
39. Chu-Hsiang Chang, et al., “The Relationship Between
Perceptions of Organizational Politics, Employee Attitudes,
Strain, and Behavior,” Academy of Management Journal,
52 (2009), 779–801.
40. Kathy Gurchiek, “Bad Bosses—More than Bad
Salaries—Drive Workers Away,” HR News, January 11,
2007, www.shrm.org.
41. David R. Hekman, et al., “Combined Effects of
Organizational and Professional Identification on the
Reciprocity Dynamics for Professional Employees,”
Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009),
506–526.
42. Riki Takevchi, et al., “A Model of Expatriate
Withdrawal Related Outcomes,” Human Resource
Management Review, 15 (2005), 119–138;
Kathryn Tyler, “Retaining Repatriates,” HR Magazine,
March 2006, 1–4.
43. Based on Padmaja Alaganandan, “India’s Human
Capital Challenge,” Workspan, November 2008, 111–114;
“The World of Work,” BusinessWeek, January 6, 2007,
57–58.
44. Cali Williams Yost, “CFO’s See Business Impacts of Work
Flexibility . . . ,” WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter
2009, 59–67.
45. Patricia K. Zinghum and Jay R. Schuster, “Workforce
Retention, Pay and Rewards Practices in Tough-Market
Cities,” WorldatWork Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2008,
16–27.
46. Raymund Flandez, “Rewards Help Soothe Hard Times,”
The Wall Street Journal, July 7, 2008, B4.
47. Patricia K. Zingheim, et al., “Compensation, Reward,
and Retention Practices in Fast-Growth Companies,”
WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter, 2009, 22–37.
48. Matthew Smith and Derek Irvine, “Employee Recognition
Program . . . ,” Workspan, August 2009, 29–37.
49. Kathy Gurchiek, “Lack of Career Advancement Main
Reason Workers Consider Leaving,” HR News, February
29, 2008, www.shrm.org.
50. Phred Dvorak, “Firms Shift Underused Workers,” The Wall
Street Journal, June 22, 2009, B2.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 174
17/07/10 5:48 PM
CHAPTER 5
175
Human Resource Planning and Retention
51. Lisa Cooling, “Keep Your IT People Happy,” Inside Supply
Management, May 2008, 38–40.
52. William Werhane “How Do We Get Better
Information from Our Exit Interviews?” Workforce
Management Online, October 1, 2009,
www.workforce.com.
53. “First-Year Turnover Rate,” SHRM Metric of the Month,
October 1, 2006, www.shrm.org/research.
54 Based on Jessica Marquez, “Accentuating the
Positive,” Workforce Management, September 22,
2008, 18–25. Also see information available at
www.accenture.com.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 175
17/07/10 5:48 PM
C H A P T E R
6
Recruiting and Labor
Markets
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
List different ways that labor markets can be identified and
approached.
•
Discuss strategic recruiting decisions on recruiting images,
outsourcing, and other related areas.
•
Explain why Internet recruiting has grown and how it
affects recruiting efforts done by employers.
•
List and briefly discuss five external recruiting sources.
•
Identify three internal sources for recruiting and issues
associated with their use.
•
Describe three factors to consider when doing recruiting
measurement and metrics.
176
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 176
26/06/10 5:09 PM
HR Headline
Passive Recruiting Becomes Active
E
Digital Vision/Photodisc/Jupiter Images
mployed individuals who may not be
considering other jobs but who are
recruited are called passive job seekers.
For firms to search to fill jobs with persons
who are not actively looking for a job means
that they have to use a variety of means to
encourage passives to become actives.
Many passives are approached via Internet
tools. This approach is especially used for
executive and other hard-to-fill openings, even
for passives who do not have current résumés.
Search consultants use passive recruiting to
locate possible individuals to fill jobs to which
the consultants have been assigned. Use of IT
networking sites such as Facebook, Linked In,
ZoomInfo, and others provides information
on passive individuals.
Once information on a “passive candidate”
is located, personal contact can be made and
conversations held to encourage the passive to
consider job openings. Personal communication about certain employers and job openings
helps get passives to consider the openings.
This type of recruiting is becoming increasingly common as people use the Internet sites
that can be accessed by others to learn about
both jobs and individuals. Several Internet sites are adding thousands of
individual profiles weekly. More than 20% of the large Fortune 500 firms
use such sites along with other ways to find candidates for difficult-to-fill
openings and top executive jobs.1 So, as an employer, are you ready to
find passives?
177
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 177
26/06/10 5:09 PM
178
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
The staffing process used by an employer, based on HR planning and retention
as key components, must include successful recruiting and selection efforts.
However, as the HR Headline illustrates, new approaches to those actions are
evolving. Without significant attention and measurement, recruiting and selection can become just a set of administrative functions: coordinating internal
openings, handling the flow of candidate data, dealing with regulatory reporting, and moving candidates through the system.
This chapter examines recruiting, and the next chapter examines selection. Recruiting is the process of generating a pool of qualified applicants for
organizational jobs. If the number of available candidates equals the number
of people to be hired, no real selection is required—the choice has already
been made. The organization must either leave some openings unfilled or take
all the candidates. One survey of employers in slow labor markets found that
almost half of the hiring managers cited less qualified applicants as the biggest
recruiting and hiring challenge.2 It is important to view recruiting broadly as
a key part of staffing, and not just as a collection of administrative and operational activities.
RECRUITING
Recruiting is becoming more important as labor markets shift. Although
recruiting can be expensive, an offsetting concept that must be considered
is the cost of unfilled jobs. For example, consider a company in which three
operations-related jobs are vacant. Assume these three vacancies cost the company $300 for each business day the jobs remain vacant. If the jobs are not
filled for four months, the cost of this failure to recruit in a timely fashion will
be about $26,000.
Although cost is certainly an issue, and some employers are quite concerned about cost per hire as well as the cost of vacancies, quality might be
an important trade-off. For example, if an organizational strategy focuses on
quality as a competitive advantage, a company might choose to hire only from
the top 15% of candidates for critical jobs, and from the top 30% of candidates for all other positions. Though this approach may raise the cost per hire,
it will improve workforce quality.
These examples illustrate that recruiting should not just be seen as an
expense, but as part of overall HR planning and strategy. To be effective,
recruiters need to integrate efforts involving labor markets, recruiting responsibilities and goals, and recruiting sources, including the Internet. Figure 6-1
highlights key integrative recruiting components.
Strategic Recruiting and HR Planning
It is important that recruiting be treated as a part of strategic HR planning
because it is a key mechanism for filling positions necessary to get the work
done. Recruiting requires an employer to:
•
•
Recruiting Process of
generating a pool of qualified
applicants for organizational
jobs.
•
•
Know the industry and where to successfully recruit qualified employees.
Identify keys to success in the labor market, including competitors’
recruiting efforts.
Cultivate relationships with sources of prospective employees.
Promote the “company brand” so that the employer is known as a good
place to work.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 178
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
179
Recruiting and Labor Markets
FIGURE 6-1
Integrating Recruiting Components
Integrative
Recruiting
Success
Recruiting
Sources, including
Internet
Labor Markets
Recruiting
Responsibilities
and Goals
•
LOGGING ON
Airs
Training and educational resources
for recruiters are available at
www.airsdirectory.com.
Use recruiting metrics in order to measure the
effectiveness of recruiting efforts.
Recruiting decisions can identify not only the kinds and
numbers of applicants, but also how difficult or successful recruiting efforts may be by type of jobs. In addition,
effective recruiting focuses on discovering talent before it is
needed.
Training of Recruiters and Managers
Regardless of the methods used, an important recruiting issue is how much
training will be given to recruiters and managers. Training on recruitingrelated activities, communications skills, and job-specific details is common.
Also, those involved in recruiting should learn the types of actions that violate
EEO regulations and how to be sensitive to diversity issues with applicants.
Such training areas often include appropriate language to use with applicants
so that racist, sexist, and other inappropriate remarks do not hurt the image
of the employer and result in legal complaints.
Training recruiters may include the importance of employers engaging
in ethical behaviors during recruiting efforts. One way to evaluate training
efforts in this area is through follow-up activities. For instance, to assess ethical behavior when recruiting college graduates, some employers send followup surveys to interviewees asking about the effectiveness of the recruiters and
the image the candidates have of the employers as a result of the recruiting
contacts.3
LABOR MARKETS
Labor markets External
supply pool from which
employers attract employees.
Because staffing takes place in different labor markets that can vary a great
deal, learning some basics about labor markets aids in understanding recruiting. Labor markets are the external supply pool from which employers attract
employees. To understand where recruiting takes place, one can think of the
sources of employees as a funnel, in which the broad scope of labor markets
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 179
26/06/10 5:10 PM
180
SECTION 2
FIGURE 6-2
Jobs and Labor
Labor Market Components
narrows progressively to the point of selection and job offers, as Figure 6-2
shows. Of course, if the selected candidates reject the offers, then HR staff
members must move back up the funnel to the applicant pool for other candidates, and in extreme cases may need to reopen the recruiting process.
Labor Market Components
Labor force population
All individuals who are
available for selection if all
possible recruitment strategies
are used.
Applicant population
A subset of the labor force
population that is available
for selection using a particular
recruiting approach.
Applicant pool All persons
who are actually evaluated
for selection.
Several different means of identifying labor markets exist. One useful
approach is to take a broad view of the labor markets and then narrow them
down to specific recruiting sources. The broadest labor market component and
measure is the labor force population, which is made up of all individuals who
are available for selection if all possible recruitment strategies are used. For
firms with global locations in multiple countries, the labor force population
can be much larger than that of a business operating in only one country. For
example, some U.S.-based airlines have customer service centers located in the
Philippines, India, and other countries as well as the United States. The labor
force population for such businesses is much broader than that of a business
operating in a single country.
The applicant population is a subset of the labor force population that is
available for selection if a particular recruiting approach is used. This population can be broad or narrow depending on the jobs needing to be filled and
the approaches used by the employer. For example, if a firm is recruiting highly
specialized engineers for multiple geographic locations, the recruiting methods
may involve a broad range of approaches and sources, including professional
associations, convention attendance, general and specialized websites, using
recruiting consulting firms, and offering recruitment incentives to existing
employees. However, a smaller firm in a limited geographic location might
limit its recruiting for management trainees to MBA graduates from major
universities in the area. This recruiting method would result in a different
group of applicants from those who might apply if the employer were to
advertise the openings for management trainees on a local radio station, post a
listing on an Internet jobs board, or encourage current employee referrals and
applications. Figure 6-3 illustrates some common items that affect recruiting
applicant populations.
The applicant pool consists of all persons who are actually evaluated for
selection. Many factors can affect the size of the applicant pool, including the
reputation of the organization and industry as a place to work, the screening
efforts of the organization, the job specifications, and the information available. It is important to develop an applicant tracking system when considering
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 180
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
181
Recruiting and Labor Markets
FIGURE 6-3
Considerations for Determining Applicant Populations
CONSIDERATIONS FOR DETERMINING
APPLICANT POPULATIONS
Number and type of recruits needed
Timing of recruiting to ensure timely placement
External and internal messages on job details
Qualifications of competent applicants to be considered
Sources for obtaining qualified applicants
Outside and inside recruiting means to be used
Administrative recruiting and application review activities
LOGGING ON
JobWeb
For a special report about labor markets
and jobs outlook, visit www.jobweb.com.
the applicant pool. Using such a system, both administratively and electronically, can make the recruiting process
more effective.4 For example, when the applicant pool size
increases, recruiters can consistently identify the most effective future employees for several jobs, and not just fill current jobs because of a larger supply.5
Unemployment Rates and Applicant Population When the unemployment rate is high in a given market, many people are looking for jobs. When
the unemployment rate is low, there are fewer applicants. Unemployment rates
vary with business cycles and present very different challenges for recruiting
at different times. For instance, in some U.S. states, when many automobile
plants closed and workers were laid off, manufacturers in other industries and
even retailers experienced a significant increase in their numbers of job applicants, making recruiting easier and larger applicant pools a fact.
Different Labor Markets and Recruiting
The supply of workers in various labor markets differs substantially and affects
staffing. Organizations recruit in a number of different labor markets, including
industry-specific markets and occupational, educational and technical, and geographic markets. Labor markets can be viewed in several ways to provide information that is useful for recruiting. It is important to understand the broad labor
markets from which candidates are identified and attracted. These labor markets
can include both internal and external sources, which will be discussed later.
Industry and Occupational Labor Markets Labor markets can be classified by industry and occupation. Depending on economic and industry aspects,
recruiting emphases can be changed. For example, the biggest increases in U.S.
jobs until the year 2016 are going to be in the positions of registered nurses,
retail sales and customer service representatives, home health aides, and postsecondary teachers.6 These data illustrate that recruiting will be more difficult
in filling these jobs during the next few years. Trucking and welding jobs are
also expected to present significant recruiting difficulties.7
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 181
26/06/10 5:10 PM
182
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Recruiting for smaller firms can be challenging. For instance, a small certified professional accounting (CPA) firm had to work extensively to identify
which CPA professionals would prefer working in a small firm rather than a
large one. One key to this firm’s recruiting efforts was to clearly identify the
unique characteristics of working in a smaller firm, which included greater
assignment variety, more work flexibility, and better career possibilities.8
Those characteristics would appeal to some but not all who might apply.
Educational and Technical Labor Markets Another way to look at labor
markets is by considering the educational and technical qualifications that
define the people being recruited. Employers may need individuals with specific licenses, certifications, or educational backgrounds. For instance, recruiting physician leaders for a medical organization led to the establishment of
a special search committee to set goals for the committee members. Then,
as part of recruiting and selection, the top candidates were asked to develop
departmental vision statements and three-year goals. That information made
the recruiting and selection process more effective.9
Another special labor market is suppliers and contractors for U.S. military
forces. Firms such as Cintas Corporation, with more than 34,000 employees,
and Raytheon, with 77,000 employees, serve as federal government defense
contractors. The need to recruit for specialty jobs in engineering and technology by such firms illustrates why considering different types of labor markets
is appropriate.10
A prominent occupational area that is expected to be extremely tight
during the next few years is the information technology (IT) labor market.
That labor market, which was tight several years ago, is now becoming tight
again as IT is used in a wider variety of jobs.11 Another example of a tight
labor market is that of business professors with PhDs, who are forecast to be
in short supply in the next few years due to the retirement of baby boomers
from faculty positions. Other examples of shortages in specific labor markets
include certified auto mechanics, heating and air-conditioning technicians, and
network-certified computer specialists.
Geographic Labor Markets One common way to classify labor markets is
based on geographic location. Markets can be local, area or regional, national,
or international. Local and area labor markets vary significantly in terms of
workforce availability and quality, and changes in a geographic labor market
may force changes in recruiting efforts. For instance, if a new major employer
locates in a regional labor market, other existing area employers may see a
decline in their numbers of applicants.
Geographic markets require different recruiting considerations. For
example, attempting to recruit locally for a job market that is a national competitive market will likely result in disappointing applicant rates. A catalog
retailer that tries to recruit a senior merchandising manager from the small
town where the firm is located may encounter difficulties, although it may not
need to recruit nationally for workers to fill administrative support jobs. This
example shows how varying geographic labor markets must be evaluated as
part of recruiting.
G L O B A L
Global Labor Markets Employers in the United States are tapping global
labor markets when necessary and expanding export work to overseas labor
markets when doing so is advantageous. Firms in different industries are
expanding in India, China, Indonesia, Romania, Poland, and other countries.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 182
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
183
The migration of U.S. work overseas has been controversial. While many
decry the loss of American jobs, some employers respond that they cannot be
competitive in a global market if they fail to take advantage of labor savings.
For example, at some operations in India and China, U.S. employers pay less
than half of what they would pay for comparable jobs to be performed in U.S.
facilities. A significant number of U.S. and European firms have farmed out
software development and back-office work to India and other countries with
lower wages. However, some advancements in American worker productivity
have made it possible to have fewer U.S. employees to produce certain items,
which has resulted in a cost savings, even at those employees’ higher wage
rates. Hence, those types of jobs are not being exported to other countries.
The use of the Internet has resulted in global jobs being recruited in many
places, but often recruiting employees for global assignments requires different approaches from those used for typical recruiting efforts in the home
country. The recruiting processes must consider variations in culture, laws,
and language. For instance, in some countries, potential recruits like to work
for European and U.S. firms, so recruiters emphasize the “Western” image.
But in other countries, cultural employer operational differences change how
recruiting is done.
Dealing with foreign labor markets can present challenges. For example,
in China recruiting is regulated and generally requires the approval of local
personnel or labor authorities. Hiring foreign employees into U.S. jobs must
meet certain legal requirements, including H1 visa requirements. Concerns
exist about hiring illegal immigrants as well.12
STRATEGIC RECRUITING DECISIONS
When there are economic declines in certain geographic areas and occupations, a greater number of talented recruits are available, and recruiting costs
can be lower.13 But whether recruits are plentiful or scarce, employers must
decide on several recruiting issues. These important strategic decisions for
recruiting are discussed next.
Recruiting Presence and Image
Recruiting efforts may be viewed as either continuous or intensive. Continuous
efforts to recruit offer the advantage of keeping the employer in the recruiting
market. For example, with college recruiting, some organizations may find it
advantageous to have a recruiter on a given campus each year. Employers that
visit a campus only occasionally are less likely to build a following at that
school over time. Also, continuous recruiting may lead to constant Internet
job postings, contact with recruiting consultants, and other market-related
actions.
Intensive recruiting may take the form of a vigorous recruiting campaign
aimed at hiring a given number of employees, usually within a short period of
time. Sometimes such efforts are the result of unforeseeable changes in external
factors, but they also can result from a failure in the HR planning system to
identify needs in advance or to anticipate drastic changes in workforce needs.
Employment “Branding” and Image The “employment brand” or image
of an organization is the view of it held by both employees and outsiders.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 183
26/06/10 5:10 PM
184
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Effective Recruitment
at USDA
Every year Optimas Awards are given by Workforce.com
to recognize and highlight how organizations improve
results through workforce actions. One federal
government entity received the award for its recruitingrelated efforts.
The federal agency, the United States Department
of Agriculture (USDA) Food Safety and Inspection
Service, faced significant competition with private
employers for candidates in positions such as science
professionals, veterinarians, and other jobs. With
position openings at 6,000 sites, the agency had to
take significant action. First, more than 100 agency
employees were trained to be effective recruiters
as an expansion of their regular professional job
responsibilities. Next, these “recruiters” annually
visited more than 50 universities and colleges to
recruit more staff. By using their training, these USDA
individuals were able to reduce the time in which jobs
were unfilled by more than five days on average.
HR best practices
One occupational group that needed significantly
more recruiting was veterinarians. Given a shortage of
qualified individuals, the agency took several actions in
this area. One was raising the beginning salary level for
veterinarians. Also, a hiring incentive was established in
the form of 25% of base pay over four years. As a result,
the shortage of veterinarians decreased by 50% as
approximately 100 veterinarians were hired each year.
The recruiting efforts have significantly changed
agency operation as well. Some operational actions
that have been implemented are more flexible work
scheduling, telework usage, and flexible management.
These actions have helped make the USDA Food
Safety and Inspection Service more appealing to
applicants and employees. That this entity received the
Optimas award indicates that governmental and publicsector employers, and not just private-sector ones, must
continually adapt and improve their recruiting planning
and strategies.14
Organizations that are seen as desirable employers are better able to attract
qualified applicants than are those with poor reputations. For example, one
firm had good pay and benefits, but its work demands were seen as excessive,
and frequent downsizings had resulted in some terminations and transfers. The
result was high turnover and fewer applicants interested in employment at the
company. That firm had a poor brand or image as an employer.
Companies can spend considerable effort and money establishing brand
images for their products. Not only can the company brand help generate
more recruits, but it also can help with applicant self-selection because it
affects whether individuals ever consider a firm and submit applications.
Recruiting and employer branding should be seen as part of organizational
marketing efforts and linked to the overall image and reputation of the organization and its industry. The HR Best Practices illustrates how a federal government agency changed its recruitment culture to improve its image and be more
effective in its recruiting efforts.
Organization-Based versus Outsourced Recruiting
A basic decision is whether the recruiting will be done by the employer or outsourced to someone else. This decision need not be focused on an “either-or”
situation entirely. In most organizations, HR staff members handle many of
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 184
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
185
the recruiting efforts. However, because recruiting can be a time-consuming
process and HR staff and other managers in organizations have many other
responsibilities, outsourcing is a way to decrease the number of staff needed
for recruiting and free some of their time for other responsibilities.
Recruitment process outsourcing (RPO) can be done to improve the number and quality of recruiting candidates, as well as to reduce recruiting costs.15
Estimates are that RPO is expected to grow significantly in the near future.
Both large and small employers in different industries outsource such functions as placement of advertisements, initial screening of résumés, and initial
telephone contacts with potential applicants. For example, General Electric
(GE) uses RPO to save time and efforts of HR staff, as well as to target its
recruiting efforts more effectively. Once the RPO activities are done, the
employer’s HR staff members can take over the rest of the recruiting activities
in a cost-effective and timely manner.16
Professional Employer Organizations and Employee Leasing A
specific type of outsourcing uses professional employer organizations (PEOs)
and employee leasing. The employee leasing process is simple: An employer
signs an agreement with the PEO, after which the staff is hired by the leasing
firm and leased back to the company for a fee. In turn, the leasing firm writes
the paychecks, pays taxes, prepares and implements HR policies, and keeps all
the required records for the employer.
One advantage of leasing companies for employees is that they may receive
better benefits than they otherwise would get in many of the small businesses that use leasing firms. But all this service comes at a cost to employers.
Leasing companies often charge employers between 4% and 6% of employees’
monthly salaries. Thus, while leasing may save employers money on benefits
and HR administration, it also may increase total payroll costs.
The PEO and the employment agency are different types of entities. A
PEO has its own workforce, which it supplies by contract to employers with
jobs. However, an employment agency provides a “work-finding” service for
job seekers and supplies employers with applicants whom they may then hire.
Regular versus Flexible Staffing
Another strategic decision affects how much recruiting will be done to fill
staffing needs with regular full-time or part-time employees. Decisions as to
which should be recruited hinge on whether to seek regular employees or to
use more flexible approaches, which might include temporaries or independent contractors. A number of employers have decided that the cost of keeping a regular workforce has become excessive and is growing worse due to
economic, competitive, and governmental considerations. However, not just
money is at issue. The large number of employment regulations also constrains
the employment relationship, making many employers reluctant to hire new
regular full-time employees.
Flexible staffing uses workers who are not traditional employees. Using
flexible staffing arrangements allows an employer to avoid some of the cost of
full-time benefits such as vacation pay and pension plans. Flexible staffing may
lead to recruiting in different markets, since it includes the use of temporary
workers and independent contractors.
Temporary Workers Employers who use temporary employees can hire
their own temporary staff members or contract with agencies supplying
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 185
26/06/10 5:10 PM
186
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
temporary workers on a rate-per-day or rate-per-week basis. Originally developed to provide clerical and office workers to employers, temporary workers in professional, technical, and even managerial jobs are becoming more
common. The importance of using temporary workers is illustrated through
the use of computer technology by an educational publisher. The publisher
utilized an automated employment, recruiting, and screening system to obtain
sufficient temporary workers for its firm. That employer obtained sufficient
qualified workers which resulted in a return on its hiring investment of $6 for
every $1 of cost.17
Some employers hire temporary workers as a way for individuals to move
into full-time, regular employment. Better-performing workers may move to
regular positions when these positions become available. This “try before you
buy” approach is potentially beneficial to both employers and employees.
However, if individuals come through temporary service firms, those firms
typically bill client companies a placement charge if a temporary worker is
hired full-time. Also, employing temporary workers as opposed to full-time
workers can have implications in regard to federal laws such as the Family
Medical Leave Act, the Fair Labor Standards Act, and others.18
Independent Contractors Some firms employ independent contractors
as workers who perform specific services on a contract basis. These workers must be truly independent as determined by regulations
used by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service and the U.S.
LOGGING ON
Department of Labor. Independent contractors are used in
Arbita
a number of areas, including building maintenance, security,
This consulting firm provides resources
advertising, and others. One major reason for the use of
on recruiting-related topics, including a
independent contractors is that some employers experience
collection of articles and white papers.
significant savings because benefits are not provided to those
Visit the website at www.arbita.net.
individuals.
Recruiting and EEO: Diversity Considerations
Recruiters must consider EEO and diversity factors for several reasons, as
Figure 6-4 indicates. The following text highlights each of the diversity consideration dimensions.
FIGURE 6-4
Recruiting and Diversity Considerations
Compliance with
EEO Regulations
Targeting Recruiting of
Diverse Applicants
of Varying Types
Diversity-Specific
Recruiting Efforts
(ads, websites, etc.)
Training of Recruiters
on EEO/Diversity
Issues
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 186
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
187
EEO and Recruiting Efforts Recruiting as a key employment-related activity
is subject to various considerations, especially equal employment laws and
regulations. As part of legal compliance in the recruiting process, organizations must work to reduce external disparate impact, or underrepresentation
of protected-class members compared to the labor markets utilized by the
employer. If disparate impact exists, then the employer may need to make
special efforts to persuade protected-class individuals to apply for jobs. For
employers with affirmative action plans (AAPs), special ways to reduce disparate impact can be identified as goals listed in those plans. Also, many employers
that emphasize internal recruiting should take actions to obtain protected-class
applicants externally if disparate impact exists in the current workforce.
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission (EEOC) guidelines state
that no direct or indirect references implying gender or age are permitted.
These guidelines affect interviews, advertisements, and other recruiting activities. Some examples of impermissible terminology are: “young and enthusiastic,” “Christian values,” and “journeyman lineman.” Also, advertisements
should contain wording about being an Equal Opportunity Employer (EEO),
or even more specific designations such as EEO/M-F/AA/ADA. Employers
demonstrate inclusive recruiting by having diverse individuals represented in
company materials, in advertisements, and as recruiters.
Recruiting Diversity A broad range of factors applies to recruiting diversity.
Many employers have expanded efforts to recruit workers from what, for
some, are nontraditional labor pools. Nontraditional diverse recruitees for
certain jobs may include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Persons with different racial/ethnic backgrounds
Older workers over 40 years of age
Single parents
Workers with disabilities
Welfare-to-work workers
Homeless/substance abuse workers
The growth in racial/ethnic workforce diversity means that a wider range
of potential employment sources should be utilized. Almost 60% of surveyed
employers review their recruitment practices to ensure that they are inclusive,
and almost half provide diversity training to managers involved in hiring.19
The population growth in Hispanics in the United States means that specialized recruiting programs to tap Hispanics as applicants may grow in use.
For instance, Goodwill Industries, a large nonprofit organization, provides
diversity training of staff members and has partnerships with Hispanic community organizations to aid in the recruitment and retention of Hispanic
workers.20
Older potential workers may include retirees who have become bored
(or need money), those who have been involuntarily laid off, or those who
are making career changes and want to try a new field. But some employers
prefer younger workers as recruites, even though that can create both legal
and recruiting supply issues.21 Single parents may be attracted to a familyfriendly employer that offers flexibility, including part-time work, because it
is frequently difficult to balance job and family life. Some firms also recruit
stay-at-home parents by using flexibility and work-at-home technology.
Individuals with disabilities are another group of potential resources. More
than 21 million people with disabilities are of working age, but only about
8 million of them are employed. Therefore, it is appropriate that employers
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 187
26/06/10 5:10 PM
188
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
expand their educational, training, and staffing policies and practices to employ
more individuals with disabilities.22
Realistic Job Previews
Providing a balanced view of the advantages, demands, expectations, and
challenges in an organization or a job may help attract employees with more
realistic expectations and reduce the number of employees who quit a few
months after being hired because the “reality” they discover does not match
what they expected. Thus, recruiting efforts can benefit from realistic job previews, but their usage must be monitored. RJPs will be further discussed in the
next chapter as part of the selection process.23
Recruiting Source Choices: Internal versus External
Most employers combine the use of internal and external recruiting sources.
Both promoting from within the organization (internal recruitment) and hiring
from outside the organization (external recruitment) come with advantages
and disadvantages.
Organizations that face rapidly changing competitive environments and
conditions may need to place a heavier emphasis on external sources in addition to developing internal sources. A possible strategy might be to promote
from within if a qualified applicant exists and to go to external sources if
not. However, for organizations existing in environments that change slowly,
emphasis on promotion from within may be more suitable. Once the various
recruiting policy decisions have been addressed, the actual recruiting methods
can be identified and used for both internal and external recruiting.
INTERNET RECRUITING
The Internet has become the primary means for many employers to search for
job candidates and for applicants to look for jobs. The growth in Internet use
is a key reason that the following employer actions occur:
•
•
•
Adjusting general employer recruiting systems to use new approaches
Identifying new types of recruiting for specific jobs
Training managers and HR professionals on technical recruiting sources,
skills, and responsibilities
E-Recruiting Means
The growth in the Internet has led both employers and employees to use
Internet recruiting tools. Internet links, Web 2.0 sites, blogs, twitters, and other
types of Internet/Web-based usages have become viable parts of recruiting.
One survey of e-recruiting software providers identified numerous firms as
e-recruiting clients, and some of them serve more than 1,000 employers.24 Of
the many recruiting sites using special software, the most common ones are
Internet job boards, professional/career websites, and employer websites.
Internet Job Boards Numerous Internet job boards, such as Monster and
Yahoo! HotJobs, provide places for employers to post jobs or search for
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 188
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
189
candidates. Job boards offer access to numerous candidates. Some Internet
locations allow recruiters to search one website, such as MyJobHunter.com, to
obtain search links to many other major job sites. Applicants can also use these
websites to do one match and then send résumés to all jobs in which they are
interested.25 However, a number of the individuals accessing these sites are “job
lookers” who are not serious about changing jobs, but are checking out compensation levels and job availability in their areas of interest. Despite such concerns,
HR recruiters find general job boards useful for generating applicant responses.
Professional/Career Websites Many professional associations have employment sections at their websites. As illustration, for HR jobs, see the Society
for Human Resource Management site, www.shrm.org, or WorldatWork,
www.worldatwork.org. The SHRM organization has established a Job Posting
Center that numerous recruiters and employers can use to post a wide range
of industry openings.26 A number of private corporations maintain specialized
career or industry websites to focus on IT, telecommunications, engineering,
medicine, and other areas. Use of these targeted websites may limit somewhat
recruiters’ search time and efforts. Also, posting jobs on such websites is likely
to target applicants specifically interested in the job field and may reduce the
number of applications from less-qualified applicants.
Employer Websites Despite the popularity of job boards and association
job sites, many employers have learned that their own websites can be most
effective and efficient when recruiting candidates. The most successful of these
websites are created by highly prominent firms and take extensive actions to
guide job seekers to their firm.27 Employers include employment and career
information on their websites under headings such as “Employment” or
“Careers.” This is the place where recruiting (both internal and external) is
often conducted. On many of these sites, job seekers are encouraged to e-mail
résumés or complete online applications.
It is important for the recruiting and employment portions of an employer
website to be seen as part of the marketing efforts of the firm.28 The formatting of the employment section of an organizational website must be shaped to
market jobs and organizational careers effectively. A company website should
market the employer by outlining information on the organization, including
its products and services, organizational and industry growth potential, and
organizational operations. The attractiveness, usability, and formatting of an
employer’s website can affect job seekers’ view of that organization positively
or negatively.29 See HR On-the-Job for company website recruiting ideas.
Recruiting and Internet Social Networking
The Internet has led to social networking of individuals on blogs, twitters, and
a range of websites. Many people initially use the social media more than job
board sites.30 Internet connections often include people who work together as
well as past personal contacts and friends.
The informal use of the Web presents some interesting recruiting advantages and disadvantages for both employers and employees. Social networking sites allow job seekers to connect with employees of potential hirers. For
instance, some sites include posts on what it is like to work for a boss, and job
hunters can contact the posters and ask questions. An example is LinkedIn,
which has a job-search engine that allows people to search for contacts who
work for employers with posted job openings.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 189
26/06/10 5:10 PM
190
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
HR on-the-job
Effective Recruiting Using an
Employer Website
Employers who are effective recruiters through their
company websites have sites that enhance the image
of their companies and their jobs. Important guidelines
to creating an effective website include:
•
•
•
Make the site easy to navigate. The
“Employment” or “Careers” button should
be on the home page. Job information should
be no more than three clicks away.
Include information that people want. Describe
the company, its products and services, careers
in the organization, and advantages of working
for the firm.
Use qualifying categories (location, job function,
skills, education, etc.) to help candidates find
the jobs for which they are eligible. Use of such
categories saves time, especially for companies
who are large employers.
•
Use self-assessment checklists to ask candidates
about experience and interests and to direct
them to the jobs that fit them the best.
• Make it easy to apply for a job by providing the
means to build a résumé on the site or to paste
in an existing résumé. Online applications also
should be provided.
• Design the site to provide recruiters with an
additional way to post jobs, search for résumés
and applications, and screen applicants.
Otherwise, it is difficult to manage a busy
website.
• Collect metrics on the site. To determine its
effectiveness, gather information about the site,
such as the number of visitors, hits from ads,
actual hires, and other details.
Firms and employers are now engaging in social collaboration by joining and accessing social technology networks such as MySpace, Facebook,
and many others. Posting job openings on these sites means that millions of
website users can see the openings and can make contact online. Often those
doing recruiting can send individuals to the company website and then process
candidates using electronic résumés or completed online applications.31
Job Applicants and Social Network Sites Many individuals see social
media and networking websites as a key part of online recruiting. A study of
200 users of one such website indicated that the individuals who were job
seeking were doing so for active reasons such as career opportunities, job
inquiries, and others; relatively few of them were passive job seekers who were
just looking at website information.32
Almost half of surveyed employers indicated that instead of using general
job boards, they were changing to social networking and niche job sites for
recruiting workers with specific skills. However, employers who use social networking sites for recruiting must have plans and well-defined recruiting tools
to take full advantage of these sites.33
Recruiting Using Special Technology Means
For a number of years, the Internet has been used by people globally. Several
special Internet tools that can be used as part of recruiting efforts are blogs,
e-videos, and twitters.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 190
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
191
Blogs and Recruiting Both employers and individuals have used blogs as
part of recruiting to fill jobs. Firms such as Best Buy, Microsoft, Honeywell,
and Manpower have used blogs on which individuals could read and provide
content. For instance, describing job openings and recruiting needs on the Best
Buy blog has resulted in individuals responding to job areas such as finance,
marketing, HR, and other specialties. Numerous other employers have used
blogs to generate recruiting results as well.34
E-Video and Recruiting With video capabilities of all types available,
employers are using videos in several ways. Some firms use videos to describe
their company characteristics, job opportunities, and recruiting means.
Suppliers such as Monstor.com, CareerTV, and others have worked with
employer clients to produce online recruitment videos.35
Some of the online videos contain “employment games” for both current
and potential employees that focus on creating positive employment images.
People who are interested in working for the company can then follow up by
using online job application documentation and information. For example,
MITRE, a systems engineering firm, developed a “Job of Honor” video game
that drew more than 5,000 hits in one year; more than 600 people in the
United States and from 25 other countries became registered players in the
game. Participation levels like this have led employers to increase job-related
recruiting and follow-up activities using Web-based linkages.36
Recruiting through Twitter Twitter can be used for many different purposes, including personal, social, legal, and employment-related messages.
More than 7 million people have joined Twitter.com to become “tweeters.”
One professional sent a tweet in January 2009, and by June of that year more
than 20,000 people had responded by contacting JobAngels
with tweets.37
The Twitter system limits messages to 140 specific charLOGGING ON
acters, but even so tweeting has rapidly become a social
RecruitingBlogs.com
network recruiting method. Recruiters send tweet messages
For HR professional resources and
to both active and passive job candidates, and then follow
information on using social networks
up with longer e-mails to computers, personal contacts, and
for recruiting, including Twitter,
other actions to facilitate recruiting. Since Twitter is such a
Facebook, and LinkedIn, visit
relatively new service, how exactly it will be best used for
www.recruitingblogs.com.
recruiting is still evolving.38
Legal Issues in Internet Recruiting
With Internet recruiting expanding, new and different concerns have arisen.
Several of these issues have ethical and moral as well as legal implications. The
following examples illustrate some of these concerns:
•
•
•
•
When companies use screening software to avoid looking at the
thousands of résumés they receive, are rejections really based on the
qualifications needed for the job?
How can a person’s protected-category and other information be
collected and analyzed for reports?
Are too many individuals in protected categories being excluded from the
later phases of the Internet recruiting process?
Which applicants really want jobs? If someone has accessed a job board
and sent an e-mail asking an employer about a job opening, does the
person actually want to be an applicant?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 191
26/06/10 5:10 PM
192
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
•
What are the implications of Internet recruiting in terms of
confidentiality and privacy?
Loss of privacy is a potential disadvantage with Internet recruiting. Sharing
information gleaned from people who apply to job boards or even company
websites has become common. As a company receives résumés from applicants, it is required to track those applicants and report to the federal government. But the personal information that can be seen by employers on websites
such as MySpace, Facebook, LinkedIn, and others may be inappropriate and
can possibly violate legal provisions. Also, blogging creates enough possible
legal concerns that regulations may be implemented by the U.S. Federal Trade
Commission (FTC).39
Employment lawyers are issuing warnings to employers about remarks and
other characteristics posted on LinkedIn, Facebook, and Twitter. According
to one survey of employers, about three-fourths of hiring managers in
various-sized companies checked persons’ credentials on LinkedIn, about
half used Facebook, and approximately one-fourth used Twitter.40 Some of
the concerns raised have included postings of confidential details about an
employee’s termination, racial/ethnic background, or gender and the making
of discriminatory comments. All of these actions could lead to wrongful
termination or discrimination lawsuits. Thus, because Internet usage has both
advantages and disadvantages for recruiting, legal advice should be obtained,
and HR employment-related policies, training, and enforcement should
include such advice.
Advantages of Internet Recruiting
Employers have found a number of advantages to using Internet recruiting. A
primary one is that many employers have saved money using Internet recruiting versus other recruiting methods such as newspaper advertising, employment agencies, and search firms, all of which can cost substantially more.
Another major advantage is that a very large pool of applicants can be
generated using Internet recruiting. Individuals may view an employer more
positively and obtain more useful information, which can result in more individual applications.41 In fact, a large number of candidates may see any given
job listing, although exposure depends on which Internet sources are used.
One side benefit of Internet recruiting is that jobs literally are posted globally,
so potential applicants in other geographic areas and countries can view job
openings posted on the Internet. It also improves the ability to target specific
audiences, including more diverse persons, through the use of categories, information, and other variables.42
Internet recruiting also can save time. Applicants can respond quickly to
job postings by sending electronic responses, rather than using “snail mail.”
Recruiters can respond more rapidly to qualified candidates in order to obtain
more necessary applicant information, request additional candidate details,
and establish times for further communication, including interviews.43
A good website and useful Internet resources also can help recruiters
reach “passive” job seekers—those who have a good job and are not really
looking to change jobs but who might consider it if a better opportunity
were presented. These individuals often do not list themselves on job boards, but
they might visit a company website for other reasons and check out the careers
or employment section. A well-designed corporate website can help stimulate
interest in some passive job seekers, as well as other potential candidates.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 192
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
193
Recruiting and Labor Markets
Disadvantages of Internet Recruiting
The positive things associated with Internet recruiting come with a number of
disadvantages. Because of broader exposure, Internet recruiting often creates additional work for HR staff members and others internally. More online job postings
must be sent; many more résumés must be reviewed; more e-mails, blogs, and twitters need to be dealt with; and expensive specialized software may be needed to
track the increased number of applicants resulting from Internet recruiting efforts.
Another issue with Internet recruiting is that some applicants may have
limited Internet access, especially individuals from lower socioeconomic
groups and from certain racial/ethnic groups. In addition, many individuals
who access Internet recruiting sources are browsers who may submit résumés
just to see what happens, but they are not actively looking for new jobs.
Internet recruiting is only one approach to recruiting, but its use has been
expanding. Information about how Internet recruiting methods compare with
other, more traditional approaches is relevant. Also, how well the Internet
recruiting resources perform must be compared to the effectiveness and integration of other external and internal recruiting sources.
EXTERNAL RECRUITING SOURCES
Even when the overall unemployment rate increases, numerous jobs and/or
employers still face recruiting challenges. External recruiting is part of effective
HR staffing. Regardless of the methods used, external recruiting involves some
common advantages and disadvantages, which are highlighted in Figure 6-5.
Some of the prominent traditional and evolving recruiting methods are highlighted next.
Media Sources
Media sources such as newspapers, magazines, television, radio, and billboards
typically have been widely used in external recruiting. Some firms have sent
FIGURE 6-5
Advantages and Disadvantages of External Recruiting
ADVANTAGES
New sources bring new
perspectives.
Training new hires may be
cheaper and faster because
of prior external experience.
New hires are likely to have
fewer internal political
supporters in the firm.
New hires may bring new
industry insights and
expertise.
DISADVANTAGES
The firm may not select
someone who will fit well
with the job and the
organization.
The process may cause
morale problems for internal
candidates not selected.
New employees may require
longer adjustment periods
as well as orientation efforts.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 193
26/06/10 5:10 PM
194
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
direct mail using purchased lists of individuals in certain fields or industries.
Internet usage has led to media sources being available online, including postings, ads, videos, webinars, and many other expanding media services. In some
cities and towns, newspaper ads are still very prominent, though they may
trigger job searchers to go to an Internet source for more details.
Recruiting differs depending on company and location; for instance, filling jobs at community banks in rural areas might involve different types of
recruiting from filling jobs in larger banks in urban areas.44 Whatever medium
is used, it should be tied to the relevant labor market and should provide sufficient information on the company and the job. Thus, one major key is to
make the wording of job ads readable and understandable, rather than using
extensive abbreviations and omitting appealing details.45 Figure 6-6 shows the
kinds of information a good recruiting ad contains.
Evaluating Media Ads HR recruiters should measure the responses that different media generate in order to evaluate the effectiveness of various sources.
The easiest way to track responses to ads is to use different contact names,
e-mail addresses, or phone number codes in each ad, so the employer can identify which advertisement has prompted each applicant response that is received.
Although the total number of responses to each ad should be tracked, judging the success of an ad only by this number is a mistake. For example, it is
better to have 10 responses with two qualified applicants than 30 responses
with only one qualified applicant. Therefore, after individuals are hired,
follow-up should be done to see which sources produced the employees who
stay longer and perform better.
FIGURE 6-6
What to Include in an Effective Recruiting Ad
Information on the Job and on the Application Process
Job title and responsibilities
Geographic/flexible location of job
Starting pay range
Acceptance of online applications
Where/how to submit application or résumé details
Closing date of application
Desired Candidate Qualifications
Years of experience
Three to five key characteristics of successful
candidates
Special useful work capabilities
Effective Details in
Recruiting Ads
Information on the Organization
Organizational values and culture
An EEO employer
Primary business capabilities
Unique characteristics and recognition
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 194
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
195
Competitive Recruiting Sources
Other sources for recruiting include professional and trade associations, trade publications, and competitors. Many professional societies and trade associations publish newsletters or magazines and have websites containing job ads. Such sources
may be useful for recruiting the specialized professionals needed in an industry.
Some employers have extended recruiting to customers. Retailers such
as Wal-Mart and Best Buy have aggressive programs to recruit customers to
become employees in stores. While in the store, customers at these firms can
pick up applications, apply online using kiosks, and even schedule interviews
with managers or HR staff members. Other firms have included employment
announcements when sending out customer bills or newsletters.
Employment Agencies
Employment agencies, both public and private, are a recruiting source. Every
state in the United States has its own state-sponsored employment agency.
These agencies operate branch offices in cities throughout the states and do
not charge fees to applicants or employers. They also have websites that potential applicants can use without having to go to the offices.
Private employment agencies operate in most cities. For a fee collected
from either the employee or the employer, these agencies do some preliminary
screening and put employers in touch with applicants. Private employment
agencies differ considerably in the levels of service, costs, policies, and types of
applicants they provide. One specific type of private agency, the outplacement
firm, is highlighted in the HR Perspective.
“Headhunters” The size of the fees and the aggressiveness with which some
firms pursue candidates for executive and other openings have led to such
firms being called headhunters. These employment agencies focus their efforts
on executive, managerial, and professional positions. The
executive search firms are split into two groups: (1) continLOGGING ON
gency firms that charge a fee only after a candidate has been
Job Agencies.com
hired by a client company, and (2) retainer firms that charge
For information about employment
a client a set fee whether or not the contracted search is
agencies, including a directory of
successful. Most of the larger firms work on a retainer basis.
worldwide agencies spanning many
However, search firms are generally ethically bound not to
employment industries, visit
approach employees of client companies in their search for
www.jobagencies.com.
job candidates for another employer.46
Labor Unions
Labor unions may be a useful source of certain types of workers. For example,
in electrical and construction industries, unions traditionally have supplied
workers to employers. A labor pool is generally available through a union,
and workers can be dispatched from the hiring hall to particular jobs to meet
the needs of employers.
In some instances, labor unions can control or influence recruiting and
staffing activity. An organization with a strong union may have less flexibility
than a nonunion company in deciding who will be hired and where those
people will be placed. Unions can benefit employers through apprenticeship
and cooperative staffing programs, as they do in the building and printing
industries.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 195
26/06/10 5:10 PM
196
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Outplacement Firms as
Recruiting Sources
Outplacement firms typically aid individuals who have
lost jobs with obtaining reemployment. As mentioned
in earlier chapters, jobs can be lost because specific
employees are removed from their jobs, because broad
organizational downsizing or department reorganization
occurs, or because people leave their jobs. Causes for
eliminating specific persons or for people leaving jobs
can include work factors, managerial conflicts, and
various personal or work-life reasons.
The outplacement firms offer individuals a number
of services, such as career counseling, résumé
preparations and revisions, website sourcing, training
on interview skills, and other useful job-related
activities. By providing this assistance, these firms help
individuals improve their job-hunting capabilities.
One beneficial service of many outplacement firms
HR perspective
is helping job seekers develop and utilize personal
networks, composed of past and present professional
industry persons, business contacts from previous jobs,
and other people.
A major asset of large outplacement firms such as
Right Management and Keystone Partners is that they
have contacts with a wide range of employers. They
can contact potential employers and ask them to meet
with outplaced individuals. These firms also utilize
networking contacts with the employers with whom
they have worked in the past.
In summary, outplacement firms provide a
“recruiting bank” for both job-searching individual
clients and employers needing new recruits. Because
such firms serve both groups, they are another
recruiting source that is widely used.47
Job Fairs and Creative Recruiting
Employers in various labor markets needing to fill a large number of jobs
quickly have used job fairs and special recruiting events. Job fairs have
been held by economic development entities, employer and HR associations, and other community groups to help bring employers and potential
job candidates together. For instance, the SHRM chapter in a midwestern
metropolitan area annually sponsors a job fair at which 75 to 100 employers can meet applicants. Publicity in the city draws several hundred potential
recruits for different types of jobs. However, two cautionary notes are in order:
(1) Some employers at job fairs may see attendees who are currently their
employees “shopping” for jobs with other employers; and (2) “general” job
fairs are likely to attract many people, including attendees who are not only
unemployed but also unemployable. Industry- or skill-specific events usually
offer more satisfactory candidates. Such job fairs also can attract employed
candidates who are casually looking around but may not put their résumés
on the Internet.
“Virtual” job fairs with Web-based links have been used by the federal
government and others. “Drive-through” job fairs at shopping malls have been
used by employers in a number of communities. At one such event, interested
persons could drive up to a tent outside the mall, pick up applications from
a “menu board” of employers, and then park and interview in the tent with
recruiters if time allowed. Such creative recruiting methods sometimes can be
used to generate a pool of qualified applicants so that jobs can be filled in a
timely manner.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 196
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
197
Recruiting and Labor Markets
Educational Institutions and Recruiting
College and university students are a significant source of entry-level professional and technical employees. Most universities maintain career placement
offices in which employers and applicants can meet. A number of considerations affect an employer’s selection of colleges and universities at which to
conduct interviews, as Figure 6-7 indicates.
Because college/university recruiting can be expensive and require significant
time and effort, employers need to determine whether both current and future
jobs require persons with college degrees in specific fields. Despite the economic
changes in industries and among employers, a majority of employers who were
surveyed still plan to have more than half of their hires be college graduates.48
A number of factors determine success in college recruiting. Some employers actively build continuing relationships with individual faculty members
and career staff at designated colleges and universities. Maintaining a presence
on campus by providing guest speakers to classes and student groups increases
the contacts for an employer. Employers with a continuing presence and support on a campus are more likely to see positive college recruiting results.
Desirable Capabilities of College Recruits For many employers, a moderately high grade point average (GPA) is a criterion for considering candidates
for jobs during on-campus interviews. Recruiters may use GPA benchmarks
to initially screen applicants in college recruiting decisions. Considerations
beyond grades include the graduates’ leadership potential, interpersonal
communication skills, and professional motivation factors.49 Employers also
FIGURE 6-7
College Recruiting: Considerations for Employers
Organizational budget
and college graduate
pay levels
Experiences with
prior college graduates
and interns
Current/anticipated
job openings
College
Recruiting:
Employer Aspects
Reputation of firm at
college and with
previous graduates
College graduate
specialty programs
and faculty links
College placement office
reputation, assistance,
and programs
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 197
26/06/10 5:10 PM
198
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
HR on-the-job
Internships as Part of College
Recruiting
Many employers utilize internships as a basis
for recruiting college students and graduates.
Companies using internships believe they achieve
better retention through the use of internships and
cooperative programs. Well-planned internships
have the potential to benefit both the individual
student interns and the employers.50 A student gets
an opportunity to see if an employer and its culture
fit, and the employer gets the equivalent of several
months worth of “interview experiences” instead
of the short traditional one. The following basic
guidelines for the employer can help improve the
odds that internships will be rewarding:
•
Decide what the company needs in terms of
specific jobs and projects, rather than just
providing general internships.
•
•
•
If interns are paid, provide relatively realistic
competitive wages, as that will help attract
talented individuals.
Treat the interns like new employees by giving
them appropriate work spaces, tools, Internet
access, and other resources.
Effectively manage the interns, including
training, mentoring, and performance feedback.
The growth in IT resources has led to some “virtual
internships.”51 In these arrangements, interns can access
an employer’s website, do project work, and interact
with managers and others via e-mail, text-messages,
and other means. Still, having some personal contact
is likely to be useful for establishing the employer and
intern images and relationships, which can lead to
successful job offers for some interns.
are more likely to hire college candidates with related experience. That is
one reason why internships are very important to employers, candidates, and
college/university efforts, as the HR On-the-Job indicates.
School Recruiting High schools and vocational/technical schools may be
valuable sources of new employees for some organizations. Many schools have
a centralized guidance or placement office. Participating in career days and
giving company tours to school groups are ways of maintaining good contact
with school sources. Cooperative programs, in which students work part-time
and receive some school credits, also may be useful in generating qualified
future applicants for full-time positions.
Employers recognize that they may need to begin attracting students with
capabilities while those students are in high school. For example, GE, IBM,
and other corporations fund programs to encourage students with science and
math skills to participate in engineering internships during summers. Some
employers specifically target talented members of racial/ethnic groups in high
schools and provide them with career encouragement, summer internships,
and mentoring programs as part of aiding workforce diversity efforts.
INTERNAL RECRUITING METHODS
Filling openings internally may add motivation for employees to stay
and grow in the organization rather than pursuing career opportunities
elsewhere. The most common internal recruiting methods include: organizational databases, job postings, promotions and transfers, current-employee
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 198
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
199
Recruiting and Labor Markets
FIGURE 6-8
Advantages and Disadvantages of Internal Recruiting
ADVANTAGES
DISADVANTAGES
The morale of a promotee
is usually high.
The firm can better assess
a candidate’s abilities due
to prior work actions.
Recruiting costs are lower
for some jobs.
The process is a motivator
for good performances by
employees.
The process can aid
succession planning,
future promotions, and
career development.
The firm may have to hire
only at the entry level and
then move employees up
based on experience and
performance.
“Inbreeding” of employees
may result in a less diverse
workforce, as well as a lack
of new ideas.
Those persons not promoted
may experience morale
problems.
Employees may engage in
“political” infighting for
promotions.
A development program
often is needed to transfer
employees into supervisory
and management jobs.
Some managers may resist
having employees promoted
into their departments.
referrals, and rerecruiting of former employees and applicants. Some of the
common advantages and disadvantages of internal recruiting are highlighted
in Figure 6-8.
Internal Recruiting Databases and Internet-Related
Sources
HR information technology systems allow HR staff to maintain background
and knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSA) information on existing employees.
As openings arise, HR can access databases by entering job requirements
and then get a listing of current employees meeting those requirements.
Employment software can sort employee data by occupational fields, education, areas of career interests, previous work histories, and other variables. For
instance, if a firm has an opening for someone with an MBA and marketing
experience, the key words MBA and marketing can be entered in a search field,
and the program displays a list of all current employees with these two items
identified in their employee profiles.
The advantage of such databases is that they can be linked to other HR
activities. Opportunities for career development and advancement are
a major reason why individuals stay at or leave their employers. With
employee databases, internal opportunities for individuals can be identified. Employee profiles are continually updated to include such items as
additional training and education completed, special projects handled, and
career plans and desires noted during performance appraisals and career
mentoring discussions.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 199
26/06/10 5:10 PM
200
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Job Posting
The major means for recruiting current employees for other jobs within the
organization is job posting, a system in which the employer provides notices
of job openings and employees respond by applying for specific openings.
Without some sort of job posting system, it is difficult for many employees to
find out what jobs are open elsewhere in the organization. In many unionized
organizations, job posting and bidding can be quite formal because the procedures are often spelled out in labor agreements. Seniority lists may be used by
organizations that make promotions based strictly on seniority.
Regardless of the means used, the purpose of the job posting system is to
provide employees with more opportunities to move within the organization.
When establishing and managing a job posting system, a number of questions
must be addressed:
•
•
•
•
What happens if no qualified candidates respond to postings?
Must employees inform their supervisors that they are applying for
another job?
Are there restrictions on how long an employee must stay in a job before
applying for another internal one?
What types of or levels of jobs will not be posted?
Internet/Web-Based Job Posting While many employers historically have
had some kind of job posting system in place for internal jobs, a number of
companies are using proactive efforts to get employees to apply through Webbased systems. Kenexa, Oracle, Softscape, LinkedIn, ResumePal, Facebook,
and JobFox are just some of the vendors that provide internal recruiting
website job posting. The complexity of using such job posting methods varies according to the employer and the technology capabilities and systems
available.52 Employees can log onto a company intranet and create personal
profiles, including career objectives, education, skill sets, and pay expectations.
They also may attach a résumé. When a job opens, the placement program
automatically mines the database for matches. Candidates then are notified by
e-mail and go through the regular hiring cycle.
Effective Job Posting For job posting efforts to be effective, especially with
better-performing employees, posting wording must be relevant and accurate.
Also, the posting should be based on the important characteristics of talented
employees. Those people may be most likely to respond because of the organizational reputation, coworkers and bosses, and the possibility of more important and interesting work.53
Jobs generally are posted before any external recruiting is done. The
organization must allow a reasonable period of time for present employees
to check notices of available jobs before it considers external applicants.
Employees whose bids are turned down should discuss with their supervisors
or someone in the HR area what knowledge, skills, and abilities are needed in
order to improve their opportunities in the future.
Job posting System in which
the employer provides notices
of job openings and employees
respond by applying for
specific openings.
Promotions and Transfers Many organizations choose to fill vacancies
through promotions or transfers from within whenever possible. Firms such
as Verizon Communications, Dow Chemical, Microsoft, and IBM have established systems to encourage employees to learn about current and future career
needs and opportunities. Some advantages of these programs are reducing
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 200
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
201
Recruiting and Labor Markets
Enhancing Opportunities for
Internal Promotion
Recruiting tools can help identify prospective
candidates internally. It has been noted that “if you
are not recruiting your own employees, someone else
will.” This is another way of saying that if employees
have no internal opportunities for advancement, the
best performers will look outside the company.
By taking an electronic look within the company
for candidates to promote, firms may not only save
money, but also enhance the prospects for retention of
current employees. Employers are using HR technology
systems to identify employee capabilities for entering
management positions from within the company. Some
firms have implemented electronic systems for internal
HR perspective
recruiting. The advantage of this Web-based approach
can be seen in statistics that show that in one year, a
significant number of positions were filled internally,
much higher than previously.
When a job opens, Internet programs automatically
look in the company database for qualified applicants,
and those persons can be notified by e-mail or personal
contact. Those individuals can then participate in the
firm’s hiring process by registering their profiles easily
and quickly. Other internal approaches took more time,
and fewer people participated. Thus, these technological
changes have helped with employee recruiting for
promotions and reduced employers’ time and costs.54
employee turnover, enhancing individuals’ skills and talent, and improving
productivity.55 The HR Perspective highlights some of the opportunities of
these programs.
Although often successful, internal transfer and promotion of employees
within the company may have some drawbacks. For instance, a person’s performance on one job may not be a good predictor of performance on another,
because different skills may be required on the new job. Also, as employees
transfer or are promoted to other jobs, individuals must be recruited to fill the
vacated jobs. Planning on how to fill those openings should occur before the
job transfers or promotions, not afterward.
Employee-Focused Recruiting
One reliable source of potential recruits is suggestions from current or former employees. Because current and former employees are familiar with the
employer, most of them will not refer individuals who are likely to be unqualified or who will make them look bad for giving the referral. Also, follow-up
with former employers is likely to be done only with persons who were solid
employees previously.
Current-Employee Referrals A reliable source of people to fill vacancies is composed of acquaintances, friends, and family members of current
employees. The current employees can acquaint potential applicants with the
advantages of a job with the company, furnish e-mails and other means of
introduction, and encourage candidates to apply. Word-of-mouth referrals and
discussions can positively aid organizational attractiveness and lead to more
application decisions by those referred.56 However, using only word-of-mouth
or current-employee referrals can violate equal employment regulations if
protected-class individuals are underrepresented in the current organizational
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 201
26/06/10 5:10 PM
202
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
workforce. Therefore, some external recruiting might be necessary to avoid
legal problems in this area.
Utilizing this source is usually one of the most effective methods of recruiting because many qualified people can be reached at a relatively low cost.
Some firms indicate that more than 60% of new hires are due to employee
referrals.57 In an organization with numerous employees, this approach can
develop quite a large pool of potential employees. As an example, Integris
Health Institute in Oklahoma used a referral program to hire more than 500
medical technicians and nurses in relatively difficult-to-fill jobs. One key component of this program was a referral incentive, whereby the individuals giving
the referrals received up to $1,000 per difficult-to-fill job.58
Employers in many geographic areas and occupational fields have established employee referral incentive programs similar to that at Integris Health
Institute. Mid-sized and larger employers are more likely to use employee
referral bonuses. Some referral programs provide different bonus amounts for
hard-to-fill jobs compared with common openings; in these situations, appropriate legal concerns should be met.59
Rerecruiting of Former Employees and Applicants Former employees
and applicants represent another source for recruitment. Both groups offer
a time-saving advantage because something is already known about them.
Seeking them out as candidates is known as rerecruiting because they were
successfully recruited previously. Former employees are considered an internal
source in the sense that they have ties to the employer; sometimes they are
called “boomerangers” because they left and came back.
Individuals who have left for other jobs sometimes are willing to return
because the other jobs and employers turned out to be less attractive than initially thought. For example, at Qualcomm, a California-based telecommunications firm, about 70% of former Qualcomm individuals who left voluntarily
indicated that they would return if requested.60 The discussion on follow-up
of exit interviews in the previous chapter illustrated that rerecruiting can be a
key recruiting contribution.
To enhance such efforts, some firms have established “alumni reunions”
to keep in contact with individuals who have left, and also to allow the companies to rerecruit individuals as appropriate openings arise. Key issues in the
decision to rerecruit someone include the reasons why the individual left originally and whether the individual’s performance and capabilities were good.
Another potential source consists of former applicants. Although they are
not entirely an internal source, information about them can be found in the
organizational files or an applicant database. Recontacting those who have
previously applied for jobs can be a quick and inexpensive way to fill unexpected openings. For instance, one firm that needed two cost accountants
immediately contacted qualified previous applicants and was able to hire two
persons who were disenchanted with their current jobs at other companies.
RECRUITING EVALUATION AND METRICS
To determine how effective various recruiting sources and methods have been,
it is important to evaluate recruiting efforts. But in a survey, a majority of HR
executives identified that their firms were not getting sufficient metrics on the
quality of hires and how well the new hires fit into the organizations.61
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 202
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
203
Recruiting and Labor Markets
The primary way to find out whether recruiting efforts are financially
effective is to conduct formal analyses as part of recruiting evaluation. An
evaluation done by a consulting firm found that higher shareholder value
occured when using time of successful recruiting as a metric. If recruiting was
completed within two weeks, the study noted that the total return to shareholders was about 60%, compared to about 10% for companies that needed
more than seven weeks to fill job openings. Also, greater use of employee
referrals produced a much higher return to shareholders than use of other
recruiting means.62
Various areas can be measured when evaluating recruiting. Figure 6-9 indicates key recruiting measurement areas in which employers frequently conduct
evaluations.
Evaluating Recruiting Quantity and Quality
To evaluate recruiting, organizations can see how their recruiting efforts
compare with past patterns and with the recruiting performance of other
organizations. Measures of recruiting effectiveness can be used to see whether
sufficient numbers of targeted population groups are being attracted.
For example, one area of concern in recruiting might be protected category
persons. In Chicago, a network-based recruiting firm received only 16 black
and 4 Hispanic applicants out of 276 persons for a customer service job.
Yet Chicago has 37% blacks and 26% Hispanics in its population. Clearly,
the efforts to increase recruiting in these racial/ethnic groups needed major
attention.63
Information about job performance, absenteeism, cost of training, and
turnover by recruiting source also helps adjust future recruiting efforts. For
example, some companies find that recruiting at certain colleges or universities
furnishes stable, high performers, whereas recruiting at other schools provides
employees who are more prone to leave the organization. General metrics for
evaluating recruiting include quantity and quality of applicants.
FIGURE 6-9
Recruiting Measurement Areas
Recruits: Quantity
and Quality
Time to Fill Openings
Costs per
Recruiting Method
Recruitment
Satisfaction Analyses
Recruiting
Measurement
Metric Areas
Process Metrics
Yield Ratios
Selection Rates
Acceptance Rates
Success Base Rates
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 203
26/06/10 5:10 PM
204
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Quantity of Applicants Because the goal of a good recruiting program is
to generate a large pool of applicants from which to choose, quantity is a
natural place to begin evaluation. The basic measure here considers whether
the quantity of recruits is sufficient to fill job vacancies. A related question
is: Does recruiting at this source provide enough qualified applicants with an
appropriate mix of protected-class individuals?
Quality of Applicants In addition to quantity, a key issue is whether or not
the qualifications of the applicant pool are sufficient to fill the job openings.
Do the applicants meet job specifications, and do they perform the jobs well
after hire? What is the failure rate for new hires for each recruiter? Measures
that can be used include items such as performance appraisal scores, months
until promotion, production quantity, and sales volume for each hire.
Evaluating Recruiting Satisfaction
The satisfaction of two groups is useful in evaluating recruiting. Certainly
the views of managers with openings to fill are important, because they
are “customers” in a very real sense. But the applicants (those hired and those
not hired) also are an important part of the process and can provide useful
input.
Managers can respond to questions about the quality of the applicant
pool, the recruiter’s service, the timeliness of the process, and any problems
that they see. Applicants might provide input on how they were treated, their
perceptions of the company, and the length of the recruiting process and other
aspects.
Evaluating the Time Required to Fill Openings
Looking at the length of time it takes to fill openings is a common means of
evaluating recruiting efforts.64 If openings are not filled quickly with qualified
candidates, the work and productivity of the organization are likely to suffer.
If it takes 45 days to fill empty positions, managers who need those employees
will be unhappy. Also, as noted earlier, unfilled positions cost money.
Generally, it is useful to calculate the average amount of time it takes from
contact to hire for each source of applicants, because some sources may produce recruits faster than others. For example, one firm calculated the following
averages for nonexempt, warehouse and manufacturing jobs:
Source
Internet applicants
Employment agencies
Walk-in candidates
Employee referrals
Average Time from Contact to Hire
32
25
17
12
days
days
days
days
These data revealed that, at least for this firm, the Internet methods and use
of employment agencies took significantly longer to fill the openings than
did relying on other means. Matching the use of sources to the time available
showed that employee referrals resulted in faster recruiting results for that
particular group of jobs. However, different results might occur when filling
executive jobs or highly skilled network technician jobs. Overall, analyses need
to be made both organization-wide and by different types of jobs.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 204
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
205
Recruiting and Labor Markets
Evaluating the Cost of Recruiting
Different formulas can be used to evaluate recruiting costs. The calculation
most often used to measure such costs is to divide total recruiting expenses for
the year by the number of hires for the year:
Recruiting expenses
Number of recruits hired
The problem with this approach is accurately identifying what details should
be included in the recruiting expenses. Should expenses for testing, background checks, relocations, or signing bonuses be included, or are they more
properly excluded?
Once those questions are answered, the costs can be allocated to various
sources to determine how much each hire from each source costs. It is logical that employers should evaluate the cost of recruiting as a primary metric.
Recruiting costs might include costs for employment agencies, advertising,
internal sources, external means, and others.65 The costs also can be sorted
by type of job—costs for hiring managers, secretaries, bookkeepers, and sales
personnel will all be different.
Certainly, cost is an issue, and some employers are quite concerned about
cost per hire, but quality might be the trade-off. For example, if an organizational HR strategy focuses on quality as a competitive advantage, a company
might choose to hire only from the top 15% of candidates for critical jobs.
General Recruiting Process Metrics
Because recruiting activities are important, the costs and benefits associated
with them should be analyzed. A cost–benefit analysis of recruiting efforts may
include both direct costs (advertising, recruiters’ salaries, travel, agency fees,
etc.) and indirect costs (involvement of operating managers, public relations,
image, etc.). Cost–benefit information on each recruiting source can be calculated. Comparing the length of time that applicants hired from each source
stay in the organization with the cost of hiring from that source also offers a
useful perspective.
Yield Ratios One means for evaluating recruiting efforts is yield ratios, which
compare the number of applicants at one stage of the recruiting process with
the number at another stage. The result is a tool for approximating the necessary size of the initial applicant pool. It is useful to visualize yield ratios as
a pyramid in which the employer starts with a broad base of applicants that
progressively narrows. As Figure 6-10 depicts, to end up with five hires for the
job in question, a sample company must begin with 100 applicants in the pool,
as long as yield ratios remain as shown.
A different approach to using yield ratios suggests that over the length of
time, organizations can develop ranges for crucial ratios. When a given indicator ratio falls outside that range, it may indicate problems in the recruiting process. As an example, in college recruiting the following ratios might be useful:
Yield ratio Comparison of
the number of applicants at
one stage of the recruiting
process with the number at
the next stage.
College seniors given second interviews
= Range of 30%–50%
Total number of seniors interviewed
Number who accept offer
= Range of 50%–70%
Number invited to the company to visit
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 205
26/06/10 5:10 PM
206
SECTION 2
FIGURE 6-10
Jobs and Labor
Sample Recruiting Evaluation Pyramid
Hires / Offer recipients
(Yield ratio ⴝ 50%)
5/10
Hires ⴝ 5
Offer recipients ⴝ 10
Offer recipients / Final
interviewees
(Yield ratio ⴝ 66%)
10/15
Hires / Total
initial contacts
(Selection
rate ⴝ 5%)
5/100
Final interviewees ⴝ 15
Final interviewees / Initial
contacts
(Yield ratio ⴝ 15%)
15/100
Formal applicants ⴝ 30
Total initial contacts ⴝ 100
Number hired
= Range of 70%–80%
Number offered a job
Number finally hired
= Range of 10%–20%
Total number interviewed on campus
Selection rate Percentage
hired from a given group of
candidates.
Acceptance rate Percent
of applicants hired divided
by total number of applicants
offered jobs.
Selection Rate Another useful calculation is the selection rate, which is the
percentage hired from a given group of candidates. It equals the number hired
divided by the number of applicants; for example, a rate of 30% indicates
that 3 out of 10 applicants were hired. The selection rate is also affected by
the validity of the selection process. A relatively unsophisticated selection program might pick 8 out of 10 applicants for the job. Four of those might turn
out to be good employees. A more valid selection process might pick 5 out of
10 applicants but all perform well. Selection rate measures not just recruiting
but selection issues as well. So do acceptance rate and success base rate.
Acceptance Rate Calculating the acceptance rate helps identify how successful the organization is at hiring candidates. The acceptance rate is the
percent of applicants hired divided by the total number of applicants offered
jobs. After the company goes through all the effort to screen, interview, and
make job offers, hopefully most candidates accept job offers. If they do not,
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 206
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
Recruiting and Labor Markets
207
then HR might want to look at reasons why managers and HR staff cannot
“close the deal.” It is common for HR staff members to track the reasons
candidates turn down job offers. That analysis helps explain the rejection
rate in order to learn how competitive the employer is compared with other
employers and what factors are causing candidates to choose employment
elsewhere.
Success Base Rate A longer-term measure of recruiting effectiveness is the
success rate of applicants. The success base rate can be determined by comparing the number of past applicants who have become successful employees
against the number of applicants they competed against for their jobs, using
historical data within the organization. Also, the success base rate can be compared with the success rates of other employers in the area or industry using
benchmarking data. This rate indicates whether the quality of the employees
hired results in employees who perform well and have low turnover. For example, assume that if 10 people were hired at random, it might be expected that
4 of them would be satisfactorily performing employees. Thus, a successful
recruiting program should be aimed at attracting the 4 in 10 who are capable
of doing well on this particular job.
Realistically, no recruiting program will attract only the people who will
succeed in a particular job. However, efforts to make the recruiting program
attract the largest proportion possible of those in the base rate group can make
recruiting efforts more productive in both the short and long term.
Increasing Recruiting Effectiveness
Evaluation of recruiting should be used to make recruiting activities more
effective. Some common activities that are reviewed during evaluation are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Résumé mining—a software approach to getting the best résumés for a fit
from a big database
Applicant tracking—an approach that takes an applicant all the way
from a job listing to performance appraisal results
Employer career website—a convenient recruiting place on an
employer’s website where applicants can see what jobs are available
and apply
Internal mobility—a system that tracks prospects in the company and
matches them with jobs as they come open
Realistic job previews—a process that persons can use to get details on
the employer and the jobs
Responsive recruitment—whereby applicants receive timely responses
Recruiting effectiveness can be increased by using the evaluation data to target different applicant pools, tap broader labor markets, change recruiting
methods, improve internal handling and interviewing of applicants, and train
recruiters and managers.
Another key way to increase recruiting effectiveness rests with the recruiters themselves. Those involved in the recruiting process can either turn off
recruits or create excitement. For instance, recruiters who emphasize positive
aspects about the jobs and their employers can enhance recruiting effectiveness. Thus, it is important that recruiters communicate well with applicants
and treat them fairly and professionally. Effective recruiting is a crucial factor
for HR management, as it leads to selecting individuals for employment who
will enhance organizational success.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 207
26/06/10 5:10 PM
208
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
S U M M A R Y
• Recruiting is the process of generating a pool
of qualified applicants for organizational jobs
through a series of activities.
• Recruiting must be viewed strategically as tied to
HR planning, and discussions should be held about
the relevant labor markets in which to recruit.
• The components of labor markets are labor
force population, applicant population, and the
applicant pool.
• Labor markets can be categorized by geographic
area, industry, occupation, qualifications, and
other characteristics.
• Employers must make decisions about
organization-based versus outsourced recruiting, regular versus flexible staffing, and other
aspects of recruiting.
• Efforts should be made to recruit a diverse
workforce, including older workers, individuals
with disabilities, women, and members of racial/
ethnic groups.
• Internet recruiting has grown in use through job
boards, various websites, social networking, and
special technology methods.
• While Internet recruiting may be able to save
costs and time, it also can generate more
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
T H I N K I N G
1. What labor markets should be considered when
recruiting to fill an opening for a sales representative for a pharmaceutical manufacturer?
2. Discuss ways a regional bank could use the
Internet effectively to recruit loan officer
professionals.
3. Describe how a local firm might be able to
utilize college/university interns to generate
H R
•
unqualified applicants and may not reach certain groups of potential applicants.
The decision to use internal or external recruiting sources should consider both the advantages
and disadvantages of each source.
The most common external recruiting sources
are media sources, competitive sources, labor
unions, employment agencies, job fairs and special events, and educational institutions.
The most common methods of internal recruiting include organizational databases, job postings, promotions and transfers, current-employee
referrals, and rerecruiting of former employees
and applicants.
Recruiting efforts should be evaluated as part
of utilizing HR measurement to assess the effectiveness of the methods and approaches.
Recruiting evaluation using recruiting metrics
typically includes evaluating recruiting quantity
and quality, tracking the time to fill openings,
examining the costs and benefits of various
recruiting sources, and determining recruiting
satisfaction.
E X P E R I E N T I A L
Your small marketing company of about 50
workers has traditionally recruited employees using
newspaper print advertisements. Due to diminished
recruiting efforts from your ads, the company is
interested in using more Internet and social media
recruiting. The company President has requested
that you, as HR Manager, prepare an overview
A C T I V I T I E S
future applicants for jobs planned within the
next one to two years.
4. Assume you are going to look for a current job
of interest to you. Utilize broad websites such
as www.Job.com, Yahoo! HotJobs, Monster,
Taleo, and others to learn about job possibilities for yourself.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
of how Internet recruiting efforts will be different
from the traditional methods used by the company. You will need to make a case for why the
company should transition to Internet recruiting
and identify the benefits for doing so. To prepare an overview, review the resources found at
http://www.recruitersnetwork.com/
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 208
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
209
Recruiting and Labor Markets
1. What will your company need to do differently to actively use Internet recruiting as you
compete with other employers for qualified
applicants?
2. As you recruit marketing professionals, identify
the niche websites that you recommend be used
for your Internet postings and the reasons for
your recommendations.
C A S E
Recruiting at Kia
As economic conditions became more demanding for some employers, other firms continued
to recruit people for jobs. One firm, Kia Motors
America, added a large number of jobs at one
of its newer facilities. As a subsidiary of a South
Korean corporation, Kia Motors America added
tons of equipment at its West Point, Georgia,
plant, so that ultimately about 300,000 vehicles
would be produced annually.
As the firm sought recruits to fill its Georgia
plant workforce, more than 40,000 individuals applied for the jobs, the bulk of which were
production and maintenance positions. However,
the need for people in a variety of other occupations, including air-conditioning service people,
cafeteria workers, and medical staff, added to the
depth and scope of Kia’s recruiting. A limited time
frame for applications was set by Kia as part of its
recruitment planning.
In the recruiting process, a variety of regional
and area sources were contacted as part of the Kia
broad publicity and inclusive efforts in the area.
Randy Jackson, HR Director, spent a month visiting colleges and churches, appearing on radio and
television shows, and using other means to market
Kia’s recruiting and employment efforts. All of
these activities were done to inform applicants
about the numerous jobs at Kia and the monthlong time frame for application.
To make its recruiting system effective in
screening the large number of applicants, Kia
established an online-only application process on
a special website. As part of its recruiting efforts,
Kia and a Georgia Department of Labor agency
worked together. One of the agency activities was
to make computers available at a local technical
college, libraries, and other locations for those
persons without home-based Internet. Having
the online system allowed Kia’s HR staff to move
quickly to identify those applicants who matched
available jobs. The use of this system by HR
recruiters and managers doing the hiring made the
selection process more efficient.
To aid in the selection of employees, recruiting software was used to sort applicants into
electronic “buckets,” divided by work experiences
and education. Then an eight-step process was
established to let applicants obtain a realistic
job preview of working at Kia. These recruiting
actions resulted in the hiring of more than 500
new employees within six months. During the
rest of the year, an additional 1,200 workers were
hired, primarily for the second shift, and more
were hired later.
Although smaller employers might not use
such an extensive recruiting process, the Kia process illustrates the kinds of recruiting planning,
activities, Internet linkages, and other means that
can be used by both large and small employers
doing recruiting. The long-term success of Kia’s
efforts to staff its Georgia operation demonstrates
ways in which HR can use both time- and costeffective recruiting to hire qualified individuals.66
QUESTIONS
1. Describe how employing a large number of new
workers requires strategic recruiting planning
and operational efforts, and discuss what
aspects might be different in smaller firms.
2. Discuss how utilizing the Internet, like Kia
did and other employers do, is changing how
recruiting efforts are occurring for a variety of
jobs in employers of different sizes.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 209
26/06/10 5:10 PM
210
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Northwest State College
Enterprise Recruiting
This case shows how recruiting policies can work
against successful recruiting when a tight labor
market exists. (For the case, go to www.cengage
.com/management/mathis.)
This case highlights how a large car rental firm
uses a range of recruiting approaches successfully.
(For the case, go to www.cengage.com/
management/mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Based on John Flanigan,
“Capturing & Captivating the
Passive Job Seeker,” Best Practices
in Candidate Sourcing, Workforce
Management, 2008; Amitai Givertz,
“Passive Candidate Recruiting,”
ZoomInfo White Paper, 2008,
www.zoominfo.com.
2. Rick Be, “Employment Doldrums
May Be Easing, Survey Notes,”
Workforce Management
Online, August 25, 2009,
www.workforce.com.
3. “Ethics as Recruiting Tool,” Journal
of Accountancy, January 2009, 21.
4. “What SmBs Should Look for in
an Applicant Tracking System,”
September 25, 2009, www.taleo.com.
5. John Yuva, “Round Up the
Recruits,” Inside Supply
Management, July 2008, 23–25;
Auren Hoffman, “Why Hiring
Is Paradoxically Harder in a
Downturn,” HR Leaders, July 14,
2009, www.hrleaders.org.
6. U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics,
www.bls.gov.
7. Joe Barrett, “Manufacturers Get
Top Talent for Hard-to-Fill Jobs,”
The Wall Street Journal, May 30,
2009, A5.
8. “Recruiting for Small Firms,”
Journal of Accountancy, December
2008, 40.
9. Kurt Scott, “The Search for Effective
Physician Leaders,” Physician
Executive, March/April 2009,
44–48.
10. Theresa Minton-Eversole, “Mission:
Recruitment,” HR Magazine,
January 2009, 43–45.
11. Bill Roberts, “Manage Candidates
Right from the Start,” HR Magazine,
October 2008, 73–76.
12. Rita Zeidner, “Does the United
States Need Foreign Workers?”
HR Magazine, June 2009, 42–49;
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Paul Gallagher, “H-1B Headaches,”
Human Resource Executive, April
2009, 23–27; Jessica E. Vascellero
and Justin Scheck, “Justice
Department Probes Hiring Practices
in Silicon Valley,” The Wall Street
Journal, June 4, 2009, B3.
John Sullivan, “Countercyclical
Hiring: The Greatest Recruiting
Opportunities in the Last 25 Years,”
Electronic Resource Exchange,
August 24, 2009, www.ere.net.
Based on Mark Schoeff, Jr.,
“Managing Change: USDA Food
Safety and Inspection Service,”
Workforce Management, October
20, 2008, 26.
“What Is Recruitment Process
Outsourcing?” Recruitment Process
Outsourcing Association, June 2009,
www.RPOassociation.org.
Beth Ellyn Rosenthal, “GE
Looks to Recruitment Process
Outsourcing . . .,” Outsourcing
Journal, October 2006, 1–4.
Justin Lahart, “Employers Shed
Fewer Temp Workers,” The Wall
Street Journal, September 5–6, 2009,
A2; Patrick Buckley, et al., “The
Use of Automated Employment
Recruiting and Screening System for
Temporary Professional Employees,”
Human Resource Management, 43
(2004), 233–241.
Keisha-Ann G. Gray, “Dividing
Lines,” Human Resource Executive
Online, September 8, 2009,
www.hreonline.com.
“Study Ranks Top Diversity
Hiring Tools,” WorldatWork
Newsline, August 21, 2008,
www.worldatwork.org.
Gina Ruiz, “Goodwill Offers
Recruiting Ideas on Training
Hispanic Workers,” Workforce
Management, May 2007,
www.workforce.com.
21. Joanna N. Lahey, “Age, Women,
and Hiring,” Journal of Human
Resources, 43 (2008), 30–56.
22. Mark L. Lengnick-Hall, et al.,
“Overlooked and Underutilized:
People with Disabilities Are an
Untapped Human Resource,”
Human Resource Management, 47
(2008), 255–273.
23. Brendan J. Morse and Paula M.
Popovich, “Realistic Recruitment
Practices in Organizations,” Human
Resource Management Review,
19 (2009), 1–8; William Gardner,
et al., “Attraction to Organizational
Culture Profiles: Effects of Realistic
Recruiting . . .,” Management
Communication Quarterly, 22
(2009), 437–472.
24. “E-Recruiting Software Providers,”
Workforce Management, June 22,
2009, 14.
25. “New Job Search Engine Makes
Finding a Job Easier,” The Career
News, September 21, 2009,
www.thecareernews.com.
26. For details, go to www.shrm.org/jpc.
27. Emma Parry and Shaun Tyson, “An
Analysis of the Use and Success of
OnLine Recruitment Methodism
in the U.K.,” Human Resource
Management Journal, 18 (2008),
257–274.
28. Steven D. Maurer and Yupin Liu,
“Developing Effective E-Recruiting
Websites: Insights for Managers
from Marketers,” Business Horizons,
50 (2007), 305–314.
29. Lori Foster Thompson, et al.,
“E-Recruitment and the Benefits
of Organizational Web Appeal,”
Human Behavior, 24 (2008),
2384–2398.
30. Dan Schaubel, “Skip Job Boards
and Use Social Media Instead,”
BusinessWeek Online, July 29,
2009, 14.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 210
26/06/10 5:10 PM
CHAPTER 6
211
Recruiting and Labor Markets
31. Chris Tratar, “Recruiting by
Relationship to Fill the Candidate
Pipeline,” Workforce Management,
July 20, 2009, S5.
32. Vangie Sison, “Social Media:
Attracting Talent in the Age of
Web 2.0,” Workspan, May 2009,
45–49; Sam De Kay, “Are BusinessOriented Social Networking
Websites Useful Resources for
Locating Passive Job Seekers?”
Business Communications
Quarterly, March 2009, 101–104.
33. Gonzado Hernandez and Ed
Frauenheim, “Logging Off of Job
Boards,” Workforce Management,
June 22, 2009, 25–28.
34. Juki Hasson, “Blogging for Talent,”
HR Magazine, October 2007,
65–68.
35. Andrew R. McIlvaine, “Lights,
Camera, Interview,” Human
Resource Executive, September
16, 2009, 22–25; Rita Zeidner,
“Companies Tell Their Stories
in Recruitment Videos,” HR
Trendbook, 2008, 28.
36. Michael O’Brien, “Building a Buzz,”
Human Resource Executive, June
16, 2008, 36–38.
37. Adrienne Fox, “Newest Social
Medium Has Recruiters All-aTwitter,” HR Disciplines, June 24,
2009, www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines.
38. Tracy Cote and Traci Armstrong,
“Why Tweeting Has Become an
Ad Agency’s Main Job Posting
Strategy . . .?” Workforce
Management Online, May 2009,
www.workforce.com.
39. For details and current status, go to
www.ftc.gov. Also see Ed Fraurnheim
and Rich Bell, “A Tighter Rein
on HR Blogging?” Workforce
Management Online, September
2009, www.workforce.com.
40. Tresa Baidas, “Lawyers Warn
Employers Against Giving Glowing
Reviews on LinkedIn,” National
Law Journal, July 6, 2009,
www.nlj.com.
41. Marcel J. H. Van Birgelen, et al.,
“Effectiveness of Corporate
Employment Web Sites,”
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
International Journal of Manpower,
29 (2008), 731–751.
Caren B. Goldberg and David
G. Allen, “Black and White and
Read All Over: Race Differences
in Reactions to Recruitment
Web Sites,” Human Resource
Management, 47 (2008), 217–236.
Gary Crispin, “The Future of
Recruiting,” Human Resource
Executive, September 16, 2009,
32–35.
Eric Robbins and Forest Myers,
“The Staffing Challenges Lie Ahead
for Community Banks,” RMA
Journal, April 2009, 18–23.
Mo Edjlali, “The 2 Keys to Killer
Job Ads,” Electronic Recruiting
Exchange, July 27, 2006,
www.ere.net.
Stephanie Overman, “Searching for
the Top,” HR Magazine, January
2008, 47–52.
Fay Hansen, “Recruiters Seeking
Untapped Talent Among
Outplacement Firms,” Workforce
Management Online, March 2009.
Theresa Minton-Eversole,
“Companies Plan Modest Hiring
of 2009 College Graduates,” HR
Disciplines, April 17, 2009,
www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines.
George Violette and Douglas Chene,
“Campus Recruiting: What Local
and Regional Accounting Firms
Look for in New Hires,” CPA
Journal, December 2008, 66–68.
Donna M. Owens, “College
Recruiting in a Downturn,” HR
Magazine, April 2009, 51–54.
Jonnelle Marte, “An Internship
from Your Couch,” The Wall Street
Journal, September 29, 2009, D1.
Bill Kutik, “Still Trying to Get
Recruiting Right,” Human Resource
Executive Online, April 6, 2009,
www.hreonline.com/HRE.
Peter Weddle, “The Really Big
Impact of a Small Number of
Sentient Specifics,” Dice Review, July
2009, http://marketing.dice.com.
Kathryn Tyler, “Helping Employees
Step Up,” HR Magazine, August 1,
2007, 48.
55. Sarah E. Needleman, “New Career,
Same Employer,” The Wall Street
Journal, April 21, 2008, B9.
56. Greet Von Hoye and Filip Lievens,
“Tapping the Grapevine: A Closer
Look at Word-of-Mouth as a
Recruitment Source,” Journal of
Applied Psychology, 94 (2009),
341–352.
57. Robert Gandossy and Tina Kao,
“The Right People, Right Now . . .,”
WorkSpan, December 2007,
71–74.
58. Leo Jakobson, “Nursing: A Referral
Program,” Incentive, April 2007,
36–39.
59. “What Issue Should We Consider
in Implementing Employee Referral
Program?” HRCompliance, August
15, 2009, www.hrcompliance
.cerdian.com.
60. Michael O’Brien, “Gone, But Not
Forgotten,” Human Resource
Executive, September 2, 2009,
30–33.
61. Stephanie Overman, “Staffing
Management: Measure What
Matters,” Staffing Management,
October 1, 2008, www.shrm.org.
62. Ed Emerman, “Effective Recruiting
Tied to Strong Financial
Performance,” Watson-Wyatt
Workside, 2009, www.watsonwyatt
.com/news.
63. Fay Hansen, “Sourcing
Disappears as Applications Pile
Up for Overwhelmed Recruiters,”
Workforce Management Online,
July 23, 2009, www.workforce.com.
64. “Building Championship Recruiting
Teams,” Staffing Exclusives,
April 14, 2009, www.
StaffingInstitute.org.
65. Alice Snell, “Focus on Process
to Reduce Your Recruiting Costs,”
Best Practices in Recruitment,
2009, www.workforce.com, S5.
66. Based on Julie Cook Ramirez,
“Engines of Growth,” Human
Resource Executive, August 2009,
36–39; Larry Copeland, “Kia
Breathes Life into Old Georgia
Textile Mill Town,” USA Today,
March 25, 2010, 5A.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 211
26/06/10 5:10 PM
C H A P T E R
7
Selecting Human
Resources
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Summarize the importance of realistic job previews and application
screening efforts to the selection process.
•
Diagram the sequence of a typical selection process.
•
Discuss how validity and reliability are related to selection.
•
Identify three types of selection tests and legal concerns about
their uses.
•
Contrast several types of selection interviews and some key
considerations in conducting these interviews.
•
Specify how legal concerns affect background investigations of applicants
and use of medical examinations in the selection process.
•
Describe the major issues to be considered when selecting candidates
for global assignments.
212
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 212
26/06/10 5:12 PM
HR Headline
Using Virtual Worlds for Selection
S
ome employers are experimenting with
a virtual online community to screen
possible hires. The program allows job
candidates to create a computer-generated
image to represent them and to communicate with employers as if text-messaging. The
image is called an “avatar.” The avatar can be
used to interview or to attend virtual job fairs.
Company representatives also create avatars.
The interactions among these creations in a virtual environment become the basis for screening decisions.
Those who are less tech-savy are finding that
they can shoot themselves in their virtual feet.
Some people have a difficult time designing
and controlling their avatars. For example, one
candidate spent 6 hours working on his avatar
and could not figure out how to make him sit in
a chair; he finally decided to let him sit on top
of the chair instead. Other candidates’ avatars
at an online job fair began floating in the air.
It is not just applicants who have difficulties.
Company representatives are not used to recruiting in the virtual world
either. One consulting company partner’s avatar slumped over by accident and looked like it had gone to sleep during an interview. Mishaps
involving avatars are usually viewed as amusing. The mistakes can even
be icebreakers. One candidate attending the job fair tried to hand a copy
of his résumé to a Hewlett-Packard employee and instead handed her a
virtual beer. Luckily they both laughed it off, and the candidate was given
an opportunity to continue the interview process.
Using this virtual interaction is cheaper than holding an actual job fair.
Higher-ups in the company who might want to attend can do so easily as
avatars. Job seekers seem to be much more relaxed in the virtual environment than they would be at a real job fair, since they have time to think
213
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 213
26/06/10 5:12 PM
214
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
before they type their responses rather than having to think and talk at
the same time.
Employers say they do not view this as a replacement for traditional
selection, but rather as an additional step that can help narrow the field
of candidates for some jobs. “This is really a supplement to our regular
recruiting practices,” says a manager for Hewlett-Packard.1
Some would argue that picking the right people for the jobs that need to
be done is the most important part of human resource management.2 Certainly
for a business that depends on good people and good performance for the
organization to succeed, its importance is very high. For an organization that
is failing, improvement may need to come from many different sources, but it
is difficult to imagine appropriate changes coming without some new competent people to carry out those changes. In athletic organizations that are not
doing well, it is the selection of new coaches and players that creates improvements, if any are to come, and the continued selection of good athletes and
coaches that allows ongoing success.
SELECTION AND PLACEMENT
Selection is the process of choosing individuals with the correct qualifications
needed to fill jobs in an organization. Without these qualified employees, an
organization is far less likely to succeed. A useful perspective on selection and
placement comes from two HR observations that underscore the importance
of effective staffing:
•
“Hire hard, manage easy.” The investment of time and effort in selecting
the right people for jobs will make managing them as employees much
less difficult because many problems are eliminated.
• “Good training will not make up for bad selection.” When people
without the appropriate aptitudes are selected, employers will have
difficulty training them to do those jobs that they do not fit.3
Placement
Selection The process of
choosing individuals with the
correct qualifications needed
to fill jobs in an organization.
Placement Fitting a person
to the right job.
Person/job fit Matching the
KSAs of individuals with the
characteristics of jobs.
The ultimate purpose of selection is placement, or fitting a person to the right
job. Placement of human resources should be seen primarily as a matching
process. How well an employee is matched to a job can affect the amount and
quality of the employee’s work, as well as the training and operating costs
required to prepare the individual for work life. Further, employee morale is
an issue because good fit encourages individuals to be positive about their jobs
and what they accomplish.4
Selection and placement activities typically focus on applicants’ knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs), but they should also focus on the degree to
which job candidates generally match the situations experienced both on the
job and in the company. Psychologists label this person-environment fit. In
HR it is usually called person/job fit. Fit is related not only to satisfaction with
work but also to commitment to a company, and to quitting intentions.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 214
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
215
Lack of fit between KSAs and job requirements can be classified as a “mismatch.” A mismatch results from poor pairing of a person’s needs, interests,
abilities, personality, and expectations with characteristics of the job, rewards,
and the organization in which the job is located. Five mismatch situations are:5
•
•
•
•
•
Skills/job qualifications
Geography/job location
Time/amount of work
Earnings/expectations
Work/family
Mismatches related to skills/job qualifications and amount of work/time
required are likely to cause a person to change jobs to improve fit. The other
kinds of mismatches have more to do with conflicts of interests. What makes
placement difficult and complex is the need to match people and jobs on multiple dimensions.6
People already working in jobs can help identify the most important KSAs
for success as part of job analysis. The fit between the individual and job characteristics is particularly important when dealing with overseas assignments
because employees must have the proper personalities, skills, and interpersonal
abilities to be effective in the international environment.
In addition to the match between people and jobs,
employers
are concerned about the congruence between peoLOGGING ON
ple and companies, or the person/organization fit.7 Person/
HR-Guide.com
organization fit is important from a “values” perspective,
This website offers links to HR websites
with many organizations trying to positively link a person’s
relating to selection and staffing
principles to the values of the company. Organizations tend
resources, including information on
to favor job applicants who effectively blend into how
methods, best practices, tests, and
business is conducted. Person/organization fit can influence
software programs. Visit the site at
employees’ and customers’ beliefs about the organization,
www.hr-guide.com.
making this fit a key selection consideration.
Selection, Criteria, Predictors, and Job Performance
Person/organization fit
The congruence between
individuals and organizational
factors.
Selection criterion
Characteristic that a person
must possess to successfully
perform work.
Predictors of selection
criteria Measurable or
visible indicators of selection
criteria.
Regardless of whether an employer uses specific KSAs or a more general
approach, effective selection of employees involves using selection criteria and
predictors of these criteria. At the heart of an effective selection system must
be the knowledge of what constitutes good job performance. When one knows
what good performance looks like on a particular job, the next step is to identify what it takes for the employee to achieve successful performance. These
are called selection criteria. A selection criterion is a characteristic that a person must possess to successfully perform work. Figure 7-1 shows that ability,
motivation, intelligence, conscientiousness, appropriate risk, and permanence
might be selection criteria for many jobs. Selection criteria that might be more
specific to managerial jobs include “leading and deciding,” “supporting and
cooperating,” “organizing and executing,” and “enterprising and performing.”8
To determine whether candidates might possess certain selection criteria (such as ability and motivation), employers try to identify predictors of
selection criteria that are measurable or visible indicators of those positive
characteristics (or criteria). For example, as Figure 7-1 indicates, three good
predictors of “permanence” might be individual interests, salary requirements,
and tenure on previous jobs. If a candidate possesses appropriate amounts of
any or all of these predictors, it might be assumed that the person would stay
on the job longer than someone without those predictors.9
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 215
26/06/10 5:12 PM
216
SECTION 2
FIGURE 7-1
Jobs and Labor
Job Performance, Selection Criteria, and Predictors
The information gathered about an applicant through predictors should
focus on the likelihood that the individual will execute the job competently
once hired. Predictors can be identified through many formats such as application forms, tests, interviews, education requirements, and years of experience,
but such factors should be used only if they are found to be valid predictors of
specific job performance.10 Using invalid predictors can result in selecting the
“wrong” candidate and rejecting the “right” one.
Validity
Correlation coefficient
Index number that gives
the relationship between
a predictor variable and a
criterion variable.
Concurrent validity
Measured when an employer
tests current employees and
correlates the scores with
their performance ratings.
In selection, validity is the correlation between a predictor and job performance. In other words, validity occurs to the extent that the predictor actually
predicts what it is supposed to predict. Several different types of validity are
used in selection. Most validity decisions use a correlation coefficient, an index
number that gives the relationship between a predictor variable and a criterion
(or dependent) variable. Correlations always range from −1.0 to +1.0, with
higher absolute scores suggesting stronger relationships.
Concurrent validity is one method for establishing the validity associated
with a predictor. Concurrent validity uses current employees to validate a
predictor or “test.” As shown in Figure 7-2, concurrent validity is measured
when an employer tests current employees and correlates the scores with
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 216
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
217
Selecting Human Resources
FIGURE 7-2
Concurrent and Predictive Validity
Concurrent Validity
Predictive Validity
Current Employees
Applicants
Review Job
Performance
(past records)
Give Employment
Test
Give Employment
Test
Hire Applicants
without
Considering Tests
Measure Job
Performance
Success
Score the Test
Score the Test
Evaluate Job
Performance (later)
Compare Results
Compare Results
Measure Job
Performance
Success
If Correlation Is
Significant, Validity
Exists
Correlation Can Be
Used as a Predictor of
Job Success with Future
Applicants
Predictive validity
Measured when test results of
applicants are compared with
subsequent job performance.
their performance ratings on such measures as their scores on performance
appraisals.
A disadvantage of the concurrent validity approach is that employees who
have not performed satisfactorily at work are probably no longer with the
firm and therefore cannot be tested. Also, extremely good employees may have
been promoted or may have left the company for better work situations. Any
learning on the job also might confound test scores.
Another method for establishing criterion-related validity is predictive
validity. To calculate predictive validity, test results of applicants are compared with their subsequent job performance (see Figure 7-2). Job success is
measured by assessing factors such as absenteeism, accidents, errors, and performance appraisal ratings. If the employees who had one year of experience
at the time of hire demonstrate better performance than those without such
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 217
26/06/10 5:12 PM
218
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
experience, then the experience requirement can be considered a valid predictor of job performance. In addition, individual experience may be utilized as
an important “selection criterion” when making future staffing decisions.
The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission (EEOC) has favored
predictive validity because it includes the full range of performance and test
scores. However, establishing predictive validity can be challenging for managers because a large sample of individuals is needed (usually at least 30) and a
significant amount of time must transpire (perhaps one year) to facilitate the
analysis. Because of these limitations, other types of validity calculations tend
to be more popular.
Reliability Reliability of a predictor or “test” is the extent to which it repeatedly produces the same results over time. For example, if a person took a test
in December and scored 75, and then took the same test again in March and
scored 76, the exam is probably a reliable instrument. Consequently, reliability
involves the consistency of predictors used in selection procedures. A predictor
that is not reliable is of no value in selection.
Combining Predictors
If an employer chooses to use only one predictor, such as a pencil-and-paper
test, to select the individuals to be hired, the decision becomes straightforward. If the test is valid and encompasses a major dimension of a job, and an
applicant does well on the test, then that person should be given a job offer.
When an employer uses predictors such as “three years of experience,” “possesses a college degree,” and “acceptable aptitude test score,” job applicants
are evaluated on all of these requirements and the multiple predictors must be
combined in some way. Two approaches for combining predictors are:
•
•
Multiple hurdles: A minimum cutoff is set on each predictor, and each
minimum level must be “passed.” For example, in order to be hired,
a candidate for a sales representative job must achieve a minimum
education level, a certain score on a sales aptitude test, and a minimum
score on a structured interview.
Compensatory approach: Scores from individual predictors are added
and combined into an overall score, thereby allowing a higher score on
one predictor to offset, or compensate for, a lower score on another. The
combined index takes into consideration performance on all predictors.
For example, when admitting students into graduate business programs,
a higher overall score on an admissions test might offset a lower
undergraduate grade point average.
Selection Responsibilities
Selection is a key responsibility for all managers and supervisors in a company.
However, organizations vary in how they allocate selection responsibilities
between HR specialists and operating managers. The typical selection responsibilities are shown in Figure 7-3. The need to meet EEO requirements and
the inherent strategic implications of the staffing function have caused many
companies to place greater emphasis on hiring procedures and techniques and
to centralize selection in the HR department. In other companies, each department (or its management team) screens and hires its own personnel. Managers,
especially those working in smaller firms, often select their own employees
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 218
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
219
Selecting Human Resources
FIGURE 7-3
Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Selection
HR UNIT
Provides initial reception for applicants
Conducts initial screening interview
Administers appropriate employment
tests
Obtains background and reference
information and sets up a physical
examination, if used
Refers top candidates to managers for
final selection
Evaluates success of selection process
MANAGERS
Requisition employees with specific
qualifications to fill jobs
Participate in selection process as
appropriate
Interview final candidates
Make final selection decision, subject
to advice of HR specialist
Provide follow-up information on
the suitability of selected individuals
because these individuals directly impact their work areas. But the validity and
effectiveness of this approach may be questionable because of lack of training
in selection among operating managers.
Another approach has HR professionals initially screening the job candidates, and the managers or supervisors making the final selection decisions
from the qualified applicant pool. Generally, the higher the positions being
filled, the greater the likelihood that the ultimate hiring decisions will be made
by operating managers rather than HR professionals.
Selection responsibilities are affected by the existence of a central employment office, which is often housed within a human resources department. In
smaller organizations, especially in those with fewer than 100 employees, a
full-time employment specialist or group is impractical. But for larger firms,
centralizing activities in an employment office might be appropriate.
The employment function in any organization may be concerned with
some or all of the following activities: (1) receiving applications, (2) interviewing the applicants, (3) administering tests to applicants, (4) conducting background investigations, (5) arranging for physical examinations, (6) placing
and assigning new employees, (7) coordinating follow-up of these employees,
(8) conducting exit interviews with departing employees, and (9) maintaining
appropriate records and reports.
THE SELECTION PROCESS
Most organizations take a series of consistent steps to process and select
applicants for jobs. Company size, job characteristics, the number of people
needed, the use of electronic technology, and other factors cause variations
on the basic process. Selection can take place in a day or over a much longer
period of time, and certain phases of the process may be omitted or the order
changed, depending on the employer. If the applicant is processed in one day,
the employer usually checks references after selection. Figure 7-4 shows steps
in a typical selection process.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 219
26/06/10 5:12 PM
220
SECTION 2
FIGURE 7-4
Jobs and Labor
Selection Process Flowchart
Applicant Job Interest
Preemployment Screening
Application Form
Test
Interview
Background Investigation
Additional Interview (optional)
Conditional Job Offer
Medical Exam/Drug Test
Job Placement
Applicant Job Interest
Individuals wanting employment can indicate interest in a number of ways.
Traditionally, individuals have submitted résumés by mail or fax, or applied in
person at an employer’s location. But with the growth in Internet recruiting,
many individuals complete applications online or submit résumés electronically.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 220
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
221
Regardless of how individuals express interest in employment, the selection process has an important public relations dimension. Discriminatory
hiring practices, impolite interviewers, unnecessarily long waits, unreturned
telephone inquiries, inappropriate testing procedures, and lack of follow-up
responses can produce unfavorable impressions of an employer. Job applicants’
perceptions of the organization will be influenced by how they are treated.
Realistic Job Previews Many individuals know little about companies
before applying for employment. Consequently, when deciding whether to
accept a job, they pay particularly close attention to the information received
during the selection process, including compensation data, work characteristics, job location, and promotion opportunities. Unfortunately, some employers make jobs appear better than they really are. Realistic job previews provide
potential employees with an accurate introduction to a job so that they can
better evaluate the employment situation. Indeed, a realistic job preview can
directly enhance individual training and clarify a job role. Also, in global
assignments, the use of realistic job previews increases individual confidence
and improves decision making about an expatriate position.
A company should consider several strategies when developing a recruiting brand and conveying it to potential employees via realistic job previews.
The brand of the company should establish in the minds of recruits the company’s overall purpose for being in business, and it should honestly portray
the jobs that are performed by individuals already employed in the firm. A
project director of a recruiting firm suggests that a firm should evaluate its
own strengths and develop a list of employment benefits that would make the
company attractive to potential employees. These points may include building
human capital, good compensation, and ethics and social responsibility. At
the same time, a company needs to convey the less attractive aspects of work,
such as difficult work schedules or extensive travel. However, any negative
job attributes can be outweighed by the positive factors already covered.
Truth-in-Hiring Lawsuits Recruiters may exaggerate promotional opportunities, pay, or even the company’s financial position in an attempt to hire a
candidate. However, a candidate who leaves a good job to accept a position
and later discovers such exaggerations may choose to sue the company for
misrepresenting the job. In some cases, recruiters feel such pressure to “sell”
the company that they “oversell” it. The best way to avoid truth-in-hiring
lawsuits is to use the realistic job preview correctly.11
Preemployment Screening
Many employers conduct preemployment screening to determine if applicants
meet the minimum qualifications for open jobs before they have the applicants
fill out an application.
Realistic job preview
Process through which a job
applicant receives an accurate
picture of a job.
Electronic Assessment Screening The use of electronic preemployment
screening or assessment has grown. Much of this screening utilizes computer
software to review the many résumés and application forms received during the
recruiting and selection process. Large companies often use different types of software to receive, evaluate, and track the applications of many potential employees.
When a job posting generates 1,000 or more applications, which is not
unusual with large companies or in difficult economic times, responding to
each would be a full-time job. Electronic screening can speed up the process.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 221
26/06/10 5:12 PM
222
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
HR perspective
Cheating on Electronic
Assessments
Many retailers make applicants take an assessment online
before interviewing them. If they do not do well on this
“test,” they will not be interviewed. Such tests also are
given at in-store kiosks so hiring managers can interview
high-scoring persons before they leave the store, but 90%
of the time these tests are done online. These assessment
tests ask applicants to agree or disagree with statements
such as “You have to give up on some things that you
start” or “Any trouble you have is your own fault.”
The tests cut the amount of time store managers
spend interviewing and can improve the levels of
measured results in areas such as sales performance,
turnover, safety, and so on; but the tests also create
a culture of cheating and raise questions for some
applicants about their “fairness.” Anton Smith took
such a test when he applied for hourly work at a
sneaker store, but before taking it, he had a friend do
a little digging online to find an unauthorized answer
key. Then when he took the test, Anton had a good idea
how to answer the 130 statements in it. He was hired,
but he does not think the test was useful.
The test Smith took is called UNICRV, which is
used by about 16% of major retailers. The company
that designed it believes the incidence of cheating is
low and does not affect the benefits to retailers of using
it. CVS Caremark is pleased with the test, according to
its head of HR, who says, “I think our field organization
is happy with the quality of the candidate.”
The more critical the test is to getting a job, the
more applicants will try to “game” it. They may take
it several times, compare notes with other test takers,
consult an online cheat sheet, or have a friend take it for
them. Mark Scott took the UNICRV test when applying
at Circuit City and did not get hired. A friend told him
the test disqualified him. He applied to another chain
that uses the test, but this time he had a friend who
coached him because the friend had taken and passed
the test many times. Scott was hired immediately. He
observed that the test process “weeds out people who
are honest and selects those who lie.” Opportunities
to cheat with electronic assessments exist, and people
certainly will find them.12
This may take several forms: disqualification questions; screening questions to
get at KSAs and experience; valid assessment tests; and background, drug, and
financial screening. Some of the assessments might include auditions for the
job that are based on simulations of specific job-related tasks. For example,
in a call center, candidates are given virtual customers with service problems,
and branch manager candidates demonstrate their ability to foster relationships with virtual clients and to make quick personnel decisions with virtual
employees.13
A good strategy is to use simple electronic assessment early to cut down the
number of applicants before requiring applications or interviews. That leaves
a much more qualified list of remaining applicants with which to work.14
However, such assessments have a down side as well, as shown in the HR
Perspective.
Application Forms
Some employers do not use preemployment screening prior to having applicants fill out an application form. Instead, they have every interested individual
complete an application first. These completed application forms then become
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 222
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
223
the basis for prescreening information. But collecting, storing, and tracking
these forms can create significant work for HR staff members.
Application forms, which are used universally, can take on different formats. Properly prepared, the application form serves four purposes:
1. It is a record of the applicant’s desire to obtain a position.
2. It provides the interviewer with a profile of the applicant that can be
used during the interview.
3. It is a basic employee record for applicants who are hired.
4. It can be used for research on the effectiveness of the selection process.
Many employers use only one application form for all jobs, but others use
several different forms depending on the position. For example, a hotel might
use one form for management and supervisory staff and another for line
employees.
Application Disclaimers Application forms should contain disclaimers and
notices so that appropriate legal protections are clearly stated. These recommended disclosures include:
•
Employment-at-will: Indicates the right of the employer or the applicant
to terminate employment at any time with or without notice or cause
(where applicable by state law)
• Reference contacts: Requests permission to contact previous employers
listed by the applicant on the application form or résumé
• Employment testing: Notifies applicants of required drug tests, penciland-paper tests, physical exams, or electronic or other tests that will be
used in the employment decision
• Application time limit: Indicates how long application forms are active
(typically 6 months), and that persons must reapply or reactivate their
applications after that period
• Information falsification: Conveys to an applicant that falsification
of application information can be grounds for serious reprimand or
termination
EEO Considerations and Application Forms An organization should
retain all applications and hiring-related documents and records for 3 years.
Guidelines from the EEOC and court decisions require that the data requested
on application forms must be job related. Though frequently found on application forms, questions that ask for the following information are illegal. (See
Appendix D for review.)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Marital status
Height/weight
Number and ages of dependents
Information on spouse
Date of high school graduation
Contact in case of emergency
Most of the litigation surrounding application forms has involved questions
regarding the gender and age of a potential employee, so special consideration
should be dedicated to removing any items that relate to these personal characteristics. Concerns about inappropriate questions stem from their potential
to elicit information that should not be used in hiring decisions. Figure 7-5
shows a sample application form containing questions that generally are legal.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 223
26/06/10 5:12 PM
224
Jobs and Labor
SECTION 2
Sample Application Form
FIGURE 7-5
Application for Employment
An Equal Opportunity Employer*
Today’s Date
Please Print or Type
PERSONAL INFORMATION
Name
(Last)
Current address
(First)
(Full middle name)
Social Security number
State
Phone number
( )
E-mail address
City
What position are you applying for?
Zip code
Date available for employment?
Are you willing
Are you willing to
Any restrictions on hours, weekends, or overtime? If yes, explain.
to relocate?
travel if required?
Yes
No
Yes
No
Have you ever been employed by this
Indicate location and dates
Company or any of its subsidiaries before?
Yes
No
Can you, after employment, submit verification Have you ever been
Convictions will not automatically disqualify
of your legal right to work in the United States? convicted of a felony?
job candidates. The seriousness of the crime
and the date of conviction will be considered.
Yes
No
Yes
No
PERFORMANCE OF JOB FUNCTIONS
Are you able to perform all the functions of the job for which you are applying, with or without accommodation?
Yes, without accommodation
Yes, with accommodation
No
If you indicated you can perform all the functions with an accommodation, please explain how you would perform
the tasks and with what accommodation.
EDUCATION
School level
School name and address
No. of years
attended
Did you
graduate?
Course of study
High school
Vo-tech, business,
or trade school
College
Graduate school
PERSONAL DRIVING RECORD
This section is to be completed ONLY if the operation of a motor vehicle will be required in the course of the
applicant’s employment.
How long have you been a licensed driver?
Driver’s license number
Expiration date
Issuing State
List any other state(s) in which you have had a driver’s license(s) in the past:
Within the past five years,
Been convicted of reckless If yes, give dates:
have you had a vehicle accident? or drunken driving?
Yes
No
Yes
No
Has your driver’s license ever been
revoked or suspended?
Yes
No
If yes, explain:
Been cited for moving violations?
If yes, give dates:
Yes
No
Is your driver’s license restricted?
Yes
If yes, explain:
No
*We are an Equal Opportunity Employer. We do not discriminate on the basis of race, religion, color, gender, age, national origin, or disability.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 224
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
225
Résumés as Applications Applicants commonly provide background information through résumés. When the situation arises, EEO standards require
that an employer treats a résumé as an application form. As such, if an applicant’s résumé voluntarily furnishes some information that cannot be legally
obtained, the employer should not use that information during the selection
process. Some employers require those who submit résumés to complete an
application form as well.
Regardless of how the background information is colLOGGING ON
lected, companies should be dutiful about checking the
UniformGuidelines.com
truthfulness of the information presented on résumés and
For a free resource on the use of
application forms. Various accounts suggest that a noteworselection procedures and tests to
thy percentage of applicants knowingly distort their past
ensure compliance with federal
work experiences. For example, former RadioShack CEO
laws, visit this website at www
David Edmondson resigned after it was determined that he
.uniformguidelines.com.
had embellished his educational background.15
Immigration Verification
Businesses are required to review and record identity documents, such as
Social Security cards, passports, and visas, and to determine if they appear to
be genuine. It is illegal to knowingly hire employees who are not in the country
legally. The consequences for offending businesses are high; penalties range
from $375 to $16,000 per incident and 6 months in prison. If HR personnel
know they are working with fraudulent documents, corporate liability exists,
and seizure of assets and criminal liability for top management can occur.
Immigration and Customs Enforcement (ICE) can audit the records of a business
to make certain there has been compliance with employment eligibility laws and
rules. Such audits may come from employer filings of government labor documents,
disgruntled employees, identity theft complaints, or suspicious patterns of activity.16
Employers must use the revised form I-9 for each employee hired after
1986 and must determine within 72 hours whether an applicant is a U.S. citizen, registered alien, or illegal alien. A government program called E-Verify is
run by the Department of Homeland Security to help with this process. The
use of E-Verify is mandatory for government contractors or subcontractors.17
An employer should have a policy to comply with immigration requirements and to avoid knowingly hiring or retaining illegal workers. I-9s should
be completed, updated, and audited.
SELECTION TESTING
Many different kinds of tests can be used to help select qualified employees.
Literacy tests, skill-based tests, personality tests, and honesty tests are used
to assess various individual factors that are important for the work to be
performed. These useful employment tests allow companies to predict which
applicants will be the most successful before being hired.
However, selection tests must be evaluated extensively before being utilized as a recruiting tool. The development of the test items should be linked
to a thorough job analysis. Also, initial testing of the items should include an
evaluation by knowledge experts, and statistical and validity assessments of
the items should be conducted. Furthermore, adequate security of the testing
instruments should be coordinated, and the monetary value of these tests to
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 225
26/06/10 5:12 PM
226
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
the firm should be determined. For example, Gerber Products Company was
found to be using preemployment selection tests for entry-level positions that
did not have sufficient evidence of validity. The tests were negatively impacting minority applicants. Gerber paid 1,912 minority and female applicants
$900,000 in back pay and interest.18
Ability Tests
Cognitive ability tests
Tests that measure an
individual’s thinking, memory,
reasoning, verbal, and
mathematical abilities.
Physical ability tests Tests
that measure an individual’s
abilities such as strength,
endurance, and muscular
movement.
Psychomotor tests Tests
that measure dexterity, hand–
eye coordination, arm–hand
steadiness, and other factors.
Work sample tests Tests
that require an applicant to
perform a simulated task
that is a specified part of the
target job.
Situational judgment
tests Tests that measure a
person’s judgment in work
settings.
Tests that assess an individual’s ability to perform in a specific manner are
grouped as ability tests. These are sometimes further differentiated into aptitude tests and achievement tests. Cognitive ability tests measure an individual’s
thinking, memory, reasoning, verbal, and mathematical abilities. Tests such as
these can be used to determine applicants’ basic knowledge of terminology
and concepts, word fluency, spatial orientation, comprehension and retention
span, general and mental ability, and conceptual reasoning. The Wonderlic
Personnel Test and the General Aptitude Test Battery (GATB) are two widely
used tests of this type. Managers need to ensure that these tests assess cognitive
abilities that are job related.19
Physical ability tests measure an individual’s abilities such as strength,
endurance, and muscular movement. At an electric utility, line workers regularly must lift and carry equipment, climb ladders, and perform other physical
tasks; therefore, testing of applicants’ mobility, strength, and other physical
attributes is job related. Some physical ability tests measure such areas as
range of motion, strength and posture, and cardiovascular fitness. As noted
later, care should be taken to limit physical ability testing until after a conditional job offer is made, in order to avoid violating the provisions of the
Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA).
Different skill-based tests can be used, including psychomotor tests, which
measure a person’s dexterity, hand–eye coordination, arm–hand steadiness,
and other factors. Tests such as the MacQuarie Test for Mechanical Ability
can measure manual dexterity for assembly-line workers and others using
psychomotor skills regularly.
Many organizations use situational tests, or work sample tests, which require
an applicant to perform a simulated task that is a specified part of the target job.
Requiring an applicant for an administrative assistant’s job to type a business
letter as quickly as possible would be one such test. An “in-basket” test is a work
sample test in which a job candidate is asked to respond to memos in a hypothetical in-basket that are typical of the problems experienced in that job. Once again,
these tests should assess criteria that are embedded in the job that is to be staffed.
Situational judgment tests are designed to measure a person’s judgment in
work settings. The candidate is given a situation and a list of possible solutions
to the problem. The candidate then has to make judgments about how to deal
with the situation. Situational judgment tests are a form of job simulation.
Assessment Centers An assessment center is not a place but an assessment
composed of a series of evaluative exercises and tests used for selection and
development. Most often used in the selection process when filling managerial
openings, assessment centers consist of multiple exercises and are evaluated by
multiple raters. In one assessment center, candidates go through a comprehensive
interview, a pencil-and-paper test, individual and group simulations, and work
exercises. Individual performance is then evaluated by a panel of trained raters.
It is crucial that the tests and exercises in an assessment center reflect the
content of the job for which individuals are being screened, and the types
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 226
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
227
Selecting Human Resources
of problems faced on that job. For example, a technology communications
organization used a series of assessment centers to hire employees who would
interact with clients. The company found that these centers improved the
selection process and also provided new employees with a good road map for
individual development.
Personality Tests
Personality is a unique blend of individual characteristics that can affect how
people interact with their work environment. Many organizations use various
personality tests that assess the degree to which candidates’ attributes match
specific job criteria. For instance, a sporting goods chain offers job applicants
a Web-based test. The test evaluates their personal tendencies, and test scores
are used to categorize individuals for the hiring decision. Many types of personality tests are available, including the Minnesota Multiphasic Personality
Inventory (MMPI) and the Myers-Briggs test.
Although many different personality characteristics exist, some experts
believe that there is a relatively small number of underlying major traits. The
most widely accepted approach to studying these underlying personality traits
(although not the only one) is the “Big Five” personality framework. The Big
Five traits are generally considered to be useful predictors of various types of
job performance in different occupations. The factors are shown in Figure 7-6.
FIGURE 7-6
Big Five Personality Characteristics
Conscientiousness
Achievement-oriented
Careful
Hardworking
Organized
Responsible
Agreeableness
Cooperative
Good-natured
Softhearted
Tolerant
Trusting
Extroversion
Sociable
Gregarious
Talkative
Openness to Experience
Flexible in thought
Open to new ideas
Broad-minded
Curious
Original
Emotional Stability
Neurosis
Depression
Anger
Worry
Insecurity
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 227
26/06/10 5:12 PM
228
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Several of the Big Five traits are related to dimensions such as burnout and
accident involvement in both work and nonwork contexts.
Faking Personality Tests “Faking” is a major concern for employers using
personality tests. Many test publishers admit that test profiles can be falsified, and they try to reduce faking by including questions that can be used
to compute a social desirability or “lie” score. Researchers also favor the use
of “corrections” based on components of the test to account for faking—a
preference that also constitutes a strong argument for professional scoring
of personality tests.20 Another possibility is use of a “fake warning,” which
instructs applicants that faking can be detected and can result in a negative
hiring impression.
Honesty/Integrity Tests
Companies are utilizing different tests to assess the honesty and integrity of
applicants and employees. Employers use these tests as a screening mechanism
to prevent the hiring of unethical employees, to reduce the frequency of lying
and theft on the job, and to communicate to applicants and employees alike
that dishonesty will not be tolerated. Honesty/integrity tests can be valid as
broad screening devices for organizations if used properly. About 28% of
employers use honesty/integrity testing.21
However, these instruments have limitations. For instance, socially desirable responding is a key concern; some questions can be considered overly
invasive, insulting, and not job related; sometimes “false positives” are generated (or an honest person is scored as “dishonest”); and test scores might be
affected by individual demographic factors such as gender and race.
Polygraphs The polygraph, more generally and incorrectly referred to as the
“lie detector,” is a mechanical device that measures a person’s galvanic skin
response, heart rate, and breathing rate. The theory behind the polygraph
is that if a person answers a question incorrectly, the body’s physiological
responses will “reveal” the falsification through the recording mechanisms
of the polygraph. As a result of concerns about polygraph validity, Congress
passed the Employee Polygraph Protection Act, which prohibits the use of
polygraphs for preemployment screening purposes by most
employers. Federal, state, and local government agencies
LOGGING ON
are exempt from the act. Also exempted are certain privateVangent Human Capital
sector employers such as security companies and pharmaManagement
ceutical companies. The act does allow employers to use
This consulting firm offers
polygraphs as part of internal investigations of thefts or
preemployment testing assessments
losses. But in those situations, the polygraph test should be
and other development tools. Visit their
taken voluntarily, and the employee should be allowed to
site at www.vangent-hcm.com.
end the test at any time.
Controversies in Selection Testing
Two areas in selection testing generate controversies and disagreements. One
is the appropriateness of general mental ability testing, and the other is the
validity of personality testing for selection.
General mental ability testing is well established as a valid selection tool
for many jobs, but since some minority groups tend to score lower on such
exams, there is considerable controversy over whether such tests ought to
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 228
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
229
be used.22 When these tests are used, the case for business necessity must
be made, and the instrument used should be validated for the organization
using it.
Personality testing for selection flourished during the 1950s. More than
60% of large companies at one time used it for selection.23 Sears, Standard
Oil, and Procter and Gamble used such testing extensively. But in the 1960s
researchers concluded that personality is not a good tool for selection, and the
use of these tests dropped drastically. In the 1990s, interest in research on personality as a selection tool resurfaced and vendors began selling personalityoriented selection tests. But a seminal research article appearing in Personnel
Psychology concluded that personality explains so little about actual job
outcomes that we should think very carefully about using it at all for employment decisions.24 The study of personality continues in psychology, and as it
evolves, the role of personality in selection will undoubtedly continue to be
controversial.25
SELECTION INTERVIEWING
Selection interviewing of job applicants is done both to obtain additional
information and to clarify information gathered throughout the selection
process. Interviews are commonly conducted at two levels: first, as an initial
screening interview to determine if the person has met minimum qualifications, and then later, as an in-depth interview with HR staff members and/or
operating managers to determine if the person will fit into the designated work
area. Before the in-depth interview, information from all available sources is
pooled so that the interviewers can reconcile conflicting information that may
have emerged from tests, application forms, and references.
Interviewing for selection is imperfect and should be focused on gathering
valid information that has not been gained in other ways.26 Because selection
interviewing is imperfect, the focus must be on techniques that minimize errors
and provide the best information.27
Some companies have excessive interview time requirements. For example,
one company requires applicants to bring their lunch and spend hours on
simulated work tasks, several with tight deadlines.28 However, a court case in
California held that temporary employees were owed overtime pay for time
spent in job placement interviews.29 Although this case dealt with staffing firm
employees, the message is that there may be a limit on how long the employment interviewing process can reasonably go on.
Inter-Rater Reliability and Face Validity
Interviews must be reliable and allow interviewers, despite their limitations,
to pick the same applicant capabilities again and again. High intra-rater reliability (within the same interviewer) can be demonstrated, but only moderateto-low inter-rater reliability (across different interviewers) is generally shown.
Inter-rater reliability becomes important when each of several interviewers is
selecting employees from a pool of applicants, or if the employer uses team or
panel interviews with multiple interviewers.
Employers prefer to use interviews over other selection activities because
they have high “face validity” (i.e., interviews make sense to employers). It is
often assumed that if someone interviews well and the information obtained in
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 229
26/06/10 5:12 PM
230
Jobs and Labor
SECTION 2
FIGURE 7-7
Validity and Structure in Selection Interviews
Type of Interview
Degree of Structure
Validity for General
Selection Decisions
Biographical
More
More
Less
Less
Behavioral
Competency
Situational
Stress
Nondirective
the interview is useful, then the individual will be a good hire.30 However, an
unstructured interview does not always provide much actual validity, causing
a growth in the popularity of structured interviews.
As Figure 7-7 shows, various types of selection interviews are used. They
range from structured to unstructured, and they vary in terms of appropriateness for selection.
Structured Interviews
Structured interview
Interview that uses a set of
standardized questions asked
of all applicants.
A structured interview uses a set of standardized questions asked of all applicants so that comparisons can be made more easily. This type of interview
allows an interviewer to prepare job-related questions in advance and then
complete a standardized interviewee evaluation form that provides documentation indicating why one applicant was selected over another.31
The structured interview is useful in the initial screening process because
many applicants can be effectively evaluated and compared. However, the
structured interview does not have to be rigid. The predetermined questions
should be asked in a logical manner but should not be read word for word.
The applicants should be allowed adequate opportunity to explain their
answers, and interviewers should probe with additional questions until they
fully understand the responses. This process can make the structured interview
more reliable and valid than other interview approaches.
Structured interviews—in any of several forms, including biographical, behavioral, competency, and situational—are useful when making selection decisions.
The structured format ensures that a given interviewer has similar information
on each candidate. It also ensures that when several interviewers ask the same
questions of applicants, there is greater consistency in the subsequent evaluation
of those candidates. In fact, it has been recommended that structured interviews
be utilized in selection efforts for federal jobs because individual work performance can be better forecasted. However, companies might have to provide
additional guidance to enhance interviewers’ implementation of this structure.32
Biographical Interview A biographical interview focuses on a chronological assessment of the candidate’s past experiences. This type of interview is
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 230
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
231
widely used and is often combined with other interview techniques. Overall,
the process provides a sketch of past experiences.
Behavioral Interview In the behavioral interview technique, applicants are
asked to describe how they have performed a certain task or handled a problem in the past, which may predict future actions and show how applicants
are best suited for current jobs. A recent study showed that “past behavior”
interviews are better at identifying achievement at work than are situational
interviews, because they focus on what applicants have actually done in real
situations rather than on what they think they might do in hypothetical situations.33 An example of a behavioral interview line of questioning might be:
“Tell me about a time when you initiated a project. What was the situation?
What did you do? What were the results?”
Competency Interview The competency interview is similar to the behavioral interview except the questions are designed to provide the interviewer
with something against which to measure the applicant’s response. A competency profile for the position is often utilized, which includes a list of competencies necessary to do that particular job. Using competencies as a benchmark to
predict job candidate success is useful because interviewers can identify the factors needed in specific jobs. However, these interviews take time and sometimes
benefit articulate or impression management-oriented people. Interviewers
must be trained in spotting strong answers for the competencies in question.34
Situational Interview The situational interview contains questions about
how applicants might handle specific job situations. Interview questions and
possible responses are based on job analysis and checked by job experts to
ensure content validity. The interviewer typically codes the suitability of the
answer, assigns point values, and adds up the total number of points each
interviewee has received. A variation is termed the case study interview, which
requires a job candidate to diagnose and correct organizational challenges during the interview. Situational interviews assess what the interviewee would consider to be the best option, not necessarily what they did in a similar situation.35
Less-Structured Interviews
Behavioral interview
Interview in which applicants
give specific examples of how
they have performed a certain
task or handled a problem in
the past.
Situational interview
Structured interview that
contains questions about
how applicants might handle
specific job situations.
Nondirective interview
Interview that uses questions
developed from the answers to
previous questions.
Some interviews are done unplanned and are not structured at all. Such
interviewing techniques may be appropriate for fact finding, or for counseling interviews. However, they are not best for selection interviewing. These
interviews may be conducted by operating managers or supervisors who
have had little interview training. An unstructured interview occurs when
the interviewer improvises by asking questions that are not predetermined. A
semistructured interview is a guided conversation in which broad questions
are asked and new questions arise as a result of the discussion. For example:
What would you do differently if you could start over again?
A nondirective interview uses questions that are developed from the
answers to previous questions. The interviewer asks general questions
designed to prompt applicants to describe themselves. The interviewer then
uses applicants’ responses to shape the next question. With a nondirective
interview, as with any less-structured interview, difficulties for selection decisions include keeping the conversation job related and obtaining comparable
data on various applicants. Many nondirective interviews are only partly organized; as a result, a combination of general and specific questions is asked in
no set order, and different questions are asked of different applicants for the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 231
26/06/10 5:12 PM
232
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
same job. Comparing and ranking candidates is thus more open to subjective
judgments and legal challenges, so they are best used for selection sparingly,
if at all.
Stress Interview A stress interview is designed to create anxiety and put
pressure on applicants to see how they respond. In a stress interview, the interviewer assumes an extremely aggressive and insulting posture. Firms using this
approach often justify doing so because employees will encounter high degrees
of job stress. For example, it might be appropriate in selecting FBI agents or
people for high-stress, high-pressure customer complaint positions, but it is
not appropriate for most positions. The stress interview can be a high-risk
approach for an employer because an applicant is probably already anxious,
and the stress interview can easily generate a poor image of the interviewer
and the employer. Consequently, an applicant the organization wishes to hire
might turn down the job offer.
Who Conducts Interviews?
Job interviews can be conducted by an individual, by several individuals sequentially, or by panels or teams. For some jobs, such as entry-level jobs requiring
lesser skills, applicants might be interviewed solely by a human resource professional. For other jobs, employers screen applicants by using multiple interviews,
beginning with a human resource professional and followed by the appropriate supervisors and managers. Then a selection decision is made collectively.
Managers need to ensure that multiple interviews are not redundant.
Other interview formats are also utilized. In a panel interview, several interviewers meet with the candidate at the same time so that the same responses
are heard. Panel interviews may be combined with individual interviews.
However, without proper planning, an unstructured interview can result, and
applicants are frequently uncomfortable with the group interview format. In
a team interview, applicants are interviewed by the team members with whom
they will work. This approach can improve team success, but training is
required to educate team members about the selection process, and consensus
over the hiring decision should be established.36
Effective Interviewing
Stress interview Interview
designed to create anxiety and
put pressure on applicants to
see how they respond.
Panel interview Interview
in which several interviewers
meet with candidate at the
same time.
Team interview Interview
in which applicants are
interviewed by the team
members with whom they
will work.
Many people think that the ability to interview is an innate talent, but this
contention is difficult to support. Just being personable and liking to talk is no
guarantee that someone will be an effective interviewer. Figure 7-8 lists questions commonly used in selection interviews.
Interviewing skills are developed through training. A number of suggestions for making interviewing more effective are:
•
•
•
Plan the interview. Interviewers should review all information before the
interview, and then identify specific areas for questioning. Preparation is
critical because many interviewers have not done their research.37
Control the interview. This includes knowing in advance what
information must be collected, systematically collecting it during the
interview, and stopping when that information has been collected. An
interviewer should not monopolize the conversation.
Use effective questioning techniques. Utilize questions that will produce
full and complete answers that can be evaluated based on job relatedness.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 232
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
233
Selecting Human Resources
Questions Commonly Asked in Selection Interviews
FIGURE 7-8
General Questions
What are your strengths and weaknesses?
Why did you leave your last job?
Why should we hire you?
What is most important to you in a job?
What questions do you have for me?
Problem-Solving Questions
What is the most creative work-related idea
you have had?
Describe a difficult problem you faced and solved.
What approach to problem solving works best
for you?
Describe a sale you did not make, and explain why.
Questions About Motivation
What have you done that shows initiative?
What career objectives have you met?
How do you measure success?
What rewards mean most to you?
What projects make you excited?
Selection
Interview
Questions About Working with Others
What kind of people do you like to work with?
Tell me about a conflict with a fellow worker.
How was it resolved?
Describe your management style.
When is teamwork more appropriate?
Integrity-Indicator Questions
Tell me about a time when you were not honest.
How would you react if you were asked to do
something unethical?
If you saw a coworker doing something dishonest,
what would you do?
When did you last break a rule?
When I call your previous employer, what comments
will I get?
Questions to Avoid The following are kinds of questions that should be
avoided in selection interviews:
•
Yes/no questions: Unless verifying specific information, the interviewer
should avoid questions that can be answered “yes” or “no.” For example,
“Did you have good attendance on your last job?” will probably be
answered simply “yes.”
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 233
26/06/10 5:12 PM
234
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
•
•
•
•
•
Obvious questions: An obvious question is one for which the interviewer
already has the answer and the applicant knows it.
Questions that rarely produce a true answer: Avoid questions that
prompt a less-than-honest response. An example is “How did you get
along with your coworkers?” The likely answer is “Just fine.”
Leading questions: A leading question is one to which the answer is
obvious from the way the question is asked. For example, “How do you
like working with other people?” suggests the answer “I like it.”
Illegal questions: Questions that involve information such as race, age,
gender, national origin, marital status, and number of children are illegal.
They are just as inappropriate in the interview as on the application form.
Questions that are not job related: All questions should be directly job
related.
Listening Responses to Avoid Effective interviewers avoid listening
responses such as nodding, pausing, making casual remarks, echoing, and
mirroring. The applicant might try to please the interviewers by examining
the feedback provided. However, giving no response to an applicant’s answers
may imply boredom or inattention. Therefore, interviewers should use friendly
but neutral comments when acknowledging the applicant’s comments.
Problems in the Interview
Operating managers and supervisors are more likely than HR personnel to
use poor interviewing techniques because they do not interview often or lack
training. Several problems include:
•
•
•
•
•
Snap judgments: Some interviewers decide whether an applicant is
suitable within the first two to four minutes of the interview, and spend
the rest of the time looking for evidence to support their judgment.
Negative emphasis: When evaluating suitability, unfavorable information
about an applicant is often emphasized more than favorable information.
Halo effect: The halo effect occurs when an interviewer allows a positive
characteristic, such as agreeableness, to overshadow other evidence. The
phrase devil’s horns describes the reverse of the halo effect; this occurs
when a negative characteristic, such as inappropriate dress, overshadows
other traits.
Biases and stereotyping: “Similarity” bias occurs when interviewers
favor or select people that they believe to be like themselves based
on a variety of personal factors. Interviewers also should avoid any
personal tendencies to stereotype individuals because of demographic
characteristics and differences. For instance, age disparities may be a
concern as younger executives are interviewing more senior personnel.
Additionally, applicants’ ethnic names and accents can negatively impact
personal evaluations, and older workers are sometimes less likely to get
interviewed and hired than are younger applicants.38
Cultural noise: Interviewers must learn to recognize and handle cultural
noise, which stems from what applicants believe is socially acceptable
rather than what is factual.
Other problems that can occur in the interview are demonstrated in the HR
Perspective.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 234
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
235
Selecting Human Resources
HR perspective
Common Interview
Mistakes
Bad hiring based on bad interviewing is expensive.
It causes poor performance and higher turnover, and
results in employing people who are not engaged.
Both employers and employees agree that they made
the correct hiring decision about half of the time.
The other half of the decisions were wrong—they
were bad choices. At least some errors are due to
silly or useless questions that interviewers seem to
favor when they have not been properly trained. For
example:
•
•
•
•
•
•
If you were a tree (or a fruit, or an animal, or
whatever), what kind would you be?
Do you like knives?
How do you make a peanut butter sandwich?
What is your favorite song?
What would you do if I gave you an elephant?
Do you have a girlfriend for me?
There is absolutely no evidence that these and similar
questions will help an interviewer pick the best person
for the job.
Recent surveys show that illegal questions, as well
as stupid ones, are a problem. For example, 32% of
interviewers did not know that asking a candidate’s age
is illegal, 40% did not know it is illegal to ask about
marital status, and 44% did not know it is illegal to ask
about plans to have children.
Good interviewer behavior can create positive feelings toward the job and the organization. Interviewers
who are warm, know the job and company, and have a
sense of humor are most successful. With that in mind,
how well do these comments from interviewees reflect
on their interviewers’ behaviors?
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
The interviewers were not knowledgeable.
The interviewer was unenthusiastic and
unfriendly.
She was texting while interviewing.
The interviewers were arrogant and vague.
She asked, “Do you like me as a woman?”
He asked, “What is your natural hair color?”
He asked, “How strong is your marriage?”
The interviewer was not smiling.
The interview is the first step in an employment
relationship. Questions about trees, songs, or hair color
and unfriendly or ignorant remarks from interviewers
reduce the chances that the relationship will ever
commence.39
BACKGROUND INVESTIGATIONS
Failure to check the backgrounds of people who are hired can lead to embarrassment and legal liability. Hiring workers who commit violent acts on the
job is one example. While laws vary from state to state, for jobs in certain
industries, such as those that provide services to children, vulnerable adults,
security, in-home services, and financial services, background checks are mandated in some states. Nationally background checks are required for people
with commercial drivers’ licenses who drive tractor-trailer rigs and buses
interstate.
Negligent Hiring and Retention
Lawyers say that an employer’s liability hinges on how well it investigates an
applicant’s background. Consequently, details provided on the application form
should be investigated extensively, and these efforts should be documented.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 235
26/06/10 5:12 PM
236
SECTION 2
Negligent hiring Occurs
when an employer fails
to check an employee’s
background and the employee
injures someone on the job.
Negligent retention Occurs
when an employer becomes
aware that an employee may
be unfit for work but continues
to employ the person, and the
person injures someone.
Jobs and Labor
Negligent hiring occurs when an employer fails to check an employee’s
background and the employee later injures someone on the job. There is a
potential negligent hiring problem when an employer hires an unfit employee,
a background check is insufficient, or an employer does not research potential
risk factors that would prevent the positive hire decision. Similarly, negligent
retention occurs when an employer becomes aware that an employee may
be unfit for employment but continues to employ the person, and the person
injures someone.
Many organizations use outside vendors that specialize in conducting
background checks because such outside firms can provide these services much
more efficiently and effectively. Background checks have some concern that the
information reported might be inaccurate or outdated. For instance, a woman
was denied employment by a company because a background report provided
by an outside firm contained adverse information. However, after getting the
report corrected, she was hired by the company. Consequently, the information
provided in criminal record checks should be used judiciously and with caution.
A number of companies are using personal Web pages and the Internet to
perform background checks on employees. Many believe that websites provide
a more “in-depth” snapshot of a job candidate’s individual characteristics,
regardless of the information that has been submitted to the company through
traditional means with the application form or résumé. Online network sites
such as MySpace and Facebook are used to obtain personal information, some
of which involves sexual activity, drug use, and other questionable behavior.40
Unfortunately, much of the information on personal Web pages appears to
be difficult to erase or alter, so some candidates and employees just have to live
with less-than-flattering content once it is posted. Also, damaging information
can be posted about individuals by anyone on the Internet, further complicating the process of performing fair and legitimate background checks if this
information is utilized in job selection.
Background information can be obtained from a number of sources.
Some of these sources include past job records, credit history, testing records,
educational and certification records, drug tests, Social Security numbers, sex
offender lists, motor vehicle records, and military records. Running background
checks on every applicant is very expensive. Employers sometimes check only
the two or three finalists or the candidate who has received a contingent offer.41
The need for background checking can be found in a wide range of positions: pharmacy students, school teachers, janitors, bank tellers, and so on.42
Consider a car salesman who sexually assaults a young woman while on a
test drive. If the salesman failed to tell his employer he was a convicted sex
offender, does the employer have the responsibility to do a background check
to find out? Probably. Nothing will guarantee that an employee will not commit a violent act at work. But employers can reduce the risk by following a
lawful process to screen applicants for signs that a person is not appropriate.43
Legal Constraints on Background Investigations
Various federal and state laws protect the rights of individuals whose backgrounds may be investigated during preemployment screening. An employer’s
most important action when conducting a background investigation is to
obtain from the applicant a signed release giving the employer permission to
conduct the investigation.
Safeguards are appropriate in background checks because although
employee screening has become a big business, it is not always an accurate one.44
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 236
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
Selecting Human Resources
237
When a candidate is an internal candidate, blemishes are likely known. But
when candidates come from outside the company, problems are more likely to
be hidden, at least at first.45
Fair Credit Reporting Act Many employers check applicants’ credit histories. The logic is that poor credit histories may signal, either correctly or
incorrectly, a certain level of irresponsibility. Firms that check applicants’ credit
records must comply with the federal Fair Credit Reporting Act. This act basically requires disclosing that a credit check is being made, obtaining written
consent from the person being checked, and furnishing the applicant with a
copy of the report. Some state laws also prohibit employers from getting certain credit information. Credit history should be checked on applicants for jobs
in which use of, access to, or management of money is an essential job function.
Commonly, financial institutions check credit histories on loan officers and
tellers, and retailers conduct credit checks on cashiers and managerial staff.
But unnecessary credit checks may be illegal, according to some EEOC cases.46
Medical Examinations and Inquiries
Medical information on applicants may be used to determine their physical
and mental capabilities for performing jobs. Physical standards for jobs should
be realistic, justifiable, and linked to job requirements. Even though workers
with disabilities can competently perform many jobs, they sometimes may be
rejected because of their physical or mental limitations.47
ADA and Medical Inquiries The ADA prohibits the use of preemployment
medical exams, except for drug tests, until a job has been conditionally offered.
Also, the ADA prohibits a company from rejecting an individual because of
a disability and from asking job applicants any question related to current or
past medical history until a conditional job offer has been made. Once a conditional offer of employment has been made, then some organizations ask the
applicant to complete a preemployment health checklist or the employer pays
for a physical examination of the applicant.48 It should be made clear that the
applicant who has been offered the job is not “hired” until successful completion of the physical inquiry.
Drug Testing Drug testing may be conducted as part of a medical exam, or
it may be done separately. Use of drug testing as part of the selection process
has increased in the past few years.49 If drug tests are used, employers should
remember that their accuracy varies according to the type of test used, the
item tested, and the quality of the laboratory where the test samples are sent.
Because of the potential impact of prescription drugs on test results, applicants
should complete a detailed questionnaire on this matter before the testing. If
an individual tests positive for drug use, then an independent medical laboratory should administer a second, more detailed analysis. Whether urine, blood,
saliva, or hair samples are used, the process of obtaining, labeling, and transferring the samples to the testing lab should be outlined clearly and definite
policies and procedures should be established.50
References
References provided by the candidate are of very limited predictive value.
Would someone knowingly pick a reference who would speak poorly of them?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 237
26/06/10 5:12 PM
238
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
Of course not.51 Previous supervisors and employers may provide a better
prediction. Good questions to ask previous supervisors or employers include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Dates of employment
Position held
What were the job duties?
What strengths/weaknesses did you observe?
Were there any problems?
Would you rehire?
LOGGING ON
VirtualHRScreening.com
Through its website, this company
offers employers comprehensive risk
assessments of applicants including
background checks, employment
references, drug screening, and
criminal histories. Visit the site at
www.virtualhrscreening.com.
Work-related references from previous employers and
supervisors provide a valuable snapshot of a candidate’s
background and characteristics. Telephoning references
is common. Managers should consider using a form that
facilitates the factual verification of information given by
the applicant. Some organizations send preprinted reference
forms to individuals who are giving references for applicants. These forms often contain a release statement signed
by the applicant, so that those providing references can see
that they have been released from liability on the information they furnish.
Making the Job Offer
The final step of the selection process is offering someone employment. Job
offers are often extended over the telephone. Many companies then formalize
the offer in a letter that is sent to the applicant. It is important that the offer
document be reviewed by legal counsel and that the terms and conditions of
employment be clearly identified. Care should be taken to avoid vague, general
statements and promises about bonuses, work schedules, or other matters that
might change later. These documents should also provide for the individual to
sign an acceptance of the offer and return it to the employer, who should place
it in the individual’s personnel files.
GLOBAL STAFFING ISSUES
G L O B A L
Staffing global assignments involves making selection decisions that impact
(or take place in) other countries. When staffing global assignments, cost is a
major consideration because establishing a business professional in another
country can run as high as $1 million for a 3-year job assignment. Further,
if a business professional quits an international assignment prematurely or
wants to transfer home, associated costs can be even greater. “Failure” rates
for global assignments can run as high as half of those sent overseas in some
situations.
Types of Global Employees
Global organizations can be staffed in a number of different ways, including with expatriates, host-country nationals, and third-country nationals.
Each staffing option presents some unique HR management challenges.52
For instance, when staffing with citizens of different countries, different tax
laws and other factors apply. HR professionals need to be knowledgeable
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 238
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
239
Selecting Human Resources
about the laws and customs of each country represented in their workforce.53
Experienced expatriates can provide a pool of talent that can be utilized as the
firm expands operations into other countries.
Selection Process for Global Assignments
The selection process for an international assignment should provide a realistic picture of the life, work, and culture to which the employee may be sent.
HR managers start by preparing a comprehensive description of the job to
be done. This description notes responsibilities that would be unusual in the
home nation, including negotiating with public officials; interpreting local
work codes; and responding to ethical, moral, and personal issues such as
religious prohibitions and personal freedoms.54 Figure 7-9 shows the most
frequently cited key competencies for successful global employees. The five
areas are as follows:
•
•
•
FIGURE 7-9
Cultural adjustment: Individuals who accept foreign job assignments need
to successfully adjust to cultural differences.
Personal characteristics: The experiences of many global firms
demonstrate that the best employees in the home country may not be
the best employees in a global assignment, primarily because of personal
characteristics of individuals.
Organizational requirements: Many global employers find that
knowledge of the organization and how it operates is important.
Selection Factors for Global Employees
Cultural Adjustment
Cultural awareness
Cultural adaptability
Diversity acceptance
Global experiences
Organizational
Requirements
Organizational
knowledge
Technical abilities
Job-related skills
Personal Characteristics
Emotional stability
Ambiguity tolerance
Flexibility and risk taking
Physical/stress coping
Successful
Global
Employees
Communication Skills
Language capabilities
Nonverbal awareness
Coaching and listening
skills
Conflict resolution
abilities
Personal/Family Concerns
Personal life demands
Family considerations
Financial/economic
concerns
Career development
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 239
26/06/10 5:12 PM
240
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
•
•
Communication skills: Expatriate employees should be able to
communicate in the host-country language both orally and in writing.
Personal/family concerns: The preferences and attitudes of spouses
and other family members can influence the success of expatriate
assignments.
A growing issue for U.S. firms that hire individuals to fill jobs in other
countries is the need for adequate background checks. Global companies want
to ensure that their employees have acceptable work histories and personal
characteristics. To satisfy this demand, a number of firms have begun to specialize in preemployment screening of global employees.
Some countries have varying government-controlled employment processes
that require foreign employers to obtain government approval in order to
hire local employees. Many countries such as the United States and Australia
require foreign workers to obtain work permits or visas.
For U.S.-based firms, the assignment of women and members of racial/
ethnic minorities to international posts involves complying with U.S. EEO
regulations and laws. Also, most U.S. EEO regulations and laws apply to
foreign-owned firms operating in the United States.
LEGAL CONCERNS IN THE SELECTION PROCESS
Selection is subject to a number of legalities, especially many of the EEO
regulations and laws discussed previously. Throughout the selection process,
application forms, interviews, tests, background investigations, and any other
selection activities must be conducted in a nondiscriminatory manner. But
three areas deserve special mention: defining who is an applicant, applicant
flow documentation, and selection for “soft skills.”
Defining Who Is an Applicant
Employers are required to track applicants who apply for jobs at their companies. It is increasingly important for employers to carefully define exactly who
is an applicant and who is not, because many employers are required to track
and report applicant information as part of equal employment and affirmative
action plans. It is also important because employers may be negatively affected
by individuals who claim to have applied for jobs but really just want to file
lawsuits. Any person who is interested in a position should be considered an
applicant even if no formal posting of the job opening in question has been
made, the person has not filed any sort of formal application, and the person
does not meet the minimum qualifications for the job.
The EEOC and Office of Federal Contract Compliance Programs (OFCCP)
have agreed on this definition of “applicant” to be used when an application
has been submitted electronically. An applicant is a person who:55
•
•
•
•
Has expressed interest through the Internet or electronically and is being
considered for a specific position by the employer.
Has identified that he or she has the basic position qualifications.
Does not remove his or her interest in the position at anytime during the
selection process.
Has been ranked using “hit features” by employer software or other data
techniques that are not linked to assessment qualifications.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 240
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
241
Selecting Human Resources
Applicant Flow Documentation
Employers must collect applicant data on race, sex, and other demographics to
fulfill EEO reporting requirements. Many employers ask applicants to provide
EEOC reporting data in a flow form that may be attached to the application
form. It is important that employers review this flow form separately and not
use it in any selection efforts to avoid claims of impropriety. Because completing the form is voluntary, employers can demonstrate that they tried to obtain
the data.
Selecting for “Soft Skills”
Selection in its “scientific” form is about finding valid predictors of what will
be needed on a job and picking people who score high on those predictors.
These “hard skills” include cognitive skills, education, and technical skills. But
these skills may not predict the difference between adequate and outstanding
performance. Some argue that “soft skills” provide an important part of the
ability to do a job successfully.56 What are “soft skills”? They are noncognitive
abilities that are complementary to outstanding job performance. Examples
might include:
Empathy
Openness
Cooperation
Interpersonal style
Conscientiousness
Leadership
Integrity
Ethical behavior
Effort
Emotional intelligence
But selection for soft skills is haphazard.57 Unlike hard skills, these skills
may have to be inferred from past behaviors or from an interview.58 Tests may
be available to help with some soft skills, but the basic process presented in
this chapter still must apply. First, identify KSAs, competencies, and job functions through job analysis. Next, decide how those will be identified in an
applicant (tests, interviews, experience, etc.). Then use structured behavioral
interviewing done by trained interviewers incorporating competency-focused
questions. Finally, choose those applicants who are strong in the areas necessary to do the job.59
S U M M A R Y
• Selection is the process that matches individuals
and their qualifications to jobs in an organization.
• Placement of people should consider both person/
job fit and person/organization fit.
• Mismatches in fit can occur because of skills,
geography, time required, earning expectations,
and work/family issues.
• Predictors linked to criteria are used to identify
the applicants who are most likely to perform
jobs successfully.
• The selection process—from applicant interest
through preemployment screening, application,
•
•
•
•
testing, interviewing, and background investigation—must be handled by trained, knowledgeable
individuals.
Truth-in-hiring lawsuits may arise from overselling a job.
Employers are using electronic preemployment
screening to cut down applicant pools.
Application forms must meet EEO guidelines
and must ask only for job-related information.
Selection tests include ability tests, assessment
centers, personality tests, and honesty/integrity
tests. Some are controversial.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 241
26/06/10 5:12 PM
242
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
• Structured interviews, including behavioral
and situational ones, are more effective and
face fewer EEO compliance concerns than
do unstructured interviews and nondirective
interviews.
• Interviews can be conducted individually, by multiple individuals, or by technology. Regardless of
the method, effective interviewing questioning
techniques should be used.
• Background investigation can be conducted in
a variety of areas. Both when requesting and
when giving reference information, employers
must take care to avoid potential legal concerns
such as negligent hiring and negligent retention.
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
Global organizations can be staffed by individuals who are expatriates, host-country nationals,
or third-country nationals.
Selection factors for global employees include
cultural adjustment, personal characteristics,
communication skills, personal/family concerns,
and organizational requirements.
Selection decisions must be based on job-related
criteria in order to comply with various legal
requirements.
HR professionals must be careful to properly
identify, track, and document applicants.
Selecting for “soft skills” must follow the model
used for more visible skills.
T H I N K I N G
1. Develop a set of soft skills necessary for a
college professor’s job.
2. Put together a structured interview for hiring
assistant managers at a large retail store.
3. How would you do a complete background
investigation on applicants to minimize
concerns about negligent hiring?
H R
•
E X P E R I E N T I A L
Your insurance company recently entered into a
business contract with a company in the financial
industry that requires extensive background checks
for all your existing employees and future applicants who will be doing work associated with
the contract. Previously your company conducted
only employment verification checks in the hiring
process. The management team discussions have
raised questions and concerns about issues that
need to be considered as the company develops and
implements a more extensive background screening
A C T I V I T I E S
4. Your Accounting Manager has decided that a
behavioral interview to select accountants will
solve many hiring problems. What can you tell
the manager about this type of interview and
whether it is likely to be effective? Check
www.job-interview.net and other sources to
gather information.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
protocol. Resources to help you identify issues, best
practices, and requirements can be found at www
.hire-safe.com/Employment_Background_Check_
Guidelines.pdf.
1. What concerns does your company need
to consider in following background check
guidelines?
2. Discuss with the management team the steps
your company needs to take to ensure that it
complies with the Fair Credit Reporting Act.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 242
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
243
Selecting Human Resources
C A S E
Full Disclosure on Sex Offenders?
Megan’s Law provides that all states are now
required to have all convicted sex offenders register so that residents are aware of their presence
in a neighborhood. The law is named for Megan
Kanka, a 7-year-old who was raped and murdered
by a twice-convicted pedophile who moved to her
New Jersey neighborhood. He lured her to his
house with the promise of showing her a puppy.
Megan’s Law raises issues around the use of criminal registries in hiring and employee management.
Several issues are involved for an employer
in dealing with Megan’s Law and employees.
For example, in Michigan, the Attorney General
released the names of 200 registered sex offenders
who had been using MySpace (some in violation
of the terms of their parole). Some employers
found that the list included the names of some of
their employees and had to confront the very real
problem of what to do about it.
The presence of a convicted sex offender presents conflicting obligations and concerns. Employers
want (and need) to protect other employees and
customers from harm based on negligent hiring
and negligent retention issues. But is this person a
threat? What if the person has an exemplary work
record? In some states, it is illegal for employers
to use any information found on the Megan’s Law
website for purposes of employment.
Perhaps the easiest way to proceed would be
to keep from hiring convicts in the first place, but
federal law limits an employer’s ability to do that.
The EEOC says that the use of conviction records
in employment decisions has an adverse impact
on African American and Hispanic males. Using a
blanket prohibition against convicts in hiring may
allow a plaintiff to demonstrate a disproportionate impact on protected categories of applicants.
Is an employer required to check the registry?
It depends on the job. Generally the answer is
“no,” but for certain jobs there is an obligation to
check. Those jobs include positions in health care
facilities and hospitals (e.g., nurse or aide), day
cares and schools (e.g., teacher or aide), security
(e.g., guard), social and mental health facilities
(e.g., social or mental health worker), taxi and bus
services (e.g., drivers), and recreational facilities
(e.g., fitness trainer). Virtually any position with
access to potential victims is a job with the potential for problems.
Two of the names on the Michigan list presented some difficult management decisions. In
one office equipment company, a 34-year-old
office equipment repair technician was paroled
after serving a 7-year sentence for attacking women
on jogging paths. His previous employer offered to
rehire him as a field technician who would travel
to other offices to repair business machines, as he
had been an excellent employee with outstanding
repair skills.
In the other case, a new employee was found
to be on the list. He was an African American who
had served 10 years for child pornography possession. He is driving a school bus for a church and
has thus far been a model employee, although he
did not list his conviction on the application form
even though the question was asked.60
QUESTIONS
1. Discuss what a manager should do in each of
the two Michigan cases.
2. What circumstances might lead you to make
different decisions in different cases under
Megan’s Law?
S U P P L E M E N T A L
Strategic Selection: A Review of
Two Companies
This case shows how Hallmark and United Health
Group use selection as part of their strategic
approach to HR. (For the case, go to www.cengage
.com/management/mathis.)
C A S E S
Selecting a Programmer
This case demonstrates how using a test after a
pool of candidates has already been interviewed
can present some difficulties. (For the case, go to
www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 243
26/06/10 5:12 PM
244
SECTION 2
Jobs and Labor
N O T E S
1. Anjali Anthavaley, “A Job Interview
You Have to Show Up For,” The
Wall Street Journal, June 20,
2007, D1.
2. Kathy Gurchiek, “Staffing Issues
Critical to Business Strategies,
SHRM Finds,” HR News, May 28,
2008, 1–3.
3. Alan Krueger and David Schkade,
“Sorting in the Labor Market,”
Journal of Human Resources, 43
(2008), No. 4, 859–883.
4. Melanie Wanzek, “On Second
Thought,” Sunday World Herald,
May 10, 2009, CR1.
5. Arne Kalleberg, “The Mismatched
Worker: When People Don’t
Fit Their Jobs,” Academy of
Management Perspectives, February
2008, 24–40.
6. Metin Celik, I. Deha Er, and Y. Ilker
Topcu, “Computer-Based Systematic
Executive Model of HRM in
Maritime Transportation Industry:
The Case of Master Selection for
Embarking on Board Merchant
Ships,” Expect Systems with
Applications, 36 (2009), 1048–1060.
7. Robert Grossman, “Hiring to Fit the
Culture,” HR Magazine, February
2009, 41–50.
8. Dave Bartram, “The Great Eight
Competencies: A Criterion-Centric
Approach to Validation,” Journal
of Applied Psychology, 90 (2005),
1185–1203.
9. Murray Barrick and Ryan
Zimmerman, “Hiring for Retention
and Performance,” Human Resource
Management, March–April 2009,
183–206.
10. Peter Cappelli, “The Impact of
a High School Diploma,” HR
Executive Online, August 18, 2008,
www.hreonline.com, 1–3.
11. Fay Hanson, “Avoiding Truthin-Hiring Lawsuits,” Workforce
Management Online, December
2007, 1–4.
12. V. O’Connell, “Test for Dwindling
Retail Jobs Spawns a Culture of
Cheating,” The Wall Street Journal,
January 7, 2009, A1.
13. Aldo Sualdi, “Job Seekers Put
Résumé Responders in a Frazzle,”
The Denver Post, November 8,
2009, K1; Gina Ruiz, “Job
Candidate Assessment Tests Go
Virtual,” Workforce Management
Online, January 2008, 1–4.
14. Adrienne Hedger, “3 Ways to
Improve Your Employee Screening,”
Workforce Management, March 16,
2009, 26–30.
15. Gary McWilliams, “RadioShack
CEO Agrees to Resign,” The
Wall Street Journal, February 21,
2006, A3.
16. Allison Balvs (ed.), “Employers
Beware: ICE Crackdown Target
652 Businesses Nationwide,” Baird
Holm Labor and Employment Law
Update, August 2009, 1–2.
17. “Federal Contractors Required to
Use E-Verify Beginning Sept. 8,
2009,” Ceridian Abstracts, www
.hrcompliance.ceridian.com, 1.
18. “Gerber Agrees to Pay $900,000
to Minorities and Females for
Hiring Discrimination,” Ceridian
Abstracts, August 26, 2009, www
.hrcompliance.ceridian.com, 1.
19. Martha Frase, “Smart Selections,”
HR Magazine, December 2007,
63–67.
20. Louis Greenstein, “Web of Deceit,”
Human Resource Executive, June
16, 2008, 57–60.
21. Chris Piotowski and Terry
Armstrong, “Current Recruitment
and Selection Practices: A National
Survey of Fortune 1000 Firms,”
North American Journal of
Psychology, 8 (2006), 489–496.
22. Frank Schmidt, et al., “General
Mental Ability, Job Performance,
and Red Herrings: Responses to
Osterman, Hauser, and Schmitt,”
Academy of Management
Perspectives, November 2007,
64–76.
23. David Autor and David
Scarborough, “Does Job Testing
Harm Minority Workers? Evidence
from Retail Establishments,”
Quarterly Journal of Economics,
February 2008, 219–277; Peter
Cappelli, “Assessing Personality,”
Human Resource Executive Online,
www.hreonline.com.
24. Frederick Morgeson, et al.,
“Reconsidering the Use of
Personality Tests in Personnel
Selection Contexts,” Personnel
Psychology, 60, 2007, 683–729.
25. Benjamin Schneider, “Evolution of
the Study and Practice of Personality
at Work,” Human Resource
Management, Winter 46 (2007),
583–610.
26. Scott Highhouse, “Stubborn Reliance
on Intuition and Subjectivity in
Employee Selection,” Industrial and
Organizational Psychology, 1, 2008,
333–341.
27. Jack Welch and Suzy Welch, “Hiring
Is Hard Work,” BusinessWeek,
July 7, 2008, 80.
28. Joann Lublin, “What Won’t You Do
for a Job?” The Wall Street Journal,
June 2, 2009, B1.
29. Mark McGraw, “Costly Job
Interviews,” Human Resource
Executive Online, November 4,
2009, www.hreonline.com, 1–2.
30. Kristen Weirick, “The Perfect
Interview,” HR Magazine, April
2008, 85–88.
31. Chad Van Iddekinge, et al.,
“Antecedents of Impression
Management Use and Effectiveness
in a Structured Interview,” Journal
of Management, October 2007,
752–773.
32. Therese Macan, “The Employment
Interview: A Review of Current
Studies and Directions for Future
Research,” Human Resources
Management Review, 19 (2009),
203–218.
33. Henryk T. Krajewski, Richard
D. Goffin, Julie M. McCarthy,
Mitchell G. Rothstein, and Norman
Johnston, “Comparing the Validity
of Structured Interviews for
Managerial-Level Employees: Should
We Look to the Past or Focus on the
Future?” Journal of Occupational &
Organizational Psychology, 79
(2006), 411–432.
34. Kathy Gurchiek, “Behavioral
Interviewing Popular but Training
in Use Is Urged,” SHRM HR News,
January 28, 2008, www.shrm.org,
1–3.
35. Alexandra Lopez-Pacheco, “How
Do I Recruit Great Employees?”
National Post (Canada), June 8,
2009, FP8; Laura Quinn, and
Maxine Dalton, “Leading for
Sustainability Implementing
the Tasks of Leadership,”
Corporate Governance, 9, 2009,
21–38.
36. Joann Lublin, “For Job Hunters
the Big Interview Is Getting Bigger,”
The Wall Street Journal, June 3,
2008, D1.
37. “Failing the Interview,” DD1, www
.ddiworld.com.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 244
26/06/10 5:12 PM
CHAPTER 7
245
Selecting Human Resources
38. Joanna Lahey, “Age, Women,
and Hiring,” Journal of Human
Resources, XLIII, No. 1, 30–56.
39. Nic Paton, “Half of Hiring Decisions
a Mistake, Say Managers,” October 7,
2008, www.management-issues.com;
Ann Howard and Jehanna Johnson,
“If You Were a Tree What Kind Would
You Be?” Development Dimensions
International White Paper, 2008, 1–11.
40. Rita Zeidner, “How Deep Can You
Probe?” HR Magazine, October
2007, 57–62.
41. Regan Halvorsen, “HR Solutions,”
HR Magazine, September 2008, 36.
42. Cheryl Thompson, “Background
Checks for Experiential Education
Could Get Centralized,” American
Journal of Health System Pharmacy,
September 2009, 1603–1604.
43. Leonard Schloss and J. Gregory
Lahr, “Watch Your Back: Smart
Hiring and Proper Background
Checks,” Employee Relations Law
Journal, Winter 2008, 46–71.
44. Chad Terhune, “The Trouble with
Background Checks,” BusinessWeek,
June 9, 2008, 54–57.
45. Lin Grensing-Pophal, “Hiring Inside
or Out,” Human Resource Executive
Online, November 10, 2009, www
.hreonline.com, 1–3.
46. Allen Smith, “EEOC Challenges
Unnecessary Credit Checks,” SHRM
HR News, February 9, 2007, www
.shrm.org, 1–2; “Checking Credit
of Job Candidates Drives Concern
about Civil Rights,” The Wall Street
Journal, January 19, 2007, B2.
47. “Ruling Complicates Return-toWork Tests,” Business Insurance,
October 5, 2009, 8.
48. “General Communication
Guidelines,” Ceridian Abstracts,
April 8, 2009, www.hrcompliance
.ceridian.com.
49. Cathy Fyock, “Streamlining the
Process,” HR Executive, November
19, 2007, 49.
50. “The Legal Side of Workplace DrugFree Policies,” Safety Compliance
Letter 2487, 2008, 7–13; Jo
Douglas, “Green Light for Drugs
and Alcoholic Testing,” NZ Business,
22, No. 4, 2008, 84.
51. JoAnn Lublin, “Bulletproofing
Your References in the Hunt for a
New Job,” The Wall Street Journal,
April 7, 2009, B9.
52. Mary Siegfried, “A New Approach
to Global Staffing,” Inside Supply
Management, March 2008, 30–32.
53. Ann Marie Ryan, et al., “Going
Global: Cultural Values and
54.
55.
56.
57.
58.
59.
60.
Perceptions of Selection Procedures,”
Applied Psychology: An
International Review, 2008,
1–37.
Ashly Pennington, et al. (eds.),
Human Resource Management:
Ethics and Employment (Oxford:
Oxford University Press, 2007), 255.
Allen Smith, “OFCCP Updates
Guidance on Internet Applicant,”
HR News, November 17, 2006,
www.shrm.org/news.
Lex Borghans, et al., “Interpersonal
Styles and Labor Market
Outcomes,” Journal of Human
Resources, 43 (2008) No. 4,
816–855.
Dana Mattioli, “Hard Sell on ‘Soft’
Skills,” The Wall Street Journal, May
15, 2007, B6.
Charles Handler, “Dear
Workforce . . .,”
www.Workforce.com.
IRA Blank, “Selecting Employees
Based on Emotional Intelligence
Competencies: Reap the Rewards
and Minimize the Risk,” Employee
Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008,
77–85.
Diane Cadrain, “Full Disclosure,”
HR Magazine, September 2007,
60–64.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 245
26/06/10 5:12 PM
S
E
C
T
I
O
N
3
Training and
Development
Chapter 8
Training Human Resources
Chapter 9
Talent Management
Chapter 10
Performance Management and Appraisal
247
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 247
21/07/10 8:53 PM
C H A P T E R
8
Training Human
Resources
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Define training and discuss why a strategic approach is
important.
•
Discuss the four phases of the training process.
•
Identify three types of analyses used to determine training
needs.
•
Explain different means of internal and external training
delivery.
•
Describe the importance of e-learning as part of current
training efforts.
•
Give an example for each of the four levels of training
evaluation.
248
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 248
26/06/10 5:14 PM
HR Headline
China’s Need for Training
C
(CNImaging/Newscom)
hina has enjoyed an economic bonanza, and with
that growth has come a shift
toward higher-end manufacturing
and services. This shift has led to
a greater need for experienced and
skilled labor. Local managers need
not only technical skills, but skills
that are business focused as well. As a
result, HR in China faces a large challenge in finding, training, and keeping
skilled employees who can thrive in
Western-style multinational corporations (MNCs).
China has a workforce of 800 million, but only a small percentage is considered skilled enough to work
in MNCs. The Chinese educational system does not teach the range of
needed skills, so companies are training workers. A California biomedical
testing instrument manufacturer has 270 employees in sales, marketing,
and services in China. Five years ago the focus was on technical skills, but
now the company wants employees with experience, expertise, and an
understanding of the business and relationships.
Chinese culture encourages learning and growing. A Chinese proverb
says, “If you want 100 years of prosperity, grow people.” And, Chinese
employees want the opportunity to be trained. In fact, if they see companies bring in expatriates or non-Chinese workers, they view those companies as having a short-term investment in China and not as likely to be
a good place for career growth. Available training is a retention tool that
Chinese employees are demanding.
Cisco Systems, which recognized the need to create its own skilled
labor pool, now has 220 academies in all provinces in China. The company
wants employees to know proposal design, presentation skills, teamwork,
products, and sales.
A special administrative region (SAR) of China, Macao, is a good example of an area with specific training needs. Macao’s economy is heavily
249
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 249
26/06/10 5:14 PM
250
SECTION 3
Training and Development
invested in gaming and the hospitality industry. Hotel and gaming companies have grown their training staffs; at the height of training activities,
one hotel resort had 30 full-time training people serving thousands of
employees. In the gaming industry, training includes training for dealers,
security officers, and supervisors. Training is often done on a 24/7 basis to
accommodate various work shifts.
Training has become so prominent in many global companies because
it is seen as a worthwhile investment. Companies in the United States also
have adopted training as a way to retain their talented employees.1
Competition forces business organizations to change and adapt in order to
compete successfully. Changes in the way things must be done include training or retraining employees and managers. In this sense, training is an ongoing
process for most organizations. Organizations in the United States spend more
than $126 billion annually on training and development, or more than $1,000
per employee on average.2
Training is the process whereby people acquire capabilities to perform
jobs. Training provides employees with specific, identifiable knowledge and
skills for use in their present jobs. Organizational training may include teaching of “hard” skills, such as teaching sales representatives how to use intranet
resources, a branch manager how to review an income statement, or a machinist apprentice how to set up a drill press. “Soft” skills are critical in many
instances and can be taught as well. These skills may include communicating,
mentoring, managing a meeting, and working as part of a team.
TRAINING AND HR
What kinds of activities usually require training? The most common training
topics include, among others, safety, customer service, computer skills, quality initiatives, dealing with sexual harassment, and communication.3 Training
has been studied at length in the United States.4 The results of these studies
show that training is rated as important or very important by 94% of human
resources professionals.5 Further, documented benefits of well-done training
include (for both individuals and teams) enhanced skills, greater ability to
adapt and innovate, better self-management, and performance improvement.
For organizations, research has shown that training brings improvements in
effectiveness and productivity, more profitability and reduced costs, improved
quality, and increased social capitol.
Training Categories
Training can be designed to meet a number of objectives and can be classified
in various ways. As Figure 8-1 shows, some common groupings include the
following:
Training Process whereby
people acquire capabilities to
perform jobs.
•
Required and regular training: Complies with various mandated legal
requirements (e.g., OSHA and EEO) and is given to all employees
(e.g., new employee orientation)
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 250
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
251
Training Human Resources
Types of Training
FIGURE 8-1
Required and Regular
Safety compliance
Driving provisions
Wage and hour rules
Employee orientation
Benefits enrollment
Sexual harassment
prevention
Job and Technical
Customer service
Equipment operations
Recordkeeping needs
Telecommunications
IT systems
Product details
Training
Interpersonal and
Problem-Solving
Communications
Writing skills
Team relationships
Coaching skills
Problem analyses
Conflict resolution
•
•
•
Developmental
and Career
Business trends
Strategic thinking
Leadership
Change management
Career planning
Performance
management
Job/technical training: Enables employees to perform their jobs well
(e.g., product knowledge, technical processes and procedures, customer
relations)
Developmental and career training: Provides longer-term focus to
enhance individual and organizational capabilities for the future
(e.g., business practices, executive development, organizational change,
leadership)
Interpersonal and problem-solving training: Addresses both operational
and interpersonal problems and seeks to improve organizational working
relationships (e.g., interpersonal communication, managerial/supervisory
skills, conflict resolution)
It is common for a distinction to be drawn between training and development, with development being broader in scope and focusing on individuals’
gaining new capabilities useful for both present and future jobs. Development
is discussed in Chapter 9; training is the focus of this chapter.
Legal Issues and Training
A number of legal issues must be considered when designing and delivering training. One concern centers on the criteria and practices used to select individuals
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 251
26/06/10 5:15 PM
252
SECTION 3
Training and Development
for inclusion in training programs. Companies need to make sure those criteria
are job related and do not unfairly restrict the participation of protectedcategory members. Also, failure to accommodate the participation of individuals
with disabilities in training can expose organizations to EEO lawsuits.
Another legal issue is employers’ requiring employees to sign training contracts in order to protect the costs and time invested in specialized employee
training. For instance, a telecommunications firm paid $17,000 each to train
four network technicians and certify them in specialized equipment. The firm
required that each technician sign a training contract whereby one-fourth
of the cost would be forgiven each year the employee stayed following the
training. A technician who left sooner would be liable to the firm for the
unforgiven balance. Health care organizations, IT firms,
and other employers often use training contracts, especially
for expensive external training.
LOGGING ON
Finally, the Department of Labor has ruled that employAmerican Society for Training &
ees who are training outside normal working hours (e.g., at
Development
home by completing Web-based classes) must be compensated
This website on training and
for their time. In one situation, a Web-based class required
development contains information on
employees to spend about 10 hours at home completing it;
research, education, seminars, and
once they did, they performed their job duties better. In this
conferences. Visit the site at
case, the company had to pay the employees for their 10
www.astd.org.
hours of training under the Fair Labor Standards Act.6
ORGANIZATIONAL STRATEGY AND TRAINING
Training represents a significant expenditure for most employers. But it is too
often viewed tactically rather than strategically, which means that training is
seen as a short-term activity rather than one that has longer-term effects on
organizational success. However, this is changing. For example, during the last
recession, unlike previous recessions, some companies chose to maintain training that was necessary for long-term strategic goals.7
Strategic Training
Training is used strategically to help the organization accomplish its goals. For
example, if sales increases are a critical part of the company’s strategy, appropriate training would identify what is causing lower sales and target training
to respond as part of a solution.8
Strategic training can have numerous organizational benefits. It requires
HR and training professionals to get intimately involved with the business
and to partner with operating managers to help solve their problems, thus
making significant contributions to organizational results. Additionally, a strategic training mind-set reduces the likelihood of thinking that training alone
can solve most employee or organizational problems. It is not uncommon
for operating managers and trainers to react to most important performance
problems by saying, “I need a training program on X.” With a strategic focus,
the organization is more likely to assess whether training actually can address
the most important performance issues and what besides training is needed.
Training cannot fix all organizational problems.
The value of training can be seen at Walt Disney World where the company has established specific training plans. The implementation of those
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 252
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
253
Training Human Resources
training plans results in a distinct competitive advantage for the organization.
For example, at the Disney Institute, employees (called “cast members”) get
training experience from their guests’ perspectives. As a part of their training,
individuals taking hotel reservations stay at a resort as guests in order to gain
greater understanding of what they are selling and to experience the services
themselves.
Organizational Competitiveness and Training
General Electric, Dell Computers, Motorola, Marriott, Cisco, FedEx, and
Texas Instruments all emphasize the importance of training employees and
managers. These companies and others recognize that training efforts can be
integral to business success. In a sense, for these companies, training is similar
to the “continuous improvement” practiced by some manufacturing firms.
The nature of technological innovation and change is such that if employees are not trained all the time, they may fall behind and the company could
become less competitive. For example, consider the telecommunications industry today compared with ten years ago, with all the new technologies and the
accompanying competitive shifts. Without continual training, organizations
may not have staff members with the knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs)
needed to compete effectively.
Training also can affect organizational competitiveness by aiding in the
retention of employees. One reason why many individuals stay or leave
organizations is career training and development opportunities. Employers
that invest in training and developing their employees may enhance retention
efforts.
Figure 8-2 shows how training may help accomplish certain organizational
strategies. Ideally, upper management sees the training function as providing
valuable intelligence about the necessary core skills.
Knowledge Management For much of history, competitive advantage
among organizations was measured in terms of physical capital. However, as
FIGURE 8-2
Organizational Strategies
Increase sales
Expand into overseas
market
Develop new
product line
Acquire competitor
company
Other strategies
Linking Strategies and Training
Necessary Outcomes
to Implement Strategies
Identify key sales elements
and train sales force
Assign key people and
provide necessary
global training
Train production and
sales on new products
Assimilate employees
from new company, and
provide orientation and
training
Other outcomes
Training Activities
Performance consulting,
design training
Intercultural competence,
language training
New product training,
production practice, sales
simulations
Onboarding, corporate
culture training
Other training activities
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 253
26/06/10 5:15 PM
254
SECTION 3
Training and Development
the information age has evolved, “intelligence” has become the raw material
that many organizations make and sell through their “knowledge workers.”9
Knowledge management is the way an organization identifies and leverages
knowledge in order to be competitive. It is the art of creating value by using
organizational intellectual capital, which is what the organization (or, more
exactly, the people in the organization) knows. Knowledge management is a
conscious effort to get the right knowledge to the right people at the right time
so that it can be shared and put into action.
Training as a Revenue Source Some organizations have identified that
training can be a source of business revenue. For instance, Microsoft, Ceridian,
Cisco, Hewlett-Packard, and other technology firms bundle customer training with products and services they sell. Also, manufacturers of industrial
equipment offer customers training on machine upgrades and new features.
Customers of many of these firms pay for additional training either by course,
by participant, or as part of equipment or software purchases. Not only are the
costs of the trainers’ salaries, travel, and other expenses covered, but the suppliers also make a profit on the training through the fees paid by customers.
As a side benefit, customer satisfaction and loyalty increase if customers know
how to use the products and services purchased. Thus, customer training aids
customer retention and enhances future sales revenues.
Performance Consulting Training should result in improved organizational performance. For some companies, ensuring that it does requires a
“performance consulting” approach. Performance consulting is a process in
which a trainer (either internal or external to the organization) and an organization work together to decide how to improve organizational and individual
results.10 That may or may not include training. Performance consulting takes
a broad approach by:
•
•
•
Knowledge management
The way an organization
identifies and leverages
knowledge in order to be
competitive.
Performance consulting
Process in which a trainer and
an organization work together
to decide how to improve
organizational and individual
results.
Focusing on identifying and addressing root causes of performance
problems
Recognizing that the interaction of individual and organizational factors
influences employee performance
Documenting the actions and accomplishments of high performers and
comparing them with actions and accomplishments of more typical
performers
Regardless of whether the trainer is an internal employee or an outside
consultant, a performance consulting approach recognizes that training alone
cannot automatically solve every employer performance problem. Instead,
training is one piece of a larger “bundled solution.” For instance, some
employee performance issues might be resolved by creating a training program
for employees, and others might call for compensation adjustments, job design
changes, or reassignment.
Integration of Performance with Training Job performance, training,
and employee learning must be integrated to be effective, and HR plays a
crucial role in this integration.11 Organizations find that training experiences
that use real business problems to advance employee learning are better than
more traditional approaches. Rather than separating the training experience
from the context of actual job performance, trainers incorporate everyday
business issues as learning examples, thus increasing the realism of training exercises and scenarios. For example, as part of management training at
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 254
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
255
Training Human Resources
Business Education at
Work
The following is a first-person account from an
employee of Graybar Electric Company (an employeeowned company), as she related her experience
in a “Mini MBA” set up by Rutgers University. This
training program is an excellent example of integrating
performance and training.
My employer teamed with Rutgers to produce a
new management training program to provide a
broad base of business knowledge. Graybar has
a long history of promoting people from within
and needed a program like this. I was a senior
attorney on the company’s legal team, and ready
for more business education. The training program
includes face-to-face meetings as well as online
communication. We do most of our work in crossfunctional teams. My team in addition to myself
includes Graybar employees from Canada (Vice
President), Pittsburgh (Operations Manager), and
Alabama (Branch Manager). We learn from each
other as well as from the formal instruction.
Technology includes e-mail, instant messaging, Webinars, podcasts, conference calls, and the
Internet. There are no regularly scheduled classes;
we are responsible for reading and finishing
HR perspective
assignments at our own pace. For example, a
recent assignment was to listen to a podcast by
a CEO of an international advertising agency on
customer loyalty creation. Our team then drafted
an article for the company newsletter, discussing
the Graybar brand and how to strengthen the
value of the brand with the customers. In another
assignment, each team completed an assignment
on ethics. The team members identified an ethical
issue and designed a 10-minute employee training
module based on that incident. This required
learning the ethical concepts and translating them
into an informative program for employees.
If you take a class at a local college, perhaps
you can apply 20% of what you learn to your
job. With this program, I probably apply 80–90%
directly to my job. We examine real-world
challenges affecting Graybar’s strategy. The work
done by the student is actually used to guide the
company’s future, as the hands-on learning is
presented to senior managers as part of the final
exam.12
Note: At this writing, Beverly Propst is Vice President of
Human Resources at Graybar Electric.
General Electric, managers are given actual business problems to solve, and
they must present their solutions to the business leaders in the firm. Using real
situations for practice is yet another way of merging the lines between training, learning, and job performance. For another example, see HR Perspective:
Business Education at Work.
Chief Learning Officers To emphasize the importance of training and to have
internal performance consulting expertise, some organizations have created a
position entitled chief learning officer (CLO) or chief knowledge officer (CKO).
Ideally, the CLO is not just a training director with an inflated new title, but
rather a leader who designs knowledge through training for individual employees and the organization. CLOs must demonstrate a high level of comfort in
working with boards of directors and the top management team, a track record
of success in running some type of business unit, and an understanding of adult
learning technologies and processes. If they possess these characteristics, CLOs
can take the lead in developing strategic training plans for their organizations.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 255
26/06/10 5:15 PM
256
SECTION 3
Training and Development
TRAINING FOR GLOBAL STRATEGIES
G L O B A L
For a global firm, the most brilliant strategies ever devised will not work unless
the company has well-trained employees throughout the world to carry them
out. A global look at training is becoming more crucial as firms establish and
expand operations worldwide. For U.S. employers, the challenge has increased.
According to a report, the number of U.S. job skills certifications declined
18% in one year, while there was a 47% increase in similar certifications in
India. The conclusion of the study was that U.S. firms may not remain innovative and strategic leaders much longer, due to the decline in specialized skilled
and technical workers.13 Add this problem to the number of global employees
with international assignments, and training must be seen as part of global
strategic success.14
Global Assignment Training
The orientation and training that expatriates and their families receive before
departure significantly affect the success of an overseas assignment. When such
programs are offered, most expatriates participate in them, and the programs
usually produce a positive effect on cross-cultural adjustment. Also, training
helps expatriates and their families adjust to and deal with host-country counterparts. A recent survey showed that companies recognize their expatriates
often are well trained in skills and technical capabilities but much less well
trained in knowledge of the host country culture.15
A related issue is the promotion and transfer of foreign citizens to positions
in the United States. For example, many Japanese firms operating in the United
States conduct training programs to prepare Japanese people for the food,
customs, labor and HR practices, and other facets of working and living in the
United States. As more global organizations start or expand U.S. operations,
more cross-cultural training will be necessary for international employees
relocated to the United States.16
Intercultural Competence Training
Global employers are providing intercultural competence training for their
global employees. Intercultural competence incorporates a wide range of
human social skills and personality characteristics. As noted in Figure 8-3,
three components of intercultural competence require attention when training
expatriates for global assignments:
•
•
•
Cognitive: What does the person know about other cultures?
Emotional: How does the person view other cultures, and how
sensitive is the person to cultural customs and issues?
Behavioral: How does the person act in intercultural
situations?
Increasingly, global employers are using training methods that allow individuals to behave in international situations and then receive feedback.17 One
method is the Culture Assimilator. Used worldwide, especially by Europeanbased firms, the Culture Assimilator is a programmed training and learning
method consisting of short case studies and critical incidents. The case studies
describe intercultural interactions and potential misunderstandings involving
expatriates and host-country nationals.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 256
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
257
Training Human Resources
Intercultural Competence Training
FIGURE 8-3
COMPONENT
POSSIBLE TRAINING
Cognitive
Culture-specific training (traditions, history, cultural customs, etc.)
Language course
Emotional
Uneasiness: Social skills training focusing on new/unclear and
intercultural situations
Prejudices: Coaching may be clarifying
Sensitivity: Communication skills course (active listening,
verbal/nonverbal cues, empathy)
Behavioral
Culture Assimilator method
International projects
Social skills training focusing on intercultural situations
Source: Developed by Andrea Graf, PhD, and Robert L. Mathis, PhD, SPHR.
PLANNING FOR TRAINING
Whether global or national in scope, training benefits from careful planning
before it is done. Planning includes looking at the “big picture” in which the
training takes place as well as specifics for the design of a particular training
effort. For example, the needs for skills have changed over time and things
like adaptability, problem solving, and professionalism have increased in value
in some firms.18 Planning to design training to include changes such as these
makes for a more effective training program.
Another training planning issue for some companies is knowledge retention for the firm. When retirees leave, they take everything they have learned
during a career. Perhaps a retiree is the only one in the company who knows
how to operate a piece of machinery or mix a chemical solution. In some areas
technology changes so fast that even young people leaving a company may
take with them information that cannot easily be replicated. Companies are
responding to this knowledge retention need in various ways, including identifying critical employees, having existing critical employees train and mentor
others, producing how-to videotapes, and keeping former employees on call
for a period of time after their departure.19
Training plans allow organizations to identify what is needed for employee
performance before training begins so that a fit between training and strategic
issues is made.20 Effective training efforts consider the following questions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Is there really a need for the training?
Who needs to be trained?
Who will do the training?
What form will the training take?
How will knowledge be transferred to the job?
How will the training be evaluated?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 257
26/06/10 5:15 PM
258
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Orientation: Planning for New Employees
Orientation Planned
introduction of new employees
to their jobs, coworkers, and
the organization.
A good example of one kind of training that requires planning is orientation.
Also called “onboarding,” orientation is the most important and widely conducted type of regular training done for new employees. Orientation, which is
the planned introduction of new employees to their jobs, coworkers, and the
organization, is offered by most employers. It requires cooperation between
individuals in the HR unit and operating managers and supervisors. In a
small organization without an HR department, the new employee’s supervisor or manager usually assumes most of the responsibility for orientation. In
large organizations, managers and supervisors, as well as the HR department,
generally work as a team to orient new employees. Unfortunately, without
good planning, new employee orientation sessions can come across as boring,
irrelevant, and a waste of time to both new employees and their department
supervisors and managers.
Solid academic research indicates that orientation (institutionalized socialization tactics) can be effective—if done well. Orientation reduces role ambiguity, role conflict, and intention to quit; and it increases perceptions of fit,
job satisfaction, commitment, and performance.21 Studies and observations by
practicing managers and HR managers confirm this.22 In addition, evidence
from the public sector shows how important orientation is if done well.23
Planning for orientation is reviewed in HR On-the-Job.
Among the decisions to be made during planning are what to present and
also, equally important, when to present it. Too much information on the first
HR on-the-job
Planning for New Employee
Orientation
Effective new employee orientation requires planning
and preparation. Unfortunately, orientation often is
conducted rather haphazardly. To make orientation more
effective, the following planning suggestions are useful:
•
•
•
•
Prepare for new employees. New employees
must feel that they belong and are important
to the organization. The supervisor, HR unit,
and coworkers should be prepared for a new
employee’s arrival.
Consider using mentors. Some organizations
assign coworkers or peers to serve as buddies or mentors as part of the new employees’
orientation.
Use an orientation checklist. An orientation
checklist can be used to identify what the new
employee needs to know now and later.
Cover needed information at the proper time.
It is important to give employees information
•
•
•
on the policies, work rules, and benefits of the
company when they need it. What do they
need on the first day? What later?
Present orientation information effectively.
Managers and HR representatives should determine the most appropriate ways to present orientation information both in person and using
technological means.
Avoid information overload. One common failing of many orientation programs is information overload. New workers presented with too
many facts may ignore or inaccurately recall
much of the information.
Evaluate and follow up. An HR representative
or manager can evaluate the effectiveness
of the orientation by conducting follow-up
interviews with new employees a few weeks or
months after the orientation.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 258
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
259
Training Human Resources
day leads to perceptions of ineffective onboarding. Several shorter sessions
over a longer period of time, bringing in information as it is needed, are more
effective. Effective orientation achieves several key purposes:
•
•
•
•
•
Establishes a favorable employee impression of the organization and
the job
Provides organization and job information
Enhances interpersonal acceptance by coworkers
Accelerates socialization and integration of the new employee into the
organization
Ensures that employee performance and productivity begin more quickly
Electronic Orientation Resources One way of expanding the efficiency
of orientation is to use electronic resources. Estimates are that more than
80% of employers have implemented electronic onboarding activities to
improve their employee orientation efforts.24 A number of employers place
general employee orientation information on company intranets or corporate websites. New employees log on and go through much of the general
material on organizational history, structure, products and services, mission,
and other background, instead of sitting in a classroom where the information is delivered in person or by videotape. Specific questions and concerns
can be addressed by HR staff and others after employees have reviewed the
Web-based information.25
Other companies use electronic resources a bit differently. For example, at
Mirage Resorts, when candidates accept an offer, they get an e-mail with a link
to a password-protected website that welcomes them, and they fill out their
I-9, W-2, and other forms on that website. Before reporting to work, they get
e-mails daily explaining where to park, where to get uniforms, and where to
drop off their dry cleaning. Assigning a desk, getting a computer and security
clearance, and many other orientation tasks are all done before the first day
on the job by electronic onboarding.26
Evaluating Orientation and Metrics
M E A S U R E
Although orientation is important and can provide many advantages for both
the organization and the new employee, it is not always done well. To determine
the effectiveness of an orientation training program, evaluation using specific
metrics is appropriate. Measurement should be made of the success of both the
orientation program and the new hires themselves. Suggested metrics include:27
•
Tenure turnover rate
•
New hires failure factor
•
Employee upgrade rate
•
Development program
participation rate
What percentage of new hires of 6 months or
less left the organization?
What percentage of the total annual turnover
was new hires?
What percentage of new employees received a
higher performance rating than previously?
What percentage of new employees have
moved on to training for or promotion to
higher jobs?
Successfully integrating new hires is important, and measuring the degree of
success allows the orientation program to be managed.
The way in which a firm plans, organizes, and structures its training
affects the way employees experience the training, which in turn influences the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 259
26/06/10 5:15 PM
260
SECTION 3
FIGURE 8-4
Training and Development
Systematic Training Process
Training Needs
Assessment
Analyze training
needs
Identify training
objectives and
criteria
Training Design
Pretest trainees
Select training
methods
Plan training
content
Training Delivery
Schedule training
Conduct training
Monitor training
Evaluation of training
Measure training outcomes
Compare outcome to training
objectives and criteria
effectiveness of the training. Effective training requires the use of a systematic
training process. Figure 8-4 shows the four phases of a systematic approach:
assessment, design, delivery, and evaluation. Using such a process reduces the
likelihood that unplanned, uncoordinated, and haphazard training efforts will
occur. A discussion of the training process follows.
TRAINING NEEDS ASSESSMENT
Assessing organizational training needs is the diagnostic phase of a training
plan. This assessment considers issues of employee and organizational performance to determine if training can help. Needs assessment measures the
competencies of a company, a group, or an individual as they relate to what
is required. It is necessary to find out what is happening and what should be
happening before deciding if training will help, and if it will help, what kind is
needed. For instance, suppose that in looking at the performance of clerks in
a billing department, a manager identifies problems that employees have with
their data-entry and keyboarding abilities, and she decides that they would
benefit from instruction in these areas. As part of assessing the training needs,
the manager has the clerks take a data-entry test to measure their current
keyboarding skills. Then the manager establishes an objective of increasing the
clerks’ keyboarding speed to 60 words per minute without errors. The number of words per minute without errors is the criterion against which training
success can be measured, and it represents the way in which the objective is
made specific.
Analysis of Training Needs
The first step in training needs assessment is analyzing what training might be
necessary. Figure 8-5 shows the three sources used to analyze training needs.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 260
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
261
Training Human Resources
Sources of Information for Training Needs Assessment
FIGURE 8-5
Organization-Wide Sources
Grievances
Accidents
Waste/scrap
Training
observations
Observations
Customer
complaints
Exit interviews
Equipment use
Attitude surveys
Job/Task Sources
Employee
KSAs
Benchmarks
Effectiveness
Job
specifications
Efficiency data
Employees
surveys
Individual Employee Sources
Tests
Records
Assessment
centers
Questionnaires
Surveys
Job knowledge
tools
Performance
appraisals
Organizational Analysis Training needs can be diagnosed by analyzing
organizational outcomes and looking at future organizational needs. A part
of planning for training is the identification of the KSAs that will be needed
now and in the future as both jobs and the organization change. Both internal
and external forces will influence training and must be considered when doing
organizational analysis. For instance, the problems posed by the technical
obsolescence of current employees and an insufficiently educated labor pool
from which to draw new workers should be confronted before those issues
become critical.
Organizational analysis comes from various operational measures of organizational performance. Departments or areas with high turnover, customer
complaints, high grievance rates, high absenteeism, low performance, and
other deficiencies can be pinpointed. Following identification of such problems, training objectives can be developed if training is a solution. During
organizational analysis, focus groups of managers can be used to evaluate
changes and performance that might require training.
Job/Task Analysis The second way of analyzing training needs is to review
the jobs involved and the tasks performed in those jobs. By comparing the
requirements of jobs with the KSAs of employees, training needs can be identified. For example, at a manufacturing firm, analysis identified the tasks performed by engineers who served as technical instructors for other employees.
By listing the tasks required of a technical instructor, management established
a program to teach specific instructional skills; thus, the engineers were able
to become more successful instructors.
Another way to pinpoint training gaps in the job or the task being done is to
survey employees and have them anonymously evaluate the skill levels of their
peers and estimate the skill levels necessary to be successful. This not only identifies job needs but also heightens employees’ awareness of their own learning
needs.28 A training needs survey can take the form of questionnaires or interviews with supervisors and employees individually or in groups. The growth of
the Internet has resulted in firms using Web-based surveys, requests, and other
inputs from managers and employees to identify training needs or jobs.
A good example of needs assessment for a particular job occurred in the
construction industry where there was a rash of accidents among Spanishspeaking construction workers. Construction companies recognized the need
for training in English as a second language for many people. Restaurants,
hospitals, and hotels have faced the same issue for certain (but not all) jobs.29
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 261
26/06/10 5:15 PM
262
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Individual Analysis The third means of diagnosing training needs focuses
on individuals and how they perform their jobs. The following sources are
examples that are useful for individual analysis:
•
•
•
•
Performance appraisals
Skill tests
Individual assessment tests
Records of critical incidents
•
•
•
•
Assessment center exercises
Questionnaires and surveys
Job knowledge tools
Internet input
The most common approach for making individual analysis is to use performance appraisal data. In some instances, a good HR information system
can be used to identify individuals who require training in specific areas in
order to be eligible for promotion. To assess training needs through the performance appraisal process, the organization first determines an employee’s
performance strengths and inadequacies in a formal review. Then it can design
some type of training to help the employee overcome the weaknesses and
enhance the strengths.
Another way of assessing individual training needs is to use both managerial and nonmanagerial input about what training is needed. Obtaining this
kind of input can be useful in building support for the training from those who
will be trained, as they help to identify training needs.
Tests can be a good means of individual-level analysis. For example, a
police officer might take a qualification test with her service pistol every
6 months to indicate the officer’s skill level. If an officer cannot qualify, training certainly would be necessary.
Establishing Training Objectives and Priorities
Once training requirements have been identified using needs analyses, training
objectives and priorities can be established by a “gap analysis,” which indicates
the distance between where an organization is with its employee capabilities
and where it needs to be. Training objectives and priorities are then determined
to close the gap. Three types of training objectives can be set:
•
•
•
Attitude: Creating interest in and awareness of the importance of
something (e.g., sexual harassment training)
Knowledge: Imparting cognitive information and details to trainees
(e.g., understanding how a product works)
Skill: Developing behavioral changes in how jobs and various
task requirements are performed (e.g., improving speed on an
installation)
The success of training should be measured in terms of the objectives that
were set for it. Useful objectives are measurable. For example, an objective for
a new sales clerk might be to “demonstrate the ability to explain the function
of each product in the department within two weeks.” This objective checks
internalization, that is, whether the person really learned the training content
and is able to use the training.
Because training seldom is an unlimited budget item and because organizations have multiple training needs, prioritization is necessary. Ideally, management looks at training needs in relation to strategic organizational plans and
as part of the organizational change process. Then the training needs can be
prioritized based on organizational objectives. Conducting the training most
needed to improve the performance of the organization will produce visible
results more quickly.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 262
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
263
Training Human Resources
TRAINING DESIGN
Once training objectives have been determined, training design can start.
Whether job-specific or broader in nature, training must be designed to
address the specific objectives. Effective training design considers the learners,
instructional strategies, and how best to get the training from class to the job.
Working in organizations should be a continual learning process. Different
approaches are possible because learning is a complex psychological process.
Each of the elements shown in Figure 8-6 must be considered for the training
design to be effective and produce learning.
Learner Characteristics
For training to be successful, learners must be ready and able to learn. Learner
readiness means that individuals have the ability to learn, which many people
certainly have. However, individuals also must have the motivation to learn, have
self-efficacy, see value in learning, and have a learning style that fits the training.
Ability to Learn Learners must possess basic skills, such as fundamental
reading and math proficiency, and sufficient cognitive abilities. Companies may
discover that some workers lack the requisite skills to comprehend their training. Some have found that a significant number of job applicants and current
employees lack the reading, writing, and math skills needed to learn the jobs.
Employers might deal with the lack of basic employee skills in several ways:
•
•
•
FIGURE 8-6
Offer remedial training to people in the current workforce who need it.
Hire workers who are deficient and then implement specific workplace
training.30
Work with local schools to help better educate potential hires for jobs.
Training Design Elements
Learner Characteristics
Ability to learn
Motivation to learn
Self-efficacy
Perceived utility/value
Learning styles
Training Transfer
Strategic link
Supervisor support
Opportunity
Accountability
Instructional Strategies
Practice/feedback
Overlearning
Behavioral modeling
Error-based examples
Reinforcement/
immediate
confirmation
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 263
26/06/10 5:15 PM
264
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Motivation A person’s desire to learn training content, referred to as “motivation to learn,” is influenced by multiple factors. For example, differences in
gender and ethnicity and the resulting experiences may affect the motivation
of adult learners. The student’s motivational level also may be influenced by
the instructor’s motivation and ability, friends’ encouragement to do well,
classmates’ motivational levels, the physical classroom environment, and the
training methods used.31 Regardless of what the motivation is, without it, the
student will not learn the material.
Self-Efficacy Learners must possess self-efficacy, which refers to people’s
belief that they can successfully learn the training program content. For learners to be ready for and receptive to the training content, they must feel that it
is possible for them to learn it. As an example, some college students’ levels
of self-efficacy diminish in math or statistics courses when they do not feel
adequately able to grasp the material. These perceptions may have nothing to
do with their actual ability to learn, but rather reflect the way they see themselves and their abilities. Instructors and trainers must find appropriate ways
to boost the confidence of trainees who are unsure of their learning abilities
because people with a high level of belief that they can learn perform better
and are more satisfied with the training they receive.
Perceived Utility/Value Training that is viewed as useful is more likely to
be tried on the job. Perceived utility or value of training is affected by a need
to improve, the likelihood that training will lead to improvement, and the
practicality of the training for use on the job. Learners must perceive a close
relationship between the training and things they want for it to be successful.
Self-efficacy People’s belief
that they can successfully
learn the training program
content.
Adult learning Ways in
which adults learn differently
than younger people.
Learning Styles People learn in different ways. For example, auditory learners learn best by listening to someone else tell them about the training content.
Tactile learners must “get their hands on” the training resources and use them.
Visual learners think in pictures and figures and need to see the purpose and
process of the training. Trainers who address all these styles by using multiple
training methods can design more effective training.
Training design also must sometimes address special issues presented by
adult learning. Certainly, the training design must consider that all the trainees
are adults, but adults come with widely varying learning styles, experiences,
and personal goals. For example, training older adults in technology may
require greater attention to explaining the need for changes and to enhancing
the older trainees’ confidence and abilities when learning new technologies. In
contrast, younger adults are more likely to be familiar with new technology
because of their earlier exposure to computers and technology.
Malcolm Knowles’s classic work on adult learning suggests five principles
for designing training for adults.32 According to that work and subsequent
work by others, adults:
•
LOGGING ON
Learnativity.com
For articles and other resources on
adult learning, training, and evaluation,
visit this website at
www.learnativity.com.
•
•
•
•
Have the need to know why they are learning
something.
Have a need to be self-directed.
Bring more work-related experiences into the learning
process.
Enter into a learning experience with a problemcentered approach to learning.
Are motivated to learn by both extrinsic and intrinsic
factors.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 264
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
Training Human Resources
265
Instructional Strategies
An important part of designing training is to select the right mix of strategies to
fit the learners’ characteristics. Practice/feedback, overlearning, behavioral modeling, error-based examples, and reinforcement/immediate confirmation are
some of the prominent strategies available in designing the training experience.
Practice/Feedback For some kinds of training, it is important that learners
practice what they have learned and get feedback on how they have done so
they can improve. Active practice occurs when trainees perform job-related
tasks and duties during training. It is more effective than simply reading or
passively listening. For instance, assume a person is being trained as a customer
service representative. After being given some basic selling instructions and
product details, the trainee calls a customer and uses the knowledge received.
Active practice can be structured in two ways. The first, spaced practice,
occurs when several practice sessions are spaced over a period of hours or
days. The second, massed practice, occurs when a person performs all the
practice at once. Spaced practice works better for some types of skills and for
physical learning that requires muscle memory, whereas massed practice is
usually more effective for other kinds of learning, such as memorizing tasks.
Imagine the difficulty of trying to memorize the lists of options for 20 dishwasher models if memorized at a rate of one model a day for 20 days. By the
time the appliance distribution salespeople had learned the last option, they
likely would have forgotten the first one.
Overlearning Overlearning is repeated practice even after a learner has mastered the performance. It may be best used to instill “muscle memory” for a
physical activity in order to reduce the amount of thinking necessary and make
responses automatic. But overlearning also produces improvement in learner
retention. Research suggests that even with overlearning, refreshers are still
sometimes necessary to reduce the effect of response delay.33
Active practice
Performance of job-related
tasks and duties by trainees
during training.
Spaced practice Practice
performed in several sessions
spaced over a period of hours
or days.
Massed practice Practice
performed all at once.
Behavioral modeling
Copying someone else’s
behavior.
Behavioral Modeling The most elementary way in which people learn—and
one of the best—is through behavioral modeling, or copying someone else’s
behavior. The use of behavioral modeling is particularly appropriate for skill
training in which the trainees must use both knowledge and practice. It can aid
in the transfer of skills and the usage of those skills by those who are trained.34
For example, a new supervisor can receive training and mentoring on how to
handle disciplinary discussions with employees by observing as the HR director or department manager deals with such problems.
Behavioral modeling is used extensively as the primary means for training
supervisors and managers in interpersonal skills. Fortunately or unfortunately,
many supervisors and managers end up modeling behaviors they see their
bosses use. For that reason, supervisor training should include good role
models to show how to handle interpersonal interactions with employees.
Error-Based Examples The error-based examples method involves sharing
with learners what can go wrong when they do not use the training properly.
A good example is sharing with pilots what can happen when they are not
aware of a situation they and their aircraft are entering. Situational awareness
training that includes error-based examples has been shown to improve air
crew situational awareness.35 Error-based examples have been incorporated
in military, firefighting, and police training as well as aviation training. Case
studies that show negative consequences of errors are a good tool for communicating error-based examples.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 265
26/06/10 5:15 PM
266
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Reinforcement and Immediate Confirmation The concept of
reinforcement is based on the law of effect, which states that people tend to
repeat responses that give them some type of positive reward and to avoid
actions associated with negative consequences. Positively reinforcing correct learned responses while providing negative consequences at some point
for wrong responses can change behavior. Closely related is an instructional
strategy called immediate confirmation, which is based on the idea that people
learn best if reinforcement and feedback are given as soon as possible after
training. Immediate confirmation corrects errors that, if made throughout
the training, might establish an undesirable pattern that would need to be
unlearned. It also aids with the transfer of training to the actual work done.
Transfer of Training
Reinforcement Based on
the idea that people tend to
repeat responses that give
them some type of positive
reward and to avoid actions
associated with negative
consequences.
Immediate confirmation
Based on the idea that people
learn best if reinforcement and
feedback are given as soon as
possible after training.
Finally, trainers should design training for the highest possible transfer from
the class to the job. Transfer occurs when trainees actually use on the job what
knowledge and information they learned in training. The amount of training
that effectively gets transferred to the job is estimated to be relatively low,
given all the time and money spent on training. It is estimated that about 40%
of employees apply training to their jobs immediately after training. Among
those who do not use the training immediately, the likelihood of it being used
decreases over time.36
Effective transfer of training meets two conditions. First, the trainees can
take the material learned in training and apply it to the job context in which
they work. Second, employees maintain their use of the learned material over
time. A number of things can increase the transfer of training. Offering trainees an overview of the training content and how it links to the strategy of the
organization seems to help with both short-term and longer-term training
transfer. Another helpful approach is to ensure that the training mirrors the job
context as much as possible. For example, training managers to be better selection interviewers should include role-playing with “applicants” who respond
in the same way that real applicants would.
One of the most consistent factors in training transfer is the support new
trainees receive from their supervisors to use their new skills when they return
to the job.37 Supervisor support of the training, feedback from the supervisor,
and supervisor involvement in training are powerful influences in transfer.
Opportunity to use the training also is important. To be trained on something
but never to have the opportunity to use it obviously limits transfer. Learners
need the opportunity to use new skills on the job if the skills are to remain.
Finally, accountability helps transfer training from class to job.
Accountability is the extent to which someone expects the learner to use the
new skills on the job and holds them responsible for doing so. It may require
supervisory praise for doing the task correctly and sanctions for not showing
proper trained behavior, but making people accountable for their own trained
behavior is effective.38
TRAINING DELIVERY
Once training has been designed, the actual delivery of training can begin.
Regardless of the type of training done, a number of approaches and methods
can be used to deliver it. The growth of training technology continues to
expand the available choices, as Figure 8-7 shows.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 266
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
267
Training Human Resources
Training Delivery Options
FIGURE 8-7
Internal
Traditional classes
On-the-job training
Self-guided training
at company portal
Mentoring/coaching
Job shadowing
Developing teachers
internally
Cross training
Training projects
Group-based
classroom
External
Third-party delivered
training
Web conferences
Training at outside
location
Podcasts
Educational leave
Blended training
Teleconferencing
Whatever the approach used, a variety of considerations must be balanced when selecting training delivery methods. The common variables considered are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Nature of training
Subject matter
Number of trainees
Individual versus team
Self-paced versus guided
Training resources/costs
•
•
•
•
E-learning versus traditional
learning
Geographic locations
Time allotted
Completion timeline
To illustrate, a large firm with many new hires may be able to conduct
employee orientation using the Internet, videotapes, and specific HR staff members, while a small firm with few new hires may have an HR staff member meet
individually with the new hires for several hours. A medium-sized company
with three locations in a geographic area may bring supervisors together for a
two-day training workshop once a quarter. However, a large, global firm may
use Web-based courses to reach supervisors throughout the world, with content
available in several languages. Frequently training is conducted internally, but
some types of training use external or technological training resources.
Further, training can be formal or informal. Formal training is very visible,
as it consists of planned learning activities. Informal training takes place when
learning may not be the primary focus, but it occurs anyway. The informal
learning may be the result of some sort of self-initiated effort or simply serendipitous, but it often occurs as needed.39
Internal Training
Internal training generally applies very specifically to the organization and
its jobs. It is popular because it saves the cost of sending employees away for
training and often avoids the cost of outside trainers. Skills-based technical
training is usually conducted inside organizations. Training materials are often
created internally as well.40 Due to rapid changes in technology, the building
and updating of technical skills may become crucial internal training needs.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 267
26/06/10 5:15 PM
268
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Basic technical skills training is also being mandated by federal regulations in
areas where the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA), the
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), and other agencies have jurisdiction.
Three types of internal delivery options will be discussed here: informal training, on-the-job training (OJT), and cross training.
Informal Training One internal source of training is informal training,
which occurs through interactions and feedback among employees. Much
of what employees know about their jobs they learn informally from asking questions and getting advice from other employees and their supervisors,
rather than from formal training programs.
Informal learning tends to occur as a result of a learning need in the
context of working.41 It may involve group problem solving, job shadowing,
coaching, or mentoring; or it may evolve from employees seeking out other
people who have the needed knowledge. Although “informal training” may
seem to be a misnomer, a great deal of learning occurs informally in work
organizations, and some of it happens by design.
Informal training
Training that occurs through
interactions and feedback
among employees.
FIGURE 8-8
On-the-Job Training The most common type of training at all levels in an
organization is on-the-job training (OJT) because it is flexible and relevant to
what employees do.42 Well-planned and well-executed OJT can be very effective.43
Based on a guided form of training known as job instruction training (JIT), OJT is
most effective if a logical progression of stages is used, as shown in Figure 8-8. In
contrast with informal training, which often occurs spontaneously, OJT should
be planned. The supervisor or manager conducting the training must be able
to both teach and show the employees what to do.
However, OJT has some problems. Often, those doing the training may
have no experience in training, no time to do it, or no desire to participate in
it. Under such conditions, learners essentially are on their own, and training
likely will not be effective. Another problem is that OJT can disrupt regular
work. Unfortunately, OJT can amount to no training at all in some circumstances, especially if the trainers simply abandon the trainees to learn the job
alone. Also, bad habits or incorrect information from the supervisor or manager can be transferred to the trainees.
Stages for On-the-Job Training
Prepare the
Trainees
Present the
Information
Put them at
ease
Find out
what they
know
Get them
interested
Tell, show,
question
Present one
point at a time
Make sure
the trainees
know
Provide the
Trainees with
Practice
Have the
trainees
perform the
tasks
Ask questions
Observe and
correct
Evaluate
mastery
Do Follow-Up
Put the
trainees on
their own
Check
frequently
Reduce
follow-up as
performance
improves
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 268
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
269
Training Human Resources
Cross Training “Universal
Agents”
As technology has matured in the banking business,
ATMs, debit cards, online banking, and direct deposit
have changed the job of the bank teller and reduced the
need for teller-processed transactions. Cross training
can combine the duties of a teller with the duties of a
member service representative (MSR), which helps by
retaining jobs, making the jobs more interesting and
varied, and saving the bank costs.
A “universal agent” is an employee who is crosstrained as both a teller and an MSR. This employee can
cover employee absences and lunch breaks for either
tellers or MSRs. The universal agent can be scheduled
for either position during periods of peak activity, such
as Friday afternoons. But to make these advantages
become possible, the bank or credit union must
provide support with cross training and technology that
allows the employee to shift from one job to the other.
The universal agent should be able to serve as a
transaction processor, financial counselor, and service
provider. Universal agents can approach customers and
get them to the proper place/person or handle their needs
themselves. If customers need checks cashed, the agent
can take them to the teller station. If customers need
CDs renewed, the agent can do that at a work station. If
Cross training Training
people to do more than one
job.
HR perspective
customers need loans, the agent can begin the process
and call the loan manager for consultation if necessary.
Two technological changes are necessary to make
this work. First, the traditional teller’s position has to
be redesigned to allow the agent to move between the
teller’s work station and the sales and service work
station. Employees circulate through the bank, and
every customer receives a sit-down interaction with an
agent for all activities.
The second technological change necessary to make
the universal agent position work is acquisition of a
machine called a “cash recycler.” This machine accepts,
stores, and dispenses currency and coins similar to an
ATM. It allows the universal agent to get away from the
traditional teller’s cash drawer, which must be closed,
reconciled, and locked anytime it is left.
Teller and MSR skill sets differ, and cross training
is critical to teach someone in one position the duties
of an employee in the other. Tellers may need sales
training to be able to do the MSR job, and MSRs will
need teller training. However, when properly done, the
universal agent approach can provide a better sales
and service experience for the customer and keep
transaction costs to a minimum.47
Cross Training Cross training occurs when people are trained to do more
than one job—theirs and someone else’s.44 For the employer, the advantages
of cross training are flexibility and development.45 However, although cross
training is attractive to the employer, it is not always appreciated by employees, who often feel that it requires them to do more work for the same pay.
To counteract such responses and to make it more appealing to employees,
learning “bonuses” can be awarded for successfully completing cross training.
In some organizations, the culture may be such that people seek crosstraining assignments to grow or prepare for a promotion, but that is not the
case in all organizations.46 Unions typically are not in favor of cross training
because it threatens job jurisdiction and broadens jobs. Cross training may
require scheduling work differently during training, and temporarily decreased
productivity may result from it as people learn. Overall, an effective crosstraining program can overcome the concerns mentioned and has the potential
to be good for both employer and employee, as the HR Perspective: Cross
Training Universal Agents illustrates.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 269
26/06/10 5:15 PM
270
SECTION 3
Training and Development
External Training
External training, or training that takes place outside the employing organization, is used extensively by organizations of all sizes. Large organizations use
external training if they lack the capability to train people internally or when
many people need to be trained quickly. External training may be the best
option for training in smaller firms due to limitations in the size of their training staffs and in the number of employees who need various types of specialized training. Whatever the size of the organization, external training occurs
for several reasons:
•
•
•
•
It may be less expensive for an employer to have an outside trainer
conduct training in areas where internal training resources are limited.
The organization may have insufficient time to develop internal training
materials.
The HR staff may not have the necessary level of expertise for the subject
matter in which training is needed.
There are advantages to having employees interact with managers and
peers in other companies in training programs held externally.
Outsourcing of Training Many employers of all sizes outsource training to
external training firms, consultants, and other entities. Perhaps one-third of
training expenditures go to outside training sources. The reasons more outside
training is not used may be cost concerns, and a greater emphasis on internal
linking of training to organizational strategies. However, outsourcing of training is used more frequently when mergers and acquisition occur.48
A popular route for some employers is to use vendors and suppliers to train
employees. Several computer software vendors offer employees technical certifications on their software. For example, being a Microsoft Certified Product
Specialist gives employees credentials that show their level of technical expertise. Such certifications provide employees with items to put on their résumés
should they decide to change jobs. These certifications also benefit employers,
who can use them as job specifications for hiring and promotion.
Many suppliers host users’ conferences, where employees from a number
of firms receive detailed training on using products, services, and features that
are new to the employees. Some vendors will conduct the training inside an
organization as well if sufficient numbers of employees are to be trained.
Government-Supported Job Training Federal, state, and local governments provide a wide range of external training assistance and funding.
The Workforce Investment Act (WIA) provides states with block grant programs that target adult education, disadvantaged youth, and family literacy.
Employers hiring and training individuals who meet the WIA criteria receive
tax credits and other assistance for 6 months or more, depending on the program regulations.
At state and local levels, employers that add to their workforces can take
advantage of a number of programs that provide funding assistance to offset
training costs. As an example, a number of states offer workforce training assistance for employers. Quick Start (Georgia), Smart Jobs (Texas), and Partnership
(Alabama) are three well-known training support efforts. Often such programs
are linked to two-year and four-year colleges throughout the state.
Educational Assistance Programs Some employers pay for additional
education for their employees. Typically, the employee pays for a course that
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 270
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
271
Training Human Resources
applies to a college degree and is reimbursed upon successful completion of the
course. The amounts paid by the employer are considered nontaxable income
for the employee up to amounts set by federal laws.
Lifelong Learning Accounts (LiLA) programs can be offered by employers.
These accounts are like 401(K) plans—employers and employees contribute to
a fund for adult education. The employee owns the plan and
keeps it even if the employee leaves the company. It can be
LOGGING ON
used to further one’s education, perhaps in order to move to
Quick Start Technical College
a different job in the company.49
System of Georgia
One concern about traditional forms of employee educaThe Quick Start system provides
tional
programs is that they may pose risks for the employer.
information on delivering workforce
Upon completion of the degree, the employee may choose to
training in a broad range of industry
take the new skills and go elsewhere. Employers must plan
sectors. Visit the website at
to use these skills upon employee graduation to improve the
www.georgiaquickstart.org.
retention of those employees.
Combination Training Approaches
Whether training is delivered internally or externally, appropriate training
must be chosen. The following overview identifies two common training
approaches that often integrate internal and external means. Some are used
more for job-based training, while others are used more for development.
Cooperative Training Cooperative training approaches mix classroom
training and on-the-job experiences. This training can take several forms. One
form, generally referred to as school-to-work transition, helps individuals
move into jobs while still in school or on completion of formal schooling. Such
efforts may be arranged with high schools or community colleges.
Another form of cooperative training used by employers, trade unions, and
government agencies is apprentice training. An apprenticeship program provides an employee with on-the-job experience under the guidance of a skilled
and certified worker. Certain requirements for training, equipment, time length,
and proficiency levels may be monitored by a unit of the U.S. Department of
Labor. Figure 8-9 indicates the most common areas that use apprenticeships to
train people for jobs. Apprenticeships usually last 2 to 5 years, depending on
the occupation. During this time, the apprentice usually receives lower wages
than the certified individual.
A form of cooperative training called internship usually combines job
training with classroom instruction from schools, colleges, and universities.50 Internships benefit both employers and interns. Interns get real-world
exposure, a line on their résumés, and a chance to closely examine a possible
FIGURE 8-9
Most Common Apprenticeship Occupations
Electrician (construction)
Carpenter
Plumber
Pipe fitter
Sheet metal worker
Structural-steel worker
Elevator constructor
Roofer
Sprinkler fitter
Bricklayer
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 271
26/06/10 5:15 PM
272
SECTION 3
Training and Development
employer. Employers get a cost-effective source of labor and a chance to see an
intern at work before making a final hiring decision.51
E-Learning: Online Training
E-learning is use of the Internet or an organizational intranet to conduct training online. E-learning is popular with employers. The major advantages are cost
savings and access to more employees. Estimates are that corporate training
conducted through learning technology will increase in the next few years.52
Almost 30% of learning hours today are totally technology based, according to
an ASTD report, and e-learning is preferred by workers under the age of 30.53
However, e-learning is advancing gradually, not explosively. It has found
favor as part of a “blended” solution that combines it with other forms of
learning. By itself, e-learning is not rated among the top effective training
practices by training professionals.54 Changes in technology appear to make
possible in the future some things that were not possible in the first years of
e-learning. For example, Web 2.0 tools such as instant messaging and Web
conferencing may allow trainers to expand to “soft skills” electronic training,55
and the ability to have reasonably priced video conferencing
may make training via this medium more acceptable.56
LOGGING ON
The method is certainly fast and flexible. For example,
E Learning Guild
after Hurricane Katrina, a Red Cross volunteer was able to
This website provides members with
design and make an online course to train volunteers availlearning opportunities, networking
able in 4 days. When volunteers signed up to help, they were
services, resources, and publications
immediately directed to the online training course.57 Three
on e-learning. Visit the site at
areas where online learning has proved to be beneficial are
www.elearninguild.com.
distance training/learning, simulations, and blended learning.
Distance Training/Learning Many college and university classes use some
form of Internet-based course support. Blackboard and WebCT are two
popular support packages that thousands of college professors use to make
their lecture content available to students. These packages enable virtual chat
and electronic file exchange among course participants, and also enhance
instructor-student contact.
Many large employers use interactive two-way television to present classes.
The medium allows an instructor in one place to see and respond to a “class”
in any number of other locations. With a fully configured system, employees
can take courses from anywhere in the world.58
Simulations and Training Computer-based training involves a wide array
of multimedia technologies—including sound, motion (video and animation),
graphics, and hypertext—to tap multiple learner senses. Computer-supported
simulations within e-learning can replicate the psychological and behavioral
requirements of a task, often in addition to providing some amount of physical
resemblance to the trainee’s work environment.
From highly complicated systems that replicate difficult landing scenarios
for pilots to programs that help medical trainees learn to sew sutures, simulations allow for safe training when the risks associated with failure are high.
For example, sanitation workers can get practice driving on slick roads and
down tight alleys without damaging anything. A $450,000 computer simulation uses videos, movement, and sound to simulate driving a dump truck.
Accidents from poor truck handling skills include damage to fences, posts, and
buildings. The safety training simulation reduces such accidents.59
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 272
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
273
Training Human Resources
Simulations and Games
A young woman walks into a restaurant in a busy city,
sets down a purse, and leaves. Moments later a bomb
explodes, and people are screaming and injured as the
restaurant goes up in flames. Fire trucks and police go to
work to deal with the mess. This did not really happen;
it is a training simulation made to teach emergency
response initiatives. Such real-time virtual training forces
employees to apply their knowledge in the real world,
and to make quick decisions in difficult situations.
Many people play computer games for fun, but
games in various forms also are becoming a very useful
part of training. For years military and government
workers have used games and simulations to prepare
for combat, improve the use of military equipment, and
prepare for natural and human-caused disasters. Now
many private employers of all types are using gaming
situations for both new and existing employees.
For example, a company in Pittsburg uses a virtual
training environment in which employees learn to
operate a forklift to move loads from the loading area
HR perspective
to another area. They must check their equipment
before starting, and a wrong move may result in a
forklift crashing into another employee or driving off
the dock. The simulation allows learning without tying
up the dock for training or hurting anyone.
Railroads, trucking companies, banks, retailers,
technology firms, hotels, and many others are using
gaming simulations. Doing so appears to increase
employee interest in training, promises better training
transfer, and improves performance. A younger
workforce seems to appreciate the training method.
Game-based learning (GBL) can present realistic,
complete, and captivating experiences for employees.
For many, “winning the game” is more motivating than
answering questions or taking a test.
However, GBL requires the same needs analysis
and planning as any other training effort. While the
games may be more interesting than some classes, they
do not automatically provide good training. The right
game must be used to teach the right things.60
Virtual reality is also used to create an artificial environment for trainees so
that they can participate in the training. Gaming is a growing e-learning tool,
as the HR Perspective describes.
The new technologies incorporated into training delivery affect the design,
administration, and support of training. Some companies have invested in electronic registration and recordkeeping systems that allow trainers to register
participants, record exam results, and monitor learning progress.
Generally, technology is moving from center stage to becoming embedded in
the learning and training processes. As learning and work merge even closer in
the future, technology is likely to integrate seamlessly into the work environment
of more employees. This integration will allow employees to spend less time in
the future learning how to use technology, and more time on learning the desired
content. For example, screening passenger bags in airports has been improved
by using a simulation tied to the X-ray machine that is used to screen.61
Blended learning Learning
approach that combines
methods, such as short,
fast-paced, interactive
computer-based lessons
and teleconferencing with
traditional classroom
instruction and simulation.
Blended Learning E-learning cannot be the sole method of training, according
to the findings of a number of employers.62 Therefore, the solution seems to be
blended learning, which might combine short, fast-paced, interactive computerbased lessons and teleconferencing with traditional classroom instruction and
simulation.63 Deciding which training is best handled by which medium is important. A blended learning approach can use e-learning for building knowledge of
certain basics, a Web-based virtual classroom for building skills, and significant
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 273
26/06/10 5:15 PM
274
SECTION 3
FIGURE 8-10
Training and Development
Advantages and Disadvantages of E-Learning
Advantages
Is self-paced; trainees can proceed
on their own time
Is interactive, tapping multiple
trainee senses
Enables scoring of exercises/
assessments and the appropriate
feedback
Incorporates built-in guidance and
help for trainees to use when needed
Allows trainers to update content
relatively easily
Can enhance instructor-led training
Is good for presenting simple facts
and concepts
Can be paired with simulation
Disadvantages
May cause trainee anxiety
Some trainees may not be interested
in how it is used
Requires easy and uninterrupted
access to computers
Is not appropriate for some training
(leadership, cultural change, etc.)
Requires significant upfront
investment both in time and costs
Requires significant support from
top management to be successful
Some choose not to do it even if it is
available
in-person traditional instructor-led training sessions and courses. Use of blended
learning provides greater flexibility in the use of multiple training means and
enhances the appeal of training activities to different types of employees.64
Advantages and Disadvantages of E-Learning The rapid growth of
e-learning makes the Internet or an intranet a viable means for delivering
training content. But e-learning has both advantages and disadvantages that
must be considered.65 In addition to being concerned about employee access
to e-learning and desire to use it, some employers worry that trainees will
use e-learning to complete courses quickly but will not retain and use much
of what they learned. Taking existing training materials, putting them on
the Internet, and cutting the training budget is not the way to succeed with
e-learning. An important question to ask is: Can this material be learned as
well online as through conventional methods? In some cases, the answer is no.
E-learning is the latest development in training delivery. Some of the biggest obstacles to using it will be keeping up with the rapid changes in technological innovation and designing e-courses appropriately. E-learning has had a
major impact on HR and training, but there are no “ten easy steps” to making
e-learning successful. Figure 8-10 presents a listing of the most commonly
cited advantages and disadvantages of e-learning.
TRAINING EVALUATION
Evaluation of training compares the post-training results to the pre-training
objectives of managers, trainers, and trainees. Too often, training is conducted
with little thought of measuring and evaluating it later to see how well it
worked. Because training is both time consuming and costly, it should be
evaluated.66
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 274
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
275
Training Human Resources
F I G U R E 8 - 11
Levels of Training Evaluation
High
Value to Organization
Results
Behavior
Learning
Reaction
Low
Easy
Difficult
Levels of Evaluation
It is best to consider how training is to be evaluated before it begins. Donald
L. Kirkpatrick identified four levels at which training can be evaluated. As
Figure 8-11 shows, the evaluation of training becomes successively more difficult to do as it moves from measuring reaction to measuring learning to
measuring behavior and then to measuring results. But the training that affects
behavior and results versus reaction and learning provides greater value in
viewing training as a strategic performance contributor.67
Reaction Organizations evaluate the reaction levels of trainees by conducting
interviews with or administering questionnaires to the trainees. Assume that
30 managers attend a two-day workshop on effective interviewing skills. A
reaction-level measure could be gathered by having the managers complete a
survey that asked them to rate the value of the training, the style of the instructors, and the usefulness of the training to them.
Learning Learning levels can be evaluated by measuring how well trainees
have learned facts, ideas, concepts, theories, and attitudes. Tests on the training
material are commonly used for evaluating learning, and they can be given both
before and after training to provide scores that can be compared. If test scores
indicate learning problems, then instructors get feedback and courses can be
redesigned so that the content can be delivered more effectively. Of course,
learning enough to pass a test does not guarantee that trainees will remember
the training content months later or that it will change job behaviors.68
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 275
26/06/10 5:15 PM
276
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Behavior Evaluating training at the behavioral level means measuring the
effect of training on job performance through observing job performance. For
instance, the managers who participated in an interviewing workshop might
be observed conducting actual interviews of applicants for jobs in their departments. If the managers asked questions as they had been trained to and used
appropriate follow-up questions, then behavioral indicators of the effectiveness of the interviewing training exist.
Results Employers evaluate results by measuring the effect of training on the
achievement of organizational objectives. Because results such as productivity, turnover, quality, time, sales, and costs are relatively concrete, this type of
evaluation can be done by comparing records before and after training. For the
managers who attended interviewing training, evaluators could gather records
of the number of individuals hired compared with the number of employment
offers made before and after the training.
The difficulty with measuring results is pinpointing whether changes were
actually the result of training or of other major factors. For example, the
managers who completed the interviewing training program can be measured
on employee turnover before and after the training, but turnover also depends
on the current economic situation, the demand for workers, and many other
variables.
Training Evaluation Metrics
M E A S U R E
Training is expensive, and it is an HR function that requires measurement and
monitoring. Cost–benefit analysis and return-on-investment (ROI) analysis
are commonly used to measure training results, as are various benchmarking
approaches.
Cost–Benefit Analysis Training results can be examined through cost–benefit
analysis, which is comparison of costs and benefits associated with training.
There are four stages in calculating training costs and benefits:69
1. Determine training costs. Consider direct costs such as design, trainer
fees, materials, facilities, and other administration activities.
2. Identify potential savings results. Consider employee retention, better
customer service, fewer work errors, quicker equipment production, and
other productivity factors.
3. Compute potential savings. Gather data on the performance results and
assign dollar costs to each of them.
4. Conduct costs and savings benefits comparisons. Evaluate the costs per
participant, the savings per participant, and how the costs and benefits
relate to business performance numbers.
Cost–benefit analysis
Comparison of costs and
benefits associated with
training.
One firm uses HR metrics for many aspects of evaluating how general
managers and their stores are performing. Scoring results are produced annually, quarterly, and monthly.
Figure 8-12 shows some costs and benefits that may result from training.
Even though some benefits (such as attitude changes) are hard to quantify,
comparison of costs and benefits associated with training remains a way to
determine whether training is cost-effective. For example, one firm evaluated
a traditional safety training program and found that the program did not lead
to a reduction in accidents. Therefore, the safety training was redesigned, and
better safety practices resulted.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 276
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
277
Training Human Resources
FIGURE 8-12
Possible Costs and Benefits in Training
Typical Costs
Trainer’s salary and time
Trainees’ salaries and time
Materials for training
Expenses for trainer and trainees
Cost of facilities and equipment
Lost productivity (opportunity cost)
Typical Benefits
Increase in production
Reduction in errors and accidents
Reduction in turnover
Less supervision necessary
Ability to use new capabilities
Attitude changes
Cost–Benefit Analysis
Return-on-Investment Analysis and Benchmarking In organizations,
training is often expected to produce an ROI. Still, too often, training is justified because someone liked it, rather than on the basis of resource accountability. ROI simply divides the return produced because of the training by the
cost (or investment) of the training.
In addition to evaluating training internally, some organizations use
benchmark measures to compare it with training done in other organizations. To do benchmarking, HR professionals gather data on training in their
organization and compare them with data on training at other organizations
in the same industry and in companies of a similar size. Comparison data are
available through the American Society for Training and Development and
its Benchmarking Service. This service has training-related data from more
than 1,000 participating employers who complete detailed questionnaires
annually. Training also can be benchmarked against data from the American
Productivity & Quality Center and the Saratoga Institute.
Training Evaluation Designs
With or without benchmarking data, internal evaluations of training programs
can be designed in a number of ways. The rigor of the three designs discussed
next increases with each level.
Post-Measure The most obvious way to evaluate training effectiveness is
to determine after the training whether the individuals can perform the way
management wants them to perform. Assume that a customer service manager
has 20 representatives who need to improve their data-entry speeds. After
a one-day training session, they take a test to measure their speeds. If the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 277
26/06/10 5:15 PM
278
SECTION 3
Training and Development
representatives can all type the required speed after training, was the training
beneficial? It is difficult to say; perhaps most of them could have done as well
before training. Tests after training do not always clearly indicate whether a
performance is a result of the training or could have been achieved without
the training.
Pre-/Post-Measure By differently designing the evaluation just discussed,
the issue of pretest skill levels can be considered. If the data-entry speed is
measured before and after training, then it will indicate whether the training
made any difference. However, a question would remain: Was any increase in
speed a response to the training, or did these employees simply work faster
because they knew they were being tested? People often perform better when
they know their efforts are being evaluated.
Pre-/Post-Measure with a Control Group Another evaluation design can
address the preceding problem. In addition to testing the 20 representatives
who will be trained, the manager can test another group of representatives
who will not be trained, to see if they do as well as those who are to be trained.
This second group is called a control group. After training, if the trained representatives work significantly faster than those who were not trained, the
manager can be reasonably sure that the training was effective.
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Training is the process that provides people with
the capabilities they need to do their jobs.
Four types of training are regular/required, job/
technical, interpersonal/problem solving, and
developmental/career in nature.
A strategic approach to training links organizational strategies and HR planning to various
training efforts.
Training affects factors such as organizational
competitiveness, knowledge management, revenue, and performance.
Performance consulting compares desired and
actual results in order to identify needed training and nontraining actions.
Global strategies must consider training as a key
component, including intercultural competence
training to prepare employees to respond more
appropriately to situations encountered during
global assignments.
The training process consists of four phases:
assessment, design, delivery, and evaluation.
Training needs can be assessed using organizational, job/task, and individual analyses, and
then training objectives can be set to help the
organization meet those needs.
• Training design must consider learner readiness,
learning styles, and learning transfer.
• Training can be delivered internally (e.g., OJT
training) or through external means, and formally (e.g., through classes) or informally.
• Common training approaches include cooperative training and classroom/conference training.
• Orientation is a form of onboarding designed to
help new employees learn about their jobs.
• E-learning is training conducted using the
Internet or an intranet, and both its advantages
and its disadvantages must be considered in its
development.
• Various organizations are taking advantage of
training that uses technology, such as Web-based
multimedia, video streaming, simulation, and
virtual reality.
• Training can be evaluated at four levels: reaction, learning, behavior, and results.
• Training evaluation metrics may include cost–
benefit analysis, ROI analysis, and benchmarking.
• A pre-/post-measure with a control group is the
most rigorous design for training evaluation;
other, less rigorous designs can be used as well.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 278
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
279
Training Human Resources
C R I T I C A L
T H I N K I N G
1. Identify training needs for a group of new
salespeople in a high-end jewelry store.
2. Why is evaluating training an important part
of strategic training?
3. Develop an orientation checklist based on one
first-day session and a second session of 4
hours each to cover 30-days later.
H R
E X P E R I E N T I A L
Due to rapid growth of your technology company,
the executive team has asked HR to develop an
internal training program. The purpose of the program is to help employees recently promoted to
supervisory positions develop the leadership skill
sets they need to be successful as supervisors. This
will be the first formal training program for your
small company. As part of the process, you want
to consider the learning styles of the new supervisors. To assist you in developing a successful,
A C T I V I T I E S
4. Make a briefing for division managers showing
the advantages and disadvantages of e-learning
and how to “blend” it with other teaching
techniques. Use websites, including
www.ASTD.org.
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
results-oriented program, review various training
websites, including www.agelesslearner.com.
1. To meet the needs of the varied learning styles
and maximize the learning potential of the
participants, what training techniques should
be implemented?
2. Identify the content topics that you will recommend be included in the program to ensure the
development of successful leaders.
C A S E
21st-Century Onboarding
New employees at Sun Microsystems begin their
orientation sessions after being hired with a computer game. It is part of an attempt to integrate
new people, improve the image of the company,
get feedback, and start training. Looking over the
shoulder of a new employee, one would see the
person playing a computer game called “Dawn of
the Shadow Spectors,” battling evil forces that are
trying to destroy Sun’s network.
Before Sun changed its orientation program, an
employee’s first day at work consisted mostly of
filling out paperwork, as in most companies. Some
new employees waited 2 weeks to get e-mail, and
people who worked remotely sometimes waited
weeks or months before meeting their managers.
The chief learning officer at Sun said, “We
wanted to make a better first impression,” unlike
that made on an employee’s first day if the
company/manager is not ready and the person just
sits there. That can make a bad impression that is
lasting. Now at Sun the onboarding starts as soon
as a person accepts a job. The new employee logs
on to the company’s new hire website and learns
about the company by playing video games. The
person sees a welcome video from the CEO and
connects with other employees via social networks. New employees also fill out their W-4s,
I-9s, and other paperwork on the website. Sun,
which has about 34,000 employees, believes orientation should start the moment a person is hired
and continue until the person is productive.
A Houston-based company, El Paso Corporation, which employs about 5,000, has a different
onboarding process. New hires attend a first-day
orientation and then another a month later. During
their first week at the company, they get an e-mail
with links to everything from ordering business
cards to joining the credit union. Before the new
system was instituted, employees sometimes waited
to even get a computer. One company official
noted that new employees “were here but just sitting around because they didn’t have the tools to
work.” Now they have a workspace, computer, and
network access on their first day.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 279
26/06/10 5:15 PM
280
SECTION 3
Training and Development
An advertising agency in Fort Lauderdale,
Florida, takes yet a different approach. Zimmerman
Advertising, which has about 1,000 employees,
wants employees to understand the company, so
new hires log on and learn from the new hire
website what the company does, its client philosophy, and about its leadership. Then they meet for
an hour with the CEO who talks about how he
built the company. New hires get a 30-, 60-, and
90-day training checklist that must be completed
on time and signed by their supervisor. They also
have an opportunity to provide feedback via the
website. Modern onboarding systems help new
employees understand what the company is all
about so they are prepared to integrate into it,
says Zimmerman’s Vice President of HR.70
QUESTIONS
1. The case introduces three companies of very
different sizes with three different onboarding
approaches. What differences do you see in
their approaches? What similarities?
2. Are there important ideas missing from all
three approaches? If so, what are they?
3. Which approach sounds best to you? Why?
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Training Crucial for Hotels
New Payroll Clerk
This case illustrates the increased role training is
playing in large U.S. hotel chains. (For the case,
go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
This case shows the frustration that often
accompanies the first day at work, and why
orientation is important in reducing turnover. (For
the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/
mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Based on Adrienne Fox,
“China: Land of Opportunity
and Challenge,” HR Magazine,
September 2007, 38–44; Z.A.S.
Udani, “International Briefing
21: Training and Development in
MACAO,” International Journal of
Training and Development, 12, No.
4 (2009), 280–296.
2. Herman Aquinis and Kurt
Kraiger, “Benefits of Training and
Development for Individuals and
Teams, Organizations and Society,”
Annual Review of Psychology, 60
(2009), 451–474.
3. Julie Bos, “Maximize Every Training
Dollar,” Workforce Management,
November 17, 2008, 39.
4. Gilad Chan and Richard Klimoski,
“Training and Development of
Human Resources at Work,” Human
Resource Management Review, 17
(2007), 180–190.
5. Michael Felton-O’Brien, “Taking the
Pulse,” Human Resource Executive,
November 19, 2007, 9.
6. James Hall and Marty Denis,
“Compensability of Job Related
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Training,” Workplace Management,
April 6, 2009, 10.
Charlotte Huff, “Training Adapts
to the Downturn,” Workforce
Management, March 16, 2009, 22.
“Tying Training and Development
to Competitive Strategy,” Workforce
Management, May 18, 2009, 53.
“Strategic Training and
Development,” SHRM Research
Quarterly, First Quarter 2008, 1–9.
Julie Bos, “Top Trends in Training
and Leadership Development,”
Workforce Management,
November 19, 2007, 36.
Phyllis Thaenou, et al., “A Review
and Critique of Research on Training
and Organizational Level Outcomes,”
Human Resource Management
Review, 17 (2007), 251–273.
Based on Beverly Propst, “Business
Education á la Carte,” HR
Magazine, October 2008, 52–54.
J. J. Smith, “U.S. Workers Tech
Skills Declined While India, Eastern
Europe Grew,” SHRM Global HR
News, September 2006,
www.shrm.org/global.
14. Paula Caligirvir and Saba Calakoglv,
“A Strategic Contingency Approach to
Expatriate Assignment Management,”
Human Resource Management
Journal, 17, 2007, 393–410.
15. Ann Tace, “Training for the Leap
Overseas,” T + D, August 2009, 18.
16. Andrea Edmundson, “Culturally
Accessible E-Learning,” T + D,
April 2009, 41–45.
17. Shedeh Tavakoli, et al., “Effects
of Assertiveness Training and
Expressive Writing on Acculturative
Stress in International Students,”
Journal of Counseling Psychology,
56 (2009), 590–596.
18. Stephan Miller, “Skills Critical
for a Changing Workforce,” HR
Magazine, August 2008, 24.
19. Jean Thilmany, “Passing on KnowHow,” HR Magazine, June 2008,
100–104.
20. Danielle D’Amour, “Knowledge
to Action: The Development of
Training Strategies,” Healthcare
Policy, 3, 2008, 68–79.
21. Alan M. Saks, et al., “Socialization
Tactics and Newcomer Adjustment,”
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 280
26/06/10 5:15 PM
CHAPTER 8
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
281
Training Human Resources
Journal of Vocational Behavior, 70,
2007, 413–446.
Bridget Testa, “Early Engagement
Long Relationship?” Workforce
Management, September 22,
2008, 27–31; Jerry Newman,
“The Undercover Secrets to
Successful Onboarding,” Workspan,
February 2009, 22–28.
Patricia D’Aurizio, “Onboarding:
Delivering on the Process,” Nursing
Economics, July–August 2007,
228–229; Fay Hansen, “Onboarding
for Greater Engagement,” Workforce
Management Online, October 2008,
www.workforce.com, 1–3.
Kathy Gurchiek, “Orientation
Programs Help New Hires Find
Bearings,” SHRM HR News,
May 25, 2007, www.shrm.org, 1–3.
D. J. Chhabra, “What Web-Based
Onboarding Can Do for Your
Company,” Workspan, May 2008,
111–114.
Louis Greenstein, “Beyond Day
One,” Human Resource Executive,
October 2, 2007, 1–26.
Bill Gilmyers and Amir Assadi,
“What Your New Hires Are Telling
You,” Workspan, July 2009, 30–38.
Pierre Gudjian and Oliver Triebel,
“Identifying Employee Skill Gaps,”
The McKinsey Quarterly, May 2009,
1–12.
Rita Zeidner, “One Workforce
Many Languages,” HR Magazine,
January 2009, 33–37.
Martha Frase, “An Underestimated
Talent Pool,” HR Magazine,
April 2009, 55–58.
Sara B. Kimmel and Mary N.
McNeese, “Barriers to Business
Education: Motivating Adult
Learners,” Journals of Behavioral and
Applied Management, 7 (2006), 292.
Malcolm S. Knowles, Elwood
F. Holton III, and Richard A.
Swanson, The Adult Learner, 6th ed.
(New York: Elsevier, 2005).
Lisa Burke and Holly Hutchins,
“Training Transfer: An Integrative
Literature Review,” Human Resource
Development Review, 6 (2007), 275.
John-Paul Hatala and Pamela Fleming,
“Making Transfer Climate Visible:
Utilizing Social Network Analysis
to Facilitate Transfer of Training,”
Human Resource Development
Review, 6 (2007), 33–62.
Simon Branbury, et al., “FASA:
Development and Validation of
a Novel Measure to Assess the
Effectiveness of Commercial Airline
Pilot Situation Awareness Training,”
36.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
46.
47.
48.
49.
50.
51.
52.
53.
54.
55.
International Journal of Aviation
Psychology, 17 (2007), 131–152.
Raquel Velada, et al., “The Effect
of Training Design, Individual
Characteristics and Work
Environment on Transfer of Training,”
International Journal of Training and
Development, 11 (2007), 282–294.
Burke and Hutchins, op. cit., 28.
Ibid., 281.
Ronald Jacobs and Yoonhee Park,
“A Proposed Conceptual Framework
of Workplace Learning,” Human
Resource Development Review, 8
(2009), 133–150.
Mark Partridge, “Copyrights and
Wrongs,” HR Magazine, November
2008, 101–104.
Jacobs and Park, op. cit., 140–141.
Kathryn Tyler, “15 Ways to Train on
the Job,” HR Magazine, September
2008, 105–108.
Maite Blazquez and Wiemer Salverda,
“Low Wage Employment and the
Role of Education and On-the-Job
Training,” EALE Annual Conference
(Amsterdam), September 2008, 1–27.
Jennifer Arnould, “Kicking Up
Cross-Training,” HR Magazine,
August 2008, 96–100.
Eylem Tekin, et al., “Pooling Strategies
for Call Center Agent Cross-Training,”
IEEE Transactions, 41, 2009, 546–561.
Frada Mozenter, et al., “Perspective
on Cross Training Public Service Staff
in the Electronic Age: I Have to Learn
to Do WHAT?” Journal of Academic
Librarianship, 29, 2008, 339–404.
“Cross Training Boosts Efficiency,”
CU 360, 35, July 27, 2009, 6–7.
Marianne Langlois, “Doing Learning
Right,” Workforce Management,
May 2008, 53.
Susan Ladika, “When Learning
Lasts a Lifetime,” HR Magazine,
May 2008, 57–60.
Beth Mirza, “Interns Experience the
Real World of HR,” HR Magazine,
September 2008, 144–145.
Julie Cook Ramirez, “Internal
Affairs,” Human Resource Executive,
November 19, 2007, 15–17.
Jeanne Meister, “Web Based
Corporate Learning Takes Off,”
Human Resource Executive,
November 17, 2007, 15–17.
American Society of Training and
Development, www.astd.org.
Sue Weekes, “May E-Learning
Pay and Play,” Training Magazine,
May 20, 2008, 1–2.
Bill Roberts, “Hard Facts About
Soft-Skills E-Learning,” HR
Magazine, January 2008, 76–78.
56. Jim Ware and Charlie Granthom,
“Is Video Conferencing Finally
about to Take Off?” Workspan,
December 2008, 18–20; Elizabeth
Agnvall, “Meetings Go Virtual,” HR
Magazine, January 2009, 74–78.
57. Sarah Fister Gale, “Do It Yourself
E-Learning,” Workforce Management
Online, May 2008, 1–2.
58. Elisabeth Bennett, “Virtual HRD:
The Intersection of Knowledge
Management, Culture, and Intranets,”
Advances in Developing Human
Resources, 11, 2009, 363–372.
59. Casper Star Tribune, October 4,
2009, F1B.
60. Sara Gale, “Virtual Training
with Real Results,” Workforce
Management, December 2008, 1–3;
“Let the Games Begin,” Workforce
Management, December 2008, 54.
61. Adrian Schwaninger, “Adaptive
Computer Based Training Increases
On-the-Job Performance of X-Ray
Screeners,” IEEF Xplore, 2007,
117–124.
62. Ed Frauenheim, “Your Coworker,
Your Teacher,” Workforce
Management, 86, No. 2, 2007, 19–23.
63. Ji-Hye Park, “Factors Associated
with Transfer of Training in
Workplace E-Learning,” Journal of
Workplace Learning, 19 (2007),
311–329.
64. Laura Aionso Diaz and Florentino
Entonado, “Are the Functions
of E-Learning and Face-to-Face
Environments Really Different?”
Educational Technology and Society,
12, 2009, 331–343.
65. Kurt Kraiger, “Transforming Our
Models of Learning and Development:
Web Based Instruction as Enabler
of Third Generation Instruction,”
Industrial and Organizational
Psychology, 1, 2008, 454–467.
66. Joe Ruff, “Helping Firms Measure
Worker Training Results,” Omaha
World Herald, January 21, 2008.
67. Katharine Shobe and Barbara Curtis,
“Training Assessment Challenges
in a Military Environment: A U.S.
Navy Example,” Performance
Improvement, March 2007, 42–46.
68. Yiching Chen, “Learning to Learn:
The Impact of Strategy Training,”
ELT Journal, January 2007, 20–28.
69. “Calculate the Cost and Benefits of
Training,” Workforce Management,
2007, www.workforce.com.
70. Leslie Klaff, “New Emphasis on
First Impressions,” Workforce
Management Online, March 2008,
www.workforce.com, 1–3.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 281
26/06/10 5:15 PM
C H A P T E R
9
Talent Management
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Identify the importance of talent management
and discuss two reasons it may be difficult.
•
Explain what succession planning is and its steps.
•
Differentiate between organization-centered
and individual-centered career planning.
•
Discuss three career issues that organizations
and employees must address.
•
List options for development needs analyses.
•
Identify several management development methods.
282
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 282
26/06/10 5:17 PM
HR Headline
How Top Companies Develop Stars
(© McDonald’s Corporation)
T he CEO at American Express says,
“Most companies maintain their office
copiers better than they build the capabilities of their people.” But the world is
changing and many companies are being
forced to change as well. An examination
of companies reveals that some of the
best at managing talent include American
Express, General Electric, McDonald’s,
and Eli Lily. These so-called “Academy
Companies” offer more training to their executives, and their alumni
become leaders at other firms.
American Express has built a rigorous leadership development program with metrics, incentives, goals, values, and calendars. But the biggest investment in leadership for these businesses is the time spent by
the CEO and other executives. McDonald’s CEO personally reviews the
development of the company’s top 200 managers. At GE, the CEO reviews
the top 600. As the CEO’s subordinates see the importance the boss puts
on development, they too spend time developing their subordinates. The
result is a cascading emphasis on talent management. Indeed, at American
Express 25% of a manager’s bonus is tied to talent development.
GE requires new hires to intern at least one summer before hiring, and
evaluation of their potential begins then. At Eli Lilly about two-thirds of
development comes from job experience, one-third from mentoring and
coaching, and a small bit from the classroom. Eli Lilly is also trying to deal
with the problems associated with rotational assignments; the company
is trying short-term additional work assignments where managers do
not leave their jobs, but take on a project outside their field to aid
development.
The companies on the “Academies” list are also passionate about providing candidate performance feedback along with mentoring and support. Certainly that is not always the case in many organizations, but how
can you improve if you don’t know how well you have done? Without
feedback, managers stop caring.1
283
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 283
26/06/10 5:17 PM
284
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Workforce planning is concerned with having the correct number of employees in the organization as they are needed. Talent management focuses on
having the right individuals ready for the jobs when needed, and a pipeline
full of talented people who are being developed for future organizational
needs. The focus in talent management is on key positions, key job families,
skills that will be needed, competency models, talent pools, and assessments
for employees.
The need for talent management is brought on by a demographic landscape dominated by the impending retirement of experienced baby boomers,
a shortage of young people entering the workforce in western Europe and
a decline in the 35–44 age group in the United States.2 Issues are further
complicated by the number of high school graduates who lack writing and
verbal communication skills, as well as a work ethic, and the number of college graduates who are weak in writing, leadership, critical thinking, and creativity skills.3 Where will the successful workforce of the future come from?
Additionally, problems with talent management programs seem to be common.4 Research shows that a high percentage of companies are not prepared
for a sudden loss of leadership, and most managers and executives are not held
accountable for developing their direct reports.5
The levels of an organization most likely to be included in a talent management program are the executive and director levels, followed by CEOs and
Vice Presidents.6
TALENT MANAGEMENT IN PERSPECTIVE
The idea that human capital can be a source of competitive advantage for
some organizations is gaining ground, but most organizations are not designed
or managed to optimize talent performance.7 Choices for dealing successfully
with talent needs are to: (1) emphasize stability in employment and develop
talent internally, (2) develop agility as an organization and buy talent as
needed, or (3) use some combination of 1 and 2. So the nature of the business
and the environment in which it operates to some extent define appropriate
strategies for talent management.
Talent management has other characteristics that make it challenging as
well. A major one is the nature of “talent” or people. For example, a “deep
bench” of talent can be thought of as inventory. But unlike boxes full of empty
bottles, talent does not always stay on the shelf until needed—it walks out
the door for better opportunities.8 The shelf life of promising managers and
specialists is short if they do not have opportunities where they are currently.
Further, job candidates indicate that they are most attracted to opportunities
to learn and grow. In fact, career development ranks higher than work-life
balance and compensation/benefits for most job seekers.9 This makes the need
for a successful talent management program even greater.
Managing talent in global organizations is complex because movement of
managers between countries is limited. Global leadership is especially challenging,
as HR processes in different countries are often very different, and employees
often expect to be demoted if they return to their home location.10 Global talent
management is an even greater challenge than domestic talent management.
One way to think of talent management is as a process that moves people
from recruiting and selection to meeting the need of the organization for
talent. Along the way, all the elements of talent management are encountered:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 284
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
285
Talent Management
Talent Management
FIGURE 9-1
ACQUISITION
STEPS
RESULTS
Recruiting
Training
Management talent
Selection
Career planning
Succession planning
Key job talent
Retention
Development
Performance
management
training, succession planning, career planning, development, and performance
management. Figure 9-1 shows the idea. Training and performance management
are covered in other chapters but succession planning, career planning, and
development are covered in this chapter.
Talent Management “Systems”
Talent management seems to lend itself to the use of various software-based systems that purport to integrate all the pieces of talent management into one manageable whole. For example, one company used a talent management system in:
•
•
•
•
•
Documenting new employee orientations and the onboarding training,
regardless of how and where it was done.
Tracking classroom training and certifications completed by all store
employees.
Automating registration of participants for training and development
activities.
Reporting on completions of training certifications for store employees.
Compiling and reporting the training and development history of
individuals for use with career planning and development.
However, according to one survey, although many companies are planning to
use talent management technology, about half still use a manual approach.11
One reason for the demand for automated talent management systems is
the situation that arose during the last recession. Many talented people were
cut from the workforce, and some companies cut more of them than was
necessary. Some employers view information from automation as a way to
avoid this problem in the future.12 As an example of the potential in these
automated systems, Comcast Corporation can run a search across the entire
organization to find people with certain qualifications who are strong in
specific skills. If a person is needed for a business development position with
strong customer communication and strategic skills, a search of the system will
locate a dozen people in the company with excellent performance reviews in
those areas during the last year.13
The drive to automate talent management also comes in part from the
desire to pull together HR, finance, and operations data to get insights on
talent that are otherwise difficult to obtain. Whether current systems do this
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 285
26/06/10 5:17 PM
286
SECTION 3
Training and Development
in a way that deals with the key issues is still unclear. A study found that
almost half of the companies using automated talent management systems had
trouble getting employees and managers to use them. Speculation on why this
is so centered on the idea that managers “don’t like to use computers to manage people.”14 However, regardless of the current state of the art, the potential
for automated talent management systems in the future is great as a tool to aid
decision making, but not the whole solution.
Scope of Talent Management
As talent management has evolved, a variety of approaches and tools have
come along. The HR perspective discusses some groundbreaking talent management programs.
Groundbreaking Talent
Management Programs
How do you develop good managers? Several companies try to grow talent internally by hiring people
they view as “high potentials” right out of college
and developing them. For example, a program at
Lehn and Fink Products (maker of Lysol) is designed
to develop general managers from college recruits by
using predictors of leadership through extracurricular
activities, especially athletics, rather than grades. New
recruits begin in low-level jobs and are moved every
6 months.
Curtis Lighting in Chicago rotates new college
graduates through each of the 10 departments in the
company while they take a program of 100 modular
classes led by department heads. Public Service
Company of Northern Illinois has a high-potential
program to identify employees with aptitude for senior
management positions. The program is open to every
employee; criteria for selection are performance on the
job and evidence of leadership behavior.
General Electric uses peer feedback. After classroom
training and 3-month rotational assignments, newly
hired candidates get formal peer feedback in an
attempt to grow emotional intelligence skills. Another
company uses assessment testing of IQ, vocational
interest, aptitude, and vocabulary along with structured
interviews to select management trainees.
The McCormick Company has created a “junior
board of directors.” Young executives consider the same
HR perspective
problems the board of directors is considering and then
make presentations to the real board. The U.S. Army
has used forced-ranking systems to identify enlisted
personnel who should be promoted to officers. The
Navy has used 360-degree feedback systems on performance to identify pilots with the abilities to advance in
training. Assessment centers were first used by the CIA
and later by industry. Executive coaching, succession
planning, rotational development, and assessments of
managerial potential all have been widely used.
The talent management programs mentioned above
are from 60 to 85 years old. They were well established
by the 1950s, gone by the 1990s, and are reappearing
in the early part of the twenty-first century as “new”
and “novel” approaches to talent management. What
happened?
The 1950s practices of long-term planning, succession planning, and management development were
based on the assumptions that companies could predict
personnel needs a decade in advance and that the talent
in their pipelines would stay there. These pipelines
turned out more talent than was needed, and when
the 1981 recession hit, the development apparatus
was dismantled. When the economy recovered, there
was plenty of talent on the market to be hired. That
surplus was gone by the end of the 1990s, and most
organizations today again want an alternative to simply
hiring their talent from outside.15
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 286
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
287
Target Jobs The first issue is to identify the types of jobs that will be the
focus of talent management efforts. In some organizations, talent management focuses on the CEO and other executive jobs, rather than more
broadly. Other organizations target senior management jobs, mid-level
managers, and other key jobs. However, those groups only represent about
one-third of the total workforce, which raises the question of whether talent management efforts would be more useful if they were more widely
implemented.
High-Potential Individuals Some organizations focus talent management
efforts primarily on “high-potential” individuals, often referred to as
“high-pos.” Attracting, retaining, and developing high-pos have become the
emphases for some talent management efforts. Some firms classify individuals as being in the top 10% and then set limits on the number of people who
can participate in intensive talent management efforts. Other organizations
view talent management more broadly. Targeting primarily high-pos may lead
to many other employees seeing their career opportunities as being limited.
Thus, talent management may need to include more than the top 10% in
some cases.
Competency Models What does a person who is ready to be moved up
look like? What competencies should the person have? Competency models
show knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) for various jobs. An employer
must ask, what talent do we need to achieve this? The answer can be found
in a competency model. Competency models help to identify talent gaps.
Some companies maintain libraries of competency models. One has more
than 900 such models.16 These libraries create a clear path for talent planning.
Competency models might be created for executives, managers, supervisors,
salespeople, technical professionals, and others.
Talent Pools Talent pools are a way to reduce the risk that the company may
not need a certain specialty after developing it. The idea is to avoid developing
for a narrow specialized job and instead develop a group or pool of talented
people with broad general competencies that could fit a wide range of jobs.
Once developed, they can be allocated to specific vacancies. Just-in-time
training and coaching can make the fit work.17
Career Tracks Career tracks include a series of steps that one follows to
become ready to move up. For example, a potential branch manager in a bank
might take rotational assignments in customer sales, teller supervisor, credit
cards, and other positions before being considered ready to handle the branch
manager’s job.
Assessment Assessment most often involves tests of one sort or another. Tests
for IQ, personality, aptitude, and other factors are used. A portfolio of tests
to help predict a person’s potential for a job is called an “assessment center,”
which will be discussed in more detail later.
Development Risk Sharing The employer always runs the risk in developing talent that an employee who has been developed will leave with the valuable skills gained through development. An alternative to this risk is to have
promising employees volunteer for development on their own time. Executive
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 287
26/06/10 5:17 PM
288
SECTION 3
Training and Development
LOGGING ON
Taleo Corporation
For a research library on talent
management resources, including
articles and interactive tools, visit the
Taleo website at www.taleo.com/
resources/research.
MBA programs that can be attended on evenings or weekends, extra projects outside a person’s current assignment,
volunteer projects with nonprofit organizations, and other
paths can be used. The employer might contribute through
tuition reimbursement or some selected time away from the
job, but the risk is at least partly shared by the employee.
The rest of this chapter deals with the major elements of
talent management in more detail: succession planning,
careers, and development.
SUCCESSION PLANNING
The basis for dealing successfully with staffing surprises is succession planning. When a sudden loss of a manager occurs, the void is a serious problem.18
At that point it is too late to begin to develop a replacement. “Bench strength”
and the leadership “pipeline” are metaphors for ways to prevent the void by
having replacements ready.
However, succession planning involves more than simply replacement
planning. Replacement planning usually develops a list of replacements for
given positions. Succession planning must include a well-designed employee
development system to reach its potential. Succession planning is the process
of identifying a plan for the orderly replacement of key employees.
Succession Planning Process
Whether in small or large firms, succession planning is linked to strategic planning through the process shown in Figure 9-2. The process consists of first
defining positions that are critical to the strategy,19 and then making certain
top management is involved personally with mentoring, coaching, and talent
identification. It may be appropriate to tie some level of reward to executive
success in the process. The next step is to assess the talent available in the
organization and determine which have the potential, which are ready now
for promotion, and which need additional development. The development
practices can vary but should be aimed at specific needs in specific individuals. Finally, evaluating the success of the process is important, and appropriate
measures are necessary to do so.20
All the work involved in the succession planning process should result
in two products: (1) identification of potential emergency replacements for
critical positions and (2) other successors who will be ready with some additional development. The development necessary should be made clear to the
people involved, along with a plan for getting the development.21
Role of HR in Succession Planning Often HR has the primary responsibility for succession planning organization-wide. However, for CEO and
senior management succession efforts, top executives and board members
often have major involvement. In this case, HR commonly performs the
following actions:
•
•
•
Identifying development needs of the workforce
Assisting executives/managers in identifying needed future job skills
Participating in identifying employees who might fill future positions
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 288
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
289
Talent Management
FIGURE 9-2
Succession Planning Process
INTEGRATE WITH STRATEGY
What competencies will be needed?
Which jobs will be critical?
How should critical positions be filled?
Will international assignments be needed?
INVOLVE TOP MANAGEMENT
Is CEO personally involved?
Are top executives mentoring/coaching?
Are there authority and accountability for succession goals?
ASSESS KEY TALENT
Does this person have the competencies?
What competencies are missing?
Are assessments/performance evaluations/etc. valid?
Is a results orientation used to identify high positions?
Are individuals and career goals/interests compatible?
FOLLOW DEVELOPMENT PRACTICES
How can missing competencies be developed?
Are there opportunities for those in higher positions to
interact with executives/board members?
Can talent pools be created for job pools?
What are the rewards to subordinate development?
Are high position/successors to be told?
MONITOR/EVALUATE
Are multiple metrics used?
Are positions filled internally?
Is the process viewed favorably?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 289
26/06/10 5:17 PM
290
SECTION 3
Training and Development
•
•
G L O B A L
Communicating succession planning process to employees
Aiding in tracing and regularly updating succession plan efforts
Global Succession Planning Succession planning is not just a U.S. issue. In
fact, the percentage of the aging population in the workforce is even higher in
countries such as Japan, Germany, Italy, and England. In those countries, as
well as the United States, the growth of immigrants has added to the population, which also means that employers are facing both legal and workforce
diversity issues. Even in countries with growing native workforces, such as
China and India, succession planning is important. Having younger workers
who can replace senior managers with international experiences and contacts
is a growing concern faced worldwide by employers of different sizes and
industries.22
Succession in Small and Closely Held Organizations Succession planning can be especially important in small and medium-sized firms, but few
of these firms formalize succession plans. In fact, the lack of succession
planning is frequently viewed as the biggest threat facing small businesses.
In closely held family firms (those that are not publicly traded on stock
exchanges), multiple family members may be involved. But in others, the
third- and fourth-generation family members are not employees and many do
not want to be involved, other than as owners or as members of the board
of directors.23
Even if many CEOs plan to pass the business leadership on to a family
member, most of these firms would benefit from planning for orderly succession, particularly if nonfamily members or owners are involved. Addressing
the development needs of the successor also helps to avoid a host of potential
problems for both the organization and family-member relationships.
Succession Planning Decisions
A number of decision areas should be considered as part of succession planning. Coming to the answer stage on these decisions takes analysis, as the best
answer varies depending on the situation.
“Make” or “Buy” Talent? Employers face a “make-or-buy” choice: develop
(“make”) competitive human resources, or hire (“buy”) them already developed from somewhere else. Many organizations show an apparent preference
for buying rather than making scarce employees in today’s labor market.
Current trends indicate that technical and professional people usually are
“bought” because of the amount of skill development already achieved, rather
than internal individuals being picked because of their ability to learn or their
behavioral traits. However, hiring rather than developing internal human
resource capabilities may not fit certain environments, and puts the responsibility for development on the employee.
Other organizations are focusing on growing their own leaders.24 Like any
financial decision, the make-or-buy decision can be quantified and calculated
when some assumptions are made about time costs, availability, and quality.
Potential versus Performance Another focus of succession planning is
shown in Figure 9-3. Note that when developing succession plans for jobs
and identifying candidates, focusing only on potential may be too narrow.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 290
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
291
Talent Management
Assessing Potential and Current Performance
FIGURE 9-3
High
Strong Potential
Does not meet
performance expectations
Action: Coaching/
development/job change?
P
o
t
e
n
t
i
a
l
High Potential
High performance
Action: Accelerated stretch
assignments?
Potential for Lateral Move
Meeting performance
expectations
Action: Additional
motivation?
w
Low
Low
No Potential to Advance
Poor performance
Has Reached Potential
Exceeds expectations
on performance
Action: Dismiss?
Action: Retain and reward?
Performance
High
The competency model for a job might be much more complex. For example,
assume that succession planning for a Vice President of Operations at a hospital is being done. That position needs candidates who have industry contacts,
community involvement, leadership and management capabilities, and other
competencies. These items are especially important if the current VP has
extensive experience and outstanding performance. To combine potential and
performance, a two-dimensional graph like the one shown in Figure 9-3 can
be used.
M E A S U R E
Metrics and Succession Planning Some organizations measure the impact
of succession planning. A wide range of metrics are used depending on the
company plans. The proper metric should be picked early on in the succession
decision process. One key measure is identifying the reduced costs of turnover,
which is related to employee retention. For instance, in a mid-sized bank,
turnover of “high-potential” employees declined significantly after conducting
an organization-wide succession plan. Estimates of the turnover savings were
done by the HR Director, and the median per key employee “saved” was more
than $15,000 per person.
Another factor to consider is how succession planning and its follow-up
may lead to higher performance and organizational profitability. Organizations
such as Apple Computers, General Electric, Merck, Hewlett-Packard, Motorola,
Verizon, and other companies use benchmark and quantitative measures to
show that succession planning provides significant financial returns.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 291
26/06/10 5:17 PM
292
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Other common useful metrics are:25
•
•
•
Percentage of key vacancies filled internally
Job performance of promoted successors
Bench strength breadth and depth
Computerized Succession Planning Models The expansion of information technology capabilities has resulted in employers being able to have succession planning components available electronically to staff members. Skills
tracking systems, performance appraisals, and other databases can be linked to
succession plans. As employees complete training and development activities,
their data can be updated and viewed as career openings occur in the company.
Via intranet systems, employees can access and update
LOGGING ON
their databases, review job and career opportunities, and
complete skill and career interest self-surveys and numerBusiness & Decision
ous other items. Another aid in leadership development is
This website provides an overview of
succession planning. Visit the site at
360-degree reviews of managers by others.26 One such system
www.businessdecision.com.
creates a grid that links employee performance ratings and
results to potential career movements.
Benefits of Formal Succession Planning
Employers are doing succession planning formally and informally. As companies become larger, the benefits of formal succession planning become greater.
For larger companies, formal planning is recommended. Even government organizations can benefit from formal succession planning.27 Key benefits include:
•
•
•
•
Having a supply of talented employees to fill future key openings
Providing career paths and plans for employees, which aids in employee
retention and performance motivation
Continually reviewing the need for individuals as organizational changes
occur more frequently
Enhancing the organizational “brand” and reputation of the company as
a desirable place to work
Common Succession Planning Mistakes CEO succession should be a
focus of the boards of directors. One reason why boards have increased the
priority of CEO succession is the Sarbanes–Oxley Act provisions that have
added more demands that boards do CEO succession planning.
But focusing only on CEO and top management succession is one of the
most common mistakes made. Other mistakes include:
•
•
•
•
Starting too late, when openings are already occurring
Not linking well to strategic plans
Allowing the CEO to direct the planning and make all succession decisions
Looking only internally for succession candidates
All of these mistakes are indicative of poor succession planning.28
An example of the importance of succession planning is seen in the banking industry. Regulatory provisions and auditors are requiring banks to have
succession plans identified for top management jobs. Also, law firms are recognizing the importance of succession planning as more senior partners retire.
Longer-term succession planning should include mid-level and lower-level
managers, as well as other key nonmanagement employees. Some firms target
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 292
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
293
key technical, professional, and sales employees as part of succession planning.
Others include customer service representatives, warehouse specialists, and
additional hourly employees who may be able to move up into other jobs or
departments.
Succession planning is an important part of employers doing talent management well. Actions such as career planning and development efforts follow
from succession planning efforts.
CAREERS AND CAREER PLANNING
A career is the series of work-related positions a person occupies throughout life. People pursue careers to satisfy their individual needs. Careers are
an important part of talent management, but individuals and organizations
view careers in distinctly different ways.29 Changes in employer approaches
to planning for replacement managers based upon a less predictable business
environment have put much of the responsibility for a career on the shoulders
of individual employees.
However, companies have found that the lack of a career development plan
leaves them vulnerable to turnover, and hiring from outside can have drawbacks.30 When a company attempts to manage careers internally, there may be
a typical career path that is identified for employees. Despite major investments
by employers over the last decade to improve company-sponsored career
planning, a high percentage (41%) of managers surveyed felt the employer’s
approach to career development failed to meet their personal needs.31
Changing Nature of Careers
The old model of a career in which a person worked up the ladder in one
organization is becoming rarer in reality. Indeed, in a few industries, changing
jobs and companies every few years is becoming more common. Many U.S.
workers in high-demand jobs, such as information technologists and pharmacists, dictate their own circumstances to some extent. For instance, the average
30- to 35-year-old in the United States may have already worked for up to
seven different firms. Physicians, teachers, economists, and electricians do not
change jobs as frequently. However, as would be expected, even in some of
these professions valuable employees who are given offers to switch jobs do
so at a higher rate than in the past.
Different Views of Careers Various signs indicate that the patterns of
individuals’ work lives are changing in many areas: more freelancing, more
working at home, more frequent job changes, and more job opportunities but
less security. Rather than letting jobs define their lives, more people set goals
for the type of lives they want and then use jobs to meet those goals. However,
for dual-career couples and working women, balancing work demands with
personal and family responsibilities is difficult to do.
Labels for different views of careers include the following:
•
Career Series of work-related
positions a person occupies
throughout life.
•
Protean career: assumes individuals will drive their careers and define
goals to fit their life
Career without boundaries: views a manager as having many possible
trajectories for a career, and many are across organizational boundaries
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 293
26/06/10 5:17 PM
294
SECTION 3
Training and Development
•
•
Portfolio career: careers are built around a collection of skills and
interests and are self-managed
Authentic career: people achieve a high level of personal insight and use
this to follow a “true-to-self” career
All these different views of careers have merit for different individuals, but
they all show that an organization-centered career planning effort will have to
consider the unique needs of the individual employee.
Organization-Centered Career Planning
Organization-centered
career planning Career
planning that focuses on
identifying career paths
that provide for the logical
progression of people between
jobs in an organization.
FIGURE 9-4
Careers are different than they were in the past, and managing them puts a
premium on career development by both employers and employees. Effective
career planning considers both organization-centered and individual-centered
perspectives. Figure 9-4 summarizes the perspectives and interaction between
the organizational and individual approaches to career planning.
Organization-centered career planning frequently focuses on identifying
career paths that provide for the logical progression of people between jobs
in an organization. Individuals follow these paths as they advance in organizational units. For example, the right person might enter the sales department
as a sales representative, then be promoted to account director, to district sales
manager, and finally to vice president of sales.
A good career planning program includes the elements of talent management, performance appraisal, development activities, opportunities for transfer
and promotion, and planning for succession. To communicate with employees
about opportunities and to help with planning, employers frequently use
career workshops, a career “center” or newsletter, and career counseling.
Individual managers often play the role of coach and counselor in their
direct contact with individual employees and within an HR-designed career
management system.
The systems that an employer uses should be planned and managed to guide
managers in developing employees’ careers.32 One such system is the career
path, or “map,” which is created and shared with the individual employee.
Organizational and Individual Career Planning Perspectives
INDIVIDUAL PERSPECTIVE
ORGANIZATIONAL PERSPECTIVE
Identify future organizational
staffing needs
Plan career ladders
Assess individual potential
and training needs
Match organizational needs
to individual abilities
Develop and audit a career
system for the organization
A PERSON’S
CAREER
Identify personal abilities
and interests
Plan life and work goals
Assess alternative paths
inside and outside the
organization
Note changes in interests
and goals as career and life
stage change
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 294
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
295
Career Paths Employees need to know their strengths and weakness, and
they often discover those through company-sponsored assessments. Then,
career paths to develop the weak areas and fine-tune the strengths are developed. For example, Ed Santry, VP of HR in Pittsburgh for Nisource Inc.,
had three good candidates for a position. The outside candidate had more
experience and was hired. But after the decision, Ed had a discussion with the
internal candidates. He presented ideas for them to work on over the next few
years to improve their chances of getting one of the positions later.33
Career paths represent employees’ movements through opportunities over
time. Although most career paths are thought of as leading upward, good
opportunities also exist in cross-functional or horizontal directions.
Working with employees to develop career paths has aided employers in
retaining key employees. At a call center, use of a career path program has led
to greater retention of entry-level call center employees. Career progression
opportunities are identified to employees who perform well and who see the
company as a place to stay and grow a career.
Employer Websites and Career Planning Many employers have careers
sections on their websites. Such sections can be used to list open jobs for
current employees looking to change jobs. An employer’s website is a link
to the external world, but should also be seen as a link to existing employee
development. Sites also can be used for career assessment, information, and
instruction. When designing websites, firms should consider the usefulness of
the careers section for development as well as recruitment.
Accommodating Individual Career Needs As noted earlier, not everyone
views a career the same way. Further, the way people view their careers
depends upon the stage of the career. Some research suggests that if employers expect employees to invest more of their personal resources of time and
effort in career self-management, they may find it causes conflict with efforts
to balance work and life off the job. Most people cannot both invest great
amounts of time beyond their job in career management and have a satisfactory work-life balance as well.34 This seems especially true for younger
employees.
Permitting telecommuting for fast-track employees unwilling to relocate is
a way to keep talent in the succession pipeline by accommodating individual
needs. Such flexibility is often the difference between continuing a career at a
firm and moving on. For example, the CEO of a multimillion dollar business
in the Midwest lived primarily in Atlanta. He would live in the Midwestern
town for two weeks at a time and return to Atlanta every other weekend, thus
telecommuting.35
Career paths Represent
employees’ movements
through opportunities over
time.
Individual-centered
career planning Career
planning that focuses on an
individual’s responsibility
for a career rather than on
organizational needs.
Individual-Centered Career Planning
Organizational changes have altered career plans for many people. Individuals
have had to face “career transitions”— in other words they have had to find new
jobs. These transitions have identified the importance of individual-centered
career planning, which focuses on an individual’s responsibility for a career
rather than on organizational needs.
Individual Actions for Career Planning For individuals to successfully
manage their own careers, they should be able to perform several activities.
Three key ones are as follows:
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 295
26/06/10 5:17 PM
296
SECTION 3
Training and Development
•
•
•
Self-assessment: Individuals need to think about what interests them,
what they do not like, what they do well, and their strengths and
weaknesses. Career advisors use a number of tools to help people
understand themselves. Common professional tests include the
Strong Interest Inventory to determine preferences among vocational
occupations, and the Allport-Vernon-Lindzey Study of Values to identify
a person’s dominant values.
Feedback on reality: Employees need feedback on how well they are doing,
how their bosses see their capabilities, and where they fit in organizational
plans for the future. One source of this information is through
performance appraisal feedback and career development discussions.
Setting of career goals: Deciding on a desired path, setting some
timetables, and writing down these items all set the stage for a person to
pursue the career of choice. These career goals are supported by shortterm plans for the individual to get the experience or training necessary
to move forward toward the goals.36
Individual Career Choices Four general individual characteristics affect
how people make career choices:
•
•
•
•
Interests: People tend to pursue careers that they believe match their
interests. But over time, interests change for many people, and career
decisions eventually are made based on special skills, abilities, and career
paths that are realistic for the individual.
Self-image: A career is an extension of a person’s self-image, as well as a
molder of it. People follow careers they can “see” themselves in and avoid
those that do not fit with their perceptions of their talents, motives, and
values.
Personality: An employee’s personality includes that individual’s personal
orientation (e.g., inclination to be realistic, enterprising, or artistic) and
personal needs (including affiliation, power, and achievement needs).
Individuals with certain personality types gravitate to different clusters of
occupations.
Social backgrounds: Socioeconomic status and the educational levels and
occupations of a person’s parents are included in an individual’s social
background. Children of a physician or a welder know from a parent
what that job is like and may either seek or reject it based on how they
view the parent’s job.
Less is known about how and why people choose specific organizations than about why they choose specific careers. One obvious factor
is timing—the availability of a job when the person is
LOGGING ON
looking for work. The amount of information available
Career Planning
about alternatives is an important factor as well. Beyond
This website is a resource for indivithese issues, people seem to pick an organization on the
dual career planning. Visit the site at
basis of a “fit” of the climate of the organization as they
www.careerplanning.org.
view it and their own personal characteristics, interests,
and needs.
Career Progression Considerations
The typical career for individuals today includes more positions, transitions,
and organizations—more so than in the past, when employees were less
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 296
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
297
Talent Management
mobile and organizations were more stable as long-term employers. But there
are general patterns in people’s lives that affect their careers.
Theorists in adult development describe the first half of life as the young
adult’s quest for competence and for a way to make a mark in the world.
According to this view, a person attains happiness during this time primarily
through achievement and the acquisition of capabilities.
The second half of life is different. Once the adult starts to measure time from
the expected end of life rather than from the beginning, the need for competence
and acquisition changes to the need for integrity, values, and well-being. For
many people, internal values take precedence over external scorecards or accomplishments such as wealth and job title status. In addition, mature adults already
possess certain skills, so their focus may shift to interests other than skills acquisition. Career-ending concerns, such as life after retirement, reflect additional
shifts. Figure 9-5 shows a model that identifies general career and life periods.
Contained within this life pattern is the idea that careers and lives are not
predictably linear but cyclical. Individuals experience periods of high stability
followed by transition periods of less stability, and by inevitable discoveries,
disappointments, and triumphs. These cycles of structure and transition occur
throughout individuals’ lives and careers. This cyclical view may be an especially
useful perspective for individuals affected by downsizing or early career plateaus
in large organizations. Such a perspective argues for the importance of flexibility
in an individual’s career. It also emphasizes the importance of individuals’ continuing to acquire more and diverse knowledge, skills, and abilities.
Early Career Issues Early career needs include finding interests, developing
capabilities, and exploring jobs. Some organizations do a better job than others
of providing those opportunities. Work-at-home programs, mentoring, performance bonuses, time with top executives, extensive training, hiring interns,
reimbursement for more education, and rich 401(K) plans are some of the things
employers are doing to make jobs more attractive for early career employees.37
Early career for many young people is characterized by little individual
career planning, which leads to careers that seem to be at the mercy of various
sources and out of their control. Proactiveness decreases the likelihood of
sitting back and letting someone (or something) else manage a career. Early
FIGURE 9-5
General Career Periods
CAREER STAGE
AGE
Characteristics
Age group
Early Career
Mid-Career
Late Career
Career End
20 years (ⴙ/ⴚ )
30–40 years
50 years (ⴙ/ⴚ )
60–70 years
Needs
Identifying interests,
exploring several
jobs
Advancing in career;
lifestyle may limit
options, growth,
opportunities
Updating skills; individual
is settled in; individual is a
leader whose opinions are
valued
Planning for
retirement, examining
nonwork interests
Concerns
External rewards,
acquiring more
capabilities
Values, contribution,
integrity, well-being
Mentoring, disengaging,
organizational
continuance
Retirement, part-time
employment
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 297
26/06/10 5:17 PM
298
SECTION 3
Training and Development
career people want more career planning but are not certain how to do it.38
Planning early in a career may increase employability.39
Career Plateaus Those who do not change jobs may face another problem:
career plateaus. Many workers define career success in terms of upward mobility. As the opportunities to move up decrease, some employers try to convince
employees they can find job satisfaction in lateral movement. Such moves can
be reasonable if employees learn new skills that increase individual marketability in case of future layoffs, termination, or organizational restructurings.
One strategy for individuals to get off career plateaus is to take seminars and university courses. This approach may reveal new opportunities
for plateaued employees. Rotating workers to other departments is another
way to deal with career plateaus. A computer chip manufacturer instituted a
formal “poaching” program that encouraged managers to recruit employees
from other departments, thereby giving employees greater opportunities to
experience new challenges without having to leave the employer. Some plateaued individuals change careers and go into other lines of work altogether.
Figure 9-6 shows a “portable” career path that one might encounter under
those career situations. In summary, plateaued employees present a particular challenge for employers. They can affect morale if they become negative,
but they may also represent valuable resources that are not being well used.
Career Transitions
Career transitions can be stressful for individuals who change employers and
jobs. Three career transitions are of special interest to HR: organizational
entry and socialization, job loss, and retirement.40
Entry Career and Job Loss Starting as a new employee can be overwhelming. “Entry shock” is especially difficult for younger new hires who find the
work world very different from school.41 Entry shock includes the following
concerns:
•
•
FIGURE 9-6
Supervisors: The boss–employee relationship is different from the
student–teacher relationship.
Feedback: In school, feedback is frequent and measurable, but that is not
true of most jobs.
Portable Career Path
Beginning
Expanding
Changing
Sustaining
Concluding
Spend several
years at large
company to
learn skills
and build
network
Use
networking to
develop
broader skills
and make
contacts;
establish
good
reputation
Change
industries, or
go to work for
smaller
companies;
start a
company
Refresh skills;
take a
sabbatical; go
back to school;
gain experience
in nonprofit
organizations
Move to
projects as a
temporary
employee or
subcontractor
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 298
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
•
•
299
Time: School has short (quarter/semester) time cycles, whereas time
horizons are longer at work.
The work: Problems are more tightly defined at school; at work, the
logistical and political aspects of solving problems are less certain.
Job loss as a career transition has been most associated with downsizing,
mergers, and acquisitions. Losing a job is a stressful event in one’s career,
frequently causing depression, anxiety, and nervousness. The financial implications and the effects on family can be extreme as well. Yet the potential for job
loss continues to increase for many individuals, and effectively addressing their
concerns should be considered in career transition decision making.
Retirement Issues Whether retirement comes at age 50 or age 70, it can
require a major adjustment for many people. Some areas of adjustment faced
by many retirees include self-direction, a need to belong, sources of achievement, personal space, and goals. To help address concerns over these issues, as
well as anxieties about finances, some employers offer preretirement planning
seminars for employees.
Companies in the United States will face a severe shortage of badly needed
skills in the coming decade unless they act now to convince top-performing
older employees to delay or phase in their retirement.42 Career development
for people toward the ends of their careers may be managed in a number of
ways. Phased-in retirement, consulting arrangements, and callback of some
retirees as needed all act as means for gradual disengagement between the
organization and the individual. However, phased-in retirement (which is
widely seen as a good situation for all involved) faces major obstacles in current pension laws. Under many pension plans, employees who are working
may not receive pension benefits until they reach a normal retirement age.43
Early retirement often occurs as a result of downsizings and organizational
restructurings. These events have required thousands of individuals, including
many managers and professionals, to determine what is important to them
while still active and healthy. As a result, some of these people begin second
careers rather than focusing primarily on leisure activities or travel.44 To be
successful with early retirement, management must avoid several legal issues,
such as forced early retirement and pressuring older workers to resign.
COMMON INDIVIDUAL CAREER ISSUES
Four career issues are sufficiently common as to need individual treatment.
These are issues with technical and professional workers, women, dual-career
couples, and individuals with global careers.
Technical and Professional Workers
Technical and professional workers, such as engineers, scientists, and IT
systems experts, present a special challenge for organizations. Many of these
individuals want to stay in their technical areas rather than enter management; yet advancement in many organizations frequently requires a move
into management. Most of these people like the idea of the responsibility and
opportunity associated with professional advancement, but they do not want to
leave the professional and technical puzzles and problems at which they excel.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 299
26/06/10 5:17 PM
300
SECTION 3
Training and Development
An attempt to solve this problem, a dual-career ladder, is a system that
allows a person to advance up either a management or a technical/professional
ladder. Dual-career ladders are now used at many firms, most commonly in
technology-driven industries such as pharmaceuticals, chemicals, computers,
and electronics. For instance, a telecommunications firm created a dual-career
ladder in its IT department to reward talented technical people who do not
want to move into management. Different tracks, each with attractive job titles
and pay opportunities, are provided. Some health care organizations are using
“master” titles for senior experienced specialists such as radiologists and neonatal nurses who do not want to be managers. The masters often are mentors
and trainers for younger specialists. Unfortunately, the technical/professional
ladder may be viewed as “second-class citizenship” within some organizations.
Women and Careers
According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, the percentage of women in
the workforce has more than doubled since 1970, and will reach almost 50%
in the decade following 2010. Women are found in all occupations and jobs,
but their careers may have a different element than those of men. Women give
birth to children, and in most societies they are also primarily responsible for
taking care of their children. The effect of this biology and sociology is that
women’s careers are often interrupted for childbirth and child rearing.45
Work, Family, and Careers The career approach for women frequently is to
work hard before children arrive, plateau or step off the career track when children are younger, and go back to career-focused jobs that allow flexibility when
they are older. This approach is referred to as sequencing. But some women
who sequence are concerned that the job market will not welcome them when
they return, or that the time away will hurt their advancement chances. And
indeed, many women’s careers are stifled due to their career interruptions.46
The interaction and conflicts among home, family, and a career affect the
average woman differently than they do men. By the time men and women
have been out of school for 6 years, on average women have worked much less
time than men. These and other career differences provide different circumstances for many females. Employers can tap into the female labor market to
a greater extent with child-care assistance, flexible work policies, and a general
willingness to be accommodating.
Glass Ceiling Another concern specifically affecting women is the “glass ceiling.” This issue describes the situation in which women fail to progress into
top and senior management positions. Nationally, women hold about half of
managerial/ professional positions but only 10% to 15% of corporate officer
positions.47 Some organizations provide leaves of absence, often under FMLA
provisions, but take steps to keep women who are away from work involved in
their companies. Some have used e-mentoring for women temporarily off their
jobs. Other firms use “phased returns” whereby women employees return to
work part-time and then gradually return to full-time schedules. Consequently,
in the United States, women are making slow but steady strides into senior
management and executive positions.
Dual-career ladder
System that allows a person
to advance up either a
management or a technical/
professional ladder.
Dual-Career Couples
As the number of women in the workforce continues to increase, particularly in professional careers, so does the number of dual-career couples. The
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 300
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
301
Talent Management
U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics estimates that more than 80% of all couples
are dual-career couples. Marriages in which both mates are managers,
professionals, or technicians have doubled over the past two decades.48
Problem areas for dual-career couples include family issues and job transfers
that require relocations.
Family-Career Issues For dual-career couples with children, family issues
may conflict with career progression. Thus, one partner’s flexibility may depend
on what is “best” for the family.49 Additionally, it is important that the career
development problems of dual-career couples be recognized as early as possible. Whenever possible, having both partners involved in planning, even when
one is not employed by the company, may enhance the success of such efforts.
Relocation of Dual-Career Couples Traditionally, employees accepted
transfers as part of upward mobility in organizations. However, for some
dual-career couples, the mobility required because of one partner’s transfer
often interferes with the other’s career. In addition to having two careers, dualcareer couples often have established support networks of coworkers, friends,
and business contacts to cope with both their careers and their personal
lives. Relocating one partner in a dual-career couple may mean upsetting this
carefully constructed network for the other person or creating a “commuting”
relationship. Recruiting a member of a dual-career couple to a new location
may mean HR assistance in finding an equally attractive job available for the
candidate’s partner at the new location through assistance for the nonemployee partner.50 The HR On-the-Job highlights the common global relocation
issues faced by firms with employees having dual-career jobs.
HR on-the-job
Handling Global Dual-Career
Situations
Special difficulties exist when individuals transfer to overseas jobs.
For example, a spouse who wants
to work may not be able to get a
work permit, may find that local
G L O B A L
residents have priority in the job
market, or may find incompatible certification/
licensing. In particular, women partners may have
difficulty finding employment opportunities in
certain countries due to cultural and religious
considerations. Only a small percentage of spouses
and partners of expatriates are employed during their
partners’ international assignments. This disparity
is one reason why a number of expatriates do not
complete the full term of their overseas jobs.
When setting HR policies for global employee
relocation assistance, organizations must consider
the concerns of dual-career couples. The following
approaches can help them reduce the problems
faced in such situations:
•
•
•
•
Pay employment agency fees for the
relocating partner.
Compensate for a designated number of trips
for the partner to look for a job in the proposed new location.
Help the partner find a job in the same
company or in another division or subsidiary
of the company in the new geographic
location.
Develop computerized job banks to share
with other global companies and employers
in the new area that list partners available
for job openings.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 301
26/06/10 5:17 PM
302
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Global Career Concerns
G L O B A L
Insecurity caused by layoffs and downsizings marks a trend that contrasts
with the trend toward personal control over career goals. A number of older
male American workers express fear of losing their jobs. But this situation
is not just a U.S. phenomenon. Many Japanese workers who have typically
worked for the same company their entire lives are experiencing similar job
insecurity. In Europe, employers are pressuring governments to dismantle outmoded labor rules that make eliminating employees difficult, while workers
are pressuring the same governments to alleviate high unemployment rates. As
a result, careers for many individuals worldwide contain both more flexibility
and more insecurity.51
Many global employees experience anxiety about their continued career
progression. Therefore, the international experiences of expatriates must offer
benefits both to the employer and to expatriates in terms of their careers.52
Firms sometimes address this issue by bringing expatriates back to the home
country for development programs and interaction with other company managers and professionals. Another potentially useful approach is to establish a
mentoring system that matches an expatriate with a corporate executive at the
headquarters.
Repatriation The issue of repatriation involves planning, training, and reassignment of global employees back to their home countries. For example, after
expatriates are brought home, often they no longer receive special compensation packages available to them during their assignments. The result is that they
experience a net decrease in total income, even if they receive promotions and
pay increases. In addition to dealing with concerns about personal finances,
returning expatriates often must reacclimate to U.S. lifestyles, transportation
services, and other cultural circumstances, especially if they have been living
in less-developed countries.
Many expatriates have had a greater degree of flexibility, autonomy, and
independent decision making while living overseas than their counterparts in
the United States. Back in the home organization, repatriated employees must
readjust to closer working and reporting relationships with other corporate
employees.
Another major concern focuses on the organizational status of expatriates
upon return. Many expatriates wonder what jobs they will have, whether their
international experiences will be valued, and how they will be accepted back
into the organization. Unfortunately, many global employers do a poor job of
repatriation. To counter this problem, some companies provide career planning, mentoring programs, and even guarantees of employment on completion
of foreign assignments.
Repatriation Planning,
training, and reassignment of
global employees back to their
home countries.
Global Development Global managers are more expensive than homecountry managers, and more problematic as well.53 Most global firms have
learned that it is often a mistake to staff foreign operations with only personnel from headquarters, and they quickly hire nationals to work in a country.
For this reason, global management development must focus on developing
local managers as well as global executives. Development areas typically
include such items as cultural issues, running an international business,
leadership/management skills, handling problematic people, and personal
qualities.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 302
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
303
Talent Management
DEVELOPING HUMAN RESOURCES
Development represents efforts to improve employees’ abilities to handle a
variety of assignments and to cultivate employees’ capabilities beyond those
required by the current job. Development can benefit both organizations and
individuals. Employees and managers with appropriate experiences and abilities may enhance organizational competitiveness and the ability to adapt to a
changing environment. In the development process, individuals’ careers also
may evolve and gain new or different focuses.
Development differs from training. It is possible to train people to answer
customer service questions, drive a truck, enter data in a computer system, set
up a drill press, or assemble a television. However, development in areas such
as judgment, responsibility, decision making, and communication presents a
bigger challenge. These areas may or may not develop through ordinary life
experiences of individuals. A planned system of development experiences for all
employees, not just managers, can help expand the overall level of capabilities in
an organization. Figure 9-7 profiles development and compares it with training.
Possible Development Focuses
Development Efforts to
improve employees’ abilities
to handle a variety of
assignments and to cultivate
employees’ capabilities
beyond those required by the
current job.
FIGURE 9-7
Some important and common management capabilities that may require
development include an action orientation, quality decision-making skills,
ethical values, and technical skills. Abilities to build teams, develop subordinates, direct others, and deal with uncertainty are equally important but
much less commonly developed capabilities for successful managers. For some
tech specialties (tech support, database administration, network design, etc.),
certain nontechnical abilities must be developed as well: ability to work under
pressure, to work independently, to solve problems quickly, and to use past
knowledge in a new situation.
Development versus Training
Training
Focus
Time Frame
Effectiveness
Measures
Learn specific behaviors
and actions
Demonstrate techniques
and processes
Shorter term
Performance appraisals
Cost–benefit analysis
Passing tests
Certification
Development
Understand information
concepts and context
Develop judgment
Expand capacities for
assignments
Longer term
Availability of qualified
people when needed
Possibility of promotion
from within
HR-based competitive
advantage
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 303
26/06/10 5:17 PM
304
SECTION 3
Training and Development
One point about development is clear: in numerous studies that asked
employees what they want out of their jobs, training and development ranked
at or near the top. The primary assets that individuals have are their knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs), and many people view the development of
their KSAs as an important part of their jobs.
Lifelong Learning Learning and development are closely linked. For most
people, lifelong learning and development are likely and desirable. For many
professionals, lifelong learning may mean meeting continuing education
requirements to retain certificates. For example, lawyers, CPAs, teachers, dentists, and nurses must complete continuing education requirements in most
states to keep their licenses to practice. For other employees, learning and
development may involve training to expand existing skills and to prepare for
different jobs, for promotions, or even for new jobs after retirement.
Assistance from employers for needed lifelong development typically
comes through programs at work, including tuition reimbursement programs.
However, much of lifelong learning is voluntary, takes place outside work
hours, and is not always formal. Although it may have no immediate relevance
to a person’s current job, learning often enhances an individual’s confidence,
ideas, and enthusiasm.
Redevelopment Whether due to a desire for career change or because the
employer needs different capabilities, people may shift jobs in midlife or
mid-career. Redeveloping people in the capabilities they need is logical and
important. In the last decade, the number of college enrollees
LOGGING ON
over the age of 35 has increased dramatically. But helping
employees go back to college is only one way of redevelopThe Community Training &
ing them. Some companies offer redevelopment programs to
Development Centre
recruit experienced workers from other fields. For example,
For specialized programs and
different firms needing truck drivers, reporters, and IT workservices for learning and lifelong
ers have sponsored second-career programs. Public-sector
development, visit this website at
www.ctdclearningplace.com.
employers have used redevelopment opportunities as a
recruiting tool.
Development Needs Analyses
Like employee training, employee development begins with analyses of the
needs of both the organization and the individuals. Either the company or
the individual can analyze what a given person needs to develop. The goal, of
course, is to identify strengths and weaknesses. Methods that organizations
use to assess development needs include assessment centers, psychological testing, and performance appraisals.
Assessment centers
Collections of instruments
and exercises designed
to diagnose individuals’
development needs.
Assessment Centers Collections of instruments and exercises designed to
diagnose individuals’ development needs are referred to as assessment centers.
Organizational leadership uses assessment centers for both developing and
selecting managers. Many types of employers use assessment centers for a wide
variety of jobs.
In a typical assessment-center experience, an individual spends two or
three days away from the job performing many assessment activities. These
activities might include role-playing, tests, cases, leaderless-group discussions,
computer-based simulations, and peer evaluations. Frequently, they also
include in-basket exercises, in which the individual handles typical work and
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 304
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
305
management problems. For the most part, the exercises represent situations
that require the use of individual skills and behaviors. During the exercises,
several specially trained judges observe the participants.
Assessment centers provide an excellent means for determining individual
potential.54 Management and participants often praise them because they are
likely to overcome many of the biases inherent in interview situations, supervisor ratings, and written tests. Experience shows that key variables such as leadership, initiative, and supervisory skills cannot be measured with tests alone.
Assessment centers also offer the advantage of helping to identify employees
with potential in large organizations. Supervisors may nominate people for
the assessment center, or employees may volunteer. For talented people, the
opportunity to volunteer is invaluable because supervisors may not recognize
their potential interests and capabilities.
Assessment centers also can raise concerns. Some managers may use the
assessment center to avoid making difficult promotion decisions. Suppose a
plant supervisor has personally decided that an employee is not qualified for
promotion. Rather than being straightforward and informing the employee,
the supervisor sends the employee to the assessment center, hoping the report
will show that the employee is unqualified for promotion. Problems between
the employee and the supervisor may worsen if the employee earns a positive report. Using the assessment center for such purposes does not aid in the
development of employees, but such uses do occur.
Psychological Testing Psychological tests have been used for several years
to determine employees’ developmental potential and needs. Intelligence tests,
verbal and mathematical reasoning tests, and personality tests are often given.
Psychological testing can furnish useful information on individuals about
such factors as motivation, reasoning abilities, leadership style, interpersonal
response traits, and job preferences.
The biggest problem with psychological testing lies in interpretation,
because untrained managers, supervisors, and workers usually cannot accurately interpret test results. After a professional scores the tests and reports
the scores to someone in the organization, untrained managers may attach
their own meanings to the results. Also, some psychological tests are of limited
validity, and test takers may fake desirable responses. Thus, psychological testing is appropriate only when the testing and feedback processes are closely
handled by a qualified professional.
Performance Appraisals Well-done performance appraisals can be a source
of development information. Performance data on productivity, employee relations, job knowledge, and other relevant dimensions can be gathered in such
assessments. In this context, appraisals designed for development purposes,
discussed in more detail in Chapter 10, may be different and more useful in
aiding individual employee development than appraisals designed strictly for
administrative purposes.
HR DEVELOPMENT APPROACHES
Common development approaches can be categorized under three major headings, as Figure 9-8 depicts. Investing in human intellectual capital can occur on
or off the job and in “learning organizations.” Development becomes imperative
as “knowledge work,” such as research skills and specialized technology
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 305
26/06/10 5:17 PM
306
SECTION 3
FIGURE 9-8
Training and Development
HR Development Approaches
JOB-SITE APPROACHES
Coaching
Committees
Job rotation
“Assistant-to” position
OFF-SITE APPROACHES
Classroom courses
Seminars
Outdoor training
Sabbatical/leaves
LEARNING ORGANIZATION
Corporate universities
Career development
centers
E-development
Effective HR
Development
expertise, increases for almost all employers. But identifying the right mix of
approaches for development needs requires analyses and planning.
Job-Site Development Approaches
All too often, unplanned and perhaps useless activities pass as development
on the job. To ensure that the desired development actually occurs, managers
must plan and coordinate their development efforts. Managers can choose
from various job-site development methods.55
Coaching The oldest on-the-job development technique is coaching, which
is the training and feedback given to employees by immediate supervisors.
Coaching involves a continual process of learning by doing. For coaching to
be effective, employees and their supervisors or managers must have a healthy
and open relationship. Many firms conduct formal courses to improve the
coaching skills of their managers and supervisors.56
The success of coaching is being seen in companies throughout the world.
One type of coaching that is growing is team coaching. This approach focuses
on coaching groups of individual employees on how to work more effectively
as parts of workforce teams. Such team efforts may utilize outside consultants
and cover many different areas. Group coaching on leadership may help create
high-performance teams.
Unfortunately, organizations may be tempted to implement coaching without
sufficient planning. Even someone who is good at a job or a particular part of a
job will not necessarily be able to coach someone else to do it well. “Coaches”
can easily fall short in guiding learners systematically, even if they know which
experiences are best.57 Often the coach’s job responsibilities take priority over
learning and coaching of subordinates. Also, the intellectual component of many
capabilities might be better learned from a book or a course before coaching
occurs. Outside consultants may be used as coaches at the executive level.
Committee Assignments Assigning promising employees to important
committees may broaden their experiences and help them understand the
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 306
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
307
personalities, issues, and processes governing the organization. For instance,
employees on a safety committee can gain a greater understanding of safety
management, which would help them to become supervisors. They also may
experience the problems involved in maintaining employee safety awareness.
However, managers need to guard against committee assignments that turn
into time-wasting activities.
Job Rotation The process of moving a person from job to job is called job
rotation. It is widely used as a development technique. For example, a promising
young manager may spend 3 months in a plant, 3 months in corporate planning,
and 3 months in purchasing. When properly handled, such job rotation fosters
a greater understanding of the organization and aids with employee retention
by making individuals more versatile, strengthening their skills, and reducing
boredom. When opportunities for promotion within a smaller or medium-sized
organization are scarce, job rotation through lateral transfers may help rekindle
enthusiasm and develop employees’ talents. A disadvantage of job rotation is
that it can be expensive because a substantial amount of time is required to
acquaint trainees with the different people and techniques in each new unit.
Assistant Positions Some firms create assistant positions, which are staff
positions immediately under a manager (e.g., Assistant to HR Director).
Through such jobs, trainees can work with outstanding managers they
might not otherwise have met. Some organizations set up “junior boards of
directors” or “management cabinets” to which trainees may be appointed.
These assignments provide useful experiences if they present challenging or
interesting tasks to trainees.
Off-Site Development Approaches
Off-the-job development techniques give individuals opportunities to get away
from their jobs and concentrate solely on what is to be learned. Moreover,
contact with others who are concerned with somewhat different problems
and come from different organizations may provide employees with new and
different perspectives. Various off-site methods can be used.
Classroom Courses and Seminars Most off-the-job development programs include some classroom instruction. Most people are familiar with
classroom training, which gives it the advantage of being widely accepted. But
the lecture system sometimes used in classroom instruction encourages passive
listening and reduced learner participation, which is a distinct disadvantage.
Sometimes trainees have little opportunity to question, clarify, and discuss
the lecture material. The effectiveness of classroom instruction depends on
multiple factors: group size, trainees’ abilities, instructors’ capabilities and
styles, and subject matter.
Organizations often send employees to externally sponsored seminars or professional courses, such as those offered by numerous professional and consulting
entities. Many organizations also encourage continuing education by reimbursing employees for the costs of college courses. Tuition reimbursement programs
provide incentives for employees to study for advanced degrees through evening
and weekend classes that are outside their regular workdays and hours.
Job rotation Process of
moving a person from job to job.
Outdoor Development Experiences Some organizations send executives
and managers off to the wilderness, called outdoor training or outdoor
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 307
26/06/10 5:17 PM
308
SECTION 3
Training and Development
development. The rationale for using these wilderness excursions, which can
last one day or even seven days or longer, is that such experiences can increase
self-confidence and help individuals reevaluate personal goals and efforts. For
individuals in work groups or teams, shared risks and challenges outside the
office environment can create a sense of teamwork. The challenges may include
rock climbing in the California desert, whitewater rafting on a river, backpacking in the Rocky Mountains, or handling a longboat off the coast of Maine.
Survival-type management development courses may have more impact
than many other management seminars. But companies must consider the
inherent perils. Some participants have been unable to handle the physical
and emotional challenges associated with rappelling down a cliff or climbing
a 40-foot tower. The decision to sponsor such programs should depend on the
capabilities of the employees involved.
Sabbaticals and Leaves of Absence A sabbatical is time off the job to
develop and rejuvenate oneself. Some employers provide paid sabbaticals while
others allow employees to take unpaid sabbaticals. Popular for many years in
the academic world, sabbaticals have been adopted in the business community
as well.58 Some firms give employees 3 to 6 months off with pay to work on
“socially desirable” projects. Such projects have included leading training programs in urban ghettos, providing technical assistance in foreign countries, and
participating in corporate volunteer programs to aid nonprofit organizations.59
Companies that offer sabbaticals speak well of the results. Positive reasons for sabbaticals are to help prevent employee burnout, offer advantages
in recruiting and retention, and boost individual employee morale. Women
employees have made use of sabbaticals or leaves for family care reasons. The
value of this time off to employees is seen in better retention
of key women, who also often return more energized and
LOGGING ON
enthusiastic about their work-life balancing act. One obviThe Training Registry®
ous disadvantage of paid sabbaticals is the cost. Also, the
Information on more than 200 seminars
nature of the learning experience generally falls outside the
and video/interactive courses for
control of the organization, leaving it somewhat to chance.
management and organizational
development is available at this website.
Visit the site at www.tregistry.com.
Sabbatical Time off the job
to develop and rejuvenate
oneself.
Learning Organizations
and Development
As talent management becomes more important, employers may attempt to
become learning organizations. These organizations encourage development
efforts through shared information, culture, and leadership that stress the
importance of individual learning. This approach focuses on employees who
want to develop new capabilities, and they can learn from others in the organization because informal (and formal) teaching and learning is the norm in such
organizations.60 A learning mind-set is probably difficult to introduce into an
organization where it does not exist. But where it does exist, it represents a
significant potential for development. Figure 9-9 depicts some possible means
for developing employees in a learning organization.
Knowledge-based organizations that deal primarily with ideas and information must have employees who are experts at one or more conceptual
tasks. These employees continuously learn and solve problems in their areas
of expertise. Developing such employees requires an “organizational learning
capacity” based on solving problems and learning new ways not previously
used. Encouraging them to pass their knowledge on to others is the basis for
a learning organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 308
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
309
Talent Management
FIGURE 9-9
Possible Means for Developing Employees in
a Learning Organization
Means
Informal development
Formal development
Team sharing
Coaching or mentoring
Observation
Individual development plans
Job rotation
Result
Individual learning
and development
Corporate Universities and Career Development Centers Large
organizations may use corporate universities to develop managers and other
employees. Corporate universities take various forms.61 Sometimes regarded as
little more than fancy packaging for company training, they may not provide a
degree, accreditation, or graduation in the traditional sense. A related alternative, partnerships between companies and traditional universities, can occur
where the universities design and teach specific courses for employers.
Career development centers are often set up to coordinate in-house programs and programs provided by suppliers. They may include assessment data
for individuals, career goals and strategies, coaching, seminars, and online
approaches.
E-Development The rapid growth in technology has led to more use of
e-development. Online development can take many forms, such as video conferencing, live chat rooms, document sharing, video and audio streaming, and
Web-based courses. HR staff members can facilitate online development by
providing a learning portal, which is a centralized website for news, information, course listings, business games, simulations, and other materials.
Online development allows participation in courses previously out of
reach due to geographic or cost considerations. It allows costs to be spread
over a larger number of people, and it can be combined with virtual reality
and other technological tools to make presentations more interesting. It can
eliminate travel costs as well. When properly used, e-development is a valuable
HR development tool. However, the lack of realism can diminish the learning
experience. The focus must be learning, not just “using the technology.”
MANAGEMENT DEVELOPMENT
Although development is important for all employees, it is essential for managers. Without appropriate development, managers may lack the capabilities
to best deploy and manage resources (including employees) throughout the
organization.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 309
26/06/10 5:17 PM
310
Training and Development
SECTION 3
FIGURE 9-10
Management Lessons Learned from Job Experience
SOURCES OF MANAGERS’ LEARNING
JOB TRANSITIONS
New jobs
Problems
New people
Changes in
responsibilities
CHALLENGES
Starting or changing
some major organizational
feature
Having decision-making
responsibility
Influencing others
without formal authority
OBSTACLES
A bad job situation
A difficult boss
Demanding clients
Unsupportive peers
Negative economic
circumstances
LESSONS MANAGERS NEED TO LEARN
Setting agendas: Developing technical/business knowledge, taking
responsibility, setting goals
Handling relationships: Dealing successfully with people
Management values: Understanding successful management behavior
Personality qualities: Having the temperament necessary to deal with
the chaos and ambiguity of executive life
Self-awareness: Understanding oneself and how one affects others
Experience plays a central role in management development.62 Indeed,
experience often contributes more to the development of senior managers than
does classroom training, because much of it occurs in varying circumstances
on the job over time. Yet, in many organizations it is difficult to find managers for middle-level jobs. Some individuals refuse to take middle-management
jobs, feeling that they are caught between upper management and supervisors.
Similarly, not all companies take the time to develop their own senior-level
managers. Instead, senior managers and executives often are hired from the
outside. Figure 9-10 shows experience-based sources of managers’ learning
and lists some lessons important in effectively developing supervisors, middle
managers, and senior-level executives.
A number of approaches are used to mold and enhance the experiences
that managers need to be effective.63 The most widely used methods are supervisor development, leadership development, management modeling, management coaching, management mentoring, and executive education.
Supervisor Development
At the beginning level for managerial development is the first-line supervisory
job. It is often difficult to go from being a member of the work group to being the
boss. Therefore, the new supervisors who are used to functioning as individual
contributors often require new skills and mind-sets to be successful supervisors.
A number of employers conduct presupervisor training. This effort is done
to provide realistic job previews of what supervisors will face and to convey to
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 310
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
Talent Management
311
individuals that they cannot just rely on their current job skills and experience
in their new positions.
Development for supervisors may vary but usually contains common elements. The usual materials for supervisor training and development include
several topics: basic management responsibilities, time management, and
human relations.
Human Relations Training This type of training attempts to prepare supervisors to deal with “people problems” brought to them by their employees.
The training focuses on the development of the human relations skills a person
needs to work well with others. Most human relations programs are aimed
at new or relatively inexperienced first-line supervisors and middle managers. They cover motivation, leadership, employee communication, conflict
resolution, team building, and other behavioral topics.
The most common reason employees fail after being promoted to management is poor teamwork with subordinates and peers. Other common reasons
for management failure include not understanding expectations, failure to
meet goals, difficulty adjusting to management responsibilities, and inability
to balance work and home lives.
Leadership Development
Organizations are aware that effective leaders create positive change and
are important for organizational success. Firms such as Johnson & Johnson,
General Electric, and 3M Company are among the top firms in leadership
development. Leadership development is expanding a person’s capacity to be
effective in leadership roles. This development occurs in many ways: classroom
programs, assessments, modeling, coaching, job assignments, mentoring, and
executive education.
While it is difficult to develop good leaders in one’s home country, it is
even more difficult to do so in another country.64 Also, although universities
produce smart, ambitious graduates with good technical skills, many graduates face a very steep learning curve when making the change from school into
leadership positions.65 The material that follows examines common ways to
help individuals in many different circumstances transition successfully into
leadership roles.
Modeling A common adage in management development says that managers tend to manage as they were managed. In other words, managers learn
by behavior modeling, or copying someone else’s behavior. This tendency is
not surprising, because a great deal of human behavior is learned by modeling. Children learn by modeling the behaviors of parents and older children.
Management development efforts can take advantage of natural human
behavior by matching young or developing managers with appropriate models
and then reinforcing the desirable behaviors exhibited by the learners. The
modeling process involves more than straightforward imitation or copying.
For example, one can learn what not to do by observing a model who does
something wrong. Thus, exposure to both positive and negative models can
benefit a new manager as part of leadership development efforts.
Coaching In the context of management development, coaching involves a
relationship between two individuals for a period of time as they perform their
jobs. Effective coaching requires patience and good communication skills.66
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 311
26/06/10 5:17 PM
312
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Coaching combines observation with suggestions. Like modeling, it complements the natural way humans learn. An outline of good coaching pointers
will often include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
Explain appropriate behaviors.
Make clear why actions were taken.
Accurately state observations.
Provide possible alternatives/suggestions.
Follow up and reinforce behaviors used.
A specific application of coaching is the use of leadership coaching.
Companies use outside experts as executive coaches to help managers improve
interpersonal skills or decision-making skills. Sometimes these experts are
used to help deal with problematic management styles. Consultants serving as
executive coaches predominantly come from a psychology or counseling background and can serve many roles for a client by providing key questions and
general directions. Sometimes they meet with employees in person, but many
do their coaching by phone or electronically. Research on the effectiveness
of coaching suggests that coaching can be beneficial in dealing with chronic
stress, psychological difficulties, and even physiological problems faced by
executives and managers.
Management Mentoring A method called management mentoring is a
relationship in which experienced managers aid individuals in the earlier
stages of their careers.67 Such a relationship provides an environment for
conveying technical, interpersonal, and organizational skills from a moreexperienced person to a designated less-experienced person. Not only does
the inexperienced employee benefit, but the mentor also may enjoy having the
opportunity and challenge of sharing wisdom.68
Fortunately, many individuals have a series of advisors or mentors during their careers and may find advantages in learning from the different
mentors. For example, the unique qualities of individual mentors may help
less-experienced managers identify key behaviors in management success and
failure.69 Additionally, those being mentored may find previous mentors to be
useful sources for networking. Figure 9-11 describes the four stages in most
successful mentoring relationships.
In virtually all countries in the world, the proportion of women holding
management jobs is lower than the proportion of men holding such jobs.
Similarly, the number of racial and ethnic minorities who fill senior management positions is less than 10%. Unfortunately, younger minority employees
and managers may have difficulty finding mentors.70 Company mentoring
programs that focus specifically on women and individuals of different racial/
ethnic backgrounds have been successful in a number of larger firms. Based on
various narratives of successful women executives, breaking the glass ceiling
requires developing political sophistication, building credibility, and refining
management styles aided by mentoring.
Management mentoring
Relationship in which
experienced managers aid
individuals in the earlier
stages of their careers.
Executive Education Executives in an organization often face difficult
jobs due to changing and unknown circumstances. “Churning” at the top
of organizations and the stresses of executive jobs contribute to increased
turnover in these positions. In an effort to decrease turnover and increase
management development capabilities, organizations are using specialized
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 312
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
313
Talent Management
Stages in Management Mentoring Relationships
F I G U R E 9 - 11
Less-Experienced
Manager
STAGE
Admires the senior
manager’s competence;
recognizes him or her
as a source of guidance
Initiation
LENGTH
OF TIME
More-Experienced
Manager
6–12
months
Realizes younger
manager has potential
and “is coachable”
Gains self-confidence,
values, and styles of
operation
Cultivation
2–5
years
Provides challenging
work, coaching,
visibility, protection,
and sponsorship
Experiences
independence but at
times has feelings of
anxiety and loss
Separation
6–12
months
Knows when to begin
to move away
Responds with gratitude
for the early years; finds
that the mentoring
relationship becomes a
friendship
Redefinition Ongoing
Continues to be a
supporter; takes pride in
the younger manager’s
accomplishments
education for executives. This type of training includes executive education
traditionally offered by university business schools and adds strategy formulation, financial models, logistics, alliances, and global issues. Enrollment in
Executive Masters of Business Administration (EMBA) degree programs is
popular also.
Problems with Management Development Efforts
Development efforts are subject to certain common mistakes and problems.
Many of the management development problems in firms have resulted from
inadequate HR planning and a lack of coordination of HR development
efforts. Common problems include the following:
•
•
•
Failing to conduct adequate needs analysis
Trying out fad programs or training methods
Substituting training for selecting qualified individuals
Another common management problem is encapsulated development,
which occurs when an individual learns new methods and ideas, but returns to
a work unit that is still bound by old attitudes and methods. The development
was “encapsulated” in the classroom and is essentially not used on the job.
Consequently, in this situation, it is common for individuals who participate
in development programs paid for by their employers to become discouraged
and move to new employers that allow them to use their newly developed
capabilities more effectively.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 313
26/06/10 5:17 PM
314
SECTION 3
Training and Development
S U M M A R Y
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Talent management is growing in importance
because it is concerned with the attraction,
development, and retention of human resources.
Training, succession planning, career planning,
and performance management are crucial parts
of talent management.
Succession planning is the process that identifies
how key employees are to be replaced, including deciding whether to make or buy talent and
how to use electronic and Web-based succession
planning programs.
A number of different mistakes can occur in
succession planning, including focusing only on
CEO and senior management succession.
The nature of careers is changing, as retention of
employees and work-life balance have become
more important.
Career planning may focus on organizational
needs, individual needs, or both; and career
paths and employer websites are part of career
planning.
A person chooses a career according to interests,
self-image, personality, social background, and
other factors.
Several special individual career issues must be
addressed, including those related to technical
and professional workers.
Career issues for women may include workfamily balancing and glass ceiling concerns, as
well as being part of dual-career couples.
C R I T I C A L
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Global career development has special challenges, including relocations of dual-career couples, global development, and repatriation.
Development differs from training because it
focuses on less tangible aspects of performance,
such as attitudes and values.
Developing specific competencies may require
lifelong learning and redevelopment of employees.
Needs analyses for development may include
assessment centers, psychological testing, and
performance appraisals.
HR development approaches can involve jobsite, off-site, and learning organization activities.
On-the-job development methods include
coaching, committee assignments, job rotation,
and “assistant-to” positions.
Off-site development means often include classroom courses, seminars, and degrees; outdoor
experiences; and sabbaticals and leaves of
absences.
Learning organization development efforts
reflect knowledge-based means, such as corporate universities and centers and e-development
efforts.
Management development is a special focus in
many organizations, including supervisor development and leadership development.
Management modeling, coaching, and mentoring are valuable parts of management development efforts.
T H I N K I N G
1. Discuss what talent management is and why
it is a consideration addressed by a growing
number of employers.
2. Describe the broad range of talent management
efforts that use software applications by going
to www.learn.com. Then give some examples
of firms that have successfully used these
applications.
H R
•
E X P E R I E N T I A L
You are the HR Director of a large manufacturing
company that is approximately 50 years old. The
company has reaped the benefits of a mostly tenured
workforce, and many of the key workers are now
approaching retirement age. It is anticipated that
A C T I V I T I E S
3. How has the increase in uncertainty in business
affected the “make-or-buy” decision, and is this
trend likely to change?
4. Design a management development program
for first-level supervisors in an electric utility
company. What courses and experiences do
they need?
P R O B L E M
S O L V I N G
approximately 20% of the company’s workforce
will retire in the next 3 to 5 years. You also are planning to retire within that period of time. To assist
the company with the retirement transition process,
you want to present a business case to the President
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 314
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
315
Talent Management
for a succession plan for several key positions,
including the Chief Financial Officer and Director
of Operations. To develop an effective succession
plan, visit www.score.org/article_succession_plan
.html.
2. The successor employee for the replacement
of the Director of Operations should have an
advanced level of work experience in what key
essential functions?
1. Identify the outside company advisors who
should be included in the succession planning
process.
C A S E
Leadership Leverage
Gunderson Lutheran Health System in La Crosse,
Wisconsin, is a health care delivery company that
includes a 325-bed hospital, several specialty medical practices, and 41 clinics. In a recent year, they
saw 1.4 million outpatient visits. The network has
6,834 employees including physicians, medical
staff, managers and supervisors, and senior leaders. The age of their health care managers was a
concern when asked whether they had a ready
supply of leaders to step in. Upper management
felt that growing leaders internally made sense
from the standpoint of continuity and cultural fit.
The HR staff researched best practices in talent management and development. The result was
the establishment of a Talent Development Review
Group including the top leaders. This group
became accountable for developing leaders, making necessary development happen, and overseeing
the growth of high-potential (high-po) talent. The
Review Group followed five steps in their process.
1. They spent two years building a tiered
leadership competency model that included
criteria for executives, directors, and managers
to ensure the right mix of KSAs. The tiered
model defined behaviors and competencies
necessary to demonstrate excellence in
each role. The competencies were used for
behavioral interview questions and for position
descriptions, and they formed the basis for
360-degree feedback.
2. The next step was to identify high-potential
talent. The Review Group picked candidates
for consideration in each of four pools. Pool
members had to demonstrate willingness to:
• Advance
• Participate in leadership assessment
• Receive feedback and coaching
• Take on development opportunities
• Invest the necessary time
In the five years after the program began, 60
high-po employees at all levels of leadership
were identified, assessed, and had their career
paths discussed.
3. Once high-pos had been identified and invited
into a pool, it was time to assess the talent.
The high-pos took assessment tools to identify
strengths and development needs. Each
candidate and the Review Group determined
an initial strategy for closing gaps in the
candidate’s readiness.
4. A variety of tools were used to develop
plans for individual high-pos, including stretch
assignments, role expansion, job rotations,
coaching, onboarding, continuing education,
mentoring, project assignments, and committee
assignments.
5. Tracking progress included setting milestones
and success metrics to make sure candidates
would build the necessary skills. The effect of
the development activities on performance was
measured as well, with feedback from peers,
colleagues, and superiors. The Review Group
continues to look at progress annually.
While numbers tell a positive story, another
big change has been in the culture among the top
leaders, who now see talent development as a
strategic necessity.71
QUESTIONS
1. The top managers are very busy people. Why
was it necessary to involve them in leadership
leverage?
2. The program took 5 years to get to the end
point. Is that realistic, or did it take too long?
Explain why the timing may vary.
3. Would you let the names of the high-pos out to
the rest of the organization? Why or why not?
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 315
26/06/10 5:17 PM
316
SECTION 3
Training and Development
S U P P L E M E N T A L
C A S E S
Equipping for the Future
Developed Today, Gone Tomorrow
This case shows how one company in the oil
industry started a succession planning program.
For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/
mathis.)
This case illustrates a serious concern some
employers have about developing employees only
to have them leave. For the case, go to www
.cengage.com/management/mathis.)
N O T E S
1. Geoff Colvin, “How Top Companies
Breed Stars,” CNN Money,
September 20, 2007, 1–5.
2. Matthew Guthridge, et al., “Making
Talent a Strategic Priority,” The
McKinsey Quarterly, January 2008,
2–9; David Semb, “The Upcoming
Crisis in Talent Management,” Chief
Learning Officer, October 2009,
54–56.
3. Mark Schoeff, Jr., “Skills of Recent
High School Graduates Leave
Employers Cold,” Workforce
Management, April 13, 2007, 1–2.
4. Guthridge, op. cit., 54, 55.
5. “Two-Thirds of Companies Are
Not Prepared for Sudden Loss of
Leadership,” WorldatWork, August
14, 2008, 1; “Few Companies Can
Execute Their Talent Management
Plan,” WorldatWork, October 30,
2008, 1.
6. Ibid.
7. Edward Lawler, Talent: Making
People Your Competitive Advantage
(Jossey-Bass, 2008).
8. Peter Cappelli, “A Supply Chain
Model for Talent Management,”
People and Strategy, 32 (2009), 5.
9. Helene Cavalli, “Development
Opportunities Most Important to
Job Seekers,” LinkedIn, December 1,
2009, 1–3.
10. Matthew Guthridge and Asmus
Komm, “Why Multi-Nationals
Struggle to Manage Talent,” The
McKinsey Quarterly, May 2008, 2.
11. “Talent Management Continues to
Go High Tech,” HR Focus, October
2009, 8–9.
12. Ed Fravenheim, “Special Report on
HR Technology—Talent Planning for
the Times,” Workforce Management,
October 19, 2009, 37–43.
13. Grae Yohe, “The Talent Solution,”
Human Resource Executive, June 2,
2009, 1ff.
14. Ed Fravenheim, “Style Over
Substance?” Workforce
Management, May 19, 2008, 30.
15. Peter Cappelli, “The Great Circle
of Talent Management,” Human
Resource Executive Online, August 20,
2007, www.hreonline.com, 1–3; Peter
Cappelli, “Talent Management Cycles:
Part II,” Human Resource Executive
Online, September 17, 2007, www
.hreonline.com, 1–3.
16. Adrienne Hedger, “How to Improve
Talent Management?” Workforce
Management, September 8, 2008,
54; Jon Younger, et al., “Developing
Your Organization’s Brand as a
Talent Developer,” Human Resource
Planning, 30 (2007), 23.
17. P. Cappelli, 2009, 6.
18. B. Behan, “Lesson from VOA:
Avoiding a Succession Debate,”
BusinessWeek Online, October 7,
2009, 1.
19. Stephan Miles and Theodore
Dysart, “Road Map for Successful
Succession Planning,” Directors and
Boards, First Quarter 2008, 57–59.
20. Dan Dalton and Catherine Dalton,
“CEO Succession: Best Practices in
a Changing Environment,” Journals
of Business Strategy, 28 (2007),
11–13.
21. Charles Greer and Meghna Virick,
“Diverse Succession Planning
Lessons from the Industry Leaders,”
Human Resource Management
(2009), 351–367.
22. Jennifer Robison, “Scientific,
Systematic Succession Planning,”
Gallup Management Journal, June 2,
2009, 1–6.
23. Steve Schumacher, “Passing the
Torch,” Rock Products, October
2008, 32–34.
24. Matt Boyle, “The Art of Succession,”
BusinessWeek, May 11, 2009,
30–32.
25. Jayson Saba and Kevin Martin,
“Succession Management,”
Aberdeen Group, 2008, 2–28.
26. “Succession Success,” Human
Resource Executive, July 2008,
22–27.
27. Karen Jarrell and Kyle Pewitt,
“Succession Planning in
Government,” Review of Public
Personnel Administration, 27 (2007),
297–309.
28. Paula Ketter, “Sounding Succession
Alarms,” T + D, January 2009, 20.
29. Traci McCready and Chris Hatcher,
“How to Align Career Development
and Succession Planning,”
Workspan, March 2009, 61–63.
30. Edward Lawler III, “Choosing the
Right Talent,” Workspan, July 2008,
73–75.
31. Kathy Gurchiek, “Career
Development Gets Failing Grade
from Many Workers,” 2008 HR
Trendbook, 49–50.
32. Ronan Carbery and Thomas
Garavan, “Conceptualizing the
Participation of Managers in CareerFocused Learning and Development,”
Human Resource Development
Journal, 6 (2007), 396–397.
33. Kathryn Tyler, “Helping Employees
Step Up,” HR Magazine, August
2007, 49.
34. Jane Sturges, “All in a Day’s Work?”
Human Resource Management
Journal, 18 (2008), 132.
35. Kathy Gurchiek, “Telecommuting
Becomes Succession Planning
Tool,” HR News, July 14, 2008,
www.shrm.org, 1–3.
36. Yongho Park and William Rothwell,
“The Effects of Organizational
Learning Climate, Career
Enhancing Strategy, and Work
Orientation on the Protean Career,”
Human Resource Development
International, 8 (2009), 387–405.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 316
26/06/10 5:17 PM
CHAPTER 9
317
Talent Management
37. Lindsey Gerdes, “The Best Places to
Launch a Career,” BusinessWeek,
September 15, 2008, 37–44.
38. Dennis Laker and Ruth Laker,
“The Five Year Resume: A Career
Planning Exercise,” Journal of
Management Education, 31 (2007),
128–141.
39. Johannes Thijssen, et al., “Toward
the Employability Link Model,”
Human Resource Development
Review, 7 (2008), 164–183.
40. Nancy Wendlandt and Aaron
Rochler, “Addressing the College to
Work Transition,” Journal of Career
Development, 35 (2008), 151–165.
41. Thomas Ng and Daniel Feldman,
“The School to Work Transition: A
Role Identity Perspective,” Journal
of Vocational Behavior, 71 (2007),
114–134.
42. Marjorie Armstrong-Stassen,
“Organizational Practices and
the Post Retirement Employment
Experience of Older Workers,”
Human Resource Management
Journal, 18 (2008), 36–53.
43. Collin Barr, “Pension Tension on
the Rise,” Fortune CNN Money,
November 30, 2009, 1–3.
44. “Millions Now in ‘Encore’ Careers,”
WorldatWork Newsline, June 18,
2008, www.worldatwork.org, 1.
45. Sherry Sullivan and Lisa Mainiero,
“Benchmarking Ideas for Fostering
Family Friendly Workplaces,”
Organizational Dynamics, 36, 2007,
45–62.
46. Cari Tuna, “Initiative Moves
Women Up the Corporate Ladder,”
The Wall Street Journal, October 20,
2008, B4.
47. Jessica Marquez, “Gender
Discrimination Begins Much Earlier
than Exec Levels, Report Shows,”
Workforce Management, May 12,
2009, 1–3.
48. Cathy Arnst, “Women Want
Careers Just as Much as Men,”
BusinessWeek, March 27, 2009, 1.
49. Joy Pixley, “Life Course Patterns
of Career Prioritizing Decisions
and Occupational Attainment in
Dual-Earner Couples,” Work and
Occupations, 35 (2008), 127–162.
50. Michael Harvey, et al., “Global
Dual-Career Exploration and
the Role of Hope and Curiosity,”
Journal of Management Psychology,
24 (2009), 178–197.
51. Jena McGregor and Steve Hamm,
“Managing the Workforce,”
BusinessWeek, January 28, 2008,
34–51.
52. Jean-Luc Cerdin and Marie Le
Pargneux, “Career and International
Assignment Fit,” Human Resource
Management, January–February
2009, 5–25.
53. Bill Leisy and N. S. Rajan, “Global
Talent Management,” Workspan,
March 2009, 39–45.
54. Jayson Saba, et al., “Assessments
in Talent Management,” Aberdeen
Group, 2009, www.aberdeen.com,
1–23.
55. Alina Dizik, “Training Without a
Campus,” The Wall Street Journal,
April 15, 2009, D4.
56. “Employees Want to Be Challenged
by Coaches,” WorldatWork
Newsline, December 12, 2008, 1–2.
57. “What Is a Coaching Culture?”
Coaching Conundrum 2009 Global
Executive Summary, Blessing White,
2009, 5–23.
58. Frank Giancola, “Making Sense of
Sabbaticals,” Workspan, July 2006,
39–41.
59. Beth Mirza, “Build Employee Skills,
Help Non Profits,” HR Magazine,
October 2008, 30.
60. Jia Wang, “Developing Organizational
Learning Capacity in Crises
61.
62.
63.
64.
65.
66.
67.
68.
69.
70.
71.
Management,” Advances in
Developing Human Resources, 10
(2008), 425–444; Paul Tosey and Jane
Mathison, “Do Organizations Learn?”
Human Resource Management
Review, 7 (2008), 13–31.
Desda Moss, “A Lesson in
Learning,” HR Magazine, November
2007, 31–52.
Donna Owens, “Success Factors,”
HR Magazine, August 2008,
87–89.
Lisa Dragoni, et al., “Understanding
Management Development,”
Academy of Management Journal,
52 (2009), 731–743.
Mary Siegfried, “Filling the
Leadership Void,” Inside Supply
Management, April 2007, 22–26.
E. Norman, “Develop Leadership
Talent During a Recession,”
Workspan, May 2009, 35–42.
Robert Hooijberg and Nancy
Lane, “Using Multisource
Feedback Coaching Effectively
in Executive Education,”
Academy of Management
Learning and Education, 8 (2009),
483–493.
Lillian Eby, et al., “Does Mentoring
Matter?” Journal of Vocational
Behavior, 72 (2008), 254–267.
Susan Wells, “Tending Talent,” HR
Magazine, May 2009, 53–56.
Sarah Hazlett and Sharon Gibson,
“Linking Mentoring and Social
Capitol,” Advances in Developing
Human Resources, 9 (2007),
384–411.
Mario Gardiner, et al., “Show Me
the Money,” Higher Education
Research and Development, 27
(2007), 425–442.
Based on Nancy Noelke, “Leverage
the Present to Build the Future,”
HR Magazine, March 2009,
34–36.
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 317
26/06/10 5:17 PM
C H A P T E R
10
Performance
Management and
Appraisal
After you have read this chapter, you should be able to:
•
Identify the components of performance management
systems.
•
Distinguish between performance management and
performance appraisal.
•
Explain the differences between administrative and
developmental uses of performance appraisal.
•
Describe the advantages and disadvantages of multisource
(360-degree) appraisals.
•
Discuss the importance of training managers and
employees about performance appraisal, and give
examples of rater errors.
•
Identify several concerns about appraisal feedback and
ways to make it more effective.
318
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 318
26/06/10 5:19 PM
HR Headline
Performance Management Does Not
Focus Enough on Ethics
A
(Ryan McVay/Photodisc/Getty Images)
recent study determined that many
organizations do not focus enough
on ethics when managing performance. For instance, only 43% of HR practitioners indicated that their employers included
measures of ethics on performance evaluations. Making matters worse, professionals
claimed that they were expected to take an
active role in managing ethics, but many felt
disconnected from the process. Further, many
companies do not have a comprehensive
program that raises awareness of ethics, and
some companies have developed no ethics
policies whatsoever. Such findings are troubling considering that problems are common.
Organizations need to develop standards governing how employees are
expected to behave.1
Given these realities, HR professionals should be involved in the development of those standards. Performance management practices such as
evaluation forms should include measures that identify positive behaviors. HR professionals also need to create comprehensive programs that
increase the motivation to take appropriate actions. Developing codes of
conduct that outline company guidelines, offering training that teaches
employees important workplace values, and increasing communication
of important job standards can all work together to promote an ethical
culture. In additon, reinforcement programs should be developed so that
positive behaviors are rewarded and undesirable behaviors are punished.
HR managers need to be in the “driver’s seat” when it comes to encouraging ethics.
319
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 319
26/06/10 5:19 PM
320
SECTION 3
Training and Development
Employers want employees who perform their jobs well and contribute to
the mission and objectives of the organization, but managers have to provide
the proper context for such high productivity. Performance management is the
primary tool used to identify, communicate, measure, and reward employees
so that they can make these contributions, and the process is one that supports
a company’s strategic direction. Properly designing the performance management system is therefore a key method for increasing overall organizational
performance.
THE NATURE OF PERFORMANCE MANAGEMENT
The performance management process starts by identifying the strategic goals
an organization needs to accomplish to remain competitive and profitable.
After these ideas are crystallized, managers identify how they and their
employees can help support organizational objectives by successfully completing work. In a sense, the sum of the work completed in all jobs should
advance the strategic plan. By adopting a “big-picture” quantitative approach,
managers can successfully combine individual efforts in a manner that provides practical measures of organizational effectiveness. Performance management can also provide a unified approach to dealing with individual career
development.2
As Figure 10-1 shows, performance management links organizational
strategy to ultimate results. Performance management enables a company to
convert overall strategy into results that support the mission and objectives.
However, just having a strategic plan does not guarantee that results will be
achieved and objectives will be satisfied. When organizational strategies have
been defined, they must be translated into department- or unit-level actions.
Then these actions must be assigned to individuals who are held accountable
for efficient and effective goal accomplishment.3
Often performance management is confused with one of its key components—performance appraisal. Performance management is a series of activities designed to ensure that the organization gets the performance it needs
from its employees. Performance appraisal is the process of determining how
well employees do their jobs relative to a standard and communicating that
information to them.
An effective performance management system should do the following:
Performance
management Series of
activities designed to ensure
that the organization gets the
performance it needs from its
employees.
Performance appraisal
Process of determining how
well employees do their
jobs relative to a standard
and communicating that
information to them.
•
•
•
•
Make clear what the organization expects
Provide performance information to employees
Identify areas of success and needed development
Document performance for personnel records
Performance management starts with the development and understanding of organizational strategy, and then dovetails into a series of steps that
involves identifying performance expectations, providing performance direction, encouraging employee participation, assessing job performance, and
conducting the performance appraisal. As Figure 10-2 suggests, successful performance management is a circular process that requires a system of administrative tools that effectively structures the dialogue between managers and
their employees, and the motivation to utilize the system in a productive way.4
A successful performance management system allows managers to better
prepare employees to tackle their work responsibilities by focusing on
Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part.
5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 320
26/06/10 5:19 PM
CHAPTER 10
321
Performance Management and Appraisal
FIGURE 10-1
Performance Management Linkage
Organizational Strategies
Performance Management
Identify expected performance levels
Encourage high levels of performance
Measure individual performance; then evaluate
Provide feedback on individual performance
Provide assistance as needed
Reward or discipline depending on performance
Employee Performance
Performance Management Outcomes
Pay increases
Incentive rewards
Promotions/advancement
Training and development
Career planning
Disciplinary actions
Organizational Results
Goals met or not met
Employee satisfaction or dissatisfaction strong or weak
Coordination between performance and pay
these activities. For example, the software company CA recently revised its
performance review procedures so that the process would better facilitate
individual motivation and growth. Employees are rated on standardized job
criteria, complete self-evaluations, and are given completed evaluation forms
several days ahead of appraisal meetings to consider ratings. “Performance
agreements” explicitly connect individual actions to corporate goals, and the
whole process of performance management is strengthened through positive
communication.5
Even well-intentioned employees do not always know what is expected or
how to improve their performance, which also makes performance management necessary. A
Download